Skip to main content

Full text of "The new botanic garden"

See other formats


THE   NEW 


BOTANIC   GARDEN, 


1 


Acanthus 


t 
Deanr 


fiyrart: 

A-fcUptaj      tub  ere  so. 

f '/  -I I  /ft/ 1         .l/'l  'I'  V //  It  HI 


THE  NEW 


BOTANIC    GARDEN, 


ILLUSTRATED    WITH 


ENGRAVED  BY  SANSOM, 

FROM    THE 

ORIGINAL    PICTURES, 

AND 

COLOURED  WITH  THE  GREATEST  EXACTNESS 

FROM 

DRAWINGS  BY  SYDENHAM  EDWARDS. 


IN    TWO    VOLUMES. 

VOL.  I. 

—        ^      — 

LONDON: 

PRINTED  FOR  JOHN  STOCKDALE,   PICCADILLY, 

BY  T.  SENSLET,  BOLT-COURT,  FLEET-STREET. 

1812. 


-,:,! 


•.I 


CONTENTS. 


Plate.  Page. 

1  f  Acanthus  Mollis  . . . .' Smooth  Bear's  Breech. 1 

t  Asclepias  Tuberosa Orange  Apocynum 4 

fAgrostemma  Coronaria Rose  Campion J 1 

-I  Anchusu  Officinalis Officinal  Bugloss 13 

\  Aquilegia  Canadensis Canadian  Columbine 15 

^.Actiea  Racemosa American  Herb  Christopher 18 

„  |  Agapanthus  Umbellatus African  Agapanthus 21 

\  Asphodelus  Luteus Yellow  Asphodel 23 

.  f  Anemone  Hortensis Star  Anemone 26 

1  Albuca  Minor Lesser  Albuca 37 

.  f  Arbutus  Unedo Strawberry  Tree 41 

t  Alyssum  Saxatila Yellow  Aiyssum 45 

g  f  Anthericum  Liliastrum Savoy  Anthericum 50 

1  Amaryllis  Formossima Jacobean  Amaryllis 54 

_  f  Aster  Amcllus Italian  Aster 66 

\  Amaranthiis  Hypochondriacus  ......  Prince's  Feather 72 

„  f  Apocynum  Androseemifolium Fly-Catching  Dog's-Bane 79 

I  Antirrhinum  Purpnreum Purple  Toad-Flax 82 

„  C  Argcmone  Mexicana Mexican  Argemone 89 

I  Azalia  Nudiftora  Coccinea Scarlet  Azalia 90 

10  \  Bignonia  Radicans Ash-Leaved  Trumpet  Flower 93 

1  Butomws  Umbellatus .., Flowering  Rush 97 

r  Bupleurum  Fruticosum Shrubby  Hare's-Ear 99 

11.)  Bulbocodiitm  Vernum Spring  Bulbocodium 101 

t  Blitum  Capitatum Berry-Headed  Straw berry-Blite 102 

0  f  Calla  JEthiopica Ethiopian  Calla 105 

"  \  Coroni/la  Emeris Scorpion  Senna 106 

C  Ca/ycant/ins  Floridus Carolina  Allspice 1 1O 

13  <  Cofutea  Arborescens Common  Bladder  Senna Ill 

(.  Ceunothus  Amcricanus New  Jersey  Tea-Tree 113 

e  Campanula  Rapunculoides Nettle-Leaved  Campanula '..117 

14.?  Crepis  Barbata Yellow  Hawkweed 123 

£  Convolvulus  Tricolor Small  Blue  Convovulus 124 


7135190 


CONTENTS. 

Hate.  Page. 

r  Chelone  Ob/igua Red-flowered  Chelone 128 

15  <  Colchicum  Autumnale Autumnal  Crocus 130 

(.  Catanancht  Cterulea Blue  Catananche  . . , 132 

fi  <  Convallaria  Majalis Lily  of  the  Valley   134 

0 1  Cerinthe  Major Great  Honey- Wort 136 

_  C  Chdidonium  Glaucum   Yellow-Horned  Poppy 138 

\  Cistus  Ladaniferus Gum  Cistus    139 

|H  f  Crassula  Coccinea Scarlet-flowered  Crassula 144 

\  Cytisus  Laburnum Laburnum 146 

C  Cyclamen  Persicum Persian  Cyclamen 149 

\  Crocus  Vernus Spring  Crocus 152 

Dahlia  Pinnata Purple  Dahlia 156 

Dahlia  Crocata Yellow  Dahlia ib. 

r  Daphne  Cneorum Trailing  Daphne   160 

1  Dracocephalum  Virginianum Virginian  Dragon's  Head 163 

e    f  Delphinium  Elatum Larkspur 167 

|  Dianthus  Barbatut Sweet  William 169 

e    C  Dodecatheon  Meadia Mead's  Oodecatheon 185 

[  Dictamnus  Albus White  Fraxinella 186 

Q    |  Eckinops  Sph&rocephalus Great  Globe  Thistle 189 

'    i  Ejyngium  Alpinum Alpine  Eryngo 190 

OA  C  Erica  Grandiflora Great-flowered  Heath    194 

'   {  Epilobium  Angustifolium Rose-Bay  Willow-Herb 202 

0  -  c  Fritillaria  Imperialis Crown  Imperial 204 

0 1  Fumaria  Cava Hollow-Rooted  Fumitory 207 

2^  f  Genliana  Acaulis Large-flowered  Gentian 2O9 

i  Glycine  Rubicunda Dingy-flowed  Glycine 212 

Helleborus  Viridis Green  Hellebore 215 


20 


2_ 

Hypericum  Hircinum Fetid  St.  John's  Wort 218 

oft  f  Hemerocallis  Fulva Town  Lily 22 1 

'    (.  Hibiscus  Syriacus Althea  Frutex 223 

QQ  f  Ixia  Chinerisis Chinese  Ixia 227 

1  Iberis  Gibraltarica Gibraltar  Candy  Tuft 232 

f  Iris  Germanica German  Iris 235 

30-?  Iris  Versicolor Various-coloured  Iris ib. 

(_  Iris  Varieguta Variegated  Iris ib. 

.. .  C  Knl in'ui  Glauca Glaucous  Kalinin 245 

I  Linum  Arbareum Tree  Flax 247 

'32  /  ffelianthwt  Multiflorm Perennial  Sun-flower 252 

i  Hedysarum  Obscurum. Creeping-Rooted  Hedysarum 255 

33  f  Lavatera  Trimestris Annual  Lavatera 258 

|  Lathyrus  Sativus Blue-flowered  Lathy rus 203 

t  Lychnis  Chalcedonica Scarlet  Lychnis 266 

34  ^  Leucojum  Ve.rnu.rn Spring  Snow-Flake 27 1 

(  Lysimachia  Nummularia  ..........  Creeping  Moneywort , ,  274 


CONTENTS. 

Plats.  Page. 

-  f  Lobelia  Carditialii Scarlet  Lobelia,  or  Cardinal's  flower . . .  276 

i  Lilium  Candidum White  Lily 279 

f  Mirabilh  Jalapa Marvel  of  Peru 288 

36 )  Mimosa  Sensitiva Sensitive  Plant 292 

(.Monarda  Didyma Scarlet  Monarda 303 

„_  f  Nigel/a  Damascena Love  in  a  Mist.     Devil  in  a  Bush 306 

|  Narcissus  Jonquil/a Jonquil 309 

„„  y  Nelumbium  Speciosum Chinese  Water-Lily 317 

'    £  No/ana  Prostrata Trailing  Nolana ib. 

f  Oenothera  Fruticosa Shrubbery  Oenothera 319 

1  Organum  Dictamnus Dittany  of  Crete ,, 323 

40  (  Primula  Veris Oxlip 307 

'    t  Pteonia  Tetiuifolia Fine-leaved  Paeony 342 

f  Pancratium  Maritimum Sea  Pancratium 347 

1  Soldanella  Alpina Alpine  Soldanella 350 

r  Papaver  Orientate Eastern  Poppy 352 

I  Pulmonaria  Firgi/iica Virginian  Lung- Wort 355 

f  Philadelphus  Coronarius Common  Philadelphus 353 

I  Passiflora  Carulea Common  Passion  flower 360 

r  Philadelphus  Coronarius Syringa,  or  Mock  Orange 370 

1  Polemonium  Ctzru/eum Blue  Greek  Valerian  ....  V 373 

(  Phlox  Paniculata Panicled  Lychnidea 374 

45  s  Polygala  Chamabuxus Box-leaved  Milkwort . . . ; 373 

I  Physalis  Alkekengi Winter  Cherry 380 

.a  (  Rudbeckia  Purpurea Purple  Rudbeckia 335 

|  Rosa  Liitea Single  yellow  Rose 388 

C  Rhododendron  Ponticum Pontic  Rhododendron 402 

1  Robinia  Hispida Rose  Acacia 405 

48  5  Symphytum  Orientate Eastern  Comfrey 41O 

|  Salvia  Indica I Indian  Sage ....412 

.„  f  Sanguinaria  Canadensis Canada  Puccoon 420 

|  Saxifraga  Crassifolia Oval-leaved  Saxifrage 43 1 

50  5  Sy'H§a  f'ulgaris Lilac 427 

I  Sarracena  F/ava Yellow  Sarracena 429 

, .  f  Scabiosa  Atropurpurea Sweet  Scabious , . .  433 

1  Scilla  Campanulata Bell-flowered  Squill 437 

„  f  Sedum  Anacampseros Evergreen  Orpine 440 

'    |  Sophora  Tetraptera Wing-Podded  Sophora 446 

.  „  C  Sempervivum  Arachnoideum Cobweb  Houseleek 450 

I  Strelitzia  Regina, Canna-leaved  Strelitzia 453 

f  Solidago  Stricta Willow-leaved  Golden  Rod 455 

54  <  Senecio  Elegans Double  Purple  Groundsel 460 

(.  Spartium  Junceum Spanish  Broom 463 


CONTENTS. 

Hate.  Page. 

,    f  Spiraa  Lobata Lobe-leaved  Meadow  Sweet 466 

I  Sisyrinckium  Iridioides Iris-leaved  Sisyrinchium 4?  1 

5Tradescantia  virginica Virginian  Spiderwort 474 
Trillium  Sessile Sessile  Trillium 475 

£  Thalictrum  Aquilegifolium Feathered  Columbine 476 

57     Tropteolum  Majus Greater  Nasturtium 479 

,ft  f  Valerian  Rubra Red  Valerian 481 

(.  Veronica  Sibirica Siberian  Speedwell 485 

f  Finca  Rosea Madagascar  Periwinkle 489 

^  •£  Viburnum  Tinus Laurustinus 492 

_-  f  fVachendorfia  Paniculata Panicled  Wachendorfia 498 

00 1  Vitf x  Negundo Five-leaved  Chaste  Tree 500 


TO  THE   BINDER. 

Plate  I  to  face  the  Title-page  to  Vol.  I. 
Plate  LIII  to  face  the  Title-page  to  Vol.  II. 


PLATE    I. 

1.  ACANTHUS    MOLLIS. 

SMOOTH  BEAR'S  BREECH. 


THIS  genus  comprehends  several  hardy  herbaceous  plants  of  the 
perennial  flowering  kind,  which  are  in  use  for  the  purpose  of  orna- 
ment in  pleasure-grounds,  &c.  and  also  one  of  the  evergreen  shrubby 
sort  for  the  stove. 

It  is  of  the  class  and  order  Didynamia  Angiospermia,  and  ranks  in 
the  natural  order  of  Personate. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  perianthium,  with  leaflets 
in  three  alternate  pairs,  unequal,  and  permanent:  the  corolla  single- 
petalled  and  unequal,  having  a  short  tube  closed  with  a  beard;  no 
upper  lip;  very  large  under  lip,  which  is  flat,  straight,  very  broad, 
three-lobed,  obtuse,  and  of  the  length  of  the  upper  lip  of  the  calyx  : 
the  stamina  have  four  filaments,  subulate,  shorter  than  the  corolla, 
the  two  upper  rather  longer,  recurved  and  incurved  at  the  top:  the 
antherae  are  oblong,  compressed,  obtuse,  the  lateral  ones  parallel, 
and  villous  before:  the  pistillum  has  a  conical  germ,  a  filiform  style 
of  the  length  of  the  stamina,  and  two  acute  lateral  stigmas:  the 
pericarpium  is  a  subovate  pointed  capsule,  two-celled  and  two- 
valved,  with  a  contrary  partition,  alternate  claws,  curved  and  fas- 
tened to  the  partition:  the  seed  is  ovate,  gibbous  and  single,  but 
sometimes  double. 

The  species  most  commonly  cultivated  are:  1.  A.mollis,  Smooth 
Acanthus;  2.  A.  spinosus,  Prickly  Acanthus;  3.  A.ilicifolius,  Holly- 
leaved  Shrubby  Acanthus. 

The  first,  or  Smooth  Acanthus,  according  to  Miller,  has  the  stem 
from  two  to  three  feet  in  height.  The  leaves  are  oblong,  smooth  on 


2 

both  sides  and  shining,  from  a  span  to  a  foot  in  length,  divided 
deeply  into  opposite  ovate  lobes,  which  are  bluntly  toothed  and 
finely  ciliate  about  the  edges,  placed  on  roundish  petioles,  with  a 
flat  channel  running  along  the  upper  surface.  Both  the  leaves  and 
flower  stems  rise  directly  from  the  root :  the  former,  by  spreading 
closely  upon  the  ground  in  circular  clusters,  produce  a  good  effect. 
But  though  the  leaves  are  said  to  be  smooth,  they  are  not  without 
white  bristles  on  both  sides,  especially  along  the  nerves.  The  flow- 
ers are  white,  and  come  out  from  about  the  middle  to  the  top  of  the 
stalk.  They  make  their  appearance  in  July  or  August,  continuing 
in  blow  a  month  or  six  weeks,  and  then  produce  seed. 

There  is  a  variety  of  this  plant  in  which  the  leaves  are  larger  and 
less  sinuated,  the  upper  side  shining. 

The  second  sort,  or  Prickly  Acanthus,  has  the  leaves  deeply 
jagged  in  very  regular  order;  each  segment  is  terminated  by  a  sharp 
spine,  as  are  also  the  petioles  and  the  calyx  of  the  flowers,  so  that 
the  plant  is  troublesome  to  handle.  In  both  these  species  the  leaves 
and  stalks  are  annual. 

The  Holly-leaved  Acanthus  is  an  evergreen  shrub,  which  rises 
about  four  feet  in  height,  dividing  into  many  branches ;  the  leaves 
being  similar  to  those  of  the  common  holly  both  in  size  and  shape, 
and  also  armed  with  spines  in  the  same  manner.  The  flowers  come 
out  singly  in  an  upright  raceme  at  the  end  of  the  stalk,  are  white, 
and  shaped  like  those  of  the  Common  Acanthus,  but  smaller. 

The  two  first  are  thick,  fleshy,  fibrous-rooted  plants,  which  spread 
considerably,  and  penetrate  the  earth  to  a  great  depth.  They  are 
found  in  their  native  state  in  Spain,  Italy,  and  Portugal ;  but  grow 
without  difficulty  in  the  open  ground  in  this  climate. 

The  last  is  a  very  tender  plant,  which  in  this  climate  requires 
the  constant  heat  of  the  stove  to  preserve  it.  It  is  a  native  of  South 
America,  and  also  of  both  the  East  and  West  Indies.  It  is  retained 
in  hot-houses  for  the  purpose  of  variety. 

Culture. — Both  the  Smooth  and  Prickly  Acanthus  are  found  to 
succeed  in  any  common  soil  without  much  attention  to  the  nature  of 
the  exposure,  and  are  said  by  Miller  to  be  lasting  plants,  which  may 


be  propagated  either  by  seeds  or  the  parting  of  the  roots.  If  by  the 
former  method,  the  seed  should  be  sown  in  a  light  dry  soil  towards 
the  end  of  March,  either  in  slight  drills  or  on  the  plain  surface,  and 
immediately  raked  in.  When  the  season  proves  favourable,  the 
plants  appear  in  May,  and  all  the  after-culture  they  require  is  to 
keep  them  clean  from  weeds,  and,  where  they  stand  too  close,  to 
thin  them  out,  so  as  to  leave  them  about  six  inches  apart ;  which  is 
room  sufficient  for  them  to  grow  in  until  the  autumn,  when  they 
should  be  transplanted  into  situations  where  they  are  designed  to 
remain.  The  first,  as  being  the  most  tender,  is  advised  to  be  planted 
in  a  warm  border  near  a  wall,  and  which,  as  the  plants  do  not  mul- 
tiply so  fast  by  their  roots,  do  not  require  more  room  than  about 
three  feet ;  but  the  second,  as  it  spreads  its  roots  to  a  great  distance, 
should  have  more  than  twice  that  space.  From  this  last  sort  being 
hardy,  it  may  be  proper  to  be  planted  between  shrubs  to  fill  up  va- 
cant spaces ;  where  it  will  grow  without  difficulty,  provided  the 
ground  be  light  and  not  over  wet;  and  when  in  flower  will  thus 
make  an  agreeable  variety. 

When  they  are  propagated  by  their  roots,  the  operation  may 
be  performed  either  in  spring  or  autumn:  but  the  former  should 
only  be  removed  in  the  spring;  for,  if  transplanted  in  the  au- 
tumn, and  the  following  winter  should  prove  cold,  it  will  run  the 
hazard  of  being  destroyed.  The  roots  in  these  cases  should  not 
be  parted  too  small,  and  the  plants  be  at  once  placed  out  where 
they  are  to  remain.  As  these  plants  take  very  deep  root,  when 
planted  in  wet  ground,  the  roots  are  liable  to  rot  in  the  winter. 
They  have  frequently  been  traced  more  than  four  feet:  they  should 
not  therefore  be  wholly  removed  after  they  have  been  growing 
long  in  a  place;  but  the  side  shoots  be  annually  taken  off,  otherwise 
they  will  be  apt  to  spread  so  far  as  to  overpower  the  neighbouring 
plants  or  shrubs.  The  remaining  culture  is  only  that  of  affording  the 
flowering  stems  due  support  when  it  becomes  requisite,  and  carefully 
clearing  away  the  decayed  stalks  in  the  autumn. 

When  these  plants  arc  once  established  in  a  piece  of  ground, 
they  are  observed  by  Miller  to  be  eradicated  with  great  difficulty. 


Both  the  Smooth  and  Prickly  Acanthus  are  moslly  kept  in  the 
nurseries  for  the  purpose  of  sale. 

The  Shrubby  species  of  Acanthus  may  be  propagated  with  the 
greatest  certainty  by  sowing  seed  that  has  been  procured  from  abroad, 
in  pots;  to  be  plunged  in  a  bark-bed  in  the  stove  until  the  plants  are 
raised,  when  they  are  to  be  managed  in  the  same  manner  as  other 
hot-house  plants.  Layers  and  cuttings  likewise  sometimes  succeed, 
when  planted  in  pots  and  placed  in  the  same  situations. 


2.   ASCLEPIAS   TUBEROSA, 

ORANGE    APOCYNUM. 


THIS  genus  comprises  various  plants  of  the  flowery,  perennial, 
herbaceous,  and  shrubby  exotic  sorts;  and  of  the  Swallow-wort  and 
Dog's-bane  kinds. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Pentandria  Digynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Contortce. 

The  characters  of  which  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  five-cleft,  sharp, 
very  small,  permanent  perianthium.  The  corolla  monopetalous,  flat 
or  reflex,  five-parted:  the  divisions  ovate-acuminate,  slightly  bending 
with  the  sun.  The  nectaries  five,  growing  to  the  tube  of  the  fila- 
ments below  the  anthers,  fleshy,  or  cowled;  protruding  from  the 
bottom  a  sharp  horn,  bending  inwards.  The  stamina  consist  of 
five  filaments  collected  into  a  tube,  swelling  at  the  base:  the  anthers 
oblong,  upright,  and  two-celled,  terminated  by  an  inflex  membrane 
lying  on  the  stigma,  having  a  reversed  wing  on  each  side,  growing 
broader  downwards  with  its  edge  contiguous  to  the  next.  The  pol- 
len is  collected  into  ten  corpuscles,  inversely  lanceolate,  flat,  hanging 
down  into  the  cells  of  the  anther  by  short  threads,  frequently  flex- 
uose;  which  are  annexed  by  pairs  to  five  cartilaginous,  twin  tuber- 
cles, each  placed  on  the  tip  of  the  wings  of  the  anthers,  adhering  to 


the  angles  of  the  stigma,  between  the  anthers.  The  pislillum  con- 
sists of  two  oblong  acuminate  germs;  styles  two,  subulate:  stigma 
common  to  both,  large,  thick,  five-cornered,  covered  at  top  by  the 
apexes  of  the  anthers,  umbilicate  in  the  middle.  The  pericarpium 
has  two  follicles,  large,  oblong,  acuminate,  swelling,  one-celled, 
one-valved.  The  seeds  numerous,  imbricate,  crowned  with  down: 
the  receptacle  is  membranaceous  and  free. 

The  species  are  very  numerous,  but  those  most  commonly  in 
cultivation  are;  1.  A.  vincetoxicum,  Common  Swallow-wort,  or 
Tame-poison;  2.  A.  nigra,  Black  Swallow- wort;  3.  A.  Syriaca^,  Sy- 
rian Swallow-wort,  or  Dog's-bane;  4.  A.  purpurascens,  Purple  Vir- 
ginian Swallow-wort,  or  Dog's-bane;  5.  A.  vtrticillata,  Verticillate 
Swallow-wort;  6.  A.  decumbens,  Decumbent  Swallow-wort,  or  Dog's- 
bane;  7-  A,  tuberosa,  Tuberous-rooted  Swallow-wort,  or  Dog's-bane; 
8.  A  varicgata,  Variegated  Swallow- wort;  9.  A.  arborescens,  Arbo- 
rescent Swallow- wort;  10.  A.  fruticosa,  Shrubby  or  Willow-leaved 
Swallow-wort;  11.  A.  undulata,  Wave  leaved  Swallow- wort;  12.^4. 
crispa,  Curled-leaved  Swallow-wort;  13.  A.  curassavica,  Curassoa 
Swallow-wort,  or  Bastard  Ipecacuanha;  14,  A.  volubilis,  Twining 
Swallow-wort;  15.  A.  gigantia,  Curled  flowered  Gigantic  Swallow- 
wort. 

The  first  species  has  the  root  very  large  and  much  branched :  it 
is  composed  of  many  strong  fibres,  which  are  connected  at  the  top, 
like  those  of  Asparagus.  From  this  arise  many  stems,  in  number 
proportioned  to  the  size  of  the  root,  near  two  feet  high,  very  slender 
at  the  top,  woody,  round,  hairy,  and  not  branched.  The  leaves  are 
cordale-ovalc,  acuminate,  smooth,  hardish,  quite  entire,  glaucous- 
green,  the  midrib  and  sometimes  the  edge  of  the  leaves  a  little 
hairy:  the  petioles  short.  Peduncles  axillary,  many-flowered,  re- 
sembling proliferous  umbels.  The  calyx  small,  green,  divided  at  the 
end  into  five  bristles.  The  corolla  is  commonly  white:  the  follicles 
ovate-acuminate:  the  seeds  small,  brown,  and  wrapped  in  white 
cotton.  It  flowers  in  June,  sometimes  in  May,  and  continues  flower- 
ing to  August,  and  is  a  native  of  most  parts  of  the  continent  of 
Europe. 


It  is  said  to  var}r,  with  yellow  flowers;  and  there  is  a  variety  with 
broader  leaves. 

The  second  species  agrees  with  the  above  in  the  shape  of  its 
roots,  leaves,  and  flowers;  but  the  stalks  extend  to  a  greater  length, 
and  toward  their  upper  part  twist  round  any  sticks  or  other  plants 
near  them;  and  the  flowers  are  black. 

It  is  by  no  means  so  common  as  the  foregoing,  having  been  found 
only  in  the  south  of  France,  the  mountains  about  Nice,  and  in  Spain. 
It  flowers  at  the  same  time  with  the  other. 

The  third  creeps  greatly  at  the  root,  and  sends  up  strong  stems 
upwards  of  four  feet  high;  towards  the  top  of  them  the  flowers  come 
out  on  the  side;  these  are  of  a  worn-out  purple  colour,  smelling  sweet; 
and  sometimes  they  are  succeeded  here  by  large  oval  pods.  It 
flowers  in  July,  and  is  a  native  of  North  America.  The  French  in 
Canada  eat  the  tender  shoots  in  spring  as  Asparagus.  The  flowers 
are  highly  odoriferous. 

The  fourth  species  has  many  stems,  as  thick  as  the  little  finger, 
at  bottom  quadrangular  with  blunted  angles,  and  of  a  brownish  green 
colour;  above  round  and  green,  a  little  hairy.  The  leaves  are  on 
short  petioles,  from  four  to  six  inches  long,  and  two  or  three  broad; 
the  midrib  purple.  The  flowers  have  the  petals  of  a  dusky  herba- 
ceous colour,  the  horns  of  the  nectaries  pale  and  gaping,  not  erect 
but  horizontal.  It  is  a  native  of  North  America,  and  flowers  from 
July  to  September. 

The  fifth  species  rises  with  slender  upright  stalks,  at  the  top  of 
which  grow  umbels  of  small  white  flowers,  appearing  in  July,  but 
never  succeeded  by  pods  in  this  climate.  The  leaves  are  frequently 
four  together.  The  peduncles  forming  an  umbel  are  opposite  to 
the  leaves.  It  is  a  native  of  North  America. 

The  sixth  has  declining  stalks,  which  are  hairy,  and  eighteen 
inches  in  length.  The  leaves  are  narrow.  The  umbels  grow  at  the 
extremity  of  the  branches,are  compact,  and  the  flowers  of  a  bright 
orange  colour.  It  is  a  native  of  North  America. 

In  the  seventh  species  the  stems  are  a  foot  high,  hairy,  round, 
and  dusky  red.  The  leaves  alternate,  except  on  the  upper  part  of 


the  stem.  Below  where  it  branches  are  generally  two  leaves,  and  at 
the  place  of  branching  four:  on  the  branches  themselves  the  leaves 
are  again  alternate.  The  flowers  are  of  a  bright  orange  colour.  The 
tuberous  roots  very  large.  It  is  a  native  of  North  America,  and 
flowers  from  the  end  of  July  to  September,  sometimes  ripening  seed 
in  this  climate. 

The  eighth,  according  to  Linnaeus,  is  allied  to  the  third;  but  Dil- 
lenius  thinks  that  it  approaches  very  near  to  the  Amosna,  but  that 
the  stems  are  shorter,  and  commonly  variegated  with  dusky  purple 
spots;  the  leaves  broader  and  rounder,  more  excavated,  less  rigid, 
not  shining  or  hoary  underneath,  with  the  oblique  veins  deeper,  so  as 
to  be  even  grooved;  the  flowers  larger,  pale,  dusky  flesh-coloured, 
sweet-smelling,  the  horns  of  the  nectaries  standing  out  and  gaping 
more. 

According  to  Miller,  it  resembles  the  fourth  sort,  but  the  leaves 
are  rough,  and  the  umbels  of  flowers  more  compact;  they  come  out 
on  the  side  of  the  stalk,  are  of  an  herbaceous  colour,  and  are 
not  succeeded  by  pods  in  this  climate.  It  is  a  native  of  North 
America. 

In  the  ninth  species  the  stem  is  shrubby,  rough  with  hairs,  up- 
right, as  thick  as  the  finger.  The  leaves  opposite,  on  very  short  pe- 
tioles, ending  rather  obtusely,  but  with  a  minute  point,  and  smooth. 
The  peduncles  from  the  summit  of  the  stem,  umbelled,  villose.  The 
corollas  are  white.  It  is  a  native  of  the  Cape  of  Good  Hope,  and 
flowers  in  December. 

In  the  tenth  the  nectaries  are  compressed  without  a  claw,  instead 
of  which  are  two  long  reflex  ears.  The  follicles  are  inflated,  and  set 
with  soft  prickles.  It  is  also  a  native  of  the  Cape,  and  flowers  from 
June  to  September. 

The  eleventh  is  a  native  6f  the  Cape  of  Good  Hope,  and  flowers 
here  in  July. 

The  twelfth  has  the  stem  pubescent,  branching  at  bottom.  The 
leaves  subsessile,  repand.  One  umbel  of  yellow  flowers  terminates 
the  stem.  Found  at  the  Cape  of  Good  Hope. 

The  thirteenth  species  has  the  stem  from  a  foot  to  two  or  three 


8 

feet  in  height,  upright,  simple,  or  generally  so,  round,  pubescent, 
and  milky.  The  leaves  opposite  and  decussated,  petioled,  acute, 
entire,  and  smooth  on  both  sides.  The  flowers  in  umbels:  umbellules 
terminating,  or  opposite  to  the  terminating  leaflet  in  pairs,  pedun- 
cled.  Involucre  none,  but  only  a  few  subulate  leaflets.  The  pe- 
duncle the  length  of  the  leaves:  pedicels  shorter,  one-flowered.  Ca- 
lyx of  five,  lanceolate,  reflex  leaflets :  corolla  reflex.  Nectaries  five, 
round  the  middle  corpuscle,  ovate,  ear-cowled  obliquely  inwards, 
with  a  little  horn  from  the  nectareous  base,  sabre-shaped,  bent  in- 
wards. In  the  middle  is  a  truncate  corpuscle,  hollowed  at  the  tip, 
bluntly  five-cornered,  covered  with  five  scales  at  the  sides,  and  gaping 
with  as  many  chinks.  Scales  hollowed  within.  Glands  five,  roundish, 
black,  to  which  are  fixed  above,  within  the  scales,  pairs  of  glandu- 
liferous  pedicels,  in  place  of  anthers;  these  glands  are  oblong,  pel- 
lucid, panduriform,  and  filled  with  prolific  moisture.  Germs  two, 
ovate,  acuminate;  styles  two,  subulate,  hid  within  the  column; 
stigmas  simple,  and  obtuse.  Follicles  oblong,  acuminate,  toothless, 
ventricose,  and  smooth.  It  is  a  native  of  South  America,  the  West- 
Indian  Islands,  and  China  near  Canton,  and  flowers  from  June  to 
September. 

The  fourteenth  species  is  quite  smooth,  with  shining  branches. 
The  leaves  petioled,  ovate-subcordate,  and  veined.  The  umbels 
quite  simple,  on  peduncles  the  length  of  the  petiole.  The  flowers 
greenish.  It  is  a  native  of  Malabar,  Ceylon,  &c. 

The  fifteenth  rises  to  six  or  seven  feet  in  height.  The  leaves  are 
thick;  the  flowers  white;  the  pods  very  large;  the  base  of  the  pe- 
tiole bearded  above.  The  nectaries  do  not  put  forth  awl-shaped 
horns,  but  solid  converging  plates.  It  flowers  from  July  to  Sep- 
tember. 

Culture. — The  method  of  propagating  the  different  hardy  kinds, 
as  the  first  eight  species,  is  by  parting  the  roots  and  planting  them 
out,  either  in  the  autumn  as  soon  as  the  stems  decay,  or  in  the  early 
spring  months  before  the  new  shoots  are  protruded.  They  require  a 
rather  dry  soil,  as  when  there  is  too  much  moisture  they  are  apt  to 
have  their  roots  destroyed  by  it  in  the  winter  season.  They  are  like- 


wise  capable  of  being  raised  from  seed,  when  it  can  be  procured,  by 
sowing  it  in  beds  or  pots  of  light  fresh  earth  in  the  spring  months. 
With  the  seventh  and  eighth  species,  the  pots  should  be  plunged  in 
a  hot-bed,  and  as  soon  as  the  plants  present  themselves  they  should 
be  exposed  gradually  to  the  influence  of  the  open  air  to  strengthen 
their  growth,  and  when  sufficiently  vigorous,  be  either  pricked  out 
on  warm  borders,  or  in  the  situations  where  they  are  to  remain.  In 
the  former  method  they  must  be  transplanted  the  March  following 
into  the  places  where  they  are  to  grow.  In  either  mode  occasional 
shade  and  water  must  be  provided,  and  in  the  winter  the  roots  be 
protected  from  the  action  of  the  frost  by  being  covered  with  old  tan, 
litter,  or  mats.  These  two  sorts  may  also  be  occasionally  increased  by 
planting  the  offsets  in  the  early  spring. 

They  last  many  years  when  proper  care  is  taken  of  them  in  the 
winter;  but  do  not  bear  frequent  removing  well,  or  flower  so  strongly 
under  such  circumstances. 

In  the  culture  of  the  ninth  and  three  following  sorts  the  pro- 
tection of  a  green-house  is  essentially  necessary  in  the  winter 
season. 

The  ninth  and  tenth  kinds  may  be  increased  either  by  seeds  or 
cuttings.  In  the  first  manner  the  seed  should  be  sown  in  small  pots 
filled  with  a  light  earthy  compost,  placing  them  in  a  hot-bed;  and 
when  the  plants  have  attained  a  proper  degree  of  size  and  strength 
they  must  be  pricked  out  into  separate  pots,  a  due  degree  of  shade 
and  water  being  given  till  they  have  stricken  fresh  root,  and  after- 
wards as  occasion  may  require. 

The  eleventh,  twelfth,  and  other  Cape  sorts,  may  be  propagated 
by  sowing  the  seeds  in  the  latter  end  of  March  or  beginning  of  April 
on  a  moderate  hot-bed,  covered  with  light  mould,  under  glasses,  or 
even  sometimes  in  the  open  air;  and  when  the  plants  are  become 
sufficiently  strong  and  a  few  inches  in  height,  they  may  be  placed 
out  into  separate  small  pots  filled  with  light  fresh  earth,  being  at  first 
properly  shaded  and  supplied  with  moisture:  after  being  fully  rooted 
they  may  be  exposed  in  warm  situations  in  assemblage  with  other 

c 


10 

exolic  plants  till  the  beginning  of  the  autumn,  when  they  must  re- 
ceive the  shelter  of  the  green-house. 

The  principal  attention  which  is  afterwards  necessary  with  plants 
of  this  description  is,  that  of  properly  potting  them  as  they  increase 
in  size,  and  carefully  exposing  them  in  the  open  air  during  the 
summer  months. 

These  sorts  are  likewise  capable  of  being  raised  by  setting  the 
cuttings  of  the  shoots  in  the  latter  end  of  the  summer  in  shady  situa- 
tions, and  after  they  have  stricken  good  roots  carefully  removing 
them  into  pots,  to  be  managed  as  the  seedling  plants. 

The  thirteenth  and  following  kinds  require  to  be  kept  constantly 
in  the  stove  of  the  hot-house.  They  may  be  increased  by  sowing 
the  seeds  in  the  spring  either  on  a  hot-bed,  or  in  pots,  and  plunging 
them  into  the  hot-bed;  the  plants,  when  sufficiently  grown,  being  in 
the  first  mode  transplanted  into  separate  pots  of  good  earth,  to  be,  as 
in  the  latter  method,  plunged  into  the  tan-bed  in  the  stove  of  the 
hot-house.  Plants  of  the  thirteenth  species  should  be  annually 
raised,  as  they  decline  in  the  production  of  flowers  after  the  first 
year. 

The  first  kinds  may  be  employed  in  the  fronts  of  the  clumps  and 
borders  of  pleasure,  or  other  grounds,  where  they  have  a  good  effect 
in  mixture  with  other  plants  of  similar  growth. 

The  second  sorts  afford  an  agreeable  diversity  in  the  green-house 
during  the  winter,  and  in  the  compartments  about  the  house  in  the 
summer  season. 

Those  of  the  last  description  present  a  pleasing  variety  among 
other  stove  plants. 


tf.2 


.-nJ.-n  A/////.. 

AjmrfrmmM   <•<>,;•„„, -ni      ^   .[„< /,„.>„     ,•//,<,„„/,.,  Ayni/,,,,,,    ,„,„„/,„.„.>•  ./,/,„    ,,„,„„•.,;.• 

a**  <•„,„,„,.„  fff,,,,,,,/  a „.,/,,/:,  *('„„,„/,„„/'„/„„,/„„,.     ' .1  „,<•,•„„>,//,,•/,  f/,,, .?/,-,, 


t<  / 


PLATE  II. 

1.   AGROSTEMMA  CORONARIA, 

ROSE    CAMPION. 


THE  plants  of  this  genus  are  of  the  hardy  herbaceous,  annual, 
and  biennial-perennial  kinds. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  of  Decandria  Pentagynia,  and 
ranks  in  the  natural  order  of  Caryophyllei. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  one-leafed,  coriaceous,  or 
leather-like,  tubulous,  five-toothed,  permanent  perianthium:  th6  co- 
rolla has  five  petals,  with  claws  of  the  length  of  the  tube  of  ihe 
calyx;  and  border  spreading,  obtuse,  and  undivided:  the  stamina 
are  ten  awl-shaped  filaments,  five  alternately  later  than  the  other 
five,  inserted  into  each  claw  of  the  petals:  the  antherae  simple:  the 
pistillum  is  an  ovate  germ,  with  filiform,  erect  styles,  of  the  length 
of  the  stamina,  and  simple  stigmas:  the  pericarpium  an  oblong- 
ovate,  covered,  one  celled,  five-valved  capsule:  the  seeds  are  very 
numerous,  kidney-shaped,  and  dotted:  the  receptacles  free,  as  many 
as  seeds;  the  interior  ones  gradually  longer. 

There  are  a  number  of  different  species,  but  those  for  cultivation, 
as  ornamental  plants  are,  1.  A.  coronaria,  Rose  Campion:  2.  A. 
Flos  Jovis,  Umbellate  Rose  Campion. 

The  first  of  these  species,  in  its  natural  state, -has  the  corolla 
white,  with  the  middle  red;  and  it  has  the  habit  of  the  species  be- 
low, but  is  harder,  more  pulpy,  and  more  lomentose.  The  calyxes 
are  much  harder,  callous,  and  covered  with  a  white  pile,  with  hard 
thick  ribs,  not  green  hairy  lines  as  in  that:  the  petals  are  much 
broader,  slightly  emarginate:  the  auricles  bifid:  the  flowers  not 


12 

heaped  into  an  umbel,  but  scattered  on  the  branches  of  the  slem  on 
very  long  peduncles.     Native  of  Italy  and  the  Valais. 

There  are  three  varieties  of  this  plant:  one  with  deep  red,  another 
•with  flesh-coloured,  and  a  third  with  white  flowers:  and  the  Double 
Rose  Campion,  with  a  large  crimson  flower,  which  is  chiefly  cultivated 
as  being  an  elegant  and  beautiful  flower. 

In  the  second,  the  stem  is  erect,  dichotomous  at  the  top,  and 
covered  with  a  white  nap.  The  leaves  are  conjugate,  connate, 
ovate-lanceolate,  quite  entire,  erect,  and  pressed  to  the  stem,  being 
all  over  nappy.  The  flowers  from  the  top  and  forks,  solitary.  The 
flower-stem  rises  near  a  foot  or  a  foot  and  a  half  high,  and  the 
flowers  grow  in  umbels  on  the  top  of  the  stalk,  and  are  of  a  bright 
red  colour.  It  flowers  in  July,  and  the  seeds  ripen  in  September. 
It  is  a  native  of  the  mountains  of  Switzerland. 

Culture. — In  cultivating  these  plants  all  the  single  kinds  may  be 
easily  propagated  by  the  seeds,  which  may  be  sown  either  in  the 
spring  or  autumn  on  a  bed  of  common  earth;  and  after  the  plants 
have  attained  the  height  of  about  three  inches,  they  should  be 
pricked  out  into  another  bed,  at  the  distance  of  six  or  seven  inches 
from  each  other,  water  being  immediately  applied  in  not  too  large  a 
quantity,  and  afterwards  occasionally  repeated.  In  the  autumn  or 
spring  following  the  plants  will  be  in  a  proper  situation  to  be  trans- 
planted into  the  places  where  they  are  to  remain  for  the  purpose  of 
flowering  in  the  ensuing  summer  months.  And  as  the  plants  fre- 
quently come  up  from  the  self-sown  seeds  with  equal  strength  and 
vigour,  these  may  be  transplanted  in  the  same  manner,  and  often 
succeed  fully  as  well. 

As  the  double  sorts  afford  no  seed,  they  can  only  be  propagated 
by  parting  the  roots;  which,  as  they  mostly  afford  abundance  of 
offsets,  may  be  easily  effected.  This  should  be  performed  in  the 
autumn,  as  soon  as  the  flowering  is  over,  every  head  being  parted 
that  can  be  slipped  off  with  roots.  These  should  then  be  planted  out 
in  fresh  ground  that  has  not  lately  received  any  manure,  at  the 
distance  of  six  or  seven  inches  from  each  other;  water  being  applied 
in  a  sparing  manner  until  they  have  taken  fresh  root,  after  which  it 


13 

must  be  wholly  omitted,  as  much  moisture  is  very  prejudicial.  In 
the  spring  they  should  be  put  into  the  situations  where  they  are  to 
remain  for  flowering. 

A  few  plants  may  likewise  be  placed  in  pots  of  good  fresh  mould, 
in  order  to  be  set  out  in  the  yards  or  other  compartments  about  the 
house. 

The  second  sort  admits  of  the  same  methods  of  cultivation,  but 
succeeds  best  in  a  rather  moist  soil,  where  the  situation  is  somewhat 
shady. 

Both  the  species  and  all  varieties  are  well  suited  for  the  pur- 
poses of  ornament,  affording  a  very  agreeable  diversity  in  clumps 
and  borders. 


2.    ANCHUSA  OFFICINALIS, 

OFFICINAL    BUGLOSS. 


THIS  genus  comprises  several  plants,  chiefly  of  the  herbaceous 
perennial  tribe,  of  hardy  growth,  and  of  the  Bugloss  kind. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and   order  Pentandria  Monogynia,  and 
ranks  in  the  natural  order  of  Asperifolice. 

The  characters  of  which  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  five-parted, 
oblong,  round,  acute,  and  permanent  perianthium:  the  corolla  is 
monopetalous  and  funnel-shaped :  tube  cylindrical,  of  the  length  of 
the  calyx;  limb  semiquinquefid,  form  erect,  expanding,  and  obtuse; 
throat  closed  with  five  small  scales;  convex,  prominent,  oblong,  and 
converging:  the  stamina  have  very  short  filaments  in  the  throat  of 
the  corolla:  anthers  oblong,  incumbent,  and  covered:  the  pistillum 
has  four  germs:  the  style  filiform,  of  the  length  of  the  stamina; 
stigma  obtuse  and  emarginate;  no  pericarpium,  but  the  calyx  en- 
larged and  erect,  contains  the  seeds  in  its  bosom:  the  seeds  are  four, 

oblongish,  obtuse,  and  gibbose.. 

The  species  that  are  most  deserving  of  cultivation  are:    1.  A. 


14 

officinalis,  Garden  Alkanet,  or  Bugloss;  2.  A.  undulata,  Waved  Al- 
kanct;  3.  A.  Virginica,  Virginian  Yellow  Alkanet;  4.  A.  sempervi- 
rens,  Evergreen  Alkanet. 

The  first  has  the  stems  from  a  foot  to  eighteen  inches  in  height 
and  more,  the  thickness  of  a  finger,  slightly  angular,  hairy  and 
rough.  The  leaves  slightly  decurrent,  seven  inches  long,  above  an 
inch  broad,  hairy  and  rough.  The  spikes  conjugate,  terminating 
the  stem;  the  flowers  sessile,  in  a  double  row:  the  caljx  hirsute: 
the  corollas  purple,  near  half  an  inch  in  diameter.  At  first  opening 
they  are  red,  but  afterwards  become  purple.  Sometimes  they  are 
white.  It  flowers  in  June,  July,  and  August;  and  the  seeds  ripen 
in  a  month.  It  is  a  native  of  Italy,  Spain,  &c. 

There  are  several  varieties  of  it;  as,  Common  Bugloss  with  blue 
flowers,  with  white  flowers,  with  red  flowers. 

The  second  species  is  in  height  three  feet,  with  many  strong  la- 
teral branches,  produced  from  the  main  stem  near  the  ground.  The 
leaves  stiff  and  rough,  six  or  seven  inches  long,  and  about  half  an 
inch  broad  at  the  top,  closely  embracing  the  branches  at  the  base, 
where  they  are  two  inches  broad ;  indented  and  waved  on  their 
edges;  the  upper  surface  beset  with  hairs,  and  very  rough  to  the 
touch.  The  spikes  of  flowers  axillary,  a  foot  or  more  in  length,  and 
reflex.  The  corollas  fine  blue.  It  is  a  native  of  Spain,  &c. 

The  third  seldom  rises  a  foot  in  height  where  the  soil  is  good; 
and  where  it  is  poor  not  more  than  half  that  height.  Its  flowers  grow 
in  loose  spikes  upon  a  smooth  stalk.  It  is  perennial,  flowers  eailjr, 
and  is  a  native  of  North  America. 

The  fourth  species  has  the  stems  at  the  sides  of  the  crown  of  the 
root,  hispid.  The  leaves  ovate,  marked  with  lines,  petiolate,  and 
remote.  The  peduncles  axillary;  with  two  bractes,  opposite,  sessile, 
lanceolate-ovate,  many-flowered :  the  corollas  blue,  with  a  short 
tube,  rather  salver-shaped  than  funnel-shaped:  the  calyx  thick  set 
with  long,  white,  bristly  hairs:  the  segments  rather  longer  than  the 
tube  of  the  corolla:  ihe  germs  imbedded  in  a  hollow,  glandular  re- 
ceptacle, one  or  two  generally  abortive:  the  seeds  rough,  of  a  bony 
hardness.  It  is  found  native  in  Spain  and  Italy. 


15 

Culture. — All  the  sorts  may  he  propagated  by  the  roots,  care 
being  taken  to  plant  them  on  such  soils  as  are  pretty  dry.  They 
are  likewise  capable  of  being  raised  by  sowing  the  seeds  in  the  au- 
tumnal season  upon  beds  of  sandy  earth,  and  in  the  following  spring 
removing  the  plants  that  arc  sufficiently  strong,  and  setting  them  out 
in  beds  two  feet  apart,  water  being  occasionally  given.  They  also 
all  come  up  well  from  the  self-sown  seed.  They  may  be  made  use 
of  for  the  purpose  of  ornament,  where  a  great  variety  of  easy  culti- 
vated plants  are  wanted,  though  they  possess  but  little  beauty. 


3.  AQUILEGIA  CANADENISIS. 

CANADIAN    COLUMBINE. 

• 

THIS  genus  contains  plants  of  the  hardy  herbaceous  perennial 
flowering  tribe,  and  Columbine  kind. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Polyandtia  Pentagynia,  and 
ranks  in  the  natural  order  of  Multisiliqua. 

The  characters  of  which  are:  that  there  is  no  calyx:  the  corolla 
consists  of  five  lanceolate-ovate,  flat,  equal- spreading  petals:  the 
nectaries  five,  equal,  alternate  with  the  petals;  each  horned,  and 
gradually  broader  upwards,  with  an  oblique  mouth  ascending  out- 
wardly, and  annexed  inwardly  to  the  receptacle,  produced  below 
into  a  long  attenuated  tube  with  an  obtuse  top.  The  stamina  con- 
sist of  numerous  filaments,  subulate;  the  outer  ones  shorter,  and 
oblong  erect  antherae  the  height  of  the  nectaries:  the  pistillum  con- 
sists of  five  ovate,  oblong  germs ;  ending  in  subulate  styles  longer 
than  the  stamina,  and  erect  simple  stigmas;  the  chaffs  ten,  wrinkled} 
short,  separate,  and  involving  the  germs:  the  pcricarpium  consists 
of  five  erect,  distinct,  cylindrical  capsules,  gaping  from  top  inward, 
containing  numerous  ovate,  shining  seeds,  annexed  to  the  gaping 
suture. 


16 

The  species  are:  1.  A.  vulgaris,  Common  Columbine;  2.  A.  al- 
pina,  Mountain  Columbine;  3.  A.  canadensis,  Canadian  Dwarf  Co- 
lumbine. 

In  the  first  the  stem  is  three  feet  high,  erect,  branching,  leafy, 
and  somewhat  angular.  The  leaves  smooth,  glaucous  underneath; 
the  lower  ones  petiolate,  biternate;  the  leaflets  roundish,  trilobate, 
gashed  and  notched;  the  upper  ones  digitate,  the  lobes  oval  and 
quite  entire:  the  radical  petioles  very  long.  The  flowers  are  pro- 
duced from  the  lops  of  the  naked  branches,  and  hang  down;  they 
have  generally  six  pistils  and  eight  nectaries.  It  is  a  native  of  most 
parts  of  Europe,  and  perennial,  flowering  in  June. 

There  are  several  varieties,  the  flowers  varying  greatly  by  culture, 
becoming  double  either  by  multiplying  the  petals  or  the  nectaries. 
And  of  all  these  varieties,  there  are  subordinate  variations,  both  in 
the  degree  of  doubleness,  as  with  two  or  more  rows  of  petals,  two  or 
three  rows  of  nectaries,  curiously  inserted  one  into  the  other;  and  in 
the  colours,  as  blue,  white,  red,  purple,  flesh-coloured,  ash-coloured, 
chesnut-colourcd,  and  striped  or  variegated  blue  and  purple,  blue 
and  white,  red  and  while,  &c. 

The  second  species  has  the  root  biennial.  The  leaves  bilernate, 
tender,  and  smaller  than  in  the  common  sort;  the  leaflets  multifid; 
the  lobes  sublinear  and  blunt;  with  the  appearance  and  tenderness 
of  the  Canadian  Columbine.  It  is  a  native  of  the  Alps,  &c.  and 
flowers  in  May  and  June. 

The  third  has  likewise  a  perennial  root.  The  stems  are  very 
slender,  and  reddish.  The  leaves  in  the  lower  ones  biternate,  irregu- 
larly divided,  the  extreme  lobes  blunt,  the  upper  ones  simply  ter- 
nate,  toothed  or  quite  entire;  the  uppermost  simple,  lanceolate,  and 
acuminate.  The  corollas  yellow  within,  and  red  on  the  outside.  It 
is  a  native  of  Virginia,  &c.  and  flowers  in  April. 

Culture. — The  culture  in  these  plants  may  be  effected,  either  by 
sowing  the  seeds,  or  parting  the  old  roots;  but  the  first  is  the  best 
practice,  as  the  old  roots  are  apt  to  decline  and  degenerate  after  they 
have  blown  a  few  seasons.  The  seed  may  be  put  in  either  in  the 
autumn  or  spring  season;  but  the  former  is  the  belter,  as  seed  which 


IT 

has  remained  long  out  of  the  ground  seldom  grows  well.  A  bed  of 
fresh  light  earth  is  the  best  for  the  purpose.  In  the  following  spring 
the  plants  should  be  kept  clear  from  weeds,  and  occasionally  wa- 
tered when  the  season  is  dry ;  being  transplanted  into  other  beds 
of  the  same  sort,  during  the  summer  or  autumn,  according  to  their 
growth,  at  the  distance  of  eight  or  ten  inches  every  way;  water  be- 
ing given  when  necessary.  The  plants  mostly  blow  in  the  following 
summer,  but  seldom  in  a  strong  manner.  The  best  flowering  roots 
should  therefore  be  taken  up  in  the  autumn,  and  planted  out  in  such 
situations  in  the  garden  and  pleasure-grounds  as  they  are  designed  to 
remain  in.  In  order  to  prevent  the  roots  from  degenerating  by  the 
reception  of  the  farina  of  other  flowers,  the  flower-stems  should  be 
cut  down  immediately  after  they  have  blown.  And  to  keep  up  a 
proper  succession  of  fine  flowers,  some  plants  should  be  raised  every 
two  years  from  seed. 

In  saving  the  seed  of  the  variegated  kinds,  great  care  should  be 
taken  that  no  plain  flowers  be  left  among  them. 

The  different  varieties  of  these  plants  are  capable  of  being  in- 
creased by  parting  the  roots  of  the  young  plants,  such  as  those  of 
three  years  old,  in  the  autumn  or  spring. 

The  only  general  culture  these  plants  require,  is  that  of  keeping 
them  free  from  weeds,  and  cutting  the  decayed  stems  down  in  the 
autumnal  season. 

The  last  species  often  flowers  sooner  by  a  month  than  those  of 
the  other  kinds. 

All  the  varieties  of  the  first,  however  much  they  may  seem  to 
differ  in  form,  colour,  size*  structure,  and  variegation,  are  capable  of 
being  produced  from  seed  of  the  same  plant. 

They  are  all  adapted  to  afford  variety  in  pleasure  grounds  and 
gardens;  and  the  Canada  sort  is  esteemed  for  the  early  appearance 
of  its  flowers. 


18 


4.  ACT^EA  RACEMOSA 

AMERICAN    HERB    CHRISTOPHER. 


THIS  genus  comprehends  plants  of  the  Herb  Christopher  or 
Baneberry  kind,  which  are  hardy  herbaceous  perennials,  of  tall 
growth. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Polyandria  Monogynia,  and 
ranks  in  the  natural  order  of  Multisiliqute. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  perianthium  of  four 
leaves,  with  roundish,  obtuse,  concave,  and  caducous  leaflets:  the 
corolla  has  four  petals,  acuminate  at  both  ends,  longer  than  the 
calyx,  and  caducous:  the  stamina  consist  of  numerous,  usually 
about  thirty,  papillary  filaments,  broader  at  top:  the  anthera  are 
roundish,  twin,  and  erect:  the  pistillum  has  a  superior  ovate  ger- 
men,  no  style,  and  a  thickish,  obliquely-depressed  stigma:  the  peri- 
carpium  is  an  oval-globose,  smooth,  one-furrowed,  and  one-celled 
berry;  and  the  seeds  are  many,  semi-orbicular,  and  lying  over  each 
other  in  two  rows. 

The  species  that  chiefly  deserve  notice  for  the  purpose  of  culti- 
vation are:  1.  A.  spicata,  Common-spiked,  Black-berried  Herb 
Christopher ;  2.  A.  racemosa,  Clustered,  Long-spiked,  American 
Herb  Christopher. 

The  first  sort  grows  two  feet  and  a  half  high,  the  footstalks  of  the 
leaves  rising  from  the  root;  these  divide  into  three  smaller  footstalks, 
each  of  which  divides  again  into  three,  and  these  have  each  three 
lobes,  so  that  each  leaf  is  composed  of  twenty-seven  lobes  or  small 
leaves.  And  the  flower-stem  which  rises  from  the  root  has  leaves  of 
the  same  form,  but  smaller.  On  the  top  of  the  stalk  appear  the 


19 

flowers,  which  grow  in  ramose  spikes,  and  are  of  a  pure  white;  these 
come  out  in  May,  and  are  succeeded  by  black  shining  berries  abouk 
the  size  of  peas,  which  ripen  in  autumn. 

There  is  a  variety  of  this  plant  with  white  berries,  and  another  in 
which  they  are  of  a  red  colour. 

The  second  kind  has  large  compound  leaves,  which  rise  imme- 
diately from  the  root,  and  are  branched  after  the  same  manner 
with  the  first.  The  flower-stems  frequently  rise  to  the  height  of 
four  or  five  feet  or  more.  The  flowers  are  white,  in  a  long  spike, 
reflex  at  the  top.  It  flowers  in  June,  or  the  beginning  of  July, 
but  does  not  perfect  seed  in  this  climate.  It  is  a  native  of  North 
America,  where  it  is  often  distinguished  by  the  title  of  Black  Snake- 
root. 

Culture. — The  propagation  of  these  plants  may  be  easily  effected 
by  sowing  the  seed  on  a  shady  border  of  common  earth  in  the  au- 
tumn, as  soon  as  they  are  taken  from  the  plants,  as  when  the  sowing 
is  deferred  till  the  spring  they  are  liable  to  remain  in  the  soil  until 
the  same  time  in  the  following  year  before  they  come  up,  and  much 
time  is  lost.  From  the  irregular  manner  in  which  the  plants  mostly 
appear,  the  mould  of  the  beds  should  be  as  little  as  possible  disturbed, 
Jest  they  be  destroyed.  When  fully  grown  in  the  succeeding  au- 
tumn, they  may  be  transplanted  into  the  situations  where  they  are 
to  remain,  which  should  be  rather  shady. 

The  seeds  of  the  second  species  are  mostly  sent  annually  from 
America,  and  should  be  put  into  the  ground  as  soon  as  possible  after 
they  arrive. 

As  these  plants  rise  to  a  considerable  height,  and  are  ornamented 
with  leaves  on  the  lower  part  of  the  stems,  and  with  handsome  spikes 
of  flowers  on  the  upper  parts,  they  are  well  suited  for  adorning  the 
common  compartments  and  clumps  of  pleasure-grounds,  especially 
where  there  is  a  degree  of  shade  without  the  inconveniences  of  large 
trees;  and  also  in  the  intervals  between  large  shrubs  in  conspicuous 
situations,  where,  from  their  hardy  nature,  they  will  only  require  the 
same  treatment  as  them. 


20 

As  these  plants  are  perennial  in  root,  but  annual  in  the  leaf 
and  stem,  these  last  require  to  be  cut  off  and  cleaned  away  every 
autumn. 

The  berries  of  these  plants  are  believed  to  have  a  poisonous  pro- 
perty, a  single  berry  being  said  to  be  capable  of  instantly  destroying 
fowls  and  other  birds. 


.,,-„.,  „,-„.,• 

.//,//,>/•/ 


PLATE  III. 

1.  AGAPANTHUS  UMBP:LLATUS. 

AFRICAN    AGAPANTHUS. 


THIS  genus  comprehends  the  African  Lily. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  of  Hexandria  Monogynia,  and 
ranks  in  the  natural  order  of  Liliacece. 

The  characters  of  which  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  spathe  common, 
gaping  at  the  side:  the  corolla  is  one-petalled,  funnel-shaped,  and 
regular;  the  tube  cornered,  as  if  composed  of  six  claws;  the  border 
six-parted,  with  the  parts  oblong  and  spreading:  the  stamina  are  six 
filaments  inserted  into  the  throat,  shorter  than  the  corolla,  declinate: 
the  antherae  are  kidney-shaped  and  incumbent:  the  pistillum  is  a 
superior  germ,  oblong,  three-cornered;  the  style  filiform,  of  the 
length  of  the  stamina,  and  declinate ;  the  stigma  simple  or  trifid :  the 
pericarpium  is  an  oblong  capsule,  three-sided,  three-celled,  three- 
valved:  valves  navicular,  with  contrary  dissepiment :  the  seeds  nume- 
rous, oblong,  compressed,  and  enlarged  with  a  membrane. 

There  is  only  one  species,  the  A.  umbeUntus,  African  Blue,  or 
Asphodel  Lily. 

It  has  the  root  composed  of  many  thick  fleshy  fibres,  diverging 
from  the  same  head,  striking  deep  i  nto  the  ground,  and  putting  out 
many  smaller  fibres,  which  are  of  a  white  colour  and  fleshy.  From 
the  same  head  arises  a  cluster  of  leaves  surrounding  each  other  at 
the  base,  so  as  to  form  a  kind  of  herbaceous  stalk  about  three  inches 
in  height,  from  which  the  leaves  spread  only  two  ways,  appearing 
flat  in  the  other  two.  The  leaves  are  thick,  succulent,  about  a  foot 
long,  and  near  an  inch  broad,  compressed,  and  of  a  dark  green  co- 


22 

lour.  Between  ihese  comes  out  the  flower-stalk,  which  is  from  two 
to  three  feet  in  height,  round,  and  as  large  as  a  man's  little  finger, 
naked  to  the  top,  where  it  supports  a  large  head  or  umbel  of  blue 
flowers,  inclosed  in  a  sheath,  which  splits  into  two  parts,  and  is  bent 
backward.  Each  flower  stands  on  a  pedicel  about  an  inch  long. 
The  petals  are  blunt,  and  waved  on  their  edges;  the  umbel  being 
large,  the  flowers  numerous,  and  of  a  bright  blue  colour,  making  a 
fine  appearance. 

They  appear  about  the  end  of  August,  or  the  beginning  of  Sep- 
tember, and  frequently  continue  in  full  beauty  till  the  spring. 

It  is  a  native  of  the  Cape  of  Good  Hope. 

Culture. — This  plant  may  be  easily  propagated  by  means  of  off- 
sets taken  from  the  parent  plant.     The  operation  of  parting  them  is 
to  be  performed  at  the  season  when  the  process  of  vegetation  is  in 
the  most  languid  state,  which  in  this  plant  is  generally  about  the 
latter  end  of  June.     In  performing  the  work  the  old  plants  are  to  be 
turned  out  of  their  pots,  and  the  mould  cautiously  cleared  away  from 
them,  that  the  fibres  of  the  offsets  may  be  belter  ascertained.     The 
offsets  are  then  to  be  separated  in  such  a  manner  as  that  their  heads 
may  not  be  injured.     When  they  adhere  very  closely  a  knife  may  be 
employed  for  the  purpose,  being  careful  not  to  wound  the  bulb  of 
cither  the  old  or  new  plant.     After  this  has  been  accomplished  the 
bulbs  are  to  be  planted  out  separately,  in  pots  of  good  garden  mould, 
and  placed  in  shady  situations  that  admit  the  morning  sun.     A  little 
water  should  be  given  once  or  twice  a  wrek  when  the  season  is  dry, 
care  being  taken  not  to  endanger  the  rotting  of  the  roots  by  applying 
it  in  too  large  a  proportion.     In  four  or  five  weeks,  when  the  new 
planted  bulbs  have  put  out  fresh  roots,  they  should  be  removed  into 
other  situations  that  are  more  fully  exposed  to  the  influence  of  the 
sun,  a  little  more  water  being  cautiously  applied  in  order  to  strengthen 
their  flowering.     The  flower-stems  mostly  appear  in  the  beginning  of 
September,  and  towards  the  end  of  it  the  flowers  begin  to  open.    At 
this  period,  if  the  season  be  not  quite  favourable,  the  plants  must  be 
brought  under  shelter,  in  order  to  protect  them  from  the  effects  of 
frost  or  too  much  wet,  care  being  taken  to  admit  the  air  as  freely  as 


possible,  as  without  this  the  flowers  become  pale,  weak,  ;mdt>f  a  bad 
colour.  About  the  end  of  October  it  is  necessary  to  remove  them  to 
the  greenhouse,  and  place  them  in  such  situations  as  that  they  may 
have  the  advantage  of  free  air  without  being  shaded  by  other  plants. 
During  the  winter  season,  when  the  weather  is  mild,  a  little  water 
may  be  given  occasionally;  but  in  case  of  frost  it  must  be  wholly 
omitted,  the  plants  being  kept  as  dry  as  possible. 

The  only  management  that  plants  of  this  sort  demand  is  that  of 
protection  from  the  effects  of  frost  and  too  much  moisture;  it  is  of 
course  only  necessary  to  shelter  them  in  the  house  in  the  winter 
months,  without  the  aid  of  artificial  heat,  and  place  them  out  in  the 
open  air  in  summer. 


2.  ASPHODELUS  LUTEUS. 

YELLOW    ASPHODEL. 


THIS  genus  contains  plants  of  the  herbaceous  perennial  and  an- 
nual flowery  kinds,  having  fleshy  fibrous  roots.  The  King's  Spear. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Hexandria  Monogynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Coronarice. 

The  characters  of  which  are :  that  it  has  no  calyx :  the  corolla  is 
one-petalled,  six-parted;  the  divisions  lanceolate,  flat,  and  spread- 
ing: the  nectary  consists  of  six  very  small  valves,  converging  into  a 
globe,  inserted  into  the  base  of  the  corolla:  the  stamina  have  six  fila- 
ments, subulate,  inserted  into  the  valves  of  the  nectary,  bowed;  alter- 
nately shorter:  the  anthers  are  oblong,  incumbent,  and  rising:  the 
pistillum  is  a  roundish  germ,  within  the  nectary:  the  style  subulate, 
in  the  same  situation  with  the  stamens:  stigma  truncate:  the  peri- 
carpium  is  a  globular  capsule,  fleshy,  three-lobed,  and  three-celled: 
the  seeds  several,  triangular,  and  gibbous  on  one  side. 


24 

The  species  are,  1.  A.  luteus,  Yellow  Asphodel,  or  King's  Spear; 
S.  A.  ramosus,  Branched  Greater  White  Asphodel,  or  King's  Spear  r 
3.  A.  fistulosus,  Hollow  or  Onion-leaved  Minor  Asphodel,  or  King's 
Spear. 

The  roots  of  the  first  are  composed  of  many  thick,  fleshy,  yellow 
tubers,  joined  into  a  head  at  the  top;  whence  arise  strong,  round, 
single  stalks,  near  three  feet  high,  covered  their  whole  length  with 
long  three-cornered,  boat-shaped  leaves,  of  a  sea-green  colour:  the 
upper  part  of  the  stalk  is  adorned  half  way  with  yellow  star-shaped 
flowers,  which  begin  to  open  at  bottom,  so  that  on  the  same  spike 
there  is  often  a  succession  of  flowers  during  a  full  month  from  the 
lime  of  its  beginning  to  flower,  which  is  in  June,  or  towards  the  end 
of  May.  It  is  a  native  of  Sicily. 

The  second  species  has  likewise  roots  composed  of  many  thick 
fleshy  fibres,  to  each  of  which  is  fastened  an  oblong  tuber,  as  large 
as  a  small  potato;  the  leaves  are  long  and  flexible,  having  acute 
edges;  they  grow  in  irregular  clusters  from  the  crown  of  the  root; 
among  these  come  out  the  stalks,  which  rise  more  than  three  feet 
high,  sending  out  several  side  branches,  which  are  naked;  the  upper 
parts  of  these  are  adorned  with  many  star-shaped  flowers,  which  are 
white  with  a  purple  line  running  longitudinally  along  the  outside  of 
each  segment.  They  grow  in  long  spikes,  flowering  successively 
from  the  bottom  upwards.  They  appear  the  beginning  of  June,  and 
the  seeds  ripen  in  autumn.  It  is  a  native  of  the  south  of  Europe. 

There  is  a  variety,  according  to  Miller,  which  is  unbranched,  with 
white  flowers. 

The  third  species  is  an  annual  plant.  The  roots  are  composed  of 
many  fleshy  yellow  fibres.  The  leaves  are  spread  out  from  the  crown 
of  the  root,  close  to  the  ground,  in  a  large  cluster;  they  are  convex 
on  their  under  side,  but  flat  above,  and  hollow.  The  flower-stalks 
rise  immediately  from  the  root,  and  grow  about  two  feet  high,  divid- 
ing upwards  into  three  or  four  branches,  which  are  adorned  witli 
white  starry  flowers,  having  purple  lines  on  the  outside:  these  come 
out  in  July  and  August,  and  their  seeds  ripen  in  October,  soon  after 
which  the  plants  decay.  It  is  native  of  the  south  of  France. 


25 

Culture. — These  are  plants  that  require  little  trouble  in  their  cul- 
tivation, and  which  succeed  in  almost  any  soil  or  situalion.  They 
are  capable  of  being  propagated  by  seeds  and  by  parting  the  roots. 

In  the  first  method  the  seeds  should  be  sown  as  soon  as  they  are 
perfectly  ripened  in  the  autumn,  upon  a  bed  of  light  fresh  earth  in  a 
warm  aspect.  The  plants  will  rise  in  the  early  spring  months,  and 
after  being  kept  clean  during  the  summer,  may  be  transplanted  into 
fresh  beds  in  the  succeeding  autumn  or  spring,  at  the  distance  of  six 
inches  from  each  other,  and  in  the  following  autumn  be  planted  out 
in  the  situations  where  they  are  to  remain.  But  it  is  probably  a  bet- 
ter practice  to  remove  the  plants  from  the  seed-bed  into  the  places 
where  they  are  to  continue,  as  in  this  way  they  grow  with  more  vigour. 
The  third  sort  can  only  be  raised  from  seeds,  which  should  be  sown, 
in  the  autumn;  and  the  plants,  when  they  have  put  out  three  or  four 
leaves,  be  removed  into  the  places  where  they  are  to  grow. 

In  the  latter  mode  the  slips  or  parted  roots  may  be  planted  out, 
either  on  beds  or  in  the  places  where  they  are  to  grow,  in  the  autumn 
or  early  spring.  In  the  former  case  the  plants  are  usually  allowed  a 
summer's  growth  before  they  are  removed.  In  either  way  the  tops 
of  the  roots  should  be  covered  three  or  four  inches  with  mold.  They 
usually  flower  in  the  following  summer. 

The  first  species  multiplies  rapidly  by  roots,  but  the  second  more 
sparingly,  and  does  not  bear  transplanting  so  well,  as  it  is  rendered 
more  weak  in  its  flowering. 

The  variety  with  white  flowers  is  less  hardy  than  either  of  these 
species. 

In  severe  winters  it  is  useful  to  protect  the  roots  by  the  applica- 
tion of  tan  or  stable-dung;  and  the  stems  should  be  annually  cleared 
away  when  they  begin  to  decay  in  the  autumn. 

These  plants  afford  considerable  variety,  when  properly  inter- 
mixed wjth  others  of  the  flowering  hardy  kinds  in  the  borders  and 
other  parts  of  pleasure-grounds,  producing  a  good  effect  from  their 
continuing  long  in  blow. 


PLATE  IV. 

1.  ANEMONE  HORTENSIS, 

STAR    ANEMONE. 


THIS  genus  comprehends  several  plants  of  the  tuberous-rooted 
flowery  ornamental  kind;  being  perennial  in  their  roots,  but  annual 
in  their  stems  and  flowers. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Potyandria  Polygynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Multisiliqua. 

The  characters  are:  that  it  has  no  calyx;  that  the  corolla  has 
petals  in  two  or  three  rows,  three  in  a  row,  somewhat  oblong :  the 
stamina  have  numerous  filaments,  capillary,  half  the  length  of  the 
corolla:  the  anthers  twin  and  erect:  the  pistillum  has  numerous 
germs  in  a  head,  the  styles  acuminate,  and  the  stigmas  obtuse:  no 
pericarpium :  the  receptacle  globular  or  oblong,  hollowed,  and  dot- 
ted: the  seeds  very  many,  acuminate,  retaining  the  style. 

The  species  are  very  numerous;  but  those  that  most  deserve  the 
cultivator's  attention  in  the  Anemone  kind  are:  1.  A.  coronaria,  Nar- 
row-leaved Garden  Anemone;  2.  A.hortensis,  Broad-leaved  Garden 
Anemone;  3.  A.  nemorosa,  Wood  Anemone;  4.  A.apennina,  Moun- 
tain-blue Wood  Anemone;  5.  A.  ranunculoides,  Yellow-wood  Ane- 
mone. 

In  the  first  species  the  flower-stems  rise  between  the  leaves  im- 
mediately from  the  roots,  two,  three,  or  more  from  the  same  root,  to 
the  height  of  eight,  ten,  or  twelve  inches,  having  a  leafy  appendage 
<jr  invohierum  a  little  above  the  middle.  The  radical  leaves  are 
deeply  divided  into  numerous  segments,  which  are  subdivided  by 
threes  into  many  narrow  divisions.  At  the  top  each  stem  is  adorned 
with  a  flower,  which  in  the  double  sorts  is  large  and  very  ornamental. 


l:>inlf,l  h*    ]'..,' t;,{». i !•</.<•  1.,-,,.1,'n   1',,1-lillifJ  Ju(y 

,  J in 'in,  /i,      lt(>rt/- titts 


fat  IsKfar.rkj    Flfft  Strffl 

,  J//>/n-il         im  >/i>r 
•  l//un;i 


V        ^     ^,    *  J     *  '   *    *  '  */'  *'  *        '    * 


27 

It  is  a  native  of  the  Levant,  where  it  grows  single,  but  has  been  ren- 
dered double  by  cultivation. 

The  varieties  are  very  numerous:  in  the  single  sorts,  the  Watchet 
or  Pale  Blue;  the  Common  Purple;  the  Scarlet,  and  many  interme- 
diate varieties.  In  the  double  kinds,  the  Common  Double  Red  and 
Scarlet;  the  Parti-coloured  Crimson;  the  Crimson  Velvet;  the'Great 
Double  Blush;  the  White;  the  Lesser  Blush;  the  Purple;  the  Blue; 
the  Rose-coloured;  the  Carnation;  the  Purple  Velvet;  the  Purple 
Velvet  of  three  colours;  the  Double  Brimstone;  the  Green,  &c. 

In  the  second  sort  the  stems  rise  to  the  same  height.  According 
to  Haller,  the  root-leaves  are  of  two  kinds;  one  very  deeply  gashed, 
so  that  they  have  the  appearance  of  being  five-fingered,  but  are  in 
reality  three-parted,  the  side-lobes  being  two-parted  to  the  very  base; 
all  the  lobes  are  narrow  and  sharp:  the  side  ones  deeply  bifid,  the 
middle  ones  trifid  or  quadrifid,  the  extreme  ones  sharply  lanceolate: 
the  other  kind  broad,  deeply  three-lobed,  blunt,  bluntly  and  shortly 
serrate  at  the  tip,  with  an  awn  standing  out.  The  leaf  on  the  stem, 
or  involucre,  is  ternate,  the  leaflets  ovate-lanceolate.  The  peduncle 
is  solitary  and  one-flowered,  as  in  the  first:  the  petals  three  times 
three  (in  the  natural  single  flowers,)  long,  elliptic,  marked  with  lines, 
the  outer  ones  subhirsute  on  the  outside,  white  at  the  base  with  green 
lines.  The  roots  in  this  as  well  as  the  first  consist  of  small  tubers. 

There  are  several  varieties  of  this  both  with  single  and  double 
flowers:  the  single  and  double  Yellow:  the  Purple  Starre  Anemone, 
darker  and  paler;  Violet  Purple;  Purple  striped;  Carnation;  Grede- 
line,  between  a  peach-colour  and  a  violet;  Cochenille,  of  a  fine  red- 
dish violet  or  purple;  Cardinal,  of  a  rich  crimson  red;  Bloud-red,  of 
a  deeper,  but  not  so  lively  a  red;  Crimson;  Stamell,  near  unto  a 
scarlet;  Incarnadine,  of  a  fine  delayed  red  or  flesh-colour;  Spanish 
Incarnate,  of  a  lively  flesh-colour,  shadowed  with  yellow;  Blush,  of 
a  fair  whitish  red;  Nutmegge,  of  a  dark  whitish  colour,  striped  with 
veins  of  a  blush-colour;  Monk's-gray,  pale  whitish  tending  to  a  gray; 
Great  Orengc  Tawnie;  Lesser  Orenge  Tawnie:  in  the  double,  the 
great  double  Anemone  of  Constantinople,  or  Spanish  Marigold;  great 
double  Orenge  Tawnie;  double  Anemone  of  Cyprus;,  double  Persian 


27 

It  is  a  native  of  the  Levant,  where  it  grows  single,  but  has  been  ren- 
dered double  by  cultivation. 

The  varieties  are  very  numerous:  in  the  single  sorts,  the  Watchet 
or  Pale  Blue;  the  Common  Purple;  the  Scarlet,  and  many  interme- 
diate varieties.  In  the  double  kinds,  the  Common  Double  Red  and 
Scarlet;  the  Parti-coloured  Crimson ;  the  Crimson  Velvet;  the 'Great 
Double  Blush;  the  White;  the  Lesser  Blush;  the  Purple;  the  Blue; 
the  Rose-coloured;  the  Carnation;  the  Purple  Velvet;  the  Purple 
Velvet  of  three  colours;  the  Double  Brimstone;  the  Green,  Sec. 

In  the  second  sort  the  stems  rise  to  the  same  height.  According 
to  Haller,  the  root-leaves  are  of  two  kinds;  one  very  deeply  gashed, 
so  that  they  have  the  appearance  of  being  five-fingered,  but  are  in 
reality  three-parted,  the  side-lobes  being  two-parted  to  the  very  base; 
all  the  lobes  are  narrow  and  sharp:  the  side  ones  deeply  bifid,  the 
middle  ones  trifid  or  quadrifid,  the  extreme  ones  sharply  lanceolate: 
the  other  kind  broad,  deeply  three-lobed,  blunt,  bluntly  and  shortly 
serrate  at  the  tip,  with  an  awn  standing  out.  The  leaf  on  the  stem, 
or  involucre,  is  ternate,  the  leaflets  ovate-lanceolate.  The  peduncle 
is  solitary  and  one-flowered,  as  in  the  first:  the  petals  three  times 
three  (in  the  natural  single  flowers,)  long,  elliptic,  marked  with  lines, 
the  outer  ones  subhirsute  on  the  outside,  white  at  the  base  with  green 
lines.  The  roots  in  this  as  well  as  the  first  consist  of  small  tubers. 

There  are  several  varieties  of  this  both  with  single  and  double 
flowers:  the  single  and  double  Yellow:  the  Purple  Starre  Anemone, 
darker  and  paler;  Violet  Purple;  Purple  striped;  Carnation;  Grede- 
line,  between  a  peach-colour  and  a  violet;  Cochenille,  of  a  fine  red- 
dish violet  or  purple;  Cardinal,  of  a  rich  crimson  red;  Bloud-red,  of 
a  deeper,  but  not  so  lively  a  red;  Crimson;  Stamell,  near  unto  a 
scarlet;  Incarnadine,  of  a  fine  delayed  red  or  flesh-colour;  Spanish 
Incarnate,  of  a  lively  flesh-colour,  shadowed  with  yellow;  Blush,  of 
a  fair  whitish  red;  Nutmegge,  of  a  dark  whitish  colour,  striped  with 
veins  of  a  blush-colour;  Monk's-gray,  pale  whitish  tending  to  a  gray; 
Great  Orengc  Tawnie;  Lesser  Orenge  Tawnie:  in  the  double,  the 
great  double  Anemone  of  Constantinople,  or  Spanish  Marigold;  great 
double  Orenge  Tawnie;  double  Anemone  of  Cyprus;,  double  Persian 


28 

.Anemone;  the  common  great  double  Variable  Anemone;  common 
double  and  variegated  Scarlet;  Red  and  Purple;  variegated  of  these 
colours. 

The  best  Star-Anemones  are  said  to  come  from  Brittany,  where 
they  raise  yearly  many  fine  sorts. 

In  the  third  species  the  root  is  perennial  and  creeping.  The 
height  of  the  whole  plant  from  five  to  ten  inches:  the  stem  single, 
round,  and  pubescent;  bearing  one  leaf,  and  one  flower.  The  leaf 
is  doubly  ternate;  each  part  being  petioled;  the  petiole  is  flat  and 
broad,  particularly  at  the  base;  each  part,  or  leaf  (for  some  consider 
it  as  three  leaves)  is  trifid;  each  leaflet  being  gash-serrate,  and  hairy 
underneath,  especially  on  the  nerves.  The  peduncle  is  from  an  inch 
*o  two  inches  in  length,  is  only  a  continuation  of  the  stem,  and  springs 
from  the  centre  of  the  leaf.  The  flower  consists  of  six  or  seven  ob- 
long-ovate petals,  sometimes  ending  bluntly,  sometimes  emarginate, 
and  the  Editor  of  Miller's  Dictionary  has  observed  them  not  unfre- 
quently  even  gashed  or  lacerate.  The  usual  colour  is  white,  but 
they  are  often  tinged  with  purple  on  the  outside,  particularly  the 
three  outer  ones;  and  sometimes  they  are  entirely  purple  on  both 
sides.  The  joint  of  the  stem,  and  the  backs  of  the  leaves  are  also  apt 
to  be  tinged  with  red. 

The  varieties  are:  with  single  flowers,  with  double  white  flowers, 
with  single  purple  flowers,  with  double  purple  flowers,  and  with  red- 
dish purple  flowers.  / 

In  the  fourth  species  the  root  is  perennial  and  tuberous;  the  stem 
round,  purplish,  and  about  a  span  high:  the  root-leaves  on  long 
petioles,  lernate,  and  leaflets  usually  three-parted;  the  segments  va- 
riously cut  and  divided,  somewhat  pointed,  hairy  on  both  sides;  one 
three-parted  leaf,  or  three  leaves  together  on  the  stem,  like  the  others, 
but  on  short,  sheathing  petioles.  From  the  centre  of  these  arises  the 
peduncle,  about  a  hand  high,  round  and  purplish,  except  near  the 
flower,  where  it  is  green.  The  stem,  leaves,  and  peduncle,  are  com- 
monly slightly  hairy:  the  flowers  are  upright,  of  a  pale  blue  colour, 
and  sweet  smell;  the  petals  oblong,  from  twelve  to  fifteen,  and  dis- 
posed in  three  rows.  It  flowers  in  April. 


29 

The  varielics  arc:  with  single  blue  flowers,  \vilh  double  blue 
flowers,  with  single  violet-coloured  flowers,  with  double  violet- 

3  O  • 

coloured  flowers. 

The  fifth  differs  from  the  above  in  having  a  yellow  corolla,  two 
petals  alternately  outer,  and  two  inner,  and  one  having  one  side 
within  and  the  other  side  without  the  next  petal;  whereas  that  has 
three  outer  and  three  inner  petals:  it  differs  also  in  the  peduncles 
being  accompanied  with  two  leaflets,  the  latter  of  which  is  furnished 
with  three  at  the  ba<e.  It  flowers  a  little  earlier  lihan  the  other.  It 
has  sometimes  two  flowers  on  a  stem,  though  often  but  one,  the  pe- 
duncles villose  and  short,  sa  that  the  flower  scarcely  rises  above 
the  leaves:  the  petals  are  five,  and  roundish;  the  stamens  about 
fifty.  It  grows  wild  in  Sweden,  &c. 

In  the  Pulsatilla,  or  Pasque-flower  sort,  the  species  are:  I.  A. 
piilsatilla,  Pasque-flower;  2.  A.  patens,  Woolly- leaved  Pulsatilla,  or 
Anemone;  3.  A.  vernalis,  Early  Spring  Pulsatilla,  or  Anemone. 

In  the  first  species  the  peduncles  are  erect  and  round,  from  four 
to  seven  or  eight  inches  in  height,  villose,  one-flowered;  lengthening 
after  the  flowering  is  past.  The  involucre  multifid,  with  the  divisions 
linear  and  villose.  It  sits  close  to  the  flower,  but  when  that  is  fallen 
it  is  found  almost  in  the  middle  of,  the  peduncle.  The  corolla  spe- 
cious, and  purple  in  colour;  the  petals  lanceolate,  and  villose  with- 
out; the  seeds  ovate,  tailed,  hairy,  and  scarcely  adhering  to  the 
receptacle:  the  leaves  rough  and  finely  cut,  with  three  or  four  pairs 
of  pinnas  and  pinnules.  It  grows  naturally  in  Sweden,  and  flowers- 
in  April. 

The  varieties  are;  with  single  blue  flowers,  with  double  blue 
flowers,  with  single  and  double  while  flowers,  with  single  and  double 
red  flowers,  and  with  violet-coloured  flowers. 

The  second  has  the  root  perennial ;  the  root-leaves  are  ternate- 
digitate;  leaflets  sessile,  laciniate  and  acuminate,  the  middle  leaflet 
triparlite,  the  side  ones  bipartite;  the  scape  one-flowered,  shorter 
than  the  leaves;  the  involucre  remote  and  villose;  the  corolla  while 
and  villose  underneath;  the  stamens  yellow.  It  is  a  native  of  Si- 
beria. 


so 

The  third  species  has  the  flower  red  without,  white  within;  it 
blows  earlier  than  the  Pasque-flower;  the  leaves  approach  those  of 
Meadow-Rue;  the  stem  is  half  a  foot  high,  with  a  very  tomentose, 
yellow,  shining  involucre  in  the  middle,  finely  cut.  When  the  flower 
is  young,  it  is  white  with  a  blush  of  purple  on  the  outside,  where  it 
is  hairy:  these  hairs  afterwards  become  yellow.  The  corolla  consists 
of  six  convergent  ovate-lanceolate  petals:  the  stamens  are  very  nu- 
merous. It  grows  in  the  woods  in  Sweden,  &c. 

In  the  Hepatica  kind  the  only  species  is  the  A.  Hcpatica,  or 
Hepatica. 

In  this  the  leaves  of  the  year  before  remain,  which  are  heart- 
shaped,  three-lobed,  obtuse,  and  smooth,  beneath  being  veined  in 
net- work:  the  petioles  are  cylindric,  long,  and  rising:  the  bud  has 
generally  four  outer  scales,  ovate  and  membranaceous;  three  inner 
ones,  concealing  the  leaves  and  flowers;  the  peduncles  three,  cylin- 
dric, hairy,  and  one-flowered.  The  flower  lies  a  year  complete  in 
all  its  parts  within  the  bud.  The  corolla  has  six  petals  in  two  rows 
of  three  each,  lanceolate,  and  spreading:  the  stamens  are  about 
twenty-five:  the  seeds  oblong-ovate,  involved  in  a  silky  substance; 
but  many  of  them  abortive.  It  is  found  wild  in  Sweden,  &c.  It 
flowers  early. 

The  varieties  in  cultivation  are  numerous:  the  single  and  double 
blue,  single  and  double  red  or  peach-coloured,  single  and  double 
white,  single  and  double  variegated  red  and  white,  single  and 
double  violet-coloured,  with  striped  leaves. 

Culture  in  the  Garden  kinds. — All  the  species  and  varieties  of  the 
garden  and  wood  Anemones  are  capable  of  being  propagated  by  off- 
sets from,  or  dividing  their  roots.  By  sowing  the  seed,  new  varieties 
may  also  be  obtained. 

In  order  to  procure  the  offsets,  and  dig  over  and  prepare  the  beds, 
the  best  sorts  should  bo  annually  taken  up  immediately  on  their 
leaves  beginning  to  decay,  as  in  the  early  part  of  June  for  the  more 
forward  sorts.  They  must  then  be  divided,  or  have  the  otFset  knobs 
taken  off.  This  work  should  always  be  performed  in  a  dry  season, 
the  root-bulbs,  after  the  earth  has  been  removed,  being  deposited  on 


31 

a  mat,  in  an  airy  dry  place,  where  there  is  not  much  sun,  being 
spread  out  in  a  thin  manner.  When  they  are  become  quite  dry,  the 
remainder  of  the  earth  should  be  rubbed  off  them,  and  they  may  be 
put  up  in  bags  or  boxes,  and  placed  in  a  situation  where  they  can- 
not be  injured  by  vermin.  The  roots  should  not  be  too  much  parted 
where  they  are  intended  to  flower  strongly,  and  each  part  should  be 
furnished  with  a  good  eye.  Where  the  taking  up  has  been  delayed 
till  the  roots  begin  to  make  new  shoots,  it  will  be  too  late  to  remove 
them  that  season. 

In  planting  the  roots  or  sets  thus  procured,  or  which  have  been 
purchased  from  the  seedsmen,  such  situalions  should  be  chosen  for 
blowing  them  in  as  are  free  from  much  moisture,  and  where  the  ex- 
posure is  open  to  the  influence  of  the  sun  and  air,  and  free  from  the 
shade  of  trees.     They  will  succeed  and  flower  in  tolerable  perfection, 
in  any  soil  that  is  sufficiently  light  and  friable  in  the  mould;  but  in 
order  to  have  them  blow  in  the  greatest  perfection,  beds  should  be 
prepared  with  earthy  mixtures,  made  by  taking  off  the  surface  of 
such  lands  as  have  been  long  in  the  state  of  sward,  to  the  depth  of 
eight  or  ten  inches,  where  the  earth  is  of  the  light  sandy  or  hazel 
mould  kind,  throwing  it  up  for  some  time  that  it  may  rot  and  be- 
come perfectly  mellow;  when  rotten  cow-dung,  in  the  proportion  of 
one-third,  should  be  incorporated  with  it,  by  having  them  thrown  up 
together  into  a  heap,  and  frequently  turned  over  afterwards;   the 
stones  and  clods  being  carefully  raked  out  and  reduced;  but  the 
earth  should  not  be  sifted,  as  it  is  apt  by  such  means  to  become  too 
stiff  and  compact.     Some  advise  the  addition  of  drift  or  sea-sand,  in 
the  quantity  of  about  one-fourth. 

With  this  earth  beds  must  be  formed  for  the  reception  of  the 
roots:  these  should  be  marked  out  to  the  breadth  of  about  three  feet 
and  an  half,  with  length  sufficient  for  the  quantity  of  roots,  having 
alleys  between  them  of  from  a  foot  to  eighteen  inches.  The  pre- 
pared mould  is  then  to  be  dug  or  rilled  in  to  the  depth  of  twelve  or 
sixteen  inches,  leaving  the  surfaces  of  the  beds  from  three  to  six 
inches  above  the  common  level  of  the  ground,  according  to  the  wet- 

O  *  O 

ness  of  the  soil,  giving  them  a  little  convexity  when  there  is  much 


32 

\ 

moisture.     Some  recommend  the  putting  of  a  layer  of  well-rotted 

cow-dung,  about  five  inches  in  thickness,  below  the  compost  materials. 
The  surface  of  the  beds  should  be  raked  even  before  the  roots  are 
put  in.  In  planting,  six  rows  should  be  put  in  each  bed,  the  roots 
being  set  at  the  distance  of  six  inches  from  each  other  in  the  rows, 
and  to  the  depth  of  two  or  three  inches.  When  this  has  been  done, 
the  surface  should  be  made  smooth  by  raking  it  over  lightly. 

The  time  of  planting  should  vary  according  to  that  which  it  is 
intended  they  should  blow  at.  The  best  season  where  early  flower- 
ing is  intended  is  in  the  latter  end  of  September  or  the  beginning  of 
the  following  month;  for  a  middle  flowering,  about  the  middle  of 
October;  and  for  late  flowering,  the  latter  end  of  February.  In  this 
mode  of  planting  a  succession  of  flowers  may  be  provided  from  April 
till  the  middle  of  June.  Those  roots  that  are  planted  the  earliest  are 
in  general  the  strongest,  and  afford  the  best  flowers,  as  well  as  the 
greatest  increase  of  off-sets.  It  is  always  advisable  to  keep  a  few 
roots  out  of  the  ground  till  the  spring  season,  for  the  purpose  of  a 
succession  of  flowers,  and  lest  the  early  planted  ones  should  be  in- 
jured by  the  severity  of  the  winter,  which  is  sometimes  the  case 
where  they  are  not  covered  to  protect  them  from  frost.  These  spring- 
planted  roots  flower  a  fortnight  or  three  weeks  after  those  which 
were  planted  in  autumn,  and  many  times  blow  equally  as  fair,  espe- 
cially if  it  prove  a  moist  spring,,  and  care  be  taken  to  refresh  them 
gently  with  water. 

But  the  increase  of  these  roots  will  not  be  near  so  great  as  in  those 
of  the  first  planting,  provided  they  are  not  hurt  in  winter;  and  it  is 
for  this  reason  that  those  who  deal  in  these  roots  are  forward  in  plant- 
ing; as,  although  it  may  sometimes  happen,  by  sharp  pinching  frosts 
in  the  spring,  that  their  flowers  are  not  so  double  and  fair  as  those 
planted  a  little  later,  yet,  if  they  can  preserve  the  green  leaves  of 
the  plants  from  being  injured,  the  roots  greatly  increase  in  bulk.  But 
in  gardens  where  these  flowers  are  preserved  with  care  there  is  alwaj's 
provision  made  to  cover  them  from  the  injuries  of  the  weather,  by 
arching  the  beds  over  with  hoops  or  frames  of  wood,  and  covering 
them  with  garden  rnals  or  cloths  in  frosty  nights,  especially  in  the 


33 

spring  of  the  year,  when  their  buds  begin  to  appear:  otherwise,  if 
the  best  and  most  double  flowers  be  planted,  the  black  frosts  and 
cutting  winds  in  March  will  often  cause  them  to  blow  single,  by  de- 
stroying the  thrum  that  is  in  the  middle  of  the  flower; — a  circum- 
stance which  has  often  occasioned  persons  who  have  bought  the 
roots  to  think  they  were  cheated,  when  it  was  wholly  owing  to  their 
neglect  of  covering  them. 

But,  besides  this  mode,  llieso  roots  ma}'  be  planted  in  borders, 
clumps,  and  other  places,  with  much  success  and  effect,  in  mixture 
with  other  plants;  in  which  method  three,  four,  or  more  roots  should 
be  planted  together  in  patches  of  the  breadth  of  five  or  six  inches, 
being  properly  varied  in  distance  and  situation.  And  whether  planted 
in  beds  or  the  borders  a  showery  season  should  be  chosen  for  the 
purpose,  as  in  dry  weather  they  are  apt  to  become  diseased, — proper 
care  being  taken  to  manage  the  distribution  of  the  colours  in  such  a 
way  as  to  produce  an  agreeable  variety.  They  may  likewise  be 
planted  in  pots,  where  the  varieties  are  curious  and  valuable,  three 
or  more  roots  being  put  into  each;  and  by  being  protected  by  frames, 
a  green-house  or  hot-house  during  the  winter  season,  they  may  be 
brought  forward  so  as  to  flower  very  early  and  in  great  perfection. 

In  the  wood  sorts  the  propagation  may  be  effected  in  the  same 
manner  as  in  the  garden  kinds;  but  the  sooner  the  roots  are  taken 
up  and  divided  after  the  decay  of  the  leaves  the  better.  The  wild 
Anemones  should  be  taken  up  when  the  leaves  decline,  and  be 
planted  out  in  proper  situations. 

In  raising  new  varieties  of  these  plants  from  seed,  some  of  the 
best  and  most  leafy  single,  or  what  are  usually  termed  Poppy  Ane- 
mones, should  be  provided,  and  planted  out  early  that  they  may 
groAv  vigorously  and  afford  good  seed,  which  should  be  carefully  col- 
lected a  few  weeks  after  their  flowering  is  finished.  Some,  however, 
procure  the  seed  from  the  shops.  The  best  time  of  sowing  is  proba- 
bly in  August;  but  some  advise  the  spring,  as  in  March  or  the  fol- 
lowing month.  This  may  be  performed  in  boxes,  pots,  or  broad 
earthen  pans,  where  a  small  supply  of  roots  only  is  wanted;  but 
where  the  demand  is  great,  it  is  best  sown  on  beds  prepared  for  the 

p 


34 

purpose.  The  proper  soil  or  earth  for  this  use  is  that  of  the  light 
sandy  kind.  The  seed  should  he  sown  as  evenly  as  possible,  but 
rather  thick,  and  be  covered  by  sifting  light  mould  over  it  to  the 
depth  of  about  a  quarter  of  au  inch.  The  only  attention  necessary 
afterwards  is  that  of  occasionally  shading  the  plants  from  the  effects 
of  the  sun  in  hot  weather,  and  giving  them  a  gentle  watering  now 
and  then.  In  about  six  weeks  the  plants  will  show  themselves,  when 
they  should  be  kept  perfectly  free  from  weeds  till  the  leaves  begin 
to  decay,  when  a  covering  of  light  sifted  mould  should  be  again  ap- 
plied, and  another  in  the  autumn  may  sometimes  be  required. 
During  the  winter  they  should  be  well  protected  from  the  frosts.  In 
the  second  summer  many  of  the  plants  will  flower,  and  the  best  may  be 
marked  by  a  stick;  but  none  should  be  destroyed  till  the  third  year. 
At  this  period  the  roots  will  begin  to  be  too  thick,  and  at  the  decay 
of  the  leaves  must  of  course  be  taken  up,  which  is  best  done  by  pass- 
ing the  mould  through  a  fine  sieve.  And  as  when  sown  in  beds 
many  roots  will  be  unavoidably  left,  they  should  be  levelled,  and 
suffered  to  remain  till  the  following  year.  The  roots  that  have 
been  separated  should  be  preserved,  as  before  directed,  for  future 
planting. 

These  arc  all  highly  ornamental  plants,  capable  of  being  cm- 
ployed  with  much  effect  in  pleasure-grounds:  many  of  them  are 
hardy,  flower  early,  and  produce  great  variety  in  such  situations. 
The  \vood  sorts  are  very  useful  in  adorning  wilderness  quarters.  The 
double  sorts,  when  in  beds,  afford  much  beauty  and  variety. 

In  the  pul sat  ill  a  kinds  the  propagation  may  be  accomplished 
either  by  the  seed  or  dividing  the  roots.  In  the  first  method  the 
seeds  should  be  sown  in  boxes  or  pots  filled  with  very  light  sandy 
earth,  and  not  covered  too  deep  with  mould,  which  will  prevent 
their  rising,  as  they  require  no  more  than  just  to  be  covered.  The 
boxes  should  be  placed  where  they  may  have  the  advantage  of  the 
morning  sun,  but  be  screened  from  it  in  the  heat  of  the  day;  and 
when  the  season  is  dry  the  earth  be  refreshed  occasionally  with 
water.  The  best  lime  for  sowing  is  in  July  or  August,  soon  after  the 
seed  is  ripened;  as  by  keeping  its  vegetative  power  is  apt  to  be  de- 


35 

stroyed.  The  boxes  or  pots  should  remain  in  such  shad}'  situations 
until  the  beginning  of  October,  when  they  may  be  moved  so  as  to 
enjoy  the  full  sun  during  the  winter  season.  In  March,  when  the 
plants  begin  to  appear,  they  should  be  again  removed  so  as  to  have 
only  the  forenoon  sun;  for  if  they  arc  too  much  exposed  to  heat  the 
young  plants  are  soon  destroyed.  They  should  be  refreshed  occa- 
sionally with  water  in  dry  weather,  and  be  carefully  kept  clean  from 
weeds. 

When  the  leaves  are  entirely  decayed,  the  roots  should  be  taken 
up  in  the  manner  directed  above;  and  as  there  will  be  many  small 
roots  left,  the  earth  should  either  be  returned  into  the  boxes  again,  or 
spread  upon  a  bed  of  light  earth,  to  see  what  plants  may  rise  the 
succeeding  year.  The  roots  after  bding  thus  taken  up  should  be 
immediately  replanted  in  beds  of  light  fresh  sandy  earth,  about  three 
or  four  inches  asunder;  covering  them  about  three  inches  thick  with 
the  same  light  earlh.  The  spring  following  most  of  the  plants  will 
produce  flowers,  but  not  so  large  or  fair  as  in  the  succeeding  years. 
As  the  roots  of  these  plants  are  fleshy,  and  generally  run  down  deep, 
they  will  not  bear  to  be  kept  long  out  of  the  ground;  therefore, 
when  they  are  removed,  it  should  be  done  early  in  the  autumn,  that 
they  may  take  fresh  root  before  the  frost  sets  in. 

In  this  mode  of  propagation  the  plants  thrive  best  in  loamy  soil; 
as  in  very  light  dry  ground  they  are  apt  to  be  destroyed  by  too 
much  heat. 

These  are  plants  that  afford  variety  in  the  borders  of  pleasure- 
grounds,  especially  the  first  species  and  its  varieties,  which  are  hardy, 
succeeding  in  almost  any  situation. 

In  the  hepatica  kind  the  propagation  may  be  effected  in  the  single 
sorts  either  by  the  seed  or  the  parting  of  the  roots;  but  in  the  double 
it  can  only  be  done  by  the  latter  method.  The  seed  of  the  single 
flowers  frequently,  however,  produces  double  ones.  New  varieties 
are  likewise  raised  in  the  former  manner. 

In  the  first  method  the  most  proper  season  for  sowing  the  seeds 
is  in  the  beginning  of  August,  either  in  pots  or  boxes  of  light  earth, 
which  should  be  placed  so  as  to  have  only  the  morning  sun  until 


36 

October,  when  they  should  be  removed  into  the  full  sun  to  remain 
during  the  winter  season:  but  in  March,  when  the  young  plants  be- 
gin to  appear,  they  must  be  removed  again  to  a  shady  situation, 
and  in  dry  weather  be  frequently  watered;  when  about  the  beginning 
of  August  they  will  be  fit  to  be  transplanted:  at  which  lime  prepare 
a  border  of  good  fresh  loamy  earth,  with  an  eastern  aspect;  inta 
which  remove  the  plants,  placing  them  about  six  inches  distance 
each  way,  closing  the  earth  pretty  well  to  their  roots,  to  prevent  the 
worms  from  drawing  them  out  of  the  ground.  In  the  spring  follow- 
ing they  begin  to  show  their  flowers;  but  it  is  three  years  before 
they  flower  strong,  till  which  time  their  goodness  cannot  be  ascer- 
tained: when  if  any  double  flowers,  or  such  as  are  of  a  different 
colour  from  the  common  sorts,  be  found,  they  should  be  taken  up 
and  planted  in  the  borders,  where  they  should  continue  at  least  two- 
years  before  ihey  are  taken  up  or  parted ;  as  it  is  remarkable  in  these 
plants,  that  where  they  are  often  removed  and  parted  they  are  very 
apt  to  die;  but  when  they  are  permitted  to  remain  some  years  un- 
disturbed, they  grow  rapidly,  and  become  large  roots.  In  propagat- 
ing them  by  roots  they  should  not  therefore  be  often  parted,  or  into 
too  small  parts. 

Double-flowered  plants,  as  they  never  produce  seeds,  are  only 
capable  of  being  propagated  by  parting  their  roots,  which  should  be 
done  in  March,  when  they  are  in.  flower,  care  being  taken  not  to 
separate  them  into  very  small  heads.  They  should  not  be  parted 
oflener  than  every  third  or  fourth  year,  as  they  never  thrive  or  blow 
well  where  this  is  the  case. 

These  are  plants  that  display  much  beauty,  affording  flowers  very 
early  in  the  beginning  of  the  year.  The  double  sorts  are  the  most 
ornamental,  as  the  flowers  in  them  arc  much  larger,  and  continue  in 
blow  much  longer.  These  should  therefore  be  placed  in  the  most 
conspicuous  situations  in  the  borders  or  clumps  of  pleasure-grounds; 
but  the  single  kinds  deserve  places  for  the  sake  of  variety. 


3? 


2.    ALBUCA    MINOR- 
LESSER  ALBUCA. 


THIS  genus  furnishes  different  bulbous-rooted  herbaceous  peren- 
nial plants  of  the  flowery  ornamental  kind. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  of  Hexandria  Monogynia,  and 
ranks  in  the  natural  order  of  Liliacece. 

The  characters  of  which  are:;  that  it  has  no  calyx:  the  corolla 
has  six  oblong-oval  permanent  petals,  the  three  outer  spreading,  and 
the  three  inner  converging:  the  stamina  have  filaments  shorter  than 
the  corolla;  three  opposite  to  the  inner  petals,  linear-subulate,  com- 
plicate a  little  above  the  base,  then  flat,  three  opposite  to  the  outer 
petals,  thicker;  antherne  on  the  former  oblong,  fixed  to  the  inflex 
tip  of  the  filament,  below  the  middle  upright;  on  the  latter,  similar, 
but  effete,  or  none:  the  pistillum  has  an  oblong  triangular  germ: 
style  three-sided :  stigma  a  triangular,  three-celled,  three-valved 
capsule:  the  seeds  numerous,  flat,  lying  over  each  other,  and  widen- 
ing outwards* 

The  species  are  numerous;  but  those  mostly  for  the  purposes  of 
ornament  are:  1.  A.  altissima,  Tall  Albuca;  2.  A.  major,  Great  Al- 
buca;  3.  A.  minor,  Small  Albuca;  4.  A.  coarctata,  Channel-leaved 
Albuca;  5.  A.  spiralis,  Spiral  leaved  Albuca. 

In  the  first  species  the  leaves  are  so  deeply  channelled  as  to  be 
almost  rolled  into  a  cylinder;  two  feet  long,  and  almost  three  inches 
broad  at  the  base.  The  scape  a  little  shorter  than  the  leaves,  the 
thickness  of  a  finger.  The  raceme  two  feet  long  or  more.  The 
peduncles  bent  downwards  in  the  season  of  flowering,  afterwards 
spreading  and  becoming  finally  erect ;  they  are  three  inches  in 
length.  The  bracteae  green,  except  at  the  edge,  where  they  are  of  a 
clear  white,  an  inch  long.  The  flowers  are  of  a  white  colour;  and 


38 

the  petals  more  than  an  inch  in  length;  the  ouler  ones  sharp  and 
thickened  at  the  tip,  but  the  inner  blunt,  bent  in,  and  having  a  twin 
gland,  composed  of  two  globes,  at  the  end.  The  fertile  filaments 
are  waved  on  the  edge,  with  the  anthcnu  curved  inwards  beneath 
the  glands  of  the  petals:  the  barren  filaments  are  triangular,  fur- 
rowed on  the  outside,  a  little  longer  than  the  others,  and  have  no 
anthera.  The  germ  is  subpedicelled.  The  style  obversely  pyrami- 
dal, the  length  of  the  germ,  covered  with  glandulous  scales:  the 
angles  terminate  in  subulate  horns,  covered  also  with  scales;  the 
centre  being  elongated  into  a  pyramidal  stigma.  It  flowers  in  April 
and  May. 

In  the  second  the  scape  is  a  foot  high,  upright,  roundish,  very 
minutely  streaked,  smooth,  and  ash-coloured,  with  a  glaucous  bloom 
on  it.  The  leaves  are  sharp,  smooth,  and  streaked,  a  foot  long.  The 
bracteae  are  sheath-form,  lanceolate,  concave,  with  a  long  linear- 
subulate  lip,  red,  nerved,  smooth,  straight,  and  solitary,  at  the  base 
of  the  peduncles.  The  raceme  terminating,  Jong,  of  a  crimson  co- 
lour, and  smooth :  the  flowers  alternate,  peduncled,  slightly  nod- 
ding; there  being  fewer  at  bottom.  The  peduncles  round,  smooth, 
one-flowered,  longer  than  the  bracteae,  and  spreading.  The  petals 
linear,  longitudinally  nerved,  marcescent;  the  three  ouler  broader,  a 
little  concave,  red,  blunt  at  the  end,  bent  in  with  a  small  marginal 
scale;  tiie  three  inner  narrower,  upright,  pale  red,  with  a  broad,  thin, 
membranaceous,  whitish  rim  on  each  side,  and  an  ovate,  mernbra- 
naceous,  inflex  scale  at  the  tip.  The  filaments  erect,  the  length  of 
tlie  corolla,  linear,  membranaceous,  whitish,  joined  at  the  base, 
inserted  into  the  receptacle;  they  are  alternately  free,  and  fastened 
below  by  a  broader  base  to  the  inner  petals.  Anlherre  from  incum- 
bent upright;  on  the  loose  filaments  barren;  on  the  three  others 
whitish  with  yellow  pollen,  linear,  blunt  at  each  end,  emarginate,  a 
little  curved  inwards,  convex  at  the  back,  plano-concave  in  front, 
t\vin-furro\ved.  The  germ  fleshy,  pyramidal-cylindric,  blunt,  crim- 
son, smooth,  with  three  calluses  at  the  tip,  on  a  short  peduncle, 
ending  in  several  small  blunt  teeth  pressed  close  to  it.  The  style 
very  thick,  somewhat  flatted,  with  two  of  ihe  angles  nearer  to  each 


39 

oilier,  a  little  attenuated  at  the  base,  pubescent,  red,  shorter  than 
the  germ.  The  stigma  blunt,  of  a  yellowish  red  colour,  pubescent 
at  the  edge.  Capsule  oval,  smooth,  transversely  nerved,  compressed, 
with  two  rims  along  the  back.  The  seeds  are  orbiculate.  Jt  flowers 
in  May. 

In  the  third  the  leaves  are  a  foot  long  and  more,  half  an  inch 
broad  at  the  base.  The  scape  half  a  foot  high,  scarcely  a  line  in 
diameter.  The  raceme  six  inches  in  length,  or  even  longer.  The 
peduncles  an  inch  and  a  half  long.  The  bractea^  are  green,  with 
clear  white  edges,  half  an  inch  long,  quickly  withering.  The  flow- 
ers yellow.  The  petals  less  than  an  inch  in  length;  the  outer  ones 
thickened  at  the  tip ;  the  inner  having  a  white,  inflcx,  kidney- 
shaped  gland.  Barren  filaments,  linear,  with  a  filiform  inflex  tip, 
and  no  anthera?.  The  style  obversely  pyramidal,  the  length  of  the 
germ,  covered  with  glandulous  scales.  The  stigma  pyramidal,  pro- 
minent between  the  inner  converging  petals.  It  flowers  in  May  and 
June. 

The  fourth  species  has  the  leaves  linear-subulate,  deeply  chan- 
nelled, two  feet  long  and  upAvards,  scarcely  half  an  inch  wide  at 
the  base.  The  scape  a  little  shorter  than  the  leaves,  nnd  not  so 
thick  as  a  goose  quill.  The  raceme  close,  half  a  foot  in  length.  The 
peduncles  spreading,  a  little  more  than  an  inch  in  length.  The 
bracteee  are  almost  the  length  of  the  peduncle.  The  flowers  yellow. 
Outer  petals  oblong,  thickened  at  the  tip,  above  an  inch  in  length; 
the  inner  ones  oval,  a  little  shorter  than  the  outer  ones.  Barren  fila- 
ments, somewhat  shorter  than  the  fertile  ones,  convex  without,  chan- 
nelled within:  the  an  theme  sagittate  and  effete.  The  style. prism- 
shaped,  the  length  of  the  germ,  and  terminated  by  a  stigma  from  the 
angles  of  the  style  rounded  at  the' tip.  '  It  flowers  in  May. 

In  the  fifth  the  root-leaves  are  few,  linear-filiform,  upright  at  bot- 
tom, then  spiral,  and  when  the  plant  is  more  mature,  flexuose, 
villose-scabrous,  shorter  than  the  scape,  which  is  simple,  filiform, 
flexuose,  nodding  at  the  top,  streaked,  villose-scabrous,  of  a  finger's 
length,  seldom  a  span  long  after  flowering,  one-flowered,  seldom 


40 

two-flowered.  The  bractea  lanceolate,  acuminate,  shorter  than  the 
peduncle.  There  are  three  filaments  without  antheree. 

They  are  all  natives  of  the  Cape. 

Culture. — The  best  method  of  propagating  these  plants,  is  by 
means  of  offsets  from  the  roots,  which  should  be  taken  after  the 
plants  have  flowered  in  the  summer  months.  These  are  then  to  be 
planted  out  in  pots  filled  with  good  light  mould,  and  placed  under 
the  protection  of  hot-bed  frames  during  the  winter  season.  In  this 
way  they  mostly  succeed  and  produce  flowers.  But  it  is  a  better 
practice,  where  the  convenience  of  a  border  can  be  had  in  the  front 
of  the  greenhouse  or  stove,  to  plant  them  in  the  natural  ground  in 
these  situations,  as  in  this  method  they  both  thrive  better,  and  flower 
with  more  vigour  than  when  kept  in  pots. 

The  third  sort  is  asserted  by  Miller  to  be  capable  of  being  raised 
from  seeds,  when  they  can  be  procured  from  abroad,  as  they  seldom 
or  ever  ripen  any  in  this  climate. 

The  second  species  is  also  said  to  be  of  so  hardy  a  nature,  as 
sometimes  to  succeed  when  planted  out  on  a  border  of  light  earth, 
in  the  open  ground.  All  the  species  are  ornamental,  and  afford 
variety  in  the  greenhouse  or  stove. 


J'I/H/,;/  A-  .IVY  EJwtinb  I.rnJi-nl'ulilifhrJ  Jan.llMfi    bv  t-JC,',i  >:.•/,•  t  F/,;-/  .  I'/r,;-/  .Kn.miwJ  h  F,  !.'/»/,  m 

Arbutus       ti  >«•//,>  _f  Alvfium    <\,r.r,////,f 


T 


ree 


it  //<>W       Al  V/.VII  III. 


PLATE    V. 

1.  ARBUTUS    UNEDO. 

STRAWBERRY    TREE. 


THIS  genus  contains  plants  of  the  evergreen,  shrubby  and  orna- 
mental kind. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Decandria  Monogynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Bicornes. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  five-parted,  obtuse,  very 
small  permanent  perianthium:  the  corolla  is  monopetalous,  ovate, 
and  flattish  at  the  base,  diaphanous,  with  a  quinquefid  mouth:  the 
divisions  obtuse,  revolute  and  small:  the  stamina  consist  often  subu- 
late swelling  filaments,  very  slender  at  the  base,  affixed  to  the  edge 
of  the  base  of  corolla,  and  half  the  length  of  it:  the  antherse  slightly 
bifid  and  nodding:  the  pistillum  is  a  subglobular  germ,  on  a  recep- 
tacle marked  with  ten  dots:  the  style  cylindric,  the  length  of  the 
corolla:  the  stigma  thickish  and  obtuse:  the  pericarpium  a  roundish 
five-celled  berry :  the  seeds  small  and  bony. 

The  species  of  most  importance  are:  1.  A.  Unedo,  Common  Ar- 
butus, or  Strawberry  Tree ;  2.  A.  Andrachne,  Oriental  Strawberry 
Tree ;  3.  A.  Uva  Ursi,  Trailing  Arbutus,  or  Bearberry. 

The  first  species,  Common  Arbutus,  or  Strawberry  Tree,  rises  to 
the  height  of  twenty  or  thirty  feet  in  its  native  situation,  but  rarely 
with  an  upright  stem.  But  with  us  it  is  of  much  humbler  growth. 
It  usually  puts  out  branches  very  near  the  ground.  The  leaves  keep 
on  all  the  winter,  and  are  thrust  off  in  the  spring  by  new  ones,  so 
that  it  is  always  clothed  with  leaves.  The  berries  have  many  seeds 
in  them,  and  are  roughened  with  the  tubercles  of  the  seeds. 

There  are  several  varieties;  as  with  large  oval  fruit,  with  round 

G 


42 

fruit,  with  double  flowers,  with  scarlet  flowers;  there  are  also  the 
curled-leaved  or  cut-leaved,  the  broad-leaved,  and  the  narrow -leaved. 

The  second  species  much  resembles  the  first,  but  the  bark  is  not 
rough;  some  of  the  leaves  have  no  serratures,  and  the  panicle  is  up- 
right and  viscid,  which  in  that  is  smooth.  It  grows  in  its  native 
state  to  a  middle-sized  tree,  with  irregular  branches.  The  leaves  are 
smooth,  large,  and  somewhat  like  those  of  the  Bay  Tree,  but  not 
quite  so  long:  the  flowers  are  like  those  of  the  Common  Arbutus, 
but  growing  thinly  on  the  branches:  the  fruit  oval,  of  the  same  co- 
lour and  consistence  with  the  common  sort;  but  the  seeds  of  this  are 
flat,  while  in  that  they  are  pointed  and  angular.  It  grows  naturally 
in  the  East. 

]n  the  third  species  the  branches  trail  upon  the  ground  two  or 
three  feet  round  the  root  or  more.  The  leaves  are  alternate,  bluntly 
oval  or  oblong  wedge-shaped,  with  a  net-work  of  veins  underneath, 
and  corresponding  wrinkles  above,  firm  and  evergreen,  like  those  of 
Box :  the  flowers  grow  at  the  exlremities  of  the  branches  in  small 
clusters,  each  supported  by  a  short  red  foot-stalk:  they  are  of  an 
oval-conical  figure,  flesh-coloured,  or  white  with  a  red  mouth,  and 
divided  into  five  obtuse  reflex  segments  at  the  rim :  the  berries  are 
round  with  a  depressed  umbilicus,  smooth  and  glossy,  red  when  ripe, 
and  of  the  size  of  a  holly- berry,  replete  with  an  austere  mealy  pulp, 
in  which  are  five  cells  containing  five  angular  seeds.  It  is  a  shrub 
very  abundant  in  many  parts  or'  the  continent,  as  Sweden,  &c. 

Culture. — The  most  usual  method  of  raising  these  beautiful  ever- 
greens is  by  sowing  the  seeds;  but  they  are  sometimes  capable  of 
being  raised  by  cuttings  and  layers. 

In  the  first  of  these  methods  with  the  first  species,  the  seeds  should 
be  collected  when  perfectly  ripe  in  November,  or  the  following 
month,  and  preserved  in  dry  sand  till  the  period  of  sowing,  which 
may  either  be  in  December  or  the  early  spring  season.  The  seed 
should  be  sown  in  pots,  and  lightly  covered  with  mould,  then  plunged 
into  an  old  tan  hot-bed,  and  covered  by  glasses.  In  this  mode  the 
plants  will  be  up  in  April,  when  they  should  be  often  but  sparingly 
watered,  and  kept  free  from  weeds. 


43 

As  the  hot  season  proceeds,  the  plants  should  be  shaded  during 
the  he  at  ofthe  days;  but  in  warm  weather  open  all  night  to  receive 
the  dew,  and  only  covered  in  the  middle  of  the  day.  In  this  mode 
the  plants  become  strong  the  first  summer.  In  the  beginning  of 
October  they  may  be  shaken  out  of  the  pots,  and  their  roots  care- 
fully separated,  planting  them  singly  in  small  pots  filled  with  light 
earth;  then  plunging  the  pots  into  an  old  bark-bed  under  a  common 
frame,  carefully  shading  them  from  tlie  sun  in  the  middle  ofthe  day, 
and  giving  them  water  as  they  require:  in  this  bed  the  pots  should 
remain  during  the  winter,  exposing  them  to  the  open  air  whenever 
the  weather  is  favourable ;  but  in  frosty  weather  they  should  be  cc- 
vered,  so  as  to  protect  them.  In  the  spring  following  they  may  be 
removed  to  a  gentle  hot-bed,  vvhich  requires  no  other  covering  but 
mats.  This  enables  them  to  make  strong  shoots  early  in  the  sum- 
mer, by  which  they  become  in  a  belter  condition  to  bear  the  cold  of 
the  succeeding  winter.  In  this  bed  they  should  continue  during  the 
summer,  and  be  well  protected  in  the  following  winter. 

After  the  plants  are  become  two  or  three  feet  in  height,  shake 
them  out  of  the  pots,  and  plant  them  in  the  open  ground  in  the 
places  where  they  are  to  remain,  which  should  be  done  in  April, 
that  they  may  have  taken  good  root  before  the  winter,  which  is  apt 
to  injure  them  when  newly  planted  out:  and  as  all  the  earth  about 
their  roots  is  thus  preserved,  they  will  succeed  beller. 

The  plants  are  tolerably  hardy,  and  seldom  hurt,  except  in  ex- 
treme hard  winters,  which  often  destroy  the  young  tender  branches, 
but  rarely  the  roots. 

They  delight  in  a  generous  but  not  loo  moist  soil,  as  when  planted 
in  dry  ground  they  seldom  produce  much  fruit:  the  flowers  coming 
forth  in  autumn,  when  the  winter  proves  severe,  they  are  generally 
destroyed;  consequently,  to  obtain  fruit,  they  should  be  placed  in 
warm  situations,  and  where  the  ground  is  not  naturally  moist ;  a 
good  quantity  of  loam  and  rotten  neat's  dung  should  be  laid  about 
their  roots,  and  in  dry  springs  they  should  be  plentifully  wa- 
tered. 

The  most  proper  season  for  transplanting  is  September,  at  which 


44 

time  the  blossoms  arc  beginning  to  appear;  and  when  dry  at  that 
season,  and  they  are  kept  moist,  they  very  soon  take  root;  but  to- 
wards November  their  roots  should  be  well  covered  to  keep  out  the 
frost.  In  performing  this  business  the  balls  of  earth  round  their 
roots  should  be  preserved. 

In  raising  the  second  species  the  seeds  must  be  procured  from 
abroad,  and  the  plants  be  left  longer  in  the  pots,  as  three  or  four 
years,  or  until  they  are  become  perfectly  woody;  and  when  put 
out,  warm  situations  be  chosen  for  the  purpose,  where  the  soil  is 
dry,  as  the  plants  do  not  succeed  well  where  the  land  is  too 
moist. 

The  third  species  should  be  raised  in  pots  filled  with  bog  earth, 
which  should  be  set  out  in  moist  watery  situations. 

In  propagating  them  by  the  second  method,  or  that  of  cuttings* 
they  should  be  made  from  the  young  shoots,  and  be  planted  in  pots 
in  the  spring  or  summer  months,  plunging  them  into  a  good  hot-bed 
of  tan  or  dung  till  they  have  stricken  root. 

In  the  layer  mode  of  propagation  the  young  shoots  should  be 
chosen,  as  they  otherwise  seldom  take  root  in  less  than  two  years. 

In  grafting  them,  stocks  of  any  of  the  varieties  may  be  had  re- 
course to. 

It  continuing  the  double-blossomed  and  scarlet  varieties,  some  of 
these  last  methods  must  always  be  employed. 

These  are  some  of  the  most  ornamental  plants  of  the  evergreen 
kind  for  shrubberies  and  pleasure-grounds  that  we  possess.  The 
first  sort  and  varieties  sometimes  rise  to  a  considerable  height,  as 
ten  or  fifteen  feet.  They  are  now  found  in  most  plantations,  and  in 
the  months  of  October  and  November,  which  is  the  season  when 
they  are  in  flower,  and  the  fruit  of  the  former  year  is  ripe,  as  it  is  a 
whole  year  in  growing  to  perfection;  they  are  very  ornamental. 
When  there  is  plenty  both  of  fruit  and  flowers  upon  the  trees,  they 
indeed  make  a  handsome  appearance,  as  most  other  plants  are  past 
their  beauty.  The  trees  which  have  large  oval  fruit  make  the  greatest 
figure;  the  flowers  of  this  being  larger  and  oblong.  The  variety  with 
double  flowers  is  a  curiosity;  but  the  flowers,  having  only  two  rows 


45 

of  petals,  make  no  great  appearance,  nor  do  the  trees  produce  fruit 
in  any  quantity;  the  other  is  therefore  preferable.  That  with  red 
flowers  makes  a  pretty  variety,  when  intermixed  with  the  other,  for 
the  outsides  of  shrubberies,  as  they  are  of  a  fine  red  colour  at  their 
first  appearance,  and  afterwards  change  to  purple  before  they  fall 
oflf.  The  fruit  in  this  is  the  same  as  in  the  common  sort. 

As  the  leaves  of  the  Andrachne  are  larger  than  in  the  other  sorts, 
they  have  always  a  better  effect  as  evergreens. 


2.   ALYSSUM   SAXATILA. 

YELLOW    ALYSSUM. 

THIS  genus  comprises  several  species  of  under  shrubby,  herba- 
ceous, perennial  plants  of  the  Atysson  or  Madwort  kind,  that  are 
chiefly  flowery  and  ornamental. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Tetradynamia  Siliculosa,  and 
ranks  in  the  natural  order  of  Siliquosce. 

The  characters  of  which  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  four-leaved,  ob- 
long perianthium,  the  leaflets  ovate,  oblong,  obtuse,  convergent,  and 
deciduous:  the  corolla  four-petalled  and  cruciform:  the  petals  flat, 
shorter  than  the  calyx,  very  spreading,  having  claws  of  the  length  of 
the  calyx:  the  stamina  have  six  filaments  of  the  length  of  the  calyx, 
two  opposite,  a  little  shorter,  marked  with  a  toothlet:  antherae  from 
erect  spreading:  the  pistillum  has  a  sub-ovate  germ,  the  style  sim- 
ple, of  the  length  of  the  stamina,  longer  than  the  germ,  and  the 
stigma  obtuse:  the  pericarpium  is  a  subglobose,  emarginate  silicle} 
or  broad  and  short  pod,  with  a  .style  of  the  length  of  the  silicic,  two- 
celled,  the  partitions  elliptic,  and  hemispherical;  the  seeds  are  fixed 
lo  filiform  receptacles  issuing  forth  at  the  end  of  the  silicic,  few  and 
orbicular. 

There  are  many  species,  but  those  chiefly  cultivated  are:  .1  A.  spi- 


46 

nosum,  Thorny  or  Prickly  Alysson;  2.  A.  halimifolium,  Sweet  or  Sea 
Purslane- leaved  Alysson;  3.  A.  saxatile,  Yellow  Rock  Alysson;  4.  A. 
incamim,  Hoary  Erect  Alysson;  5.  A.  calycinum,  Calycine  Alysson; 
().  A.  canipestrc,  Field  Alysson ;  7-  A.  creticum,  Cretan  Yellow  Alysson ; 
8.  A.  deltoideum,  Deltoid-leaved  Alysson;  9-  A.montanum,  Mountain 
Dark-yellow  Alysson. 

The  first  species  has  woody  branches,  which  rise  about  two  feet 
high,  and  are  armed  with  small  spines.  The  leaves  are  hoary,  lan- 
ceolate, and  thinly  placed  on  the  stalks  without  any  order.  The 
flowers  grow  in  small  clusters  at  the  extremities  of  the  branches. 
The  petals  are  white  and  entire,  and  the  filaments  toothless.  It  is  a 
native  of  Italy. 

The  second  species  spreads  itself  upon  the  ground,  and  never 
rises  to  any  height.  The  leaves  are  narrow,  spear-shaped,  pointed, 
and  entire.  At  the  extremities  of  its  branches  it  produces  very 
pretty  tufts  of  small  while-coloured  flowers,  of  which  the  plant  is 
seldom  destitute  for  six  or  seven  months  together.  In  it  the  stamina 
are  simple,  and  the  silicles  roundish  and  entire.  It  is  a  native  of  the 
southern  countries  of  Europe. 

The  third  is  also  a  low  plant,  with  a  fleshy  stalk,  which  seldom 
rises  more  than  one  foot  high,  but  divides  into  many  smaller  branches, 
which  grow  near  the  ground,  so  that  a  single  plant  spreads  to  a  con- 
siderable distance.  The  leaves  are  spear-shaped,  soft  waved  and 
entire:  the  flowers  produced  in  loose  panicles  at  the  extremity  of 
every  branch,  and  are  of  a  bright  yellow-colour.  They  mostly  ap- 
pear about  the  end  of  April,  or  beginning  of  May ;  and,  if  the  season 
be  moderate,  continue  three  weeks  or  more  in  beauty.  It  is  a  small, 
showy,  hardy  plant,  and  not  disposed  to  overrun  others.  It  fre- 
quently flowers  a  second  time  in  autumn. 

The  fourth  species  grows  to  the  height  of  two  feet,  having  woody 
stalks,  which  divide  into  several  branches  towards  the  top.  The 
leaves  are  spear-shaped,  hoary,  and  entire.  At  the  extremity  of 
every  shoot  the  flowers  are  produced  in  round  bunches;  and  are 
small  and  of  a  while  colour.  The  silicic  is  entire,  oval,  and  full  of 
seeds.  It  grows  naturally  in  the  South  of  France. 


47 

The  fifth  is  nearly  of  similar  growth  in  the  stem,  and  the  leaves 
have  much  resemblance;  but  the  four  longer  filaments  are  toothed  in 
the  middle  within,  and  the  two  shorter  ones  put  out  from  their  base 
a  lance-shaped  scale,  the  length  of  the  germ.  The  petals  are  very 
small,  scarce  apparently  emarginate,  yellow,  but  growing  white 
with  age.  Silicle  slightly  emarginate,  with  two  seeds  in  each  cell.  It 
is  found  wild  in  Austria. 

The  sixth  is  very  like  the  last  in  stem,  leaves,  and  petals,  but  is 
more  decumbent,  and  has  lance-ovate  leaves.  The  filaments  have 
no  teeth,  but  the  two  solitary  ones  have  a  bristle  on  each  side, 
not  growing  to  the  filament,  but  inserted  into  the  receptacle.  Sili- 
cles  ovate,  scarcely  compressed,  more  downy.  It  is  found  in 
France,  &c. 

The  seventh  species  grows  more  erect,  having  a  shrubby  stalk, 
which  sends  out  a  few  lateral  branches  towards  the  top,  with  oblong 
hoary  leaves.  The  flowers  grow  in  small  clusters  at  the  extremities 
of  the  branches.  It  seldom  continues  longer  than  two  years  in  Eng- 
land ,  and  in  a  warm,  dry  situation,  will  live  in  the  open  air.  It  is 
found  in  Spain,  &c. 

In  the  eighth,  the  stems  are  woody,  filiform,  diffused,  and  hairy, 
the  older  ones  having  the  bases  of  the  petioles  toothleted,  and  are 
flexuose.  The  leaves  are  lanceolate,  with  a  strong  angle  or  two  ou 
each  side,  as  it  were  deltoid,  green,  with  a  few  hairs.  The  raccmo 
is  simple,  few-flowered:  the  flowers  resemble  those  of  the  Stock  Gilli- 
flower,  and  are  of  a  purple  colour;  the  calyx  is  oblong,  closed,  and 
gibbous  at  the  base.  It  has  been  found  in  the  Levant. 

In  the  ninth  species,  the  branches  are  trailing:  the  leaves  oblong, 
hoary,  rough  to  the  touch,  and  alternate.  The  flowers  are  produced 
in  small  clusters  at  the  extremities  of  the  branches,  and  are  of  a 
dark  yellow  colour.  Four  of  the  filaments  are  bifid  at  the  top;  the 
two  others  have  a  toothlet  at  the  base.  It  grows  naturally  upon 
rocks  in  Burgundy,  and  some  other  parts  of  France,  &c. 

Culture.—  The  propagation  of  these  plants  may  be  effected  in 
different  ways.  It  may  be  accomplished  in  all  the  sorts  by  means  of 
seeds;  and  in  most  of  the  kinds  by  slips  and  cuttings  from  the 


48 

shoots.  In  the  first  method,  the  seeds  should  be  sown  upon  a  border 
of  rather  poor,  dry,  light  earth,  about  the  beginning  of  April,  being 
lightly  raked  in.  When  sown  on  rich  soils  the  plants  seldom  survive 
the  winter  in  this  climate;  but  if  they  be  put  in  on  such  as  are  of  a 
dry,  rocky,  or  gravelly  nature,  and  of  a  bad  poor  quality,  they  not 
only  withstand  the  cold  better,  but  continue  much  longer,  as  they 
are  less  succulent,  and  of  course  less  affected  by  frosts  in  the  winter 
season. 

In  this  mode  of  sowing,  the  plants  will  be  ready  to  be  transplanted 
in  the  beginning  of  the  following  autumn.  The  business  should  be 
performed  when  the  weather  is  not  too  moist. 

As  the  second  kind  rarely  continues  more  than  two  or  three 
years  in  this  climate,  it  must  be  often  sown  to  preserve  it;  bu^ 
Avhere  the  seeds  are  suffered  to  fall  and  remain  upon  the  ground,  the 
plants  often  rise  without  any  trouble  or  difficulty. 

In  the  third  sort  the  seeds  mostly  ripen  in  July;  but  it  is  only 
from  the  }roung  plants  that  they  can  be  expected,  as  the  old  ones,  or 
those  which  are  raised  from  slips  or  cuttings,  rarely  produce  any  in 
this  climate. 

The  fourth  kind  mostly  flowers  from  June  to  September,  and  the 
seeds  ripen  soon  after;  which,  if  they  be  permitted  to  scatter,  the 
plants  will  come  up,  and  require  little  care  or  trouble  afterwards. 

The  fifth  and  sixth  sorts  should  always  be  sown  where  they  are  to 
remain;  and  if  they  be  thinned  and  kept  clean  from  weeds,  they  will 
flower  in  July,  and  perfect  their  seeds  in  autumn. 

But  the  seeds  in  the  seventh  sort  should  be  sown  in  August,  soon 
after  they  are  ripe ;  and  where  a  few  of  the  plants  are  potted  in  Octo- 
ber, and  sheltered  under  a  frame  in  winter,  they  will  flower  the  fol- 
lowing June,  by  which  means  good  seeds  may  be  obtained  the  same 
year;  as  those  plants,  which  arise  early  in  the  year,  grow  luxuriantly 
in  summer,  but  do  not  often  ripen  seeds,  or  live  through  the  winter 
season. 

In  the  second  and  third  methods,  or  those  by  slips  and  cuttings, 
the  sets  are  best  put  in  on  dry  borders  about  the  latter  end  of  April  or 
beginning  of  May,  the  mould  being  applied  closely  round  them. 


49 

• 

They  should  afterwards  be  shaded  in  the  heat  of  the  day,  and  wa- 
tered occasionally  till  they  have  stricken  root. 

The  eighth  sort,  as  it  rarely  produces  seed  in  this  climate,  may 
be  best  propagated  from  its  trailing  branches,  which,  if  planted  in 
April,  will  take  root  and  become  good  plants  by  the  following  au- 
tumn, when  two  or  three  of  them  may  be  placed  in  a  common  frame 
for  shelter  in  winter,  in  order  to  preserve  the  species;  as  in  hard 
winters,  those  which  are  exposed  are  sometimes  destroyed. 

This  is  properly  a  rock  plant,  being  hardy,  and  forming  with 
very  little  care  a  neat  tuft  of  flowers,  and  is  not  apt  to  encroach  on 
its  neighbours.  It  is  valuable  as  an  ornamental  plant  from  its  be- 
ginning to  flower  in  March,  and  continuing  through  the  summer. 
All  these  plants  may  be  employed  in  borders  for  the  purpose  of 
affording  variety,  and  some  of  them  in  the  way  of  adorning  rock 
works. 


it 


PLATE  VI. 

1.   ANTHERICUM  LILIASTRUM, 

SAVOY    ANTHERICUM. 


THIS  genus  includes  plants  of  the  herbaceous  flowery  Spider-wort 
kinds. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Alexandria  Monogynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Coronarice. 

The  characters  are:  that  there  is  no  calyx:  the  corolla  consists 
of  six  oblong,  obtuse,  very  spreading  petals:  the  stamina  are  subu- 
late, erect  filaments:  the  antherae  small,  incumbent,  and  four-fur- 
rowed: the  pistillum  is  a  germ  obscurely  three-cornered:  the  style 
simple,  and  of  the  length  of  the  stamina:  the  stigma  obtuse,  and 
three-cornered:  the  pericarpium  an  ovate,  smooth,  three-furrowed, 
three-celled,  and  three-valved  capsule :  the  seeds  numerous  and  an- 
gular. 

The  species  are  numerous,  but  those  that  most  deserve  cultiva- 
tion are:  1.  A  revolutum,  Curled-flowered  Anthericum;  2.  A.  ramo- 
sum,  Branching  Anthericum;  3.  A.  datum,  Tall  Anthericum;  4.  A. 
liliago,  Grass-leaved  Anthericum;  5.  A.  liliastrum,  Savoy  Antheri- 
cum, or  Spider-wort;  6.frutescens,  Shrubby  Anthericum;  7-  A.  aloo- 
ides,  Aloe-leaved  Anthericum;  8.  A.  asphodeloides,  Mock  Asphodel, 
or  Glaucous-leaved  Anthericum. 

In  the  first  the  roots  are  fleshy,  and  composed  of  tubers  joined  at 
the  crown,  like  those  of  the  Asphodel:  the  stalk  rises  near  two  feet 
high,  and  branches  out  on  each  side;  each  branch  being  termi- 
nated by  a  loose  spike  of  flowers,  which  are  white,  and  the  petals 
are  turned  backward  to  their  peduncle.  And  according  to  Murray, 


P16. 


AntfifTicu  ///   /  /  //•/.//  /  //  /// 

.  1/t  l'i>  V    d_H 


.\///<trvi'f-i'       frf/>f,'.tt,r/rrtfff 
f  /-/re '/it  <in  .  l>nitrv/lis 


51 

the  root-leaves  are  numerous,  only  one-third  of  the  height  of  the 
scape,  subulate,  channelled  at  the  base,  then  keeled  and  flat, 
striated,  an  inch  and  half  broad,  and  spreading:  the  scape  four  feet 
high,  almost  naked,  round,  smooth  and  oblique:  the  bractes  five, 
gibbous  at  the  base,  pressed  close,  subulate,  the  lower  ones  larger 
like  the  leaves,  the  upper  ones  scaly  and  shrivelling:  the  corymb 
terminating,  compressed,  having  six  round,  long,  alternate  branches, 
knotted  where  the  flowers  spring  forth:  the  flowers  alternate,  soli- 
tary, or  two,  sometimes  three  together,  on  small  gray  pedicels,  thicker 
at  the  top,  each  supported  by  a  little  subulate  bracte:  the  corolla 
inferior:  the  petals  lanceolate-ovate,  reflex,  obtuse,  concave  at  the 
tip,  white,  except  towards  the  end  on  the  outside,  where  they  are 
brownish  green :  the  filaments  a  little  shorter  than  the  corolla:  an- 
thers erect,  oblong,  revolute  as  they  wither:  the  root  similar  to  that 
of  the  Hcemanthus  puniceus.  It  is  a  native  of  the  Cape  of  Good 
Hope. 

In  the  second  species  the  root  is  round,  and  the  stalks  rise  about 
the  same  height  as  the  former,  sending  out  many  lateral  branches  in 
like  manner,  which  are  terminated  by  loose  spikes  of  flowers:  the 
leaves  are  hard  and  grassy,  none  on  the  scape,  which  is  loosely  pa- 
nicled,  with  one-flowered  peduncles:  the  corollas  white:  the  petals 
flat,  and  not  turning  back  as  in  the  former  sort:  the  three  outer  petals 
narrower  than  the  others,  lanceolate  and  sessile:  the  three  inner  oval 
and  petioled.  In  each  angle  of  the  germ  a  small  melliferous  pore. 
It  is  a  native  of  Sweden,  &c.  The  flowers  watch  from  seven  in  the 
morning  to  three  or  four  in  the  afternoon. 

The  third  has  the  roots  composed  of  many  tubers,  each  about  the 
size  of  a  little  finger  at  top,  and  diminishing  gradually  to  the  size  of 
a  straw :  the  leaves  from  seven  or  eight,  to  nine  or  ten  inches  in 
length,  and  an  inch  and  half  broad  in  the  middle,  lessening  gra- 
dually to  both  ends;  they  are  smooth  and  glaucous:  the  flower-stem 
about  two  feet  high,  dividing  into  several  branches,  having  a  few 
narrow  leaves,  generally  one  at  every  division  of  the  branch:  the 
flowers  form  a  loose  spike,  and  are  white.  This  plant  has  been 


52 

lately  recovered  from  seeds  which  were  sent  from  the  Cape  to  Eng- 
land and  Holland.    It  usually  blows  in  August  and  September. 

.  In  the  fourth  species  the  roots  are  numerous,  round,  and  collected 
into  a  tuber  crowned  with  bristles;  the  leaves  from  the  root  many, 
firm,  a  fool  long,  carinated  and  grassy:  the  scape  erect,  eighteen 
inches  high,  firm:  the  spike  loose,  ten-flowered,  and  the  peduncles 
simple:  the  flower  two  inches  wide;  petals  in  two  ranks:  the  inner 
widest,  petiolate  and  pure  white:  the  outer  have  a  green  line  run- 
ning along  beneath.  It  is  a  native  of  Italy,  £c. 

The  fifth  species  has  the  root  fascicled,  with  fleshy  fibres.  It  has 
the  corolla  of  the  while  Lily:  the  leaves  grassy,  soft,  broader  than 
two  lines,  the  radical  ones  very  long:  the  scape  a  foot  or  eighteen 
inches  high :  the  spike  thin-set  with  spreading  flowers,  on  simple 
peduncles:  the  stipules  coloured,  ovate-lanceolate:  the  corolla  above 
an  inch  in  diameter,  gradually  widening;  petals  tender  and  white; 
ovate,  thin,  lanceolate,  with  a  reflex  point,  which  is  thicker  and  has 
a  green  dot:  they  are  marked  with  lines,  and  sweet-scented:  the  sta- 
mens almost  as  long  as  the  petals,  with  weak  filaments.  In  France 
it  is  called  St.  Bruno's  Lily. 

There  are  two  varieties  of  this,  one  with  a  flower-stalk  more  than 
a  foot  and  half  high,  the  other  with  the  stems  much  the  same:  the 
flowers  are  much  larger  in  the  former,  and  there  is  a  greater  number 
upon  each  stalk  than  in  the  latter.  It  is  a  native  of  Switzerland  and 
Savoy. 

The  sixth  species  differs  from  the  seventh  by  rising  into  a  stem 
and  branches,  by  having  the  leaves  greener,  longer,  and  narrower, 
with  a  firmer  pulp,  and  a  viscid  juice  flowing  copiously  from  them 
when  cut,  of  a  greenish  yellow  colour:  the  root  is  fibrous,  and  not 
only  the  stem,  but  even  the  branches  put  out  fibres,  which  hang 
down,  and  when  they  reach  the  ground  strike  root.  It  is  a  native  of 
the  Cape  of  Good  Hope,  and  was  formerly  known  by  the  name  of 
Onion-leaved  Aloe. 

The  seventh  has  broad,  flat,  pulpy  leaves,  resembling  those  of 
some  sorts  of  Aloe,  and  was  formerly,  on  that  account  called  Aloe 


53 

with  flowers  of  Spiderwort.  The  leaves  spread  open,  are  broader  and 
more  trans) ucid,  soft  and  pulpy,  than  the  above,  pouring  out  a  limpid 
juice:  the  root,  is  tuberous:  the  flowers  are  produced  on  loose  spikes, 
like  the  former,  but  are  shorter;  they  are  yellow,  and  appear  at 
different  seasons.  This  species  grows  close  to  the  ground,  never 
rising  with  any  stalk.  It  is  a  native  of  the  Cape  of  Good  Hope. 

The  eighth  has  the  leaves  scarcely  striated,  but  rough  at  the 
edge;  more  gibbous  at  the  back  towards  one  side;  they  are  long, 
narrow  and  pulpy,  almost  taper,  but  flatted  on  their  upper  side:  the 
flowers  are  yellow,  and  grow  on  long  loose  spikes  as  the  former; 
these  appear  at  different  seasons;  those  of  the  spring  and  summer 
are  succeeded  by  seeds  in  great  plenty,  which  ripen.  It  is  a  native 
of  the  Cape. 

Culture. — These  perennials  are  in  general  capable  of  being  pro^- 
pagated  by  the  roots,  offsets  and  suckers;  but  as  some  of  the  spe- 
cies do  not  supply  them  in  sufficiency,  they  may  be  raised  from  the 
seeds. 

In  the  first  method  the  best  season  for  the  purpose  is  in  the  latter 
end  of  summer  and  beginning  of  the  autumn,  in  beds  of  light  vege- 
table earth  in  warm  open  situations,  free  from  the  shade  and  drop- 
pings of  trees.  An  eastern  aspect,  where  the  plants  are  properly 
shaded  from  the  sun  in  the  mid-day,  is  preferable  for  some  of  the 
sorts,  as  they  keep  longer  in  blow  and  beauty. 

This  is  likewise  the  proper  period  of  transplanting,  as  when  the 
business  is  performed  in  the  spring  the  plants  seldom  flower  the  same 
year.  This  should  not  be  done  oflener  than  once  in  about  three 
years,  where  increase  is  intended;  and  in  the  execution  of  the  work 
the  roots  should  not  be  too  much  divided,  as  when  that  is  the  case 
they  do  not  flower  well. 

In  the  second  method,  or  that  by  sowing  the  seeds,  the  best  season 
is  probably  the  spring,  though  they  may  be  sown  in  the  autumn.  A 
bed  of  good  light  vegetable  mould  is  the  best  for  the  purpose,  and 
the  situation  should  be  sheltered  and  warm.  The  plants  soon  ap- 
pear, and  when  their  leaves  begin  to  decay  in  the  autumn  they 
should  be  taken  up  carefully,  and  transplanted  out  into  another  bed 


54 

of  the  same  sort  of  earth,  at  the  distance  of  from  nine  inches  to  a 
foot  from  each  other.  When  the  winter  season  is  severe  they  should 
be  protected  from  the  frost  by  a  thin  covering  of  tan  or  some  other 
substance.  In  this  situation  they  should  continue  for  about  twelve 
months,  when  they  will  in  general  be  sufficiently  strong  for  flower- 
ing. In  the  following  autumn  they  must  of  course  be  taken  up  with- 
out injuring  the  fibres  of  the  roots,  and  be  planted  out  in  the  clumps, 
borders,  or  other  places  where  they  are  to  remain.  As  they  are  apt 
to  be  destroyed  by  frost  in  the  winter  season,  care  should  be  taken 
to  protect  them  as  much  as  possible. 

The  Cape  sorts  are  capable  of  being  raised  by  seeds;  but  this  is 
seldom  necessary,  as  they  multiply  greatly  by  offsets  and  suckers; 
which  may  be  taken  off  at  the  period  mentioned  above,  and  planted 
out  in  pots  of  good  bog  earth,  a  very  small  portion  of  water  being 
given,  as  much  is  apt  to  rot  and  destroy  the  roots.  As  these  are 
tender  plants  they  require  the  constant  protection  of  a  green-house 
stove  or  frames  during  the  winter  season.  In  these  situations  they 
should  be  managed  with  great  attention  and  care. 


2.    AMARYLLIS  FORMOSISSIMA. 

JACOBEAN    AMARYLLIS. 

THIS  genus  comprehends  several  species  of  the  Lily-Daffodil  kind 
of  plants ;  all  of  which  are  of  the  bulbous-rooted  tribe,  and  mostly 
ornamental. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Hexandria  Monogynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Liliacece. 

The  characters  are :  that  the  calyx  is  a  spathe,  oblong,  obtuse, 
compressed,  emarginate,  gaping  on  the  flat  side,  and  withering:  the 
corolla  has  six  petals,  lanceolate:  the  nectary  has  six  very  short 


55 

scales,  without  the  base  of  the  filaments:  the  stamina  have  six  awl- 
shaped  filaments,  with  oblong,  incumbent,  rising  antherae:  the  pis- 
tillum  has  a  roundish,  furrowed,  inferior  germ,  the  style  filiform,  al- 
most of  the  length  and  in  the  situation  of  the  stamina:  the  stigma 
trifid  and  slender:  the  pericarpium  is  a  subovate,  three-celled  cap- 
sule, and  the  seeds  are  several.  The  inflection  of  the  petals,  sta- 
mina, and  pistillum,  is  very  various  in  the  different  species  of  this 
genus;  and  the  corolla  in  most  of  the  species  is  rather  hexapetaloid 
than  six-petalled. 

The  species  are  very  numerous,  but  those  principally  cultivated 
are:  1.  A.  lutea,  Yellow  Amaryllis,  or  Autumnal  Narcissus;  2.  A. 
atamasco,  Atamasco  Lily ;  3.  A.  formosissima,  Jacobaea  Lily ;  4.  A.  re- 
gince,  Mexican  Lily;  5.  A.  purpurea,  Purple-flowered  Amaryllis; 
6.  A.  belladonna,  Belladonna  Lily;  7-  A.  vittata,  Superb  or  Ribband 
Amaryllis;  8.  A.  longifolia,  Long-leaved  Amaryllis;  9-  A.  orientalist 
Broad-leaved  African  Amaryllis;  10.  A.  sarniensis,  Guernsey  Lily; 
11.  A.  zeylanica,  Ceylon  Lily;  12.  A.  latifolia,  Broad-leaved  Ama- 
ryllis. 

In  the  first  species,  or  Yellow  Amaryllis,  the  flower-stems  seldom 
rise  above  three  or  four  inches  in  height:  the  flowers  are  shaped 
somewhat  like  those  of  the  Large  Yellow  Crocus,  one  coming  up 
from  each  sheath:  the  leaves  are  green,  and  come  up  at  the  same 
time,  like  the  Saffron ;  and  after  the  flowers  are  past,  they  increase 
all  the  winter.  The  roots  are  shaped  like  those  of  the  Narcissus.  It 
flowers  in  September,  and  is  a  native  of  the  South  of  France. 

The  second  species,  or  Alamasco  Lily,  has  the  flowers  at  their 
first  appearance  of  a  fine  carnation  colour  on  the  outside,  but  which 
fade  till  they  arc  almost  while.  They  are  nearly  as  large  as  those  of 
the  Small  Orange  Lily,  but  do  not  grow  above  six  or  eight  inches  in 
height.  They  appear  about  the  end  of  May  or  beginning  of  June, 
and  sometimes  in  August.  Jt  is  a  native  of  Virginia. 

In  the  third,  or  Jacobaea  Lily,. the  flower-stems  are  produced  from 
the  sides  of  the  bulbs,  so  that  after  the  flower  produced  on  one  side 
is  decayed,  another  stalk  arises  from  the  other  side  of  the  bulb;  but 
there  is  usually  no  more  than  one  flower  produced  on  the  same 


56' 

stalk.  The  flowers  are  large,  and  of  a  very  deep  red;  the  under  pe- 
tals are  very  large,  and  the  whole  flower  stands  nodding  on  one  side 
of  the  stalk,  making  a  most  beautiful  appearance.  It  is  a  native  of 
South  America. 

The  fourth,  or  Mexican  Lily,  has  the  bulb  of  a  green  colour;  the 
scape  round,  and  sub-compressed.  The  corolla  scarlet,  with  a  bot- 
tom of  a  whitish  green:  the  three  outer  petals  reversed  at  the  tip, 
the  three  inner  fringed  at  the  base,  the  style  red.  The  flower-stems 
seldom  rise  more  than  one  foot  in  height;  each  stem  supports  two, 
three,  or  four  flowers,  rarely  more;  they  are  large,  and  of  a  bright 
copper-colour,  inclining  to  red :  the  spathe,  which  covers  the  buds 
before  they  open,  divides  into  two  parts  to  the  bottom,  standing  on 
each  side  the  umbel  of  flowers,  joined  to  the  peduncles.  It  flowers 
constantly  in  the  spring,  when  it  is  placed  in  a  very  warm  stove;  and 
is  in  beauty  in  February;  those  which  are  in  a  moderate  temperature 
of  air,  flowering  in  March  or  April. 

In  the  fifth  the  corolla  is  large,  and  of  a  blood-red,  or  purple- 
colour,  and  there  are  three  or  four  large  bell-shaped,  rather  erect 
flowers  corning  from  each  sheath.  It  is  a  native  of  the  Cape  of 
Good  Hope. 

The  sixth,  or  Belladonna  Lily,  differs  from  the  fourth  species  in 
having  the  edges  of  the  petals  waved,  and  not  reversed  at  the  tip. 
The  scape  is  purple,  sustaining  from  five  to  seven  flowers,  in  shape 
like  the  Common  Red  Lily,  and  nearly  as  large,  but  of  a  soft  purple 
colour,  inclining  to  white  on  the  inside  toward  the  bottom,  and  hav- 
ing an  agreeable  scent.  It  usually  flowers  about  the  end  of  Septem- 
ber, or  the  beginning  of  October,  in  this  climate;  and  if  the  roots 
are  strong,  the  stems  will  rise  upwards  of  two  feet  high.  If  the  season 
is  favourable,  or  the  flowers  be  screened  from  frosts,  violent  winds 
and  heavy  rains,  they  continue  in  beauty  a  month  or  longer;  and  are 
very  ornamental  plants  at  a  season  when  there  is  a  great  scarcity  of 
flowers.  It  is  a  native  of  the  West  Indies. 

In  the  seventh,  the  petals  uniting  at  bottom  form  a  fleshy 
tube,  but  the  edges  of  the  outer  ones  are  free  at  the  base.  It  has 
been  named  vittata,  from  its  ribband-like  appearance,  being  striped 


o? 

with  red  on  a  white  ground.  The  stem  rises  to  the  height  of  three 
feet  or  more,  and  produces  from  two  to  five  beautiful  flowers.  It 
usually  blossoms  in  April  or  May,  but  may  be  forwarded  by  artificial 
heat. 

In  the  eighth  species,  the  flower-stem  rarely  rises  more  than  three 
or  four  inches  in  height,  but  supports  a  great  number  of  flowers,  of  a 
deep  purple  colour,  appearing  in  December.  The  bulbs  are  large, 
and  the  leaves  long  and  narrow.  It  flowers  here  in  July,  and  is  a 
native  of  the  Cape  of  Good  Hope. 

In  the  ninth,  or  Broad-leaved  African  Amaryllis,  the  bulbs  are 
large  and  almost  round;  the  leaves  long,  broad,  and  rounded  at  their 
extremities,  spreading  two  ways  on  the  surface  of  the  ground,  and 
do  not  come  up  till  after  the  flower-stem  appears,  which  is  generally 
in  November;  and  after  the  flowers  are  past,  the  leaves  increase  till 
spring,  and  in  May  they  begin  to  decay,  so  that  from  the  middle  of 
June  to  October  the  plant  is  void  of  leaves.  It  grows  naturally  at 
the  Cape  of  Good  Hope. 

In  the  tenths  pecies,  or  Guernsey  Lily,  the  bulb  is  an  oblong  sphe- 
roid, flatted  most  at  the  lower  end,  six  or  seven  inches  round  where 
thickest:  the  leaves  are  of  a  dark  willow  green  colour,  shining,  from 
half  an  inch  to  three  quarters  of  an  inch  in  breadth,  a  little  blunt 
at  the  end,  from  two  to  four  in  number,  rarely  five.  The  scape  is 
flattened,  twelve  or  fourteen  inches  in  height,  and  more.  Thespathe 
splits,  and  fails  back  in  two  unequal  pieces  of  a  reddish  colour  and 
triangular  figure.  The  pedicels  are  from  an  inch  to  almost  two 
inches  in  length.  The  number  of  flowers  commonly  from  eight  to 
twelve,  the  circumference  of  each  being  about  seven  inches.  The 
corolla,  when  in  its  prime,  has  the  colour  of  a  fine  gold  tissue  wrought 
on  a  rose-coloured  ground;  and  when  it  begins  to  fade,  it  is  a  pink: 
if  beheld  in  a  full-shine,  it  seems  to  be  studded  with  diamonds,  but 
by  candle-light  the  specks  or  spangles  look  more  like  fine  gold  dust: 
when  the  petals  begin  to  wither,  they  assume  a  deep  crimson  colour. 
The  flowers  begin  to  come  out  at  the  end  of  August,  and  the  head 
is  usually  three  weeks  in  gradually  expanding  itself.  This  beauti- 

i 


58 

tul  plant  is  a  native  of  Japan,  and  has  been  long  naturalized  in 
Guernsey. 

The  eleventh  species  has  the  stature  of  the  Crinum  American-urn. 
The  leaves  are  fleshy,  scabrous  with  a  toothleled  edge.  The  spathe 
bivalve,  besides  some  interior  scales  or  fragments.  The  germs  are 
sessile.  The  tube  of  the  corolla  of  the  same  colour  with  the  scape, 
which  is  rufous.  The  border  white,  with  lanceolate,  recurved  pe- 
tals, with  a  red  keel  underneath.  The  filaments  and  style  are  of  a 
blood-red  colour,  and  the  pericarps  viviparous. 

The  twelfth  has  roots  like  the  Crinum  mentioned  below:  the 
leaves  narrower  at  their  base,  and  stained  with  purple  on  their  un- 
der side;  the  scapes  purple,  and  growing  to  the  same  height  as  those 
of  the  Crinum  Asiaticum ;  the  flowers  of  the  same  shape,  but  the  tube 
purple,  and  the  segments  having  a  purple  stripe  running  through 
them:  the  stamina  are  also  purple;  it  is  however  more  beautiful 
than  that  plant.  This  is  a  native  of  the  East  Indies. 

Culture. — In  all  the  different  sorts,  the  propagation  is  performed 
by  the  small  bulbs  or  offsets  that  are  removed  from  the  sides  of  the 
old  roots  every  year  at  the  time  they  are  transplanted.  Some  of  the 
sorts,  as  the  first  and  second,  are  often  capable  of  being  raised  on  dry 
warm  borders;  but  most  of  the  others  stand  in  need  of  artificial  heat 
to  raise  them  in  the  most  perfect  manner. 

They  all  delight  in  a  loose,  sandy,  dry  soil,  that  contains  a  good 
proportion  of  vegetable  mould;  and  require  but  little  water,  except 
where  the  roots  are  in  a  high  state  of  growth,  and  sending  forth  their 
flower-stems;  when  they  should  have  it  frequently  in  small  quantities. 
When  applied  under  other  circumstances,  it  is  apt  to  rot  and  destroy 
the  bulbs. 

All  the  more  tender  sorts  should  be  put  in  pots,  and  placed  in 
stoves,  where  they  must  be  constantly  kept;  as  much  air  as  possible 
being  admitted  to  them  during  the  hot  summer  months.  Some  of 
them  are,  however,  capable  of  bearing  the  open  air  at  this  season: 
but  in  this  method  of  management  they  neither  grow  so  well,  or 
flower  so  regularly,  as  in  the  stove  mode  of  treatment. 


59 

The  most  suitable  season  for  transplanting  the  roots  of  all  the 
different  species,  is  at  the  time  when  their  leaves  are  wholly  de- 
slroyed,  as  about  the  latter  end  of  July,  or  the  beginning  of  the  fol- 
lowing month,  before  they  begin  to  send  forth  new  root-fibres,  as 
after  that  has  taken  place  they  are  liable  to  be  greatly  injured  by 
being  removed  from  their  situations. 

The  first  kind,  or  Yellow  Autumnal  Amaryllis,  is  a  hardy  plant, 
and  may  be  increased  with  great  facility  by  offsets  from  the  roots. 
The  best  season  for  transplanting  the  root-bulbs  of  this  sort  is 
any  time  from  May  to  the  end  of  July,  when  their  leaves  are  de- 
cayed: but  after  that  period  it  will  be  too  late  to  remove  them,  as 
they  mostly  begin  to  push  out  fresh  root-fibres  about  the  middle  of 
August  or  sooner,  if  the  season  be  moist  and  warm,  frequently  flow- 
ering the  beginning  of  September;  so  that,  if  the  business  of  trans- 
planting be  performed  so  late  as  this,  it  will  spoil  their  flowering. 
This  plant  is  capable  of  growing  in  any  soil  or  situation ;  but  it 
thrives  to  the  best  advantage  in  those  of  the  above  kind,  when  suffi- 
ciently fresh  and  light,  and  in  open  situations,  that  are  not  under 
the  dripping  of  trees,  or  too  near  walls,  or  other  tall  fences  that 
produce  much  shade.  Miller  observes  that  it  is  commonly  known 
to  gardeners  by  the  name  of  Yellow  Autumnal  Narcissus;  and 
usually  sold  by  them  with  Calchicums  for  autumnal  ornaments  to 
gardens;  for  which  purpose  it  is  a  pvetly  plant,  as  it  will  frequently 
keep  flowering  from  the  beginning  of  September  to  the  middle  of 
November,  in  case  the  frost  is  not  so  severe  as  to  destroy  the  flowers; 
for  though  there  is  but  one  flower  in  each  cover,  a  succession  of 
flowers  is  produced  from  the  same  root,  especially  when  they  are 
suffered  to  remain  three  or  four  years  without  being  removed. 

A  dry  warm  border  is  the  best  exposure  for  this  sort. 

The  second  species,  or  Atamasco  Lily,  is  also  so  hardy  as  to  thrive 
in  the  open  air  in  this  climate,  when  the  root-bulbs  are  planted  out 
in  a  warm  situation  and  on  a  dry  soil:  it  is  likewise  best  propagated 
by  offsets  from  the  root-bulbs  of  the  old  plants.  As  very  severe  frost 
is  liable  to  destroy  the  bulbs  in  some  cases,  a  few  should  always  be 


60 

planted  in  pots,  in  order  that  they  may  be  protected  in  the  winter 
season. 

The  third  sort,  or  Jacobaea  Lily,  is  of  the  more  tender  kind,  but 
is  now  become  common  in  the  gardens  of  the  curious  in  this  coun- 
try. The  root-bulbs  send  forth  plenty  of  offsets,  especially  when 
they  are  kept  in  a  moderate  warmth  in  the  winter  season :  for  the 
roots  of  this  kind  will  live  in  a  good  greenhouse,  or  they  may  be  pre- 
served through  the  winter  under  a  common  hot-bed  frame;  but  in 
this  way  they  do  not  flower  so  often,  or  send  out  so  many  offsets,  as 
when  they  are  placed  in  a  moderate  stove  in  that  season.  This  sort 
produces  its  flowers  two  or  three  times  in  the  year:  it  is  not  however 
regular  to  any  season;  but  the  flowers  are  mostly  produced  from 
March  to  the  beginning  of  September,  when  the  roots  are  in  a  vigo- 
rous state  of  growth.  It  is  best  propagated  by  offsets  from  the  old 
root-bulbs,  which  may  be  taken  oft"  every  year:  the  most  proper 
time  to  part  and  shift  the  roots  in  this  kind  is  in  August,  as  by  this 
means  they  may  take  good  root  before  the  winter  sets  in.  In  doing 
this,  care  should  be  taken  not  to  break  off  the  fibres  from  their  roots. 
They  should  be  planted  out  separately  in  pots  of  a  middling  size, 
and  be  kept  in  a  moderate  degree  of  warmth  in  the  stove,  as  by  that 
means  they  produce  their  flowers  in  greater  plenty,  and  the  roots 
make  a  greater  increase,  than  where  they  are  managed  in  a  more 
hardy  manner. 

The  fourth  sort,  or  Mexican  Lily,  is  not  so  hardy  as  either  the 
above  or  the  Belladonna  Lily;  it  must  of  course  be  placed  in  a 
stove  of  much  greater  warmth;  and  if  the  pots  are  plunged  into  a 
hot-bed  of  tanner's  bark,  the  roots  will  thrive  belter,  and  the  flowers 
be  stronger. 

It  is  increased  by  offsets  from  the  old  root,  in  the  same  manner 
as  the  other  sorts,  and  usually  flowers  in  the  beginning  of  the  spring, 
when  it  produces  a  fine  appearance  in  the  stove  with  others  of  simi- 
lar growths. 

The  fifth  species,  or  Purple-flowered  Amaryllis,  is  likewise  of  the 
tender  kind,  and  is  capable  of  being  propagated  in  the  same  man- 
ner as  the  above.  It  also  succeeds  the  best,  and  flowers  to  the 


61 

greatest  advantage  and  effect,  when  constantly  kept  in  the  stove  in 
a  similar  degree  of  temperature  with  that  of  the  above  species. 

The  sixth  kind,  or  Belladonna  Lily,  is  more  hardy.     It  has  been 
cultivated,  according  to  the  editor  of  Miller's  Dictionary,  with  great 
success  in  the  following  manner: — A  border  was  prepared  close  to  a 
wall  which  had  a  south-west  aspect,  about  six  feet  in  width,  in  this 
manner.     All  the  earth  to  the  depth  of  three  feet  was  removed,  and 
some  very  rotten  dung  put  in  the  bottom  six  inches  thick,  upon 
which  light  garden  mould  was  applied,  about  twenty  inches  in  depth. 
After  making  this  level,  the  roots  were  placed  at  six  inches  distance 
every  way,  being  then  covered  over  with  light  sandy  earth,  to  the 
height  of  the  border;  by  which  means  the  upper  parts  of  the  roots 
are  five  or  six  inches  buried.     In  the  winter  season  the  border  was 
covered  all  over  with  rotten  tanner's  bark,  to  the  depth  of  three 
inches,  in  order  to  prevent  the  frost  from   penetrating  the  ground. 
And  when  it  proved  very  severe,  some  mats  or  straw  were  laid  over 
the  leaves  to  protect  the  plants  from  being  destroyed.     In  this  ma_ 
nagement  the  roots  have  greatly  increased,  and  the  plants  have  con- 
stantly flowered  every  year;  some  of  them  having  put  out  two  or 
three  stems  which  grew  near  three  feet  in  height,  producing  many 
flowers  in  each  umbel,  which  made  a  fine  appearance  during  the 
month  of  October.     It  is  added,  that  the  green  leaves  come  up  soon 
after,  and  abide  all  the  winter  and  spring  until  June,  at  which  time 
they  decay.     Soon  after  this  period  the  roots  should   therefore  be 
transplanted;  for,  if  they  are  suffered  to  stand  till  July,  they  will 
have  sent  forth  new  root-fibres,  in  Avhich  stale  it  would  greatly  in- 
jure the  roots  if  they  were  disturbed.    If  some  of  the  roots  be  planted 
in  a  warm  border  close  to  a  south  wall,  and  in  a  dry  soil,  they  mostly 
thrive  well,  especially  if  they  be  covered  in   severe  weather;  and 
these  roots  generally  flower  much  stronger  than  those  which,  are  kept 
in  pots,  and  multiply  faster  than  under  other  circumstances. 

The  seventh  species  is  more  tender  than  the  above,  as  it  rarely 
puts  forth  offsets  from  the  roots.  But  as  it  produces  ripe  seeds  in 
sufficient  quantity,  it  may  be  propagated  in  that  way  without  much 
difficulty.  These  should  be  sown  in  pots  of  good  mould  in  the  spring 


6'2 

season,  and  immediately  afterwards  plunged  into  a  bark  bed  of  mo- 
derate temperature,  a  little  Water  being  occasionally  given  till  the 
plants  appear,  and  become  of  sufficient  growth  to  be  transplanted 
out  into  separate  pots,  which  should  be  performed  in  a  careful  man- 
ner, and  a  little  water  given  immediately  afterwards,  the  pots  being 
directly  placed  in  the  stove,  where  they  are  to  be  constantly  kept,  as 
in  the  above  kinds. 

The  eighth  sort  is  likewise  tender.  It  requires  to  be  treated  in 
the  same  manner  as  the  Jacobasa  Lily.  It  is  found  to  increase  pretty 
fast  by  offsets.  When  properly  managed,  it  usually  flowers  in  the 
winter  season,  especially  if  the  pots  be  placed  in  a  stove  of  mode- 
rate temperature;  and  as  at  this  period  there  are  but  few  flowers  in 
the  open  air,  it  is  more  valuable  on  that  account  as  an  ornamental 
plant  for  the  stove. 

The  ninth  species  is  still  more  lender:  it  must  of  course  be 
placed,  during  the  winter  season,  in  a  stove  where  there  is  a  mode- 
rate share  of  warmth;  but  it  should  not  have  so  much  water  as  the 
Jacobsea  Lily.  It  may  be  raised  from  offsets. 

The  tenth  species,  or  Guernsey  Lily,  is  supposed  to  have  come 
originally  from  Japan;  but  has  been  long  cultivated  in  the  gardens 
of  Guernsey  and  Jersey ;  in  both  of  which  it  Seems  to  thrive  and 
succeed  as  well  as  if  it  were  in  its  native  soil.  From  those  islands 
its  roots  are  annually  sent  to  the  curious  in  different  parts  of  Europe. 
The  root  bulbs  are  generally  sent  to  us  in  June  and  July;  but 
the  sooner  the  bulbs  are  taken  out  of  the  ground,  after  their  leaves 
decay,  the  belter  they  are;  for  though  the  roots,  which  are  taken  up 
when  their  flower-stems  begin  to  appear,  may  flower,  their  flowers  are 
not  so  large,  or  their  rools  so  good  afterwards,  as  those  which  are 
removed  before  they  have  sent  out  fresh  root-fibres. 

On  obtaining  the  rools,  they  should  be  planted  in  pots  filled  with 
fresh,  light,  sandy  earth,  well  mixed  with  a  little  very  rotten  dung, 
to  the  depth  of  two  or  three  inches,  and  then  placed  in  a  warm  situa- 
lion;  or  whal  is  beller,  in  a  moderate-stove  heat,  ihe  earlh  being 
refreshed  wilh  water  occasionally;  but  they  should  not  have  too 
much,  as  it  would  rot  their  roots,  especially  before  the  stems  rise. 


65 

About  the  middle  of  September,  the  more  vigorous  roots  will  begin 
to  show  the  buds  of  their  flower-stems,  which  are  commonly  of  a  red 
colour;  therefore  these  pots  should  be  removed  into  a  situation  where 
they  may  have  the  full  benefit  of  the  sun,  and  be  sheltered  from  wet, 
and  strong  winds;  but  by  no  means  too  near  a  wall,  or  under  glasses, 
which  would  draw  them  up  weak,  and  render  them  less  beautiful  in 
their  blow.  At  this  season  they  should  be  gently  refreshed  with  water 
occasionally,  when  the  weather  is  warm  and  dry. 

As  soon  as  the  flowers  begin  to  open,  the  pots  should  be  removed 
from  the  open  air,  to  prevent  the  flowers  from  being  injured  by  too 
much  moisture;  but  they  must  not  be  kept  too  close,  or  be  placed 
in  situations  too  warm,  as  that  would  occasion  their  colour  to  be 
less  lively,  and  hasten  their  decay.  The  flowers  of  this  plant  often 
continue  in  beauty,  when  managed  in  the  above  manner,  a  full 
month  :  and  though  they  have  no  scent,  from  the  richness  of  their 
colour,  they  are  justly  esteemed  as  flowery  ornamental  plants. 

AVhen  the  flowers  are  decayed,  the  leaves  begin  to  shoot  forth  in 
length,  and,  if  sheltered  from  severe  cold,  continue  growing  all  the 
winter  season;  but  they  must  have  as  much  free  air  as  possible  in 
mild  weather,  and  be  covered  only  in  severe  rains  or  frosts;  for 
which  purpose  a  common  hot-bed  frame  is  the  best,  as  the  glasses 
may  be  taken  off  constantly  every  day  in  dry  open  weather,  which 
will  encourage  the  leaves  to  grow  strong  and  broad;  whereas,  when 
they  are  placed  in  a  greenhouse,  or  not  exposed  to  the  open  air,  they 
are  apt  to  grow  long  and  slender,  and  have  a  pale  weak  aspect,  by 
which  the  roots  become  weak,  seldom  producing  good  flowers. 

The  roots  should  be  transplanted  every  fourth  or  fifth  year,  about 
the  latter  end  of  June  or  beginning  of  July,  into  fresh  earth;  but  not 
oftener  removed,  as  that  would  retard  their  flowering. 

The  offsets  may  also  be  taken  off,  and  planted  out  into  different 
pots;  which,  in  three  years  time,  mostly  produce  flowers.  Conse- 
quently, after  a  person  is  once  stocked  with  these  roots,  he  may  in- 
crease them,  so  as  to  have  a  constant  supply  of  blowing  roots,  wiih- 
out  being  at  the  trouble  or  expense  of  sending  to  the  above  places 
annually  for  them;  and  the  roots,  thus  preserved,  will  flower  stronger 


C4 

than  those  which  are  brought  from   thence,  as  the  inhabitants  of 
those  islands  are  not  very  curious  in  cultivating  them ; — their  usual 
method,  according  to  Miller,  being  to  plant  them  at  a  great  distance 
in   beds  of  common  earth,  where  they  let  them  remain  for  many 
years;  in  the  course  of  which  they  produce  such  a  number  of  offsets 
that  one  single  cluster  has  frequently  contained  above  a  hundred 
roots;  by  which  means  those  which  grow  on  the  inside  are  so  much 
compressed  by  the  outer  roots,  that  they  are  perfectly  flattened :  and 
from  the  number  of  roots  growing  in  each  cluster,  they  are  all  ren- 
dered weak,  and  unfit  to  produce  such  large  steins  of  flowers  as  those 
which  have  grown  singly  and  are  of  a  spherical  form.  As  when  a  per- 
son is  possessed  of  a  great  number  of  these  roots,  it  will  be  troublesome 
to  preserve  them  in  pots,  a  bed  should  be  prepared  in  the  following 
manner,  in  some  well  sheltered  part  of  the  garden.     In  doing  this, 
a  third  part  of  fresh  virgin  earth,  from  a  pasture  ground,  which  is 
light,  should  be   provided,  with  an  equal  portion  of  sea-sand,  to 
which  should  be  added  rotten  dung  and  sifted  lime  rubbish,  of  each 
an  equal  quantity.     With  this  earth,  when  well  mixed  and  incorpo- 
rated, a  bed  should  be  made  about  two  feet  thick,  raising  it  about 
four  or  five  inches  above  the  surface  of  the  ground,  where  the  situa- 
tion is  dry;  but  where  the  ground  is  wet,  it  should  be  raised  eight 
or  nine  inches  higher.     In  this  bed,  about  the  beginning  of  July,  as 
before  directed,  plant  the  roots  about  six  or  eight  inches  asunder 
each  way;  and  in  the  winter,  when  the  frost  begins,  cover  the  bed 
with  a  frame,  or  arch  it  over,  and  cover  it  with  mats  and  straw,  to 
prevent  their  leaves  from  being  pinched  by  cold.    In  the  spring,  the 
covering  should  be  entirely  removed,  and  the  bed  kept  constantly 
clean  from   weeds  during  the  summer,  stirring  the  surface  of  the 
earth  now  and  then;  and  annually,  when  the  leaves  are  decayed,  sift 
a  little  fresh  earth  over  them,  to  encourage  the  growth  of  the  roots. 

The  roots  may  remain  in  these  beds  until  they  are  of  sufficient 
strength  to  produce  flowers,  at  which  time  they  may  be  taken  up 
and  planted  in  pots,  as  before  directed,  or  be  suffered  to  remain  in 
the  same  beds  to  flower.  These  plants  do  not  flower  again  the  suc- 
ceeding year,  as  in  many  other  sorts  of  bulbous-rooted  plants;  but 


65 

where  the  bulbs  contain  two  buds  in  their  centres,  as  is  often  the 
case,  they  frequently  flower  twice  in  the  course  of  about  three  years; 
after  which  the  same  individual  root-bulb  does  not  flower  again  in 
several  years;  but  this  is  performed  by  the  offsets,  which  are  taken 
from  it  at  different  times 

The  eleventh  species,  or  Ceylon  Lily,  is  of  a  tender  nature,  and 
must  be  treated  in  the  same  manner  as  the  Mexican  Lily.  It  is  not 
common  in  the  gardens  in  this  country,  as  it  is  a  plant  which  in- 
creases but  slowly  by  offsets  from  the  roots.  It  usually  flowers  in 
June  and  July;  and  sometimes  the  same  plant  will  produce  flowers 
again  in  autumn  if  the  pots  be  plunged  into  a  bed  of  tanners'  bark; 
but  the  flowers  are  seldom  of  long  duration  or  great  beauty. 

The  twelfth  species  is  also  of  the  tender  kind,  but  may  be  in- 
creased by  offsets  from  the  roots,  or  by  the  bulbs  which  succeed  the 
flowers.  It  should  be  treated  in  the,  same  manner  as  is  directed  for 
the  Crimims;  the  proper  culture  of  which  may  be  seen  under  that 
head. 

All  these  bulbous-rooted  plants,  as  being  both  curious  and  orna- 
mental, deserve  to  be  cultivated;  those  of  the  more  tender  kinds 
affording  much  variety  in  the  stove  or  greenhouse;  while  the  more 
hardy  sorts  produce  a  pleasing  effect  in  the  fronts  of  beds  or  borders 
in  the  garden  or  pleasure-grounds. 


PLATE  VII. 

1.  ASTER  AMELLUS, 

ITALIAN    ASTER. 


THIS  genus  comprehends  different  fibrous-rooted  flowery  plants 
of  the  annual  and  perennial  herbaceous  and  shrubby  kinds.  The 
Starworts. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Syngenesia  Polyganria  Superflua, 
and  ranks  in  the  natural  order  of  Compositi  Radiati. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  common  imbricate;  the 
inner  scales  prominent  a  little  at  the  end,  the  lower  ones  spreading: 
the  corolla  compound  radiate:  corollules  hermaphrodite  numerous 
in  the  disk:  the  females  ligulate,  and  more  than  ten  in  the  ray.  Pro- 
per, of  the  hermaphrodite,  funnel-shaped,  with  a  five-cleft  spreading 
border;  of  the  female  ligulate,  lanceolate,  three- toothed,  at  length 
rolling  back:  the  stamina  hermaphrodite,  five  filaments,  capillary,  and 
very  short:  the  anther  cylindric  and  tubulous:  the  pistillum  is  her- 
maphrodite: one  oblong  germ:  the  style  filiform,  the  length  of  the 
stamens:  stigma  bifid,  spreading:  females,  germ  and  style  the  same: 
stigmas  two,  oblong,  and  revolute:  no  pericarpium :  the  calyx  scarcely 
changed:  the  seeds  solitary,  oblong,  and  ovate:  down  capillary:  the 
receptacle  is  naked  and  flattish. 

The  species  principally  cultivated  are,  1.  A.  Chinensis,  China  As- 
ter, or  Chinese  Starwort;  2.  A.  Tradescanti,  Tradescant's  or  Virginia 
Starwort;  3.  A.  Amelias,  Amellus,  or  Italian  Starwort;  4.  A.  Alpinus, 
Alpine  or  Great  Mountain  Starwort;  5.  A.  Nov<z- Anglice,  New- Eng- 
land Starwort;  6.  A .  grandiflorus,  Great  Blue  Pyramidal  Aster,  or 
Catesby's  Starwort;  7.  A.puniceus,  Red-stalked  American  Starwort; 
8.  A.  undulatus,  Waved  Starwort;  9.  A.  linifoliits,  Flax-leaved  Star- 


• 


67 

wort;  10.  A.  tenuifolius, Fine-leaved  Stanvort;  11. -4.  Ericoides,  Heath- 
leaved  Stanvort;  12.  A.  dumqsus,  Bushy  Slarwort;  13.  A.  concolor, 
Single-stalked  Starwort;  14.  A.  divaricatus,  Divaricate  Stanvort; 
15.  A.  Novi-Belgii,  New-Holland  Starwort;  16.  A.  paniculatus,  Pa- 
nicled  Starwort;  1?.  A.  fruticosus,  Shrubby  Starwort.  In  this  nu- 
merous genus  there  are  several  other  species  equally  deserving  the 
attention  of  the  cultivator. 

The  first  is  an  elegant  annual  plant,  rising  in  height  from  eighteen 
inches  to  two  feet;  the  stem  is  erect,  stiff,  furrowed,  and  as  thick  as 
the  little  finger,  putting  out  long  bending  branches  from  top  to  bot- 
tom. The  leaves  next  the  ground  and  at  the  origin  of  the  branches 
are  large,  and  resemble  those  of  common  Chenopodium :  those  on  the 
branches  are  much  smaller,  and  the  upper  ones  narrow  and  verj*  en- 
tire: the  flowers  are  the  largest  and  handsomest  of  any  of  the  species 
in  this  genus:  the  disk  yellow,  at  first  flat,  then  convex ;  the  floscules 
of  the  ray  are  broad  and  long,  scarcely  notched  at  the  end. 

There  are  varieties  of  this  plant  with  single  white  flowers,  single 
blue  flowers,  single  purple  flowers,  single  red  flowers :  with  double 
while  flowers,  double  blue  flowers,  double  red  flowers,  and  with  va- 
riegated blue  and  white  flowers. 

The  second  species  has  radical  leaves  three  or  four  inches  long, 
like  those  of  the  willow,  from  green  inclining  to  brown,  with  small 
scattered  serratures.  Among  these  come  out  round,  smooth,  woody, 
brownish  stems,  clothed  with  similar  leaves,  only  shorter;  they  are 
elegantly  divided  into  many  slender,  hard  branches,  two  or  three  feet 
high,  adorned  with  abundance  of  very  small  white  flowers  during  the 
months  of  September  and  October.  According  to  some,  the  disk  is 
purple.  The  ray  of  the  corolla  is  first  white,  and  afterwards  purplish. 
It  is  a  native  of  Virginia. 

The  third  sort  has  the  stems  growing  in  large  clusters  from  the 
root,  each  of  them  branching  at  the  top  into  eight  or  ten  peduncles, 
€ach  terminated  by  a  single  large  flower,  having  blue  rays,  with  a 
yellow  disk.  It  flowers  in  August  or  September,  and  in  mild  seasons 
will  often  continue  till  the  middle  of  November.  It  grows  naturally 
in  Italy. 


68 

There  are  varieties  with  white  flowers  and  with  wrinkled  leaves. 
The  fourth  species  seldom  rise  more  than  nine,  commonly  from 
four  to  six  inches  high,  in  its  native  situation,  and  when  transplanted 
into  gardens,  from  nine  to  ten,  but  rarely  above  sixteen.  At  the 
top  of  each  stalk  is  one  large  blue  flower,  somewhat  like  that  of 
the  Italian  Starwort.  It  flowers  in  June,  and  is  a  native  of  the 
Alps,  &c. 

There  are  varieties  with  white  rays  and  with  blue  rays. 
The  fifth  species  has  many  stems,  five  feet  high,  brown,  termi- 
nated by  large  purple  violet  flowers,  growing  in  a  loose  panicle,  and 
expanding  in  August.     The  peduncles  are  so  short  as  scarcely  to 
appear  among  the  flowers.     It  is  a  native  of  New  England. 

The  sixth  has  many  stems,  three  and  even  four  feet  high,  stiff", 
reddish,  hairy,  and  branching  pyramid ically.  The  branches  have 
small  lanceolate  leaves,  growing  alternate,  hairy  and  rough  to  the 
touch,  the  size  of  those  of  common  Hyssop,  and  each  terminated  by 
one  large  blue  flower,  coming  out  at  the  end  of  October.  It  is  a 
native  of  Virginia. 

The  seventh  sort  has  several  strong  stems,  upwards  of  two  feet 
high,  of  a  purple  colour;  but  the  flowers  are  on  single  peduncles, 
forming  a  corymb  at  top,  and  of  a  pale  blue  colour:  they  appear 
about  the  end  of  September.  It  is  a  native  of  North  America;  va- 
ries in  height  from  eight  to  three  feet,  having  the  stems  either  dark 
purple  or  reddish  green. 

There  is  a  variety,  in  which  the  flowers  are  purple  inclining  to 
red,  and  surrounded  by  a  few  narrow  leaves.  This  is  from  Phila- 
delphia, and  flowers  in  November. 

The  eighth  species  has  the  leaves  broad  and  heart-shaped  at 
bottom ;  the  stems  between  two  and  three  feet  high,  with  small  side 
branches,  upon  which  the  flowers  come  out  in  loose  spikes;  they  are 
of  a  pale  blue  colour,  inclining  to  white.  It  flowers  in  August.  It 
is  a  native  of  North  America. 

The  ninth  has  the  leaves  lanceolate,  gradually  narrowing  to  the 
end:  peduncles  with  very  small  subulate  scales:  the  stems  strong? 
from  two  to  three  feet  high,  putting  out  many  side  branches  near  half 


69 

their  length,  terminated  by  one  blue  flower,  which  appears  in  August 
and  September. 

In  the  tenth  species  the  stems  are  five  feet  high,  slender,  angular, 
smooth,  but  not  branching  much;  the  leaves  alternate,  not  very 
rough;  the  flowers  terminal,  solitary, small,  and  white;  the  peduncles 
have  very  small  subulate  leaflets  scattered  over  them. 

The  eleventh  has  the  stems  slender,  three  feet  high,  with  slender 
side  branches  most  of  their  length,  so  as  to  form  a  thick  bush;  they 
are  terminated  by  single  flowers. 

The  twelfth  species  has  the  stems  upright,  two  feet  high,  full  of 
branches,  which  are  filiform ;  the  stem-leaves  being  narrow-lance- 
olate; on  the  branches  linear:  the  peduncles  filiform,  striated,  one- 
flowered,  with  very  narrow  leaflets  on  them;  the  flowers  small,  with 
an  erect,  imbricate,  loose  calyx;  the  ray  copious,  and  white;  the 
disk  yellow,  with  fewer  flowers. 

The  thirteenth  species  rises  four  feet  high ;  the  flowers  are  pale 
blue,  appearing  about  Michaelmas.  The  whole  plant  is  tomentose, 
especially  the  leaves  and  calyxes.  The  raceme  simple,  with  very 
short  peduncles.  It  is  a  native  of  Virginia. 

The  fifteenth  species  has  the  stem  obscurely  furrowed,  of  a  pale 
red,  not  very  erect,  but  irregularly  flexuose,  corymbosely  branched, 
the  branches  divaricate  and  much  divided;  the  leaves  of  the  same 
form,  sometimes  having  a  single  serrature,  the  edge  scabrous,  if  the 
finger  be  drawn  toward  the  base,  the  surface  rough  with  invisible 
hairs;  the  flowers  rather  solitary,  somewhat  small,  on  long,  scaly, 
yellow  peduncles;  scales  of  the  calyx  distant,  in  five  rows;  disk  of 
the  corolla  yellow;  ray  pale  blue,  revolute;  the  height  near  four 
feet,  having  broad  leaves  at  the  bottom,  which  diminish  gradually  to 
the  top.  The  flowers  appear  at  the  latter  end  of  August.  It  is  a 
native  of  Virginia. 

The  sixteenth  rises  to  the  height  of  four  feet,  the  stems  putting 
out  side  branches  towards  the  top,  which  grow  erect,  forming  a  loose 
spike  of  large  blue  flowers,  expanding  about  the  end  of  October.  It 
is  a  native  of  North  America. 

The  seventeenth  species  has  the  stems  three  feet  high,  with  side 


70 

woody  branches  having  clusters  of  narrow  leaves  like  those  of  the 
Larch-tree;  the  flowers  are  produced  from  the  side  of  the  branches, 
upon  long  slender  peduncles  singly;  they  are  of  a  pale  blue  colour, 
and  appear  the  beginning  of  March.  It  is  a  native  of  the  Cape. 

Culture. — The  hardy  kinds  of  these  plants  easily  succeed  in 
almost  any  soil  or  situation.  The  first  sort,  and  varieties  being  an- 
nual plants,  are  propagated  by  sowing  the  seeds  of  the  different  kinds 
from  the  beginning  of  March  to  May,  on  a  very  moderate  hot-bed, 
just  to  bring  up  the  plants,  the  air  being  admitted  as  much  as  possi- 
ble when  the  weather  is  suitable,  in  order  to  promote  the  vigorous 
growth  of  the  plants;  when  they  are  sufficiently  strong  they  should 
be  planted  out  either  into  beds  of  good  earth  at  six  inches  distance 
each  way,  or  into  the  places  where  they  are  to  remain,  in  the  borders 
or  other  parts:  the  latter  is  probably  the  better  practice,  as  they  grow 
more  strongly.  In  the  bed  method  they  are  usually  transplanted 
after  a  few  weeks,  with  large  balls  of  earth  to  their  roots,  into  the 
situations  where  they  are  to  flower,  the  mould  being  made  fine  about 
them.  A  few  of  the  fine  double  varieties  may  also  be  put  in  pots. 
Moist  weather  is  the  most  suitable  for  this  business,  but  in  other  cir- 
cumstances a  little  water  should  be  given  immediately  after  the  earth 
has  been  closed  round  their  roots,  as  well  as  in  future  when  it  may 
be  necessary. 

But  when  the  sowing  is  not  made  at  an  early  period,  the  best 
practice  is  to  let  it  be  done  in  the  situations  where  the  plants  are  to 
grow,  which  should  be  rather  warm  and  dry,  the  mould  being  made 
fine  by  a  rake  in  the  spots  where  they  are  to  be  put  in,  as  in  this 
way  their  growth  is  less  checked  than  when  transplanted. 

In  either  method  of  sowing,  care  should  be  taken  that  the  seed 
be  only  covered  in  a  very  light  manner,  and  that  the  mould  be  made 
very  fine. 

The  only  further  culture  which  they  require,  is  that  of  keeping 
the  plants  perfectly  free  from  weeds,  and  well  supported  in  the  time 
of  flowering. 

The  whole  of  the  hardy  American  sorts  as  well  as  the  Italian 
species  may  be  readily  increased  by  parting  the  roots.  In  the 


71 

former  it  is  best  performed  in  the  autumn,  the  parted  roots  being 
immediately  planted  out  in  the  places  where  they  are  designed  to 
flower. 

The  latter  or  Italian  sort  should  have  the  roots  parted  and  re- 
planted as  soon  as  the  flowers  begin  to  decline,  as,  when  the  busi- 
ness is  deferred  till  late  in  the  autumn  or  the  spring,  the  plants 
neither  grow  so  strong  nor  flower  so  completely.  The  roots  in  this 
kind  should  not  be  taken  up  oftener  than  once  in  three  or  four  years, 
where  a  full  display  of  flowers  is  the  principal  object. 

This  sort  has  not  been  so  much  attended  to  since  the  introduc- 
tion of  the  American  species;  but  from  the  plants  creeping  less  by 
the  roots,  and  requiring  less  support  in  the  stems,  they  are  equally 
deserving  of  regard  for  the  purpose  of  cultivation. 

As  this  sort  is  not,  however,  capable  of  increasing  fast  by  dividing 
the  roots,  it  may  be  readily  multiplied  by  planting  cuttings  from  the 
young  shoots  in  the  later  spring  months,  in  situations  where  the  mould 
is  light  and  fine,  being  well  shaded  from  the  effects  of  the  sun  till  they 
are  perfectly  established  in  the  soil. 

The  last  or  shrubby  sort  must  be  propagated  by  setting  the  cut- 
tings of  the  young  shoots,  in  pots  of  light  earth,  in  the  spring  or 
summer  months,  which  should  be  plunged  in  a  hot-bed  to  promote 
their  striking  root.  They  may  then  be  placed  out  in  the  open  air 
during  the  summer  season,  but  in  the  autumn  and  winter  they  re- 
quire the  protection  of  a  green-house. 

The  first  sort,  or  China  Asters,  are  elegant  plants  for  the  purpose 
of  variety,  in  the  clumps  and  common  borders  of  gardens,  or  plea- 
sure grounds.  In  saving  the  seeds,  they  should  be  selected  from  the 
best  coloured  flowers  of  the  most  perfect  plants,  in  October,  when 
they  are  fully  ripened,  and  be  gathered  when  quite  dry. 

The  perennial  sorts  have  likewise  a  showy  appearance,  in  large 
clumps  and  borders,  when  judiciously  distributed  among  other  hardy 
shrubs  and  herbaceous  plants;  some  of  the  species  continuing  to 
flower  to  a  late  period  in  the  autumnal  season. 

The  shrubby  kind  affords  variety  among  other  green-house  plants, 
both  in  the  summer  and  winter  season. 


I.  AMARANTHUS  HYPOCHONDRIACUS. 
PRINCE'S  FEATHER. 


THIS  genus  comprises  many  plants  of  the  Prince's  Feather  kind. 
They  are  universally  herbaceous  annuals,  several  of  them  being  highly 
beautiful  and  curious.  They  are  likewise  sometimes  distinguished 
by  the  titles  of  Flower  Gentle,  Love-lies-bleeding,  &c. 
.  It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Moncecia  Pentandria,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Miscellanea. 

The  characters  are :  that  those  species  which  have  male  flowers 
on  the  same  plants  with  the  females  have  a  calyx,  which  is  a  five 
or  three-leaved  perianthium,  upright,  coloured,  and  permanent;  the 
leaflets  lanceolate,  and  acute:  no  corolla:  the  stamina  have  five  or 
three  capillary  filaments,  from  upright  patulous,  of  the  length  of  the 
calyx,  the  anlherae  oblong  and  versatile.  Of  those  which  have  female 
flowers  in  the  same  raceme  with  the  males,  the  calyx  is  a  perianlhium 
the  same  with  the  former:  no  corolla:  the  pistillum  has  an  ovate 
germ;  the  styles  three,  short  and  subulate:  stigmas  simple  and  per- 
manent: the  pericarpium  is  an  ovate  capsule,  somewhat  compressed, 
as  is  also  the  calyx  on  which  it  is  placed,  coloured,  and  of  the  same 
size;  three-beaked,  one-celled,  cut  open  transversely:  the  seed  is 
single,  globular,  compressed,  and  large. 

The  species  that  demand  attention  for  the  purpose  of  cultivation 
are  very  numerous,  but  those  most  generally  cultivated  are:  I.  A. 
melancholicus,  Two-coloured  Amaranthus;  2.  A.  tricolor,  Three-co- 
loured Amaranthus;  3.  A.  sangninei/s,  Spreading  or  Bloody  Ama- 
ranthus; 4.  A.  caudutus,  Pendulous  Amaranthus,  or  Love-lies-bleed- 
ing; 5.  A.  mavitnus,  Tree  Amaranthus;  6.  A.cruentus,  Various-leaved 
Amaranthus;  7-  A.  hypochondriacus,  Prince's-feather  Amaranthus. 


73 

The  first,  or  Two-coloured  Amaranlhus,  has  the  stem  upright, 
half  a  foot  high,  dark  purple,  smooth,  streaked,  and  simple:  the 
leaves  are  blunt,  wrinkled,  waved,  emarginale,  mucronate,  with  a 
short  white  point;  the  lower  ones  rufous  liver-coloured  on  the  upper 
surface,  bright  purple  on  the  lower,  with  elevated  veins:  the  upper 
ones  green,  with  red  tips:  the  petioles  channelled,  bright  purple, 
smooth,  edged  at  top  with  the  decreasing  leaf:  the  lower  ones  nearly 
the  length  of  the  leaves:  the  glotnerules  subsessile,  dark  purple,  on 
a  very  short  undivided  peduncle:    the  calyxes  five-leaved:  the  leaf- 
lets oblong,  purple,  membranaceous,  ending  in  a  dark  red  point. 
Professor  Martyn  observes  that  this  species  varies  in  the  colour  of 
the  leaves;  as  in  the  open  air  they  are  of  a  dirty  purple  on  their 
upper  surface,  and  in  the  younger  ones  green;  while  in  the  stove  the 
whole  plant  is  of  a  fine  purple  colour.     It  is,  however,  easily  dis- 
tinguished in  all  slates  by  its  colour,  its  leaves,  and  the  lateness  of 
its  flowering,  which  is  after  all  the  others  are  past.     It  is  a  native 
of  Guiana  and  the  East  Indies.     Mr.  Miller  remarks  that  it  grows 
to  the  same  height  with  the  Tricolor,  and  in  the  manner  of  its  growth 
greatly  resembles  it;  but  that  the  leaves  have  only  two  colours,  an 
obscure  purple  and  a  bright  crimson,  so  blended  as  to  set  off  each 
other,  making  a  fine  appearance  when  the  plants  are  vigorous. 

The  second  species,  or  Three-coloured  Amaranthus,  has  the  stem 
a  foot  and  half  or  two  feet  in  height,  obscurely  angular,  smooth,  and 
upright:  the  leaves  blue  with  a  red  point,  smooth,  and  waved:  the 
younger  ones  red  with  yellow  tips:  those  in  a  more  mature  state 
coralled  at  the  base,  violet  in  the  middle,  and  green  at  the  end:  the 
old  ones  green  with  a  violet  base:  the  petioles  very  long,  smooth, 
green,  channelled,  and  bordered:  the  glomerules  geminate,  green, 
axillary:  the  calyxes  three-leaved:  the  leaflets  oblong,  acuminate, 
membranaceous,  with  a  green  nerve.  It  varies  in  the  colour  of  the 
leaves,  which  are  less  painted  in  the  open  air  than  in  the  stove.  It 
has  been  long  cultivated  for  the  beauty  of  its  vanegated  leaves,  in 
which  the  colours  are  elegantly  mixed.  When  the  plant  is  in  full 
vigour  these  are  large,  and  closely  set  from  the  bottom  to  the  top  of 

the  stalk:  the  branches  also  form  a  sort  of  pyramid;  so  that  there  is 

L 


74 

scarce!}'  a  more  handsome  plant  when  it  is  in  full  lustre.  It  flowers 
from  June  to  September.  And  it  is  a  native  of  Guiana. 

.  The  third,  or  Bloody-leaved  Amaranlhus,  has  the  stem  upright, 
four  feet  high,  firm,  red,  round,  and  streaked:  the  leaves  somewhat 
convex,  or  rather  so  contracted  as  to  have  the  form  of  a  boat,  and 
pointed;  the  older  ones  rather  blunt:  the  upper  surface  is  a  mixture 
of  red  and  green,  the  lower  more  or  less  purple:  the  petioles  are 
tinged  with  purple,  channelled,  roughish;  winged  at  top  with  the 
leaf:  the  racemes  very  red:  the  branches  smooth,  the  lower  one 
spreading:  the  calyxes  five-leaved:  leaflets  oblong,  blunt,  mem- 
branaceous,  and  red:  the  bracieoe  subdulato-setaceous,  red,  longer 
than  the  flowers,  closely  surrounding  the  gloinerules. 

The  fourth  species,  or  Pendulous  Amaranthus,  has  the  stem  ge- 
nerally two  feet  high,  green,  obscurely  angular,  grooved  and  streaked, 
smooth,  covered  at  top  with  thin,  whitish,  scattered  hairs:  the  upper 
part  nods  on  account  of  the  great  length  of  the  racemes:  the  leaves 
are  smooth,  bright  green,  blunt,  emarginate,  with  an  incurved  trans- 
parent point:  the  petioles  much  shorter  than  the  leaf:  the  racemes 
terminating,  elegantly  purple,  very  long,  cylindrical,  composed  of 
flowers  very  closely  glomerate:  the  calyxes  five-leaved:  the  leaflets 
oblong,  red,  acuminate,  membranaceous:  the  bractene  oblong,  point- 
ed, and  scattered. 

The  fifth,  or  Tree  Amaranthus,  rises  to  the  height  of  seven  or 
eight  feet,  sending  off  numerous  horizontal  branches  at  every  ten  or 
twelve  inches:  the  leaves  are  rough,  green,  and  luxuriant:  the  spikes 
are  seldom  half  the  length  of  those  of  the  other  sorts,  but  are 
much  thicker.  It  is  said  to  degenerate  gradually  into  the  smaller 
kind.  The  seeds,  which  at  first  are  white,  also  become  red.  Jt 
flowers  in  August  and  September.  And  it  is  a  native  of  Persia,  &c. 

In  the  sixth  species,  the  stem  is  a  foot  and  a  half  or  two  feet  in 
height,  grooved,  green  with  red  streaks,  smooth,  and  slightly  pubes- 
cent among  the  flowers:  the  leaves  are  green,  spotted  with  brown 
above,  red  beneath,  bhintish  with  a  reddish  short  point:  the  petioles 
red,  channelled,  and  smooth:  the  racemes  red  and  green,  with 
branchlets  spreading  and  nodding  a  little:  the  calyx-  five-leaved:  the 


leaflets  oblong,  pointed,  whitc-mcmbranaceous,  with  a  red  nerve,  and 
a  point  of  the  same  colour. 

It  varies  of  a  shining  red  colour, — with  a  red  stalk  with  pale 
leaves, — with  a  green  stalk  with  variegated  leaves,  &c.  As  first  cul- 
tivated in  this  climate,  according  to  professor  Marlyn,  the  stem  was 
wholly  red  and  smooth;  the  petioles,  ribs,  and  nerves  of  the  leaves 
underneath  purple;  the  spikes  purple,  m'.ich  spreading,  and  a  little 
nodding.  They  were  of  course  very  beautiful,  and  made  a  gay  ap- 
pearance for  the  two  first  years:  but  afterwards  the  seeds  degene- 
rated, and  the  plants  had  little  beauty;  which  is  the  same  with  some 
other  species  of  this  genus.  It  is  a  native  of  the  East  Indies. 

In  the  seventh  species,  the  stem  is  erect,  a  foot  and  a  half  or  two 
feet  in  height,  smooth,  except  under  the  leaves,  where  it  is  a  little 
scabrous,  reddish,  roundish,  streaked,  and  grooved:  the  leaves  are 
red  and  green,  acute,  with  elevated  veins:  the  petioles  are  channel- 
led, and  of  a  reddish  colour:  the  racemes  are  naked,  red,  lateral, 
short,  and  placed  about  the  stem  without  order:  the  calyxes  are  five- 
leaved:  the  leaflets  oblong,  acute,  membranaceous,  and  red. 

It  varies  with  leaves  more  or  less  red, — with  very  red  and  paler 
racemes,  with  a  green  and  red,— with  a  rough  and  smooth  stalk.  It 
flowers  from  July  to  September.  And  it  is  a  native  of  Virginia. 

Culture. — The  propagation  in  most  of  these  species  is  not  effected 
without  considerable  trouble,  as  they  require  ihe  aid  of  artificial  heat, 
in  order  to  bring  them  forward  in  (he  greatest  perfection.  There  are 
a  few,  however,  that  may  be  raised  in  the  open  ground  without  the 
assistance  of  heat  applied  in  the  above  manner. 

The  two  first,  as  being  the  most  tender,  demand  much  greater 
attention  and  more  artificial  heat  in  producing  them,  than  those  of 
the  third,  fourth,  and  fiflh  kinds.  And  the  sixth  and  seventh  species 
are  capable  of  being  raised  with  still  less  heat  than  those  of  the  above 
sorts,  though  not  in  the  fullest  perfection  without  a  slight  degree 
of  it. 

In  all  the  different  species  the  business  is  accomplished  by  sow- 
ing the  seeds  annually  in  the  early  spring  months,  as  about  the  latter 
end  of  March  or  beginning  of  April,  on  beds  of  good  earth,  either 


76 

over  heat  or  in  the  natural  ground,  according  to  the  nature  of  the 
plants.  The  earlier  the  sowing  can  be  performed,  the  belter  growth 
the  plants  will  attain  in  the  summer  season. 

In  raising  the  two  first  sorts  in  the  greatest  lustre  and  perfection, 
the  aid  of  two  or  three  different  hot-beds  is  necessary;  which  should 
be  covered  with  frames  and  glasses,  so  as  to  slide  with  ease  and  con- 
venience. The  first  of  these  hot-beds  should  be  small,  and  made  in 
the  ordinary  way,  for  the  purpose  of  receiving  the  seed,  and  which 
may  likewise  serve  for  that  of  other  annuals  of  the  tender  kind  of 
similar  growth.  They  should  be  earthed  over  the  top  within  the 
frames,  to  the  depth  of  five  or  six  inches,  with  good  light  dry  mould. 
In  this  the  seed  should  be  sown  in  small  shallow  drills,  and  covered 
over  very  lightly  with  fine  sifted  mould :  the  glasses  are  then  to  be 
placed  over.  In  these  situations  the  plants  should  be  suffered  to  re- 
main till  they  have  attained  the  height  of  two  or  three  inches,  air 
being  admitted  in  fine  days,  and  the  glasses  covered  at  nights  with 
garden  mats.  When  the  plants  are  in  this  situation,  a  second  hot- 
bed is  to  be  prepared  in  the  same  manner,  into  which  the  young 
plants  are  to  be  pricked  out  to  the  distance  of  about  four  inches  from 
each  other,  moderate  waterings  being  occasionally  given,  and  the 
plants  well  shaded  from  the  sun  till  they  have  taken  fresh  root.  Air 
should  now  be  admitted  more  freely  when  the  weather  is  fine,  by 
raising  one  end  of  the  glasses,  and  the  night  coverings  be  carefully 
applied.  After  the  plants  have  remained  in  these  beds  a  month  or 
six  weeks,  and  are  become  tolerably  strong  in  their  growth,  so  as  to 
require  more  space,  the  final  hot-beds  should  be  made  ready.  These 
ought  to  be  of  much  larger  dimensions.  When  the  frames  are  placed 
over  them,  earth  to  the  depth  of  four  or  five  inches  should  be  laid 
over;  and  the  plants,  after  being  taken  up  with  balls  of  earth  about 
their  roots,  planted  in  pots  of  about  the  twenty-fourth  size,  water 
being  immediately  applied  in  a  sparing  manner,  and  the  pots  plunged 
in  the  earth  of  the  beds,  the  frames  being  raised  occasionally,  as  the 
plants  advance  in  growth.  The  lights  are  to  be  constantly  kept  on, 
but  air  freely  admitted  by  raising  the  ends  daily,  and  water  applied 
every  day  or  two.  Towards  the  end  of  June  the  plants  will  have 


17 

risen  to  nearly  their  full  size;  when  they  may  be  placed  out  in  the 
open  air,  where  they  are  fully  seen  when  the  weather  is  fine  and 
settled,  each  of  them  being  supported  by  a  handsome  stick. 

In  their  after  culture,  they  require  to  be  kept  constantly  in  the 
pots,  and  to  have  water  freely  applied  almost  every  day  when  the 
season  is  hot. 

In  order  to  procure  the  seed  of  these  kinds  in  perfection,  it  is  the 
best  method  to  put  a  few  of  the  best  plants  in  a  deep  frame  towards 
the  latter  end  of  the  summer,  that  they  may,  by  being  more  per- 
fectly sheltered  by  the  glasses,  be  rendered  more  fully  ripe. 

In  the  culture  of  the  third  and   fourth  sorts,  as  they  are  more 
hardy,  one  or  two  moderate  hot-beds  at  most  will  be  fully  sufficient 
for  raising  the  plants.    In  these  cases,  the  seeds  should  be  sown  upon 
a  moderate  hot-bed  towards  the  end  of  March  ;  and  when  the  plants 
come  up  they  should  have  a  considerable  share  of  air  admitted  to 
them  in  mild  weather,  in  order  to  prevent  their  drawing  up  in  too 
weak  a  state :  and  when  they  are  become  large  enough  to  be  trans- 
planted  out,   another  moderate  hot-bed  should  be   provided,   into 
which  they  should  be  removed,  placing  them  at  six  inches  distance 
in  every  direction,  care  being  taken  to  water  them  as  well  as  to  shade 
them  from  the  sun  in  hot  weather,  until  they  have  taken  new  root: 
after  which  the  air  should  be  freely  admitted  to  them  at  all  times 
when  the  season  is  favourable.     Their  waterings  should  likewise  be 
frequent,  but  not  given  in  too  great  quantity  at  a  time.    As  the  plants 
advance  in  growth,  and   the  warmth  of  the  season  increases,  they 
should  have  a  greater  proportion  of  air,  that  by  degrees  they  may  be 
hardened  so  as  to  bear  the  open  exposure.    In  the  beginning  of  June 
the  plants  may  be  taken   up  with  large  balls  of  earth  about  their 
roots,  and  planted  some  into  pots,  and  others  in  the  borders  or  other 
parts  of  the  pleasure-grounds,  shading  them  carefully  until  they  have 
taken  good  root:  after  which  they  should  be  frequently  watered  in 
hot  dry  weather,  especially  those  in  the  pots;  as  every  evening  or 
oflener. 

As  the  Tree  Amaranlhus  does  not  thrive  well  in  pots,  it  should 
be  planted  in  a  rich  light  soil,  and  be  allowed  plenty  of  room,  and  a 


78 

full  supply  of  water,  as  often  as  may  be  neccessary.  In  these  cir- 
cumstances it  frequently  attains  a  considerable  size,  especially  in  dry 
seasons. 

The  two  last  species  are  capable  of  being  raised  upon  warm  dry 
borders  with  tolerable  facility;  but  they  neither  attain  the  full  growth, 
afford  such  large  flower-spikes,  or  appear  in  such  early  perfection,  as 
when  managed  in  the  manner  of  the  above. 

In  preserving  the  seed  of  the  last  five  sorts,  some  of  the  largest 
and  finest  spikes  should  be  collected,  as  they  ripen  towards  the  latter 
end  of  September,  and  exposed  to  the  full  sun  in  some  dry  airy  situ- 
ation until  they  become  perfectly  dry,  when  the  seeds  may  be  rub- 
bed out  and  put  by  in  a  dry  warm  place. 

Persons  who  are  curious  in  raising  these  annual  plants  in  great 
perfection,  find  it  convenient  to  have  a  glass  case  erected,  with  up- 
right sloping  glasses  on  every  side,  having  a  pit  in  the  bottom  for 
tan,  in  which  the  pots  are  plunged.  If  this  be  raised  eight  or  nine 
feet  to  the  ridge,  and  the  upright  glasses  are  five  feet,  there  will  be 
room  and  light  enough  to  raise  these  as  well  as  many  other  plants  of 
a  similar  growth  to  great  perfection:  and,  by  such  a  contrivance, 
many  of  those  tender  annual  plants,  which  rarely  perfect  seeds  in 
this  climate  under  other  circumstances,  may  be  brought  forward  so 
as  to  ripen  their  seeds  in  a  perfect  manner. 

All  these  plants  are  highly  ornamental,  the  more  tender  sorts  be- 
ing mostly  distributed  in  mixture  with  others  of  the  showy  kinds  in 
places  immediately  about  the  house;  while  those  that  are  more 
hardy  afford  much  ornament  and  variety  in  the  borders,  clumps,  and 
other  situations  in  gardens  or  pleasure-grounds.  They  should  have 
rather  open  exposures,  and  be  distributed  towards  the  fronts, 
cially  those  of  the  low  growing  kinds. 


11.8. 


tntfe/ri<  >,t 
fv  ry//r  /////,/       Deasfane 


Jf/fff  t  »/,,,, 

Anfirr/utiiitti    t>n  tint  ,;•/,>„ 
"  Jr&rpu    Totutfuue 


PLATE  VIII. 

1.  APOCYNUM  ANDROS^MIFOLIUM, 

FI.Y-CATCHING    DOG's-BANE. 


THIS  genus  contains  hardy,  herbaceous,  perennial  and  shrubby 
tender  exotics,  of  the  flowering  kind. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Pentandria  Digynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  Contortce. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  one-leafed,  five-parted, 
acute,  short,  and  permanent  perianthium:  the  corolla  is  monopeta- 
lous,  bell-shaped,  arid  semiquinquefid:  the  divisions  revolute:  the 
nectary  consists  of  five  glandular  oval  capsules  surrounding  the 
germ:  the  stamina  consist  of  very  short  filaments:  the  anlherge  ob- 
long, erect,  acute,  bifid  at  the  base,  converging:  the  pislillum  con- 
sisting of  two  ovate  germs:  the  styles  short:  the  stigmas  roundish, 
bifid  at  the  top,  muricale,  glued  to  the  anthers:  the  pericarpium 
consists  of  two  long,  acuminate,  one-valved,  one-celled  follicles: 
containing  many  very  small  seeds,  crowned  with  long  down;  the 
receptacle  subulate,  very  long,  rough,  and  free. 

The  species  are:  1.  A.  androscemifolium,  Tutsan-leaved  Dog's- 
bane;  2.  A.  canabinum,  Hemp  Dogs-bane;  3.  A.  hypericifolium,  St. 
John's  Wort-leaved  Dogs-bane;  4.  A.  vcnetuni,  Venetian  Spear- 
leaved  Dogs-bane;  5.  A.frutescens,  Shrubby  Dog-bane;  6.  A.  reti- 
culatum,  Net-leaved  Climbing  Dogs-bane. 

The  first  has  the  stems  about  three  feet  in  height,  and  upright. 
The  leaves  are  opposite ;  and  these  and  the  stems  abound  with  a 
milky  juice,  which  flows  out  when  they  are  broken.  The  corollas 
are  while,  with  the  nectaries  of  a  purplish  cast.  But,  according  to 
some,  they  are  pale  red  with  a  tinge  of  purple,  the  flowers  being 


SO 

pendulous.     It  is  a  native  of  Virginia,  and  flowers  from  July  to  Sep- 
tember.    It  is  perennial. 

The  second  species  has  the  roots  perennial,  and  creeping.  The 
steins  are  brown,  and  about  two  feet  in  height.  The  leaves  are 
smooth,  in  pairs,  abounding  wilh  a  milky  juice,  like  the  Former. 
Towards  the  upper  part  of  the  stem,  the  flowers  come  out  from  the 
wings  of  the  leaves,  in  small  bunches,  and  are  of  an  herbaceous  while 
colour,  and  small.  It  is  admitted  for  the  sake  of  variety.  It  flowers 
as  above;  and  is  a  native  of  the  same  place.  The  stems  afford  a 
hempy  substance. 

In  the  third  the  root  is  likewise  perennial,  and  creeping.  The 
stems  annual,  upright,  round,  branched,  a  foot  and  half  in  height, 
and  filled  with  a  white  pith.  The  leaves  opposite,  sharpish,  quite 
entire,  subsessile;  the  upper  ones  on  the  extreme  twigs  pelioled,  not 
revolute.  The  peduncles  umbelled,  and  terminating.  The  flowers 
small,  and  inodorous.  The  leaflets  of  the  calyx  are  oblong,  con- 
cave, erect,  and  green.  The  corolla  white,  and  longer  than  the  ca- 
lyx. Between  the  filaments  there  is  a  roundish,  green  gland.  The 
whole  plant  is  smooth,  and  abounds  with  a  milky  juice.  It  is  a  na- 
tive of  North  America,  and  flowers  in  June  and  July. 

The  fourth  species  has  the  root  perennial,  and  creeping.  The 
stems  about  two  feet  high.  The  leaves  opposite  and  smooth.  The 
flowers  grow  erect,  at  the  top  of  the  steins  in  small  umbels,  and  are 
much  larger  than  in  the  former  sorts.  It  is  a  native  of  the  islands  in 
the  Adriatic  sea,  and  flowers  in  July  and  August. 

There  are  varieties  with  purple,  and  with  white  flowers. 

In  the  fifth  the  stem  is  woody,  five  or  six  feet  in  height,  dividing 
into  several  branches.  Leaves  opposite,  pelioled,  smooth,  quite  entire. 
The  peduncles  from  the  axils,  opposite;  being  oppositely  branched. 
The  corolla  salver-shaped.  The  flowers  are  in  loose  bunches,  small, 
and  of  a  purple  colour;  but  never  succeeded  by  pods  in  this  coun- 
try. It  is  a  native  of  the  East  Indies,  &c. 

The  sixth  species  has  a  twining  stem,  by  which  it  rises  to  a  con- 
siderable height.  The  leaves  are  dark  green,  very  shining,  wilh  a 


81 

beautiful  net  of  milky  veins.  It  is  a  native  of  the  East  In- 
dies, &c. 

Culture. — The  four  first  species  are  capable  of  being  easily  pro- 
pagated, by  dividing  their  creeping  roots  either  in  the  early  spring 
months,  before  they  protrude  their  stems,  or  in  the  autumn.  The 
soil  most  proper  for  them  is  that  of  the  light  dry  kind,  as,  where 
there  is  much  moislure,  they  are  apt  to  be  destroyed  in  the  winter 
season  by  their  roots  becoming  rotten.  In  the  second  species  the 
roots  sometimes  spread  in  a  troublesome  manner. 

The  fourth  species  requires  a  very  dry,  warm  exposure;  as  it  is 
less  hardy  than  the  former.  It  is  best  to  remove  it  when  necessary 
in  the  early  spring,  when  it  is  about  to  send  forth  its  stems. 

The  two  last  species  are  best  propagated  by  layers  or  cuttings 
from  their  young  shoots,  which  should  be  made  during  the  summer 
season,  being  dried  in  the  stove  some  days  before  they  are  planted 
out.  They  are  likewise  capable  of  being  raised  by  seed,  when  it  can 
be  procured,  as  they  seldom  afford  any  in  this  climate.  In  either 
metho|j,  pots  of  light  sandy  earth  should  be  employed.  In  the  for- 
mer, the  layers  or  cuttings,  after  being  planted  out  in  them,  should 
be  placed  in  a  mild  hot-bed;  and  in  the  latter,  after  the  seeds  are 
sdwn,  the  pots  should  be  plunged  into  a  tan-bed.  When  the  plants 
are  up  they  must  be  watered  sparingly,  and  kept  constantly  in  the 
tan,  being  changed  into  larger  pots  as  they  advance  in  growth,  great 
care  being  taken  not  to  over-pot  them,  as  they  thrive  best  where  their 
roots  are  a  little  confined.  Under,  good  management,  they  mostly 
flower  in  the  second  year. 

The  first  kinds  are  sufficiently  hardy  to  bear  the  exposure  of  the 
open  air;  but  the  latter  sorts  require  the  constant  protection  of  the 
stove.  The  former  are  well  adapted  for  producing  variety  in  the 
clumps  and  borders  of  walks  in  pleasure-grounds;  and  the  latter  for 
ornament  in  the  stove,  where,  from  their  beautiful  ever-green  leaves, 
they  have  a  fine  appearance. 


M 


82 


2.  ANTIRRHINUM  PURPUREUM. 

PURPLE    TOADFLAX. 

THIS  genus  includes  various  plants  of  the  herbaceous  flowery 
tribe,  commonly  known  by  the  titles  of  Snap-Dragon,  Calf's-Snout, 
and  Toad-Flax,  or  Frogs-Mouth. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Didynamia  Angiospermia,  and 
ranks  in  the  natural  order  of  Persoiiatce. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  five-parted  permanent 
perianthium :  the  divisions  oblong,  the  two  lowermost  gaping:  the 
corolla  is  monopetalous  and  ringent:  the  tube  oblong,  swelling,  and 
opening  above  with  a  mouth  having  two  lips,  the  upper  one  two- 
parted  and  reflex  on  each  side,  the  under  one  trifid  and  obtuse:  the 
palate  convex,  usually  closed  by  a  prominency  between  the  lips, 
produced  from  the  under  lip,  the  throat  being  concave  beneath,  hav- 
ing a  prominent  nectarium  at  the  base  of  the  corolla,  produced 
downwards  and  prominent:  the  stamina  consist  of  two  short  and  two 
long  filaments,  enclosed  under  the  upper  lip;  the  antherae  converg- 
ing: the  pistillum  a  roundish  germ,  style  simple,  of  the  length  and 
in  the  situation  of  the  stamens:  the  sligrna  obtuse:  the  pericarpium 
a  roundish  capsule,  obtuse,  two-celled,  of  different  form  and  aper- 
tuie  in  the  different  species:  the  seeds  numerous:  the  receptacles 
uniform,  solitary,  and  affixed  to  the  partition. 

The  species  of  most  importance  for  cultivation  are:  1.  A.  linaria, 
Common  Yellow  Toad-Flax ;  2.  A.  cymbalaria,  Ivy-leaved  Toad- 
Flax ;  3.  A.  triphyllum,  Three-leaved  Toad- Flax;  4.  A.  purpurcum, 
Purple  Toad-Flax;  5.  A.  monspessulamim,  Montpellier  Toad-Flax ; 
6.  A.  spar t turn,  Branching  Toad-Flax  ;  7-  A.  triste,  Dark-flowered 
Toad-Flax;  8.  A.  pelisserianutn,  Violet-coloured  Toad-Flax;  9-  A. 
multicaule,  Many-slalked  Toad-Flax;  10.  A.  alpinum,  Alpine  Toad- 
Flax ;  11.  A.  dalmaticum,  Dalmatian  Shrubby  Toad-Flax;  J2.  A.  gc- 


83 

nistcefolium,  Broom-leaved  Toad-Flax;  13.  A.  tnajus,  Great  Toad- 
Flax,  or  Snap-Dragon;  14.  A.  bellidifolium,  Daisy-leaved  Toad-Flax, 
or  Snap-Dragon. 

The  first  species  has  a  hard  woody  creeping  perennial  root:  the 
stems  several,  from  one  to  two  feet  in  height,  full  of  leaves,  round 
and  smooth:  the  leaves  pointed,  smooth,  and  of  a  blueish  colour, 
growing  without  order:  the  flowers  yellow  with  the  palate  orange, 
villose,  in  a  thick  terminal  spike:  the  nectary  long  and  awl-shaped: 
the  upper  segment  of  the  calyx  a  little  longer  than  the  rest:  the  two 
lower  ones  gaping,  widest:  the  capsule  cylindric,  splitting  at  the  top 
into  several  equal  divisions.  It  grows  by  road -sides,  and  flowers 
from  June  to  August.  By  culture  the  flowers  become  larger  and 
finer. 

The  second  species  has  a  fibrous  perennial  root,  inserting  itself  so 
into  the  crevices  of  walls  and  rocks  as  scarcely  to  be  eradicated:  the 
stalks  are  numerous,  growing  in  a  tuft,  creeping  at  bottom,  branched, 
round,  purplish  and  stringy:  the  leaves  roundish,  shining,  somewhat 
fleshy,  some  opposite,  others  alternate,  frequently  purplish:  lobes 
of  the  lower  ones  blunt,  upper  acute,  the  smallest  only  three-lobed: 
the  petioles  long  and  grooved  above:  the  peduncles  from  the  axils, 
one-flowered,  round,  a  little  longer  than  the  petioles:  the  tube  of 
the  corolla  short:  the  upper  lip  purple,  with  two  deeper  veins;  seg- 
ments of  the  lower  whitish:  the  palate  yellow:  the  mouth  or  entrance 
into  the  lube  villous  and  saffron-coloured:  the  nectary  purple  and 
conical,  the  length  of  the  calyx:  the  germ  purple:  the  capsule 
wrinkled,  opening  at  top  into  several  segments:  the  seeds  are  black, 
roundish  and  wrinkled  like  the  nut  of  the  walnut.  The  whole  plant 
is  smooth,  but  has  a  disagreeable  smell. 

There  is  a  variety  with  a  white  flower. 

The  third  is  an  annual  plant,  which  rises  with  an  upright  branch- 
ing stalk  near  a  foot  and  half  high,  with  oval,  smooth,  gray  leaves, 
placed  often  by  threes,  and  sometimes  by  pairs,  opposite  at  the 
joints;  the  flowers  grow  in  short  spikes  at  the  top  of  the  stalks; 
they  are  shaped  like  those  of  the  common  sort,  but  have  not  such 


84 

long  tubes;  they  are  yellow,  with  saffron-coloured  chaps.  It  flowers 
in  July  and  August,  and  the  seeds  ripen  in  autumn.  It  grows  na- 
turally in  Sicily. 

There  are  varieties  of  this  with  a  purple  standard  and  spur;  and 
with  purple  flowers. 

In  the  fourth  species  the  root  is  perennial:  the  stem  two  feet, 
high,  round  and  smooth:  the  leaves  smooth,  and  marked  with  three 
nerves  underneath,  spreading,  alternate:  the  lower  verticillate:  the 
racemes  are  terminal,  simple,  erect,  long,  with  pedicels  longer  than 
the  flower:  the  calyx  minute:  the  corolla  all  purple,  paler  without, 
with  the  palate  pubescent  at  the  edge;  spur  the  length  of  the  corolla, 
bending  outwards:  the  capsule  subglobular:  the  seeds  three-sided- 
angular,  or  a  little  compressed:  the  angles  acute,  margined,  smooth, 
and  vernacularly  wrinkled  between  them ;  the  colour  of  smoke.  It 
is  a  native  of  Italy. 

The  fifth  has  a  perennial  root,  from  which  arise  many  branching 
stalks  near  two  feet  high,  with  very  narrow  leaves  growing  in  clus- 
ters, and  of  a  grayish  colour.  The  flowers  are  produced  in  loose 
spikes  at  the  end  of  the  branches;  they  are  of  a  pale  blue,  and  have 
a  sweet  smell.  These  appear  in  June;  and  there  is  often  a  succes- 
sion of  flowers  on  the  plants  till  winter:  the  bractes  are  lanceolate, 
one  at  the  base  of  each  peduncle:  the  corolla  pale  blue,  with  darker 
spots;  spur  nearly  as  long  as  the  body  of  the  corolla:  the  calyx  very 
small,  and  the  segments  acute. 

In  the  sixth  species  the  stem  is  a  foot  high,  quite  smooth,  pani- 
cled,  erect,  but  not  very  stiff,  with  wand-like  branches.  Primordial 
leaves,  before  the  stalk  shoots  up,  ternate,  oblong;  the  rest  alternate, 
awl-shaped,  channelled,  smooth,  fleshy,  and  straight;  the  flowers  are 
racemose:  the  calyxes  smooth,  or  rather  somewhat  villose:  the  co- 
rollas yellow:  the  palate  smooth,  with  a  tinge  of  red  in  the  reluse 
elevation  of  it. 

The  seventh  has  several  smooth  stems,  eight  or  nine  inches  long, 
usually  decumbent:  the  leaves  rather  fleshy,  convex  and  glaucous: 
the  calyx  and  bractes  only  pubescent:  the  corolla  very  dark  purple, 


85 

wilh  the  spur  streaked:  it  often  varies  of  an  ash,  yellow,  or  lighter 
purple.  By  Curtis  it  is  said  to  be  of  a  fine  rich  brown  inclining 
to  purple:  the  capsule  is  shaped  like  the  human  skull.  It  is  a  na- 
tive of  Spain,  and  flowers  during  most  of  the  summer  months. 

The  eighth  species  has  an  annual  root:  the  stem  six  or  eight 
inches  high,  erect,  round,  very  smooth,  branching  a  little:  the  leaves 
very  remote,  rather  fleshy  and  smooth:  the  radical  or  lower  ones 
three  or  four  together:  the  flowers  in  a  head  or  corymb,  and  small: 
the  calyx  erect,  not  close,  but  wilh  distant  divisions:  the  corolla  pur- 
ple, with  a  white  palate  marked  with  obscure  veins,  purple:  the 
upper  lip  longest;  spur  straight,  as  long  or  longer  than  the  corolla. 
It  is  a  native  of  France,  &c. 

The  ninth  is  an  annual  plant,  from  whose  root  proceed  many 
stalks,  which  are  lax  and  rushy,  very  slender,  and  about  a  foot  in 
height;  on  the  lower  part  they  have  five  very  narrow,  linear,  obtuse 
leaves  at  each  joint;  but  upwards  they  are  sometimes  by  pairs,  and 
sometimes  single:  the  stalks  are  divided  into  many  small  branches, 
with  little  yellow  flowers  coming  out  singly  at  a  distance  from  each 
other,  which  appear  in  July,  and  ripen  their  seeds  in  August.  It  is 
a  native  of  Sicily. 

There  are  two  varieties  of  this  plant,  one  with  a  deep  yellow- 
coloured  flower,  the  other  with  a  sulphur-coloured  flower. 

In  the  tenth  species  the  root  is  perennial :  the  stems  slender, 
branching  at  bottom,  growing  thicker  towards  the  top,  from  two  to 
seven  inches  long,  ascending,  round  and  smooth :  the  leaves  quite 
entire,  without  veins,  and  thick;  the  lowest  smaller,  and  in  fours: 
the  upper  ones  solitary,  or  two  opposite,  or  sometimes  three:  the 
flowers  in  a  close  raceme  at  the  ends  of  the  stalks;  they  are  very 
elegant,  of  a  fine  violet  purple  colour,  with  a  rich  gold  colour  in  the 
middle,  and  are  in  blow  most  part  of  the  summer.  It  is  a  native  of 
the  Alps. 

The  eleventh  species  rises  with  a  strong  woody  stalk,  three  feet 
high,  having  smooth,  spear-shaped  leaves,  placed  alternately,  and 
sitting  close  to  the  stalk.  The  flowers  are  produced  at  the  end  of 
the  branches  in  short  loose  spikes;  these  are  of  a  deep  yellow  co- 


86 

lour,  much  larger  than  those  of  the  common  sort,  and  stand  upon 
short  foot-stalks.  It  flowers  in  July,  but  the  seeds  rarely  ripen  in 
this  climate,  which  makes  the  plants  scarce.  It  is  a  native  of 
Crete,  &c. 

The  twelfth  is  a  biennal  or  perennial  plant,  which  rises  with  an 
upright,  branching  stalk  from  three  to  four  feet  high,  having  spear- 
shaped,  alternate  leaves,  ending  in  acute  points,  and  of  a  grayish 
colour.  The  flowers  are  produced  at  the  end  of  the  branches,  id 
loose  panicles:  they  are  of  a  bright  yellow  colour.  It  is  a  native  of 
Siberia,  &c.  - 

In  the  thirteenth  the  root  is  biennial :  the  stem  from  a  foot  or 
eighteen  inches  to  two  and  even  three  feet  in  height,  upright,  round, 
solid,  smooth  at  bottom,  but  pubescent  higher  up:  the  leaves  are 
lanceolate  or  ovate,  blunt,  the  lower  mostly  opposite,  the  upper 
inclined  to  be  alternate:  the  flowers  in  a  spike,  pointing  one  way, 
large  and  handsome,  on  a  very  short,  hairy  peduncle,  supported  by  a 
short,  concave,  acuminate  bracte:  the  nectary  obtuse,  scarcely  pro- 
minent: the  capsule  obliquely  opening  at  top,  unequal  at  the  base; 
vulgarly  compared in  shape  to  a  calf's  head:  the  tops  of  the  stalks 
and  the  calyxes  are  usually  viscid.  It  is  a  native  of  the  south  of 
Europe,  and  flowers  in  June  and  July. 

There  are  a  great  many  varieties,  as  with  red,  3'ellow,  purple  and 
white  flowers,  red  with  white  or  yellow  mouths,  white  and  red,  yel- 
low and  red,  yellow  and  white,  purple  and  white,  purple  with  yellow 
mouths,  with  scarlet  dotted  with  gold  colour,  with  double  flowers, 
and  variegated  leaves. 

The  fourteenth  species  is  a  biennial,  or  at  most  a  triennial  plant, 
which  frequently  perishes  soon  after  the  seeds  are  ripened.  The 
stem  is  erect,  two  feet  high,  branching,  terminated  with  a  long  thin 
spike:  the  stern-leaves  small  and  three-parted,  sometimes  live-parted, 
very  different  from  the  broad,  serrate,  radical  ones:  the  bracles  one- 
flowered,  linear,  long,  sometimes  (rifid:  the  flowers  very  small,  on 
short  peduncles,  in  a  very  long  raceme,  containing  frequently  an 
hundred  flowers:  the  segments  of  the  calyx  almost  capillary:  the 
corolla  blue,  nodding,  quinquefid,  two  of  the  divisions  erect,  three 


87 

nodding;  throat  open  without  any  palate;  spur  short,  bent  back : 
the  anthers  reflex,  dark  blue.  It  is  a  native  of  Spain,  &c. 

Culture.— In  most  of  the  plants  of  the  Toad-Flax  kind  the  pro- 
pagation may  be  readily  effected  by  sowing  ihe  seeds  either  in  the 
autumn  or  the  spring,  in  situations  where  they  are  to  remain,  and 
where  the  soil  is  light  and  not  enriched  by  manure.  The  seeds  of 
the  third,  sixth,  and  eleventh  species  are  best  put  into  the  ground  in 
the  spring;  and  those  of  the  fourth,  fifth,  eighth,  and  ninth  in  the  au- 
tumn. The  first  species  may  be  increased  by  the  trailing  stalks 
which  put  out  roots  from  the  joints.  It  will  succeed  in  any  soil  or 
situation.  The  fourth  and  fifth  species  may  likewise  be  propagated 
by  parting  the  roots.  The  seventh  and  tenth  may  be  raised  by  cut- 
tings, which  should  be  planted  out  in  a  shady  situation  in  the  sum- 
mer season,  and  when  they  have  taken  good  root  they  may  be 
removed  into  pots  of  light  earth  of  the  poorer  sort.  The  striped 
varieties  must  also  be  propagated  by  cuttings,  in  the  same  way  as 
the  above. 

The  plants  raised  by  cuttings  should  be  sheltered  during  the  win- 
ter months,  fresh  air  being  admitted  freely  in  mild  weather.  When 
protected  under  a  hot-bed  frame  they  succeed  better  than  in  the  green- 
house, as  in  the  latter  situation  the  plants  are  apt  to  be  drawn  up 
weak. 

The  plants  raised  from  seed  should  be  removed  into  pots  of  light 
sandy  earth,  especially  in  the  eleventh  species,  till  they  have  taken 
fresh  root,  being  then  exposed  in  assemblage  with  other  hardy  exotic 
plants  till  October,  when  they  should  be  placed  in  a  hot-bed  frame 
to  be  protected  from  frost.  Some  may  likewise  be  planted  out  in 
warm  situations  on  rubbish  or  poor  sandy  soils,  where  they  will  fre- 
quently stand  in  mild  winters,  as  in  such  situations  they  resist  cold 
the  best. 

In  the  Snap  dragon  kind  the  propagation  may  be  accomplished 
cither  by  the  seed  or  by  cuttings.  When  the  former  method  is  prac- 
tised, the  seeds  in  the  thirteenth  species  should  be  sown  in  the 
spring,  as  in  April  or  May,  in  the  places  where  they  are  to  remain, 
where  they  will  produce  flowers  in  the  following  spring.  But  in  the 


88 

fourteenth  species  the  seed  should  be  sown  in  the  autumn  on  borders 
or  other  places,  where  they  are  to  remain.  They  must  be  thinned  in 
the  following  spring,  and  they  mostly  flower  in  the  second.  If  the 
former  of  these  sorts  be  designed  to  grow  on  rocky  barren  situations, 
the  seeds  should  be  sown  in  March,  Avhere  they  are  to  remain. 

Where  the  latter  mode  is  employed,  the  cuttings  should  be  made 
in  the  summer,  season,  and  planted  out  in  a  proper  shade  till  they 
have  stricken  root. 

These  are  most  of  them  plants  adapted  to  the  purpose  of  orna- 
ment, either  in  rocky  barren  situations,  or  in  the  borders,  clumps  or 
other  parts  of  gardens  and  pleasure-grounds.  The  first  species  is 
particularly  suited  for  covering  rock  work,  and  the  thirteenth  also 
grows  well  in  such  situations,  and  it,  as  well  as  most  of  the  other 
species,  is  adapted  for  the  purpose  of  affording  variety  in  the  larger 
borders  or  other  compartments.  They  last  the  longest  in  dry  poor 
rocky  situations. 


LanJen  Flitltflif.!  .\iul  1JJ,WS    ty  frKeantlfv  Flftt.tlrttl 


^ 

Me.rmut 


- 

•  *•«»••»• 


PLATE    IX. 

1.  ARGEMONE  MEXICANA 

MEXICAN    ARGEMONE. 


Tins  genus  comprehends  a  planl  of  the  annual  kind :  The  Prickly 
Poppy. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Polyandria  Monogynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  RhaeadecK. 

The  characters  of  which  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  three-leaved, 
roundish  perianth:  the  leaflets  roundish  with  a  point,  concave  and 
caducous:  the  corolla  consists  of  six  roundish  petals,  from  erect 
spreading,  larger  than  the  calyx:  the  stamina  consist  of  numerous 
filiform  filaments,  the  length  of  the  calyx:  the  anthers  are  oblong 
and  erect:  the  pislillum  is  an  ovate,  five-angled  germ:  there  is  no 
style:  the  stigma  thickish,  obtuse,  reflex,  quinquefid  and  permanent: 
the  pericarpium  is  an  ovate,  five-angled,  one-celled,  half-valved  cap- 
sule: the  seeds  numerous  and  very  small:  the  receptacles  linear, 
fastened  to  the  angles  of  the  pericarpium,  but  not  gaping:  the  half- 
valved  capsule  distinguishes  this  from  the  Papaver. 

There  is  only  one  species  cultivated  in  the  garden:  A.  Mexicana. 

It  is  an  annual  plant,  rising  to  the  height  of  two  or  three  feet,  with 
stems  armed  with  prickles:  leaves  sinuate  or  jagged,  soft,  shining, 
stem-clasping,  the  points  of  the  jags  ending  in  sharp  yellow  spines; 
on  the  upper  side  there  are  milky  veins,  as  in  Our  Lady's  Thistle;  on 
the  under,  small  prickles  along  the  midrib  and  veins:  the  flowers  are 
solitary  at  the  ends  of  the  stem  and  branches:  the  corolla  is  yellow, 
with  from  four  to  six  petals:  the  calyx  consists  of  two  or  three  prickly 
leaves;  the  stigma  is  capitate,  small,  with  five  notches:  the  capsule 

I 

N 


90 

superior,  having  five  or  six  ribs  from  tob  to  bottom,  and  between  the 
ribs  armed  Avith  bristle-shaped  spines;  at  the  top  is  the  flatted  stig- 
ma: the  seeds  are  very  numerous,  round,  black,  rough,  with  a  com- 
pressed scar  on  one  side:  the  valves  of  the  capsule  vary  in  number, 
as  Avell  as  the  petals,  from  four  to  six.  It  is  a  native  of  Mexico,  and 
flowers  in  July  and  August. 

Culture. — As  this  is  an  annual  plant,  it  may  be  easily  raised  by 
sowing  the  seeds  thinly  in  spots  of  light  earth  in  the  places  where 
the  plants  are  to  remain.  As  the  plants  shed  their  seeds,  they  mostly 
continue  for  several  years  after  they  have  been  once  introduced. 


2.  AZALIA  NUDIFLORA  COCCINEA. 

SCARLET    AZALIA. 

THIS  genus  contains  plants  of  the  hardy  deciduous  flowering 
shrubby  kinds.  The  Upright  American  Honeysuckle. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Pentandria  Monogynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Bicornes. 

The  characters  of  which  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  five-parted, 
acute,  erect,  small,  coloured,  permanent  perianthium:  the  corolla  is 
monopelalous,  bell-shaped,  semiquinquefid;  the  sides  of  the  divi- 
sions bent  in:  the  stamina  consist  of  five  filiform  filaments,  inserted 
into  the  receptacle  and  free:  the  anthers  are  simple:  the  pistillum 
is  a  roundish  germ :  the  style  filiform,  the  length  of  the  corolla,  and 
permanent:  the  stigma  is  obtuse:  the  pericarpium  is  a  roundish  cap- 
sule, five-celled  and  five-valved:  the  seeds  many  and  roundish. 

The  species  chiefly  cultivated  are:  1.  A.  nudiftora,  Naked-flowered 
Azalia;  2.  A.  viscosa,  Viscid-flowered  Azalia. 

The  first  in  its  native  situation  often  rises  to  the  height  of  fifteen 
feet,  but  here  is  never  more  than  half  that  height.  It  sends  out  seve- 
ral stems  from  the  root.  The  leaves  are  oblong,  smooth,  alternate 


91 

and  pelioled.  The  peduncles  are  axillary,  long  and  naked,  sup- 
porting a  cluster  of  red  flowers,  which  arc  tubulous,  swelling  at 
their  base  like  those  of  the  hyacinth,  and  contracted  at  their  neck ; 
they  are  divided  at  the  top  into  five  equal  segments,  which  spread 
open.  The  five  stamens  and  style  are  much  longer  than  the  petals, 
and  stand  erect.  It  is  a  native  of  Virginia. 

There  are  varieties  of  this  plant  with  scarlet  flowers;  with  pale 
red  flowers;  with  curly  white  flowers;  with  red  and  white  flowers; 
and  with  variegated  flowers. 

The  second  is  a  low  shrub,  rising  with  several  slender  stems  near 
four  feet  high:  the  leaves  come  out  in  clusters  at  the  ends  of  the 
shoots  without  order:  they  are  spear-shaped,  and  narrow  at  their 
base;  their  edges  are  set  with  very  short  teeth,  which  are  rough:  the 
flowers  come  forth  in  clusters  between  the  leaves  at  the  extremities 
of  the  branches;  they  are  white,  with  a  mixture  of  dirty  yellow  on 
the  outside:  the  tube  is  an  inch  long,  and  at  the  top  they  are  pretty 
deeply  cut  into  five  segments;  the  two  upper  are  reflex,  the  two  side 
ones  bent  inward,  and  the  lower  one  is  turned  downward:  the  sta- 
mens are  a  little  longer  than  the  petals,  and  support  oblong  saffron- 
coloured  anthers.  The  style  is  much  longer  than  the  stamens,  and 
is  crowned  by  an  obtuse  stigma.  These  flowers  have  much  the  ap- 
pearance of  those  of  Honey-suckle,  and  are  as  agreeably  scented ; 
more  so  than  the  foregoing  sort.  They  appear  the  middle  of  July,  but 
are  not  succeeded  by  seeds  in  this  climate.  It  is  a  native  of  North 
America. 

This  plant  has  varieties,  with  white  striped  flowers;  with  narrow 
petalled  flowers;  and  with  clustered  flowers. 

Culture. — These  plants  may  be  raised  without  much  difficulty,  in 
rather  moist  soils  where  the  situation  is  shady.  As  they  never  pro- 
duce seeds  in  this  climate,  they  must  be  increased  by  layers  from  the 
young  shoots,  or  by  offsets  from  the  roots.  The  best  season  for 
either  of  these  methods  is  the  early  part  of  the  autumn,  when  they 
should  be  set  out  where  they  are  to  grow,  or  be  planted  in  rows  in 
the  nursery  manner.  It  is  useful  to  protect  the  roots  during  the  win- 


92 

ter,  by  covering  the  ground  about  them  with  old  tan,  or  other  simi- 
lar substances. 

Where  the  seeds  can  be  procured,  plants  may  be  raised  by  sow- 
ing them  either  in  pots  or  on  warm  borders;  in  the  former  method, 
forcing  their  growth  by  plunging  them  in  mild  hot-beds. 

These  shrubby  plants  are  suited  for  affording  variety  in  shrubbe_ 
ries  and  other  places,  both  on  account  of  their  fragrant  smell  and 
the  beauty  of  their  flowers. 


Ptio. 


/,  i  /'/,:•/  .'I'tTftt 

Butomtu   ittti/it//, 
fT&wenna    Rush 


'  /•)•  .\r,/  /•'.,/», II, I.I 
I  >!<///< 


/..'t/./.-n  J'K/'/I///<-,/  .)anll.\Y<> 

t/i/ir< 


1  >/i/tt(  r/fi/       rt/iir<t  //.i 

./•i//  /<<//•«/  Trumpet  flewer 


h'.  n.n.ir,J  t>rt'.  .. 


.    J 


PLATE   X. 

1.    BIGNONIA   RADICANS. 

ASH-LEAVED    TRUMPET    FLOWER. 


THIS  genus  comprehends  several  plants  of  the  shrubby  and  tree 
exotic  kinds.  The  Trumpet  Flower,  or  Scarlet  Jasmine. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Didynamia  Angiospermia,  and 
ranks  in  the  natural  order  of  Personate. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  one-leafed,  erect,  cup- 
form,  five- cleft  perianthium:  the  corolla  monopetalous,  campanu- 
late;  tube  very  small,  the  length  of  the  calyx:  throat  very  long,  ven- 
tricose  beneath,  oblong-cam panulate:  border  five-parted,  the  two 
upper  divisions  reflex,  lower  patulous:  the  stamina  consist  of  four 
subulate  filaments,  shorter  than  the  corolla;  two  longer  than  the 
other  two:  the  anthers  reflex,  oblong,  as  it  were  double:  the  pistil- 
lum  is  an  oblong  germ,  the  style  filiform,  having  the  situation  and 
form  of  the  stamens:  the  stigma  is  capitate:  the  pericarpium  is  a 
two-celled,  two-valved  silique:  partition  membranaceous,  parallel 
and  thickened  at  the  sutures:  the  seeds  are  very  many,  imbricate, 
compressed,  and  membrane- winged  on  both  sides. 

The  species  chiefly  cultivated  for  ornamental  purposes  are:  1.  B. 
catalpa,  Catalpa  and  Tree  Bignonia.  2.  B.  sempervirens,  Evergreen 
Carolina  Eignonia,  or  Yellow  Jasmine.  3.  B.  unguis,  Cut-claw  Big- 
nonia. 4.  B.  radicans,  Rooting  Ash-leaved  Scarlet  Bignonia. 

The  first  is  a  deciduous  tree,  rising  with  an  upright  stem,  covered 
with  a  smooth  brown  bark,  to  the  height  of  thirty  or  forty  feet  in  ils 
native  situation,  but  not  nearly  so  high  in  this  climate:  it  sends  out 
many  strong  lateral  branches,  having  very  large,  heart-shaped,  or 


94 

ovate,  leaves  on  them,  placed  opposite  at  every  joint.  The  flowers 
are  produced  in  large  branching  panicles  towards  the  end  of  the 
branches;  they  are  of  a  dirty  white  colour,  with  a  few  purple  spots* 
and  faint  stripes  of  yellow  on  their  inside:  the  lube  of  the  corolla  is 
much  shorter,  and  the  upper  part  more  spreading  than  in  the  fourth 
sort:  the  segments  also  are  deeper  cut,  and  waved  on  their  edges. 
The  flowers  are  succeeded  by  longer  taper  pods  in  its  native  situa- 
tion; but  these  have  not  as  yet  been  produced  in  this  climate.  It  is 
a  native  of  South  Carolina,  and  flowers  in  August. 

The  second  species  rises  with  slender  stalks,  which  twist  them- 
selves round  the  neighbouring  plants,  and  mount  to  a  considerable 
height:  the  leaves  come  out  single  and  opposite  to  each  other  at 
every  joint:  they  remain  green  through  the  year.  The  flowers  come 
out  from  the  wings  of  the  leaves  at  every  joint,  sometimes  but  two,  at 
other  times  four  at  each  joint;  these  stand  erect,  are  trumpet-shaped, 
yellow,  and  have  a  very  sweet  scent;  and,  in  the  countries  where 
they  grow  naturally,  are  succeeded  by  short  taper  pods  filled  with 
small  winged  seeds.  It  is  a  native  of  South  Carolina. 

The  third  rises  with  slender  stems  which  require  support.  The 
leaves  are  small,  ovate,  entire,  and  placed  opposite  at  every  joint;  at 
the  same  places  come  out  the  tendrils,  by  which  the  plants  fasten 
themselves  to  whatever  grows  near  them :  the  flowers  are  axillary, 
and  .  pe  ';e  those  of  the  Foxglove-  They  are  not  succeeded  by 
pods  in  this  climate.  It  is  a  native  of  the  West-Indies. 

The  fourth  species  has  rough  stems,  which  send  out  many  trailing 
branches,  putting  out  roots  at  their  joints,  and  thereby  fastening 
themselves  to  the  trees  in  their  natural  places  of  growth,  and  climb- 
ing to  a  great  height:  when  it  is  planted  against  walls,  it  strikes  into 
the  mortar  of  the  joints  so  strongly  as  to  support  the  branches,  and 
will  rise  to  the  height  of  forty  or  fifty  feet.  The  leaves  are  opposite 
at  every  joint,  composed  of  four  pairs  of  leaflets,  terminated  by  an 
odd  one;  they  are  serrate,  and  end  in  a  long  sharp  point.  The  flow- 
ers are  produced  at  the  ends  of  the  shoots  of  the  same  year,  in  large 
bunches ;  they  have  long  swelling  tubes,  shaped  somewhat  like  ia 


93 

trumpet,  whence  the  plant  has  the  appellation  of  Trumpet  Flower. 
The  corolla  is  of  an  orange  colour,  and  opens  at  the  beginning  of 
August.  It  is  a  native  of  Carolina. 

There  is  a  variety  of  this  with  small  flowers. 

Several  other  species  of  this  genus  are  equally  deserving  of  cul- 
tivation. 

Culture. — These  plants  are  capable  of  being  raised  either  from 
seeds,  layers,  or  cuttings  of  the  stronger  shoots,  according  to  the 
species. 

In  the  first,  the  best  methods  are  those  of  sowing  the  seeds,  ob- 
tained from  abroad,  in  pots  of  light  fresh  earth,  in  the  early  spring 
season,  plunging  them  immediately  in  a  moderate  hot-bed  of  tan  or 
dung:  when  the  young  plants  appear,  they  should  be  placed  in  warm 
sheltered  exposures  till  the  autumn,  when  they  require  the  protection 
of  frames  and  glasses,  or  of  a  good  green-house,  free  air  being  ad- 
mitted when  the  weather  will  permit.  After  the  plants  have  attained 
sufficient  growth  in  these  situations,  they  may  be  removed  from  the 
pots,  planted  out  in  warm  situations  where  they  are  to  remain,  or  in 
the  nursery,  protection  being  given  them  in  the  winter  season  when 
it  proves  severe. 

Some  however  prefer  raising  plants  of  this  sort  by  setting  the 
cuttings  of  the  young  shoots  in  the  early  spring,  in  pots  of  the  same 
earth,  plunging  them  in  moderate  hot-beds  till  they  \\»~^  sf:  '^en 
full  root,  water  and  shade  being  occasionally  given  th.ai,  gradually 
as  the  summer  advances  enuring  them  to  the  full  air,  in  order  to 
harden  them.  On  the  approach  of  autumn,  they  should  be  taken 
under  shelter  of  some  sort  when  the  weather  is  severe.  In  the  spring 
following  they  may,  if  necessary,  be  planted  out  where  they  are  to 
stand,  or  be  put  in  the  nursery  ground. 

These  plants  succeed  best  in  such  soils  as  are  rich,  and  rather 
inclined  to  moisture. 

All  the  other  species  may  likewise  be  raised  from,  seeds,  by  being 
managed  in  the  same  manner  as  the  preceding  one;  but  a  more  ready 
method  is  by  layers,  made  from  the  young  shoots  in  the  autumn  or 
spring  'seasons;  which  may  be  taken  oft"  and  planted  out,  either 


96 

where  they  are  to  remain,  or  in  the  nursery-ground,  after  they  have 
had  a  twelvemonth's  growth.  They  are  also  capable  of  being  in- 
creased by  cuttings  of  the  more  strong  shoots,  plan  led  out  and  ma- 
naged in  the  same  way  as  in  the  first  sort. 

In  all  the  kinds,  the  plants  raised  from  seeds  are  much  longer  be- 
fore they  produce  flowers,  than  when  they  are  propagated  by  layers 
or  cuttings  of  the  flowering  plants. 

The  chief  culture,  after  the  plants  are  fully  established,  is  that  of 
cutting  out  all  the  small  weak  shoots  of  the  preceding  year,  in  the 
winter  season,  and  shortening  the  stronger  ones  to  the  length  of  about 
two  feet,  in  order  to  induce  flowering  shoots  to  be  sent  out  for  the 
ensuing  summer.  These  plants  are  all  of  long  duration,  when  care- 
fully managed. 

The  first  species,  though  late  in  putting  out  its  leaves  and  flowers, 
is  a  highly  ornamental  shrubby  tree,  that  may  be  introduced  with 
propriety  and  great  effect  in  the  back  but  more  conspicuous  parts 
of  large  borders,  or  the  middle  of  large  clumps  and  other  planted 
parls  of  shrubberies  and  grounds.  When  in  full  foliage  it  has 
a  fine  appearance,  affording  an  agreeable  diversity  in  such 
situations. 

It  is  likewise  well  suited  for  planting  out  singly  on  the  more  spa- 
cious lawns  or  other  open  parts,  where  the  situations  are  not  too 
much  exposed,  as  when  permitted  to  take  its  natural  growth  it  pro- 
duces a  good  effect. 

The  second  species  is  more  tender,  requiring  the  protection  of 
mats  or  other  coverings  in  winter,  in  the  time  of  frosts,  and  the  ap- 
plication of  tan  or  litter  about  the  roots.  It  succeeds  best,  and  has 
the  finest  appearance,  when  planted  against  a  warm  wall,  where  it 
has  room  to  climb  and  spread. 

The  third  and  fourth  species  are  much  more  hardy,  though  they 
should  have  some  protection  when  frosts  occur  in  the  winter.  They 
are  very  ornamjental  when  planted  against  high  walk  or  buildings, 
especially  the  latter,  as  it  will  fix  on  the  crevices,  and  extend  itself 
over  a  vast  surface.  If  trained  up  against  high  trees,  it  also  produces 
a  fine  appearance  when  in  flower. 


97 


2.    BUTOMUS  UMBELLATUS. 

FLOWERING    RUSH. 


THIS  genus  contains  a  plant  of  the  flowery  perennial  aquatic 
kind.     The  Flowering  Rush,  or  Water  Gladiole. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Enneandria  Hexagynia,  and 
ranks  in  the  natural  order  of  Tripetaloidea. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  simple,  three-leaved,  short 
involucre:  the  corolla  consists  of  six  petals,  roundish,  concave,  wi- 
thering; three  outer  alternate,  smaller,  more  acute:  the  stamina  con- 
sist of  nine  subulate  filaments:  the  anthers  are  bilamellate:  the  pistil- 
lum  has  six  germs,  oblong,  acuminate,  ending  in  styles:  the  stigmas 
are  simple:  the  pericarpium  consists  of  six  capsules,  oblong,  gra- 
dually attenuated,  erect,  one-valved,  gaping  on  the  inside:  the  seeds 
are  very  many,  oblong-cylindric,  obtuse  at  both  ends,  fixed  to  the 
wall  of  the  capsules. 

There  is  only  one  species:  B.  umbellatus,  Umbellated  Butomus, 
or  Flowering  Rush. 

It  has  a  thick,  oblong,  fibry,  perennial  root:  the  leaves  are  ensi- 
form,  long,    triangular,   smooth,  quite   entire,    spongy,    at  bottom 
sheathing,  at  top  flat  and  twisted:  the  scape  upright,  round,  smooth, 
from  one  to  three  or  five  and  six  feet  high:  the  flowers  to  thirty,  each 
on  a  single  round  peduncle,  from  an  inch  to  about  a  finger's  length* 
forming  an  upright  umbel,  surrounded  at  bottom  by  an  involucre  of 
three  withering  membranous  sheaths;  besides  a  smaller  stipule  to  each 
peduncle:  corolla  handsome,  near  an  inch  in  breadth;  commonly  of 
a  bright  or  pale  flesh-colour,  purple  or  rose-colour.     It  is  a  native 
of  most  parts  of  Europe,  and  Flowers  in  June  and  July. 

There  are  varieties  with  white  flowers;  with  -jed  flowers;   with 
deep  purple  flowers. 


98 

f 

Culture. — The  propagation  in  this  plant  is  effected  either  by  seed 
or  the  roots.  In  the  first  mode  the  seed  may  be  sown  thick,  in  any 
watery  or  boggy  place,  in  the  autumn,  and  left  to  nature.  In  the 
second  method  the  roots  should  be  removed  any  time  after  flowering, 
and  such  as  admitof.it,  divided,  planting  them  at  once  in  the  places 
allotted  them,  where  they  flower  annually  for  a  great  length  of 
time. 

These  plants  are  very  ornamental  on  the  sides  of  waters,  or  in 
soft  boggy  situations,  in  pleasure  grounds. 


Pill 


f,/  Ir,  ,  W  R,lir,in{r 


't'.t    r-tt  /• 


'.r  (?v  h  K.;,r.,f.-v  77,-sf,  fhtft  £n; 

/'n///>rff>r/ii/f/f         ft  ///  n  ///  Jb/ihtnt     <n/>i  f,//n  »t 

c 


t  //  ft/ 


PLATE  XL 

1.  BUPLEURUM  FRUTICOSUM. 

SHRUBBY  HARE'S-EAR. 


THIS  genus  comprises  plants  of  the  evergreen  shrubby  kind. 
Hare's  Ear,  or  ./Ethiopian  Hartwort. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Pentandria  Digynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Umbellate. 

The  characters  are :  that  the  calyx  is  an  universal  umbel,  with 
fewer  than  ten  rays;  partial  with  scarcely  ten  rays,  erect-expanding: 
involucre  universal  many-leaved;  partial  five-leaved,  larger:  leaflets 
expanding,  ovate,  acute:  the  perianthium  proper  obscure:  the  co- 
rolla is  universal  uniform:  floscules  all  fertile:  proper,  of  five,  in- 
voluted, entire,  very  short  petals:  the  stamina  consist  of  five  simple 
filaments:  the  anthers  roundish:  the  pistillum  is  an  inferior  germ: 
the  styles  two,  reflected,  and  small:  the  stigmas  very  small :  there  is 
no  pericarpium:  fruit  roundish,  compressed,  striated,  splitting  in 
two:  the  seeds  two,  ovate-oblong,  convex  and  striated  on  one  side, 
flat  on  the  other. 

The  species  for  the  purpose  of  ornamental  culture  are:  l.B.fru- 
ticosum,  Shrubby  Hare's  Ear,  or  ^Ethiopian  Hartwort;  2.  JB.  difforme, 
Various-leaved  Hare's  Ear;  3.  B.frutescens,  Grass-leaved  Shrubby 
Hare's  Ear. 

The  first  is  an  evergreen  shrub  rising  to  the  height  of  five  or  six 
feet,  and  dividing  into  many  branches  so  as  to  form  a  large  regular 
bush.  The.  stem  is  covered  with  a  purplish  bark;  the  branches  are 
well  furnished  with  oblong,  smooth,  shining,  stiff  leaves,  of  a  sea- 
green  colour,  placed  alternately,  four  inches  long,  and  one  broad  in 
the  middle;  at  the  ends  of  these  the  flowers  are  produced  in  umbels: 


100 

they  are  yellow  at  first,  but  fade  away  to  a  brown :  they  come  out 
in  July  and  August,  but  seldom  perfect  seeds  in  this  climate.  It  is 
a  native  of  the  South  of  France. 

The  second  species  rises  with  a  shrubby  stalk  to  the  height  of  five 
or  six  feet,  sending  out  some  side  branches,  which  in  the  spring  have 
on  their  lower  parts  leaves  composed  of  many  small  flat  leaflets, 
finely  cut  like  those  of  coriander,  and  of  a  sea-green  colour;  these 
leaves  soon  fall  off,  and  the  upper  part  of  the  branches  is  closely 
covered  with  long  rush-like  leaves  having  four  angles,  coming  out  in 
clusters  from  each  joint.  The  flowers  grow  in  spreading  umbels 
at  the  extremities  of  the  branches;  are  small,  of  an  herbaceous 
colour,  and  succeeded  by  oblong  channelled  seeds.  It  is  a  native  of 
the  Cape,  and  flowers  from  June  to  August. 

The  third  has  a  shrubby  branching  stem  of  moderate  growth:  the 
leaves  are  sharp  and  rather  fleshy  ;  and  the  flowers  in  small  umbels 
at  the  end  of  the  branches.  It  is  a  native  of  Spain,  and  flowers  in 
August  and  September. 

Culture. — These  sorts  of  plants  may  be  propagated  either  by  seeds 
or  cuttings.  In  the  first  method  the  seeds  should  be  sown  in  autumn, 
soon  after  they  are  ripe,  in  pots  of  light  mould,  and  placed  in  a  frame, 
to  have  shelter  from  frost  during  winter,  and  in  spring  plunged  in  a 
hot-bed,  especially  the  two  green-house  kinds,  which  soon  brings  up 
the  plants.  These  should  be  inured  to  the  full  air,  and,  when  of 
proper  growth,  transplanted  into  separate  small  pots,  shade  and 
occasional  waterings  being  given  in  the  summer:  in  autumn  the 
plants  should  be  placed  in  a  green-house  or  frame,  and  in  spring 
following  those  of  the  first  sort  planted  out  in  the  nursery-ground. 

In  the  second  method  the  cuttings  should  be  planted  out  in 
spring,  in  pots  of  light  earth,  plunging  them  in  a  moderate  hot-bed, 
where  they  readily  take  root. 

The  common  shrubby  kind  may  also  be  raised  by  cuttings  in  the 
common  ground,  by  planting  them  in  the  later  summer  months,  and 
sheltering  them  occasionally  from  the  frost  during  the  winter;  or  by 
planting  them  in  pots  at  the  same  time,  and  placing  them  in  a 
garden-frame  for  occasional  shelter  from  frost.  In  either  method 


101 

the  cuttings  emit  roots  in  the  spring;  water  being  freely  given  in 
summer,  and  shelter  again  in  winter.  In  the  spring  following  they 
should  be  planted  out  in  a  sheltered  place  in  the  nursery,  to  attain 
proper  growth  for  the  shrubbery  quarters. 

The  first  affords  an  ornamental  effect  in  the  fronts  of  cliimps  and 
other  parts-  of  shrubberies,  and  the  others  in  assemblage  wilh  other 
potted  plants  of  similar  growth. 


2.  BULBOCODIUM  VERNUM. 

SPRING    BULBOCODIUM. 


THIS  genus  contains  a  plant  of  the  bulbous-rooted  flowering  pe- 
rennial kind.  Mountain  Saffron. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Hexandria  Monogynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Spathacece. 

The  characters  are:  that  there  is  no  calyx:  the  corolla  hexapeta- 
lous,  funnel-form:  claws  very  long,  linear:  throat  connecting  the 
petals:  border  erect:  petals  lanceolate,  concave:  the  stamina  con- 
sist of  six  subulate  filaments,  inserted  into  the  claws  of  the  petals: 
the  anthers  are  incumbent:  the  pistillum  is  an  ovate  subulate  germ, 
obtusely  three-cornered,  and  superior:  the  style  is  filiform,  the  length 
of  the  stamens:  the  stigmas  three,  oblong,  erect  and  channelled:  the 
pericarpiurn  is  a  triangular,  acuminate  capsule,  angles  obscure,  and 
three-celled :  the  seeds  are  numerous. 

There  is  only  one  species  cultivated  for  ornament,  B,  vernitm, 
Spring-flowering  Bulbocodium. 

In  this  the  bulb  or  root  resembles  that  of  common  colchicum  in 
shape,  but  is  much  smaller;  it  is  covered  with  a  dark-brown  skin. 
In  January,  or  before  the  middle  of  the  following  month,  the  flower 
springs  up  inclosed  within  three  brownish-green  leaves,  which  open- 
ing themselves  as  soon  almost  as  they  are  out  of  the  ground,  show 
their  buds  for  flowers  within  them  very  white  oftentimes,  before  ihey 


102 

open  far,  and  sometimes  also  purplisli  at  first  appearing.     There  is 
frequently  only  one  flower,  but  never  more  than  two  flowers  on  a' 
root;  they  never  rise  above  the  leaves,  or  the  leaves  much  higher  than 
them,  whilst  they  last;  they  are  smaller  than  those  of  colchicurn;  at 
first  are  of  a  pale  red  or  deep  blush  colour,  but  afterwards  change  to 
a  blight  purple,  and  continue  long  in  beauty,  if  the  weather  be  not 
severe.     After  the  flowers  are  past,  the  leaves  grow  to  the  length  of 
four  or  five  inches,  and  in  the  middle  of  them  the  seed-vessel  rises  up. 
It  has  the  habit  of  colchicum,  but  differs  in  having  only  one  style: 
from  the  crocus,  which  it  much  resembles,  it  is  also  distinguished  by 
the  number  of  ils  stamens.     It  is  a  native  of  Spain,  &c. 

Culture. — This  may  be  increased  by  off-sets  removed  at  the  time 
when  the  flower  and  leaf  decay,  every  second  or  third  year;  also  by 
sowing  the  seed  in  pots  filled  with  loamy  earth,  in  autumn,  shelter- 
ing them  in  a  frame  from  frost  during  the  winter:  the  plants  appear 
in  spring,  which,  on  the  decay  of  the  leaves,  should  be  taken  up  for 
planting  in  the  borders  in  the  following  autumn,  where  they  flower 
the  year  following. 

When  the  roots  are  not  frequently  taken  up,  they  flower  much 
stronger,  and  produce  a  greater  increase  than  when  treated  in  the 
contrary  manner. 

The  plants  should  have  a  warm  situation,  and  fresh  soil  lhat  has 
not  been  improved  by  manure. 

They  afford  an  agreeable  variety  in  beds,  borders,  and  clumps, 
of  pleasure  and  other  grounds. 


3.    B  L  I  T  U  M    C  A  P  I  TAT  U  M. 

BERRY-HEADED    STRAWBERRY-BLITE. 

THIS  genus  comprises  different  plants  of  the  annual  herbaceous 
ornamental  kind.  The  Elite,  or  Strawberry  Spinach. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Monandria  Digynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Holorace&. 


103 

The  characters  arc:   that  the  calyx  is  a  three-parted,  spreading, 
-permanent  perianlhium,  the  divisions  ovate,  equal,  two  more  gaping 
than  the  other:   there  is  no  corolla:  the  stamina  a  setaceous  filament, 
longer  than  the  calyx,  within  the  middle  division,  and  erect:  the  an- 
ther is  twin:  the  pistillum  is  an  ovate,  acuminate  germ:  the  styles 
.are  two,  erect,  and  gaping,  the  length  of  the  stamen:  the  stigmas  are 
simple:  the  pericarpium  is  a  very  thin  capsule,  (rather  the  crust  of 
the  seed)  ovate,  a  little  compressed,  contained  within  the  calyx  now 
become  a  berry:  the  seed  single,  globular  and  compressed,  the  size 
of  the  capsule. 

The  species  mostly  cultivated  for  ornament  are:  1.  B.  capitatum, 
Berry-headed  Strawberry  Blite;  2.  E,  virgatum,  Slender-branched 
Strawberry  Blite;  3.  B.  Tartaricum,  Tartarian  Strawberry  Blite. 

The  first  is  an  annual  plant,  with  leaves  somewhat  like  those  of 
Spinach.  The  stalk  rises  about  two  feet  and  a  half  high,  when  cul- 
tivated in  gardens.  The  leaves  on  the  lower  part  of  it  are  of  the 
same  shape  with  the  root-leaves,  only  smaller.  The  upper  part  of  it 
has  flowers  coming  out  in  small  heads  at  every  joint,  and  is  termi- 
nated by  a  small  cluster  of  the  same.  After  the  flowers  are  past, 
these  little  heads  swell  to  the  size  of  wood  strawberries,  and  when 
ripe  have  the  same  appearance;  being  very  succulent,  and  full  of  a 
purple  juice,  which  stains  the  hands,  and  was  formerly  used  for  culi- 
nary purposes  as  a  colouring  ingredient. 

There  are  varieties,  with  white  and  red  leaves. 

The  second  species  seldom  grows  more  than  one  foot  high,  with 
smaller  leaves  than  the  first,  but  of  the  same  shape.  The  flowers  are 
produced  from  the  axils,  almost  the  whole  length  of  the  stalk:  they 
are  small,  and  collected  into  little  heads,  shaped  like  those  of  the 
first,  but  smaller,  and  not  so  deeply  coloured.  It  is  a  native  of  the 
South  of  France. 

There  are  varieties,  with  striped  leaves,  and  with  white  flowers. 

The  third  rises  near  three  feet  high:  the  leaves  are  triangular, 

o  O 

ending  in  very  acute  points,  as  also  the  indentures  on  the  edges  of 
the  leaves.  The  flowers  are  axillary  in  small  heads.  The  fruit  is 
of  the  same  shape  aud  colour  as  those  of  the  first,  but  smaller.  This 


104 

differs  from  that  in  the  shape  and  indentures  of  the  leaves;  and  in 
having  leaves  placed  between  the  fruits  the  whole  length  of  the  stalk, 
which  is  not  terminated  by  heads  as  in  the  first,  but  has  leaves  above 
the  heads.  Marty n  supposes  this  is  probably  no  more  than  a  variety 
of  the  second  sort. 

Culture. — These  plants  are  raised  by  sowing  the  seeds  annually, 
in  the  early  spring  months,  in  patches  of  three  or  four  together,  in 
the  borders  or  clumps  where  they  are  to  remain,  the  mould  in  the 
places  being  broken  down  and  rendered  rather  fine  before  they  are 
put  in.  They  may  also  be  sown  on  beds  of  light  earth,  and  when 
they  rise  to  a  sufficient  growth  be  transplanted  to  the  places  where 
they  are  to  grow,  which  should  be  done  before  the  flowering  stems 
rise.  The  first  is  the  best  method.  A  few  may  also  be  raised  in  pots 
for  particular  purposes,  which  must  be  kept  occasionally  watered  in 
dry  seasons,  and  supported  by  sticks. 

When  planted  out  in  the  natural  ground,  they  must  be  kept  clear 
from  weeds,  and  properly  thinned,  and  have  support  when  necessary, 
to  prevent  their  being  pressed  down  by  the  weight  of  the  fruit.  They 
often  rise  freely  from  self-sown  seeds. 

They  are  chiefly  cultivated  for  the  ornament  which  the  fruit 
affords  in  the  latter  end  of  summer,  which  is  as  large  as  that  of  the 
common  strawberry,  and  of  a  red  colour.  They  have  a  good  effect 
when  set  out  in  assemblage  with  other  potted  plants  in  conspicuous 
situations  about  the  house. 


•'/"'•' 


PLATE  XII. 

1.  CALLA    ^ETHIOPICA, 

^ETHIOPIAN    CALLA. 


THIS  genus  contains  a  plant  of  the  herbaceous  flowery  perennial 
green-house  kind.     Ethiopian  Arum. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Gynandria  Polyandria,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Pipcrita. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  one-leafed  spathe,  ovate- 
cordate  acuminate,  coloured  at  top,  very  large  spreading,  permanent: 
the  spadix  finger-shaped,  quite  single,  erect,  covered  with  fructifica- 
tions: there  is  no  corolla:  the  stamina  consist  of  some  filaments 
intermixed  with  the  germs  the  length  of  the  pistils,  permanent,  com- 
pressed, truncate:  the  anthers  are  simple,  truncate,  and  sessile:  the 
pistillum  to  each  is  a  roundish  obtuse  germ:  the  st3'le  simple,  very 
short:  the  stigma  acute:  the  pericarpium  contains  as  many  berries 
as  there  are  pistils,  four-cornered,  globular,  pulpy,  and  one-celled 
(several-celled):  the  seeds  numerous  (six  to  twelve,)  solitary,  oblong, 
cylindric,  and  obtuse  at  both  caids. 

The  species  cultivated  for  ornament  is  C.  JEthiopica,  ./Ethiopian 
Arum,  or  Sweet  Calla. 

It  has  thick,  fleshy,  tuberous  roots,  which  are  covered  with  a 
thin  brown  skin,  and  strike  down  many  strong  fleshy  fibres  into  the 
ground.  The  leaves  arise  in  clusters,  having  foot-stalks  more  than  a 
foot  long,  which  are  green  and  succulent:  the  leaves  are  eight  or  nine 
inches  in  length,  and  of  a  shining  green,  ending  in  a  sharp  point, 
which  turns  backward:  between  the  leaves  comes  out  the  scape, 
which  is  thick,  smooth,  of  the  same  colour  as  the  leaves,  rising  above 
them,  and  terminated  by  a  single  flower  shaped  like  those  of  the 

p 


106' 

arum:  the  hood  or  spathe  is  twisted  at  the  bottom,  but  spreads  open 
at  the  top,  and  is  of  a  pure  white  colour.  In  the  centre  of  this  is 
situated  the  spadix  or  club,  which  is  of  an  herbaceous  yellow  colour, 
upon  which  the  small  herbaceous  flowers  are  closely  placed;  it  is 
only  about  half  the  length  of  the  spathe;  it  is  succeeded  by  roundish 
red  berries.  It  is  a  native  of  the  Cape. 

Culture. — This  plant  is  readily  increased  by  offsets  from  the  root, 
which  should  be  separated  in  the  autumn,  and  planted  out  singly  in 
pots  of  light  earth,  where  they  become  full  plants  the  following  year. 
The  plants  may  be  kept  in  the  full  air  during  the  summer,  but  dur- 
ing the  winter  should  have  the  protection  of  the  green-house  or  a 
garden-frame. 

These  plants,  from  the  singularity  of  their  growth,  and  their  being 
constantly  furnished  with  leaves,  have  an  agreeable  effect,  and  pro- 
duce much  variety  among  other  potted  plants. 


2.  CORONILLA  EMERIS. 

% 

SCORPION    SENNA. 


THIS  genus  comprises  plants  of  the  evergreen  and  deciduous 
shrubby  kinds. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Diadelphia  Decandria,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Papilionacea. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  simple  umbellule:  pe- 
rianth one-leafed,  very  short,  compressed,  bifid,  erect;  the  three 
inferior  teeth  smaller;  the  two  superior  conjoined;  permanent:  the 
corolla  papilionaceous  :  standard  heart-shaped,  reflected  on  all  sides, 
scarce  longer  than  the  wings:  wings  ovate,  converging  at  top,  gaping 
at  bottom,  obtuse:  keel  compressed,  acuminate,  ascending,  usually 
shorter  than  the  wings:  the  stamina  consist  of  diadelphous  filaments 
(single  and  nine-cleft),  ascending  at  almost  a  right  angle,  the  tips 
widish;  anthers  simple,  small:  the  pistillum  is  a  columnar,  oblong 


107 

germ:  style  bristled,  ascending:  stigma  small,  obtuse:  the  peri- 
carpium  is  a  legume,  very  long,  columnar,  straight,  contracted  with 
an  isthmus  between  each  seed ;  two-valved,  one-celled,  parting  by 
joints:  the  seeds  many. 

The  species  are:  1.  C.juncea,  Linear-leaved  Coronilla;  C.  Valen- 
tino, Small  Shrubby  Coronilla;  3.  C.  argente.a,  Silvery-leaved  Coro- 
nilla; 4.  C.glauca,  Great  Shrubby  Coronilla;  5.  C.  Emerits,  Scorpion 
Senna. 

The  first  rises  from  two  to  four  feet  high,  with  many  slender 
woody  branches,  as  in  broom:  the  leaves  are  linear,  spear-shaped, 
small,  and  somewhat  fleshy:  the  flowers  stand  upon  pretty  long 
axillary  peduncles,  in  small  bunches,  are  of  a  bright  yellow  co- 
lour, and  appear  for  six  or  seven  months  together,  but  have  not 
produced  seeds  in  this  climate.  It  is  a  native  of  the  South  of 
France. 

The  second  species  rises  three  or  four  feet  high:  the  leaflets  nine 
or  eleven,  oblong-cordate  or  wedge- form  retuse,  with  a  small  point 
or  none,  glaucous,  somewhat  fleshy,  having  the  colour  of  rue  in  the 
early  spring:  the  flowers  are  on  long  axillary  peduncles  .in  close 
bunches,  small  and  deep  yellow.  It  has  a  strong  odour,  and  is  a 
native  of  Spain. 

The  third  is  a  very  humble  shrub,  rarely  growing  more  than  two 
feet  high,  when  planted  in  a  good  soil;  but  in  a  dry  barren  place, 
not  much  above  one  foot:  the  stem  is  hard  and  woody,  from  which 
the  branches  are  produced  on  every  side  near  the  ground,  so  as  to 
form  a  low  bushy  shrub.  At  the  joints  where  the  leaves  are  produced 
are  two  ear-shaped  stipules.  The  floAvers  are  on  long  slender  axil- 
lary peduncles,  yellow,  and  have  a  strong  sweet  scent:  it  pro- 
duces plenty  of  flowers  in  May,  making  a  fine  appearance;  the 
seeds  ripening  in  August.  Its  silvery  colour  is  said  to  be  occa- 
sioned by  its  growing  on  a  poor  dry  soil.  It  is  a  native  of  the  island 
of  Crete. 

The  fourth  species  seldom  grows  more  than  three  or  four  feet 
high,  with  a  woody  brandling  stem:  the  leaflets  five  or  seven, 


108 

glaucous,  wedge-form,  seldom  obcordate,  with  a  small  reflex  point: 
the  flowers  bright  yellow,  in  a  roundish  bunch:  they  are  remark- 
ably fragrant  during   tire    day.     It   is   a   native   of  the   South   of 
France. 

The  fifth  rises  from  two  to  six  feet  in  height  (eight  or  nine  in  gar- 
dens): the  stem  not  very  straight,  branched  and  brachiatc  (so  weak 
as  sometimes  to  want  support):  ihe  leaflets  three  or  four  pairs,  gra- 
dually larger,  almost  cordale,  glaucous  and  smooth:  the  peduncles 
umbelled,  with  from  three  to  five  yellow  flowers.  Miller  kept  this 
species  under  its  old  name  of  Einems,  dividing  it  into  greater  and 
less;  the  former  being  common  in  gardens,  but  the  latter  in  very  few- 
It  is  a  native  of  France,  flowering  in  April. 

Culture. — As  the  first  four  sorts,  and  especially  the  second,  are 
rather  tender,  though  they  will  succeed  in  the  open  air  in  mild  win- 
ters, they  should  in  common  be  potted,  to  be  moved  to  the  shelter 
of  a  green-house,  or  glass  frame,  or  some  place  in  a  sheltered  situa- 
tion in  the  full  ground.  The  last  sorts  are  hardy  and  elegant  flower, 
ing-shrubs,  for  the  clumps  and  other  parts  of  extensive  pleasure- 
grounds. 

The  four  first  kind&may  be  increased  by  seeds  sown  in  the  spring, 
either  on  a  warm  border,  or  in  a  slender  hot-bed;  but  the  latter  is 
the  best  mode,  as  it  produces  them  more  forward^  in  pots  of  rich 
earth  half  an  inch  in  depth,  plunging  them  in  a  hot-bed  when  ne- 
cessary. When  the  plants  are  two  or  three  inches  in  height,  they 
should  be  pricked  out  in  separate  small  pots,  giving  shade,  water, 
and  air,  hardening  them  gradually  to  the  full  air,  about  the  middle 
of  summer,  in  which  they  may  remain  till  autumn,  then  removing 
them  to  the  shelter  of  a  frame  during  winter,  covering  them  only  in 
time  of  frost,  or  very  severe  weather. 

The  last  sort,  or  Scorpion  Sennar  may  be  raised  plentifully  both 
by  seeds,  layers,  and  cuttings;  the  seeds  being  sown  in  March,  in  a 
bed  of  light  earth,  and  covered  half  an  inch  deep,  giving  occasional 
waterings  in  dry  weather.  When  the  plants  have  had  one  or  two 
years'  growth,  they  should  be  removed  into  nursery  rows,  and  in  two 


109 

or  three  more  they  will  be  large  enough  for  planting  in  the  shrub- 
bery, or  other  places.  The  layers  of  the  young  shoots  may  be  laid 
down  in  autumn  or  winter,  giving  them  a  gentle  twist.  When  they 
are  perfectly  rooted,  they  should  be  taken  off,  and  planted  out  as 
above.  The  cuttings  of  the  young  shoots  should  be  planted  in  the 
spring,  or  autumn,  in  shady  borders,  giving  water  the  following  spring 
and  summer.  When  well  rooted  they  should  be  removed,  as  in  the 
above  methods. 


PLATE  XIII. 

1.  CALYCANTHUS  FLORIDUS 

CAROLINA    ALLSPICE. 


THIS  genus  comprises  a  plant  of  the  aromatic  shrubby  deciduous 
kind. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Icosandria  Polygynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  the  Rosacece. 

The  characters  of  which  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  one-leafed, 
pitcher-shaped,  squarrose  perianthium:  leaflets  coloured,  lanceolate; 
the  superior  ones  gradually  larger,  resembling  petals:  there  is  no 
corolla,  except  the  calycine  folioles,  representing  petals:  the  stamina 
consist  of  numerous  subulate  filaments,  inserted  into  the  neck  of  the 
calyx:  the  anthers  oblong,  furrowed,  growing  to  the  top  of  the  fila- 
ments: the  pislillum  consists  of  a  great  many  germs,  ending  in  subu- 
late compressed  styles  of  the  length  of  the  stamens:  the  stigmas  are 
glandulous:  there  is  no  pericarpium,  the  calyx  being  thickened,  obo- 
vate,  and  berried  :  the  seeds  are  very  many  and  tailed. 

The  only  species  cultivated  is  C.  Jloridus,  Carolina  All-spice. 

It  rises  to  the  height  of  eight  or  ten  feet  where  it  grows  naturally, 
but  seldom  more  than  four  feet  high  in  this  country,  dividing  into 
many  slender  branches  near  the  ground;  covered  with  a  brown  aro- 
matic bark,  with  two  entire  leaves  placed  opposite  at  every  joint  on 
short  foot-stalks:  the  flowers  grow  single  on  short  peduncles  at  the 
extremity  of  the  branches;  they  have  two  series  of  narrow  thick  pe- 
tals, which  spread  open,  and  turn  inward  at  the  top,  like  those  of  the 
starry  anemone  colour;  these  are  of  a  dusky  purple  colour,  and 
have  a  disagreeable  scent.  They  appear  in  May.  The  strong 
aromatic  scent  has  obtained  it  the  title  of  All-spice. 


Rl3 


(t 


t<t  >/<• 


( <i  ri'/i  itfi    Alsptee 


E  r/,/ni  i;;,'  I'r  ?',  O/'/i  '// 

An/>-  /•/ 
lea, 


Ill 

There  are  varieties  with  long  leaves  and  with  round  leaves. 

Culture. — This  is  increased  by  laying  down  the  young  branches, 
or  one-year's  shoots,  which  may  be  taken  off  in  a  twelvemonth,  and 
set  where  they  are  to  remain,  as  they  do  not  bear  transplanting  well 
afterwards.  The  effects  of  drying  winds  should  be  guarded  against 
in  the  summer,  and  frosts  in  winter;  the  former  by  very  moderate 
waterings,  and  the  latter  by  coverings  of  bark.  The  best  season  for 
laying  down  is  the  autumn,  and  for  planting  out,  the  spring. 

This  shrub  is  capable  of  bearing  the  open  air,  but  requires  a  dry 
soil  and  warm  exposure. 

It  is  very  ornamental  in  the  fore  parts  of  clumps  or  borders  in 
shrubbery  and  other  ornamented  grounds. 


2.  COLUTEA  ARBORESCENS. 

- 

COMMON    BLADDER    SENNA. 

THIS  genus  contains  plants  of  the  hardy  deciduous  flowering 
shrubby  kind.  Bladder  Senna. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Diadelphia  Decandria>  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  PapiUonacece. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  one-leafed  perianthium» 
bell-shaped,  five-cleft,  erect,  nearly  equal,  permanent:  the  corolla  is 
papilionaceous;  standard,  wings,  and  keel  differ  in  figure  and  va- 
rious proportion;  wings  pressed  close  together,  lanceolate:  the  sta- 
mina have  diadelphous  filaments,  (single  and  nine-cleft)  ascending: 
anthers  simple:  the  pistillum  is  an  oblong  germ,  compressed,  atte- 
nuated at  each  end:  style  ascending :  stigma  is  a  bearded  line  ex- 
tended from  the  middle  of  the  style  to  its  tip,  from  the  upper  part: 
the  pericarpium  is  a  legume  very  large,  very  broad,  inflated,  transpa- 
rent and  membranaceous,  the  upper  suture  erect,  the  lower  gibbous, 
one-celled,  gaping  on  the  upper  sulure  at  the  base:  seeds  several, 
kidney-shaped. 


112 

The  species  cultivated  arc:  1.  C.  arboresccns,  Common  Bladder 
Senna;  2.  C.  cruenta,  Oriental  Bladder  Senna;  3.  C.  Pocockii,  Po- 
cock's  Bladder  Senna;  4.  C.  frutescem,  Scarlet  Bladder  Senna. 

The  first  has  several  woody  stems,  which  grow  to  the  height  of 
twelve  or  fourteen  feet,  sending  out  many  woody  branches,  with 
winged  leaves,  composed  of  four  or  five  pairs  of  oval  lobes,  placed 
opposite,  terminated  by  an  odd  one;  these  are  indented  at  the  top 
in  form  of  a  heart,  and  are  of  a  grayish  colour.  The  flowers  come 
out  from  the  wings  of  the  leaves  upon  slender  peduncles  about  two 
inches  long,  each  sustaining  two  or  three  yellow  flowers,  whose  stand- 
ard is  reflexed  and  large,  with  a  dark-coloured  mark  on  it.  Native 
of  the  South  of  France,  £c. 

The  second  species  has  a  woody  stem,  which  sends  out  many 
branches  on  every  side,  which  do  not  rise  above  seven  or  eight  feet 
high;  these  are  not  so  strong  as  those  of  the  first  sort,  and  the  leaves 
are  composed  of  five  or  six  pairs  of  small  heart-shaped  leaflets,  ter- 
minated by  an  odd  one.  The  flowers  proceed  from  the  side  of  the 
branches,  standing  upon  peduncles,  each  sustaining  two  or  three 
flowers,  shaped  like  those  of  the  first  sort,  but  smaller;  they  are  of  a 
dark  red  colour,  marked  with  yellow,  appearing  in  June,  the  seeds 
ripening  in  autumn.  It  was  found  in  the  Levant. 

The  third  is  a  shrub  which  seldom  grows  more  than  six  or  seven 
feet  high  in  this  country.  The  branches  are  very  slender,  and  much 
more  pliant  than  those  of  the  common  sort,  and  therefore  it  grows 
less  erect.  The  leaves  are  composed  of  nine  pairs  of  leaflets,  and 
arc  much  smaller.  The  flowers  are  of  a.  brighter  yellow,  appear  a 
.month  earlier  than  in  the  common  sort,  and  there  is  a  succession  of 
them  till  late  in  the  autumn,  which  renders  it  much  more  valuable; 
and  the  branches  not  shooting  so  luxuriantly  nor  so  upright,  it  is  in 
less  danger  of  being  broken  by  strong  winds  in  summer.  It  is  a  na- 
tive of  the  Levant. 

The  fourth  species  is  a  hoary  shrub,  with  tomentose  leaflets, 
smooth  on  the  upper  surface.  It  rises  from  two  to  four  feet  in  height 
in  favourable  seasons,  and  in  a  warm  situation;  plants  of  three  years 
standing  will  sometimes  be  six  feet  high.  The  stem  is  weak,  the 


113 

side  branches  grow  erect,  and  the  leaves  have  ten  or  twelve  pairs  of 
leaflets.  The  flowers  are  sustained  on  axillary  peduncles,  three  or 
four  together,  and  are  of  a  fine  scarlet  colour,  coming  out  in  June- 
It  is  a  native  of  the  Cape. 

Culture. — AH  these  plants  are  capable  of  being  increased  by 
sowing  the  seed  in  the  early  spring  months,  as  in  February  for  the 
three  first  sorts,  and  the  two  following  months  for  the  fourth,  upon 
beds  of  common  earth,  covering  them  in  to  the  depth  of  about  half 
an  inch.  When  the  plants  have  attained  sufficient  growth,  as  in  the 
following  spring  for  the  former  sorts,  and  when  they  are  three  or  four 
inches  high  in  the  latter,  they  should  be  removed,  and  the  first  sorts 
planted  out  in  rows  in  the  nursery,  and  the  last  in  warm  sheltered 
situations  or  in  pots,  to  be  protected  during  the  winter. 

This  sort  may  likewise  be  rendered  much  forwarder,  so  as  to 
flower  the  same  year,  by  having  recourse  to  a  hot-bed. 

The  three  first  species  are  also  capable  of  being  raised  by  layers 
from  the  young  shoots,  made  either  in  the  autumn  or  spring  seasons; 
but  as  the  fourth  sort  does  not  continue  long,  and  is  more  tender  than 
the  others,  new  plants  should  be  raised  from  every  seed  two  or  three 
years. 

They  are  all  beautiful  ornamental  plants,  especially  the  fourth, 
and  may  be  introduced  into  the  clumps,  borders,  and  other  parts  of 
shrubberies  and  pleasure-grounds,  where  they  produce  a  fine  effect 
by  their  foliage  and  flowers.  The  last  sort  should,  however,  have  a 
dry  warm  soil  and  sheltered  sunny  situation. 


3.  CEANOTHUS  AMERICAN  US. 

NEW    JERSEY    TEA-TREE. 

THIS  genus  comprises  plants  of  the   tree  and  shrubby  exotic 
kinds. 

It  belongs  lo  the  class  and  order  Pentandria  Monogynia,  and  ranks 

in  the  natural  order  of  Dumosce. 

Q 


114 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  one-leafed,  turbinate  pe- 
rianthium;  border  five-parted,  acute,  close-converging,  and  perma- 
nent :  the  corolla  has  five  equal  petals,  roundish,  of  an  arched  sac- 
cular  shape,  compressed,  very  obtuse,  spreading,  smaller  than  the 
calyx,  seated  on  claws  the  length  of  the  petal,  growing  from  the  in- 
terstices of  the  calyx :  the  stamina  consist  of  five  subulate,  erect  fila- 
ments, opposite  to  the  petals,  the  length  of  the  corolla:  the  anthers 
are  roundish r.  the  pistillum  is  a  superior,  triangular  germ:  the  style 
cylindric,  semitrifid,  the  length  of  the  stamens:  the  stigma  obtuse 
the  pericarpium  is  a  berry  (capsule),  dry,  three-grained,  three-celled, 
obtuse,  retuse,  and  set  with  tubercles :  the  seeds  solitary  and  ovate. 

The  species  commonly  cultivated  are:  1.  C.  Americanns,  Ameri- 
can Ceanothus,  or  New  Jersey  Tea;  2.  C.  Asiaticus,  Asiatic  Ceono- 
thus;  3.  C.  Africanus,  African  Evergreen  Ceanothus. 

The  first  in  this  climate  is  a  shrub,  which  seldom  rises  more  than 
three  or  four  feet  high,  sending  out  branches  on  every  side  from  the 
ground  upwards:  the  branches  are  very  slender,  and,  as  it  is  pretty 
late  in  the  spring  before  they  begin  to  shoot,  keep  growing  very  late ; 
consequently,  unless  the  autumn  proves  dry  and  mild,  the  tender 
shoots  are  often  killed  down  very  low  by  the  early  frosts;  but  in 
favourable  seasons,  the  extreme  parts  of  the  shoots  only  are  injured 
by  the  cold:  these  branches  are  garnished  with  oval-pointed  leaves, 
placed  opposite,  deciduous,  and  of  a  light  green  colour :  the  flowers 
are  produced  at  the  extremity  of  each  shoot  in  close  thick  spikes, 
and  composed  of  five  small  petals,  of  a  clear  white  colour,  making 
a  fine  appearance,  as  the  whole  shrub  is  covered  over  with  flowers. 

These  appear  in.  July,  and  in  mild  seasons  again  in  October.  It 
is  a  native  of  North  America,  where  the  leaves  are  sometimes  used 
as  tea. 

The  second  species  rises  with  a  shrubby  branching  stem,  four  feet 
high.  The  branches  are  alternate,  flexuose,  striated  and  smooth : 
the  leaves  are  alternate,  resembling  those  of  the  pear,  acuminate, 
smooth,  at  the  ends  of  the  small  branches,  scarcely  an  inch  in  length, 
on  petioles  half  the  length  of  the  leaves :  the  racemes  from  each 
axilla  usually  two,  small,  the  length  of  the  petioles,  consisting  of 


115 

many  florets,  on  very  short  pedicels,  caducous,  one  often  ramaining 
which  bears  fruit :  hence  the  raceme  is  toothletted  from  the  falling 
of  the  flowers,  which  are  of  a  greenish  colour :  the  berries  are  large. 
It  is  a  native  of  Ceylon,  &c. 

The  third  species  rises  to  the  height  of  ten  or  twelve  feet,  with  a 
woody  stem,  covered  with  a  rough  dark-coloured  bark,  and  sends  out 
many  weak  branches,  which  hang  downwards:  these  while  young 
are  green,  but  afterward  change  to  a  purplish  colour:  they  are  gar- 
nished with  oblong  pointed  leaves,  of  a  lucid  green,  smooth,  and 
slightly  serrate  on  their  edges :  the  flowers  are  small,  of  an  herba- 
ceous colour,  coming  out  from  the  side  of  the  branches;  sometimes 
appearing  in  July,  but  not  succeeded  by  seeds  in  this  climate,  nor 
do  the  plants  often  produce  flowers;  being  chiefly  preserved  for  the 
beauty  of  their  shining  evergreen  leaves.  It  is  a  native  of  the  Cape, 
and  sometimes  known  by  the  title  of  Alaternoides. 

Culture. — This,  in  the  first  sort,  may  be  effected  either  by  seeds 
or  layers.  In  the  first  mode  the  seeds  should  be  sown,  as  soon  as 
procured,  in  pots  of  light  earth,  lightly  covered  in,  placing  them  in  a 
frame,  to  have  occasional  shelter  in  bad  weather;  and  in  spring 
plunge  them  in  a  hot-bed  to  bring  up  the  plants,  hardening  them 
gradually  to  the  full  air  in  summer,  but  in  autumn  removing  them 
to  have  shelter  until  the  following  spring,  when  they  should  be 
planted  out  in  separate  small  pots,  or  in  a  nursery-bed  in  the  full 
ground,  being  covered  occasionally  again  in  the  following  winter,  as 
they  require  protection  from  severe  frost  the  two  or  three  first  years 
of  their  growth. 

In  the  latter  method,  some  of  the  youngest  branches  should  be 
laid  down  in  autumn,  in  the  usual  way,  which  become  rooted  in 
twelve  months,  and  in  the  spring  after  should  be  planted  out.  Some 
of  the  first  young  shoots  may  also  be  laid  down  during  the  summer, 
in  order  to  have  the  greater  chance  of  success. 

In  the  second  species  the  propagation  may  be  effected  by  seeds, 
which  should  be  sown  in  pots  of  light  earth,  plunging  them  in  the 
bark-bed,  and  likewise  by  laying  the  young  shoots  down  in  the  au- 


116 

tumn,  plunging  the  pots  as  above:  the  plants  afterwards  should  be 
managed  as  other  woody  exotics  of  the  stove. 

The  third  sort  is  raised  expeditiously  by  laying  down  the  young 
shoots,  either  in  their  own  pots,  or  others  placed  for  the  purpose,  in 
the  autumn.  They  are  also  capable  of  being  increased  by  young 
cuttings,  planted  in  the  spring  in  pots,  plunging  them  in  the  bark, 
or  other  hot-bed  about  two  months.  They  afterwards  require  only 
the  ordinary  culture  of  greenhouse  plants. 

The  first  is  an  elegant  little  flowering  shrub,  for  the  more  conspi- 
cuous compartment  of  the  shrubbery,  being  planted  in  a  moderately 
dry  soil  and  sheltered  situation,  in  the  fronts  of  the  clumps  or 
borders. 

The  second  affords  variety  in  the  stove ;  and  the  third  is  worthy 
of  a  place  in  the  greenhouse  collection,  for  the  beauty  of  its  shining 
green  leaves. 


•'  v/ 


( il  r//inrri/l/,t     iitfiu  NfH/<'H/f.r 

.Vl'/f/t'      /1',/l'ti/  f  itM/l/l  /ll'/ll 


~L,'nJ,-n"fuUiAeJAut  1*MCS,  , 

(  rtplj     /ni  r/iiit<r 


EnqnvrrJ  /•>  /". '.'/ 


I  i'n  i'i  '/i'H/ii.t     /riri'/<  •/• 
,  '  /nil//     />/H<  •  ( r'Ufi'/rtt/tr.r 


•  ",  .    V 
-I   •   •     - 

-•  -    .  • 


PLATE  XIV. 

1.  CAMPANULA  RAPUNCULOIDES. 

NETTLE- LEAVED    CAMPANULA. 


THIS  genus  comprises  various  plants  of  the  annual,  biennial,  and 
perennial  herbaceous  flowery  kind.  The  Bell-flower, 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Pentandria  Monogynia,  and 
ranks  in  the  natural  order  of  Campanacea. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  five-parted  perianthium, 
acute,  erect-expanding,  superior:  the  corolla  is  monopetalous,  bell- 
form,  impervious  at  the  base,  half-five-cleft,  marcescent:  divisions 
broad,  acute,  spreading :  the  nectary  in  the  bottom  of  the  corolla,- 
composed  of  five  valves,  acute,  converging,  covering  the  receptacle: 
the  stamina  consist  of  five  capillary  filaments,  very  short,  inserted  on 
the  tips  of  the  valves  of  the  nectary :  the  anthers  are  longer  than  the 
filaments,  and  compressed:  the  pistillum  is  an  angular  inferior  germ: 
the  style  filiform,  longer  than  the  stamens:  the  stigma  three-partedy 
oblong,  thickish:  divisions  revolute:  the  pericarpium  is  a  roundish 
angular  capsule,  three  or  five-celled,  emitting  the  seeds  at  so  many 
lateral  openings:  the  seeds  are  numerous  and  small:  the  receptacle 
is  columnar  and  adnale. 

The  species  mostly  cultivated  for  the  purposes  of  ornament  and 
use  are:  3.  C.  pcrsicifolia,  Peach-leaved  Bell-flower;  2.  C.  pyramids  - 
fo,  Pyramidal  or  Steeple  Bell-flower;  3.  C.  carpatica,  Carpathian  or 
Heart-leaved  Bell-flower;  4.  C.  latifolia,  Broad-leaved  Campanula, 
or  Giant  Throat-wort ;  5.  C.  trachelium,  Great  Throat-wort,  or  Nettle- 
leaved  Campanula;  6.  C.'grandi flora,  Great-flowered  Bell-flower; 

7.  C.  medium,  Small  Pyramidal  Campanula,  or  Canterbury   Bells; 

8.  C.  speculum,  Venus's  Looking-glass;  9.  C.  Americana,  American 


118 

Bell-flower;  10.  C.  fruticosa,  Shrubby  Cape  Bell-flower;  11.  C.  ra- 
punculusi  Esculent  Rampion. 

There  are  other  species  in  this  extensive  genus  deserving  of  at- 
tention. 

The  first  has  the  root  like  that  of  Navew,  and  eatable:  the  stem 
is  very  straight,  eighteen  inches  high  and  more,  (in  gardens  two  feet 
and  a  half,)  unbranched,  angular,  smooth,  as  is  the  whole  plant:  the 
flowers  are  in  a  thin  spike,  one  or  two  together,  on  very  long  pedun- 
cles, which  have  two  stipules  at  the  base :  the  corolla  is  large,  broad 
bell-form,  deep  blue ;  the  segments  short,  and  moderately  acumi- 
nate. It  is  a  perennial  plant,  native  of  most  parts  of  the  continent 
of  Europe,  flowering  in  June  and  July. 

There  are  varieties  with  single  blue  and  white  flowers,  and  with 
double  blue  and  white  flowers. 

The  second  species,  as  it  appears  in  the  garden,  has  thick  tube- 
rous roots,  which  are  milky;  these  send  out  three  or  four  strong, 
smooth,  upright  stalks,  which  rise  near  four  feet  high,  and  are  gar- 
nished with  smooth  oblong  leaves,  whose  edges  are  a  little  indented: 
the  lower  leaves  are  much  broader  than  those  on  the  stalks:  the 
flowers  are  produced  from  the  side  of  the  stalks,  and  are  regularly 
set  on  for  more  than  half  their  length,  forming  a  sort  of  pyramid; 
these  are  large,  open,  and  shaped  like  a  bell,  and  mostly  of  a  light- 
blue  colour. 

There  are  varieties  with  white  flowers  and  with  double  flowers. 

The  third  affords  a  milky  juice  when  wounded:  the  root  is  whit- 
ish and  perennial ;  the  stems  herbaceous,  annual,  weak,  hardly 
branching,  bearing  one  or  very  few  flowers.  In  gardens  it  becomes 
branching  and  many-flowered.  The  root-leaves  are  kidney-form, 
roundish;  the  peduncle  elongated  and  smooth;  the  corolla  blue. 
It  flowers  the  whole  summer,  and  is  a  native  of  the  Carpathian 
Alps. 

According  to  Mr.  Curtis,  it  is  still  scarce  in  gardens,  but  deserves 
to  be  more  known  and  cultivated :  its  flowers  are  in  proportion  to 
the  plant,  being  large  and  showy. 

The  fourth  species  has  the  stem  three  feet  high  and  more,  angu- 


119 

lar  and  smooth,  but  not  branching :  the  leaves  are  sharply  serrate, 
on  short  petioles,  and  hirsute :  the  flowers  are  axillary,  one  or  two 
together,  on  peduncles  shorter  than  the  leaf:  calyx  smooth,  with 
broad  triangular  segments:  corolla  very  large,  blue;  the  segments 
triangular,  divided  by  a  line :  the  fruit  obliges  the  peduncle  to  bend 
down  with  its  weight.  It  is  a  native  of  the  northern  parts  of  the 
island,  flowering  in  Julyv 

There  are  varieties  with  single  and  double  purple,  and  with  single 
and  double  white  flowers;  with  single  and  double  pale-red  flowers; 
and  with  striped  flowers. 

The  fifth  species  has  a  perennial  root:  the  stems  are  from  two  to 
three  feet  in  height,  upright,  stiff,  hairy,  angular,  the  angles  membra- 
naceous,  putting  out  a  few  short  side-branches:  the  leaves  resem- 
bling those  of  the  great  nettle,  but  rather  shorter  and  broader,  alter- 
nate, ovate,-  cordate,  pointed,  hairy,  deeply  toothed,  sometimes 
having  two  or  three  lobes;  petioled,  except  the  upper  ones,  which 
are  sessile :  the  peduncles  are  alternate,  axillary,  trifid,  and  three- 
flowered.  The  number  of  flowers,  however,  varies  from  one  or  two 
to  three,  four,  and  even  five;  they  are  large  and  nodding.  It  is  a 
native  of  most  parts  of  Europe,  &c.  flowering  in  July  and  August. 

There  are  varieties,  with  single  and  double  blue  flowers,  with 
single  and  double  white  flowers,  and  with  single  and  double  pale 
purple  flowers. 

The  sixth  species  has  the  whole  plant  very  smooth;  the  root  pe- 
rennial, white,  fusiform,  the  thickness  of  a  finger,  and  branched:  the 
stems  are  few,  erect  or  ascending,  simple,  round,  a  foot  high,  leafy 
all  over,  annual,  terminated  with  one  handsome  flower,  but  without 
scent,  nodding  a  little,  with  sometimes  one  or  two  flowers  more 
from  the  upper  axillas:  the  leaves  are  irregularly  scattered,  sessile  or 
on  very  short  petioles,  ovate  or  sublanceolate,  short  and  sharply 
serrate:  sometimes  a  few  of  the  leaves,  and  at  others  all  of  them,  are 
in  threes :  the  corolla  is  two  inches  in  diameter  or  more,  very  deep 
blue,  with  numerous  blue  veins;  elegantly  pear-shaped  before  ex- 
panding, and  at  first  green.  It  flowers  in  June  and  beginning  of- 
July,  and  is  a  native  of  Siberia. 


120 

The  seventh  has  a  biennial  root:  the  leaves  are  oblong,  rough, 
hairy,  serrate,  coming  out  without  order  from  the  root,  narrowing 
into  a  petiole.  From  the  centre  of  these,  the  second  season,  arises  a 
stiff,  hairy,  furrowed  stalk  about  two  feet  high,  sending  out  several 
lateral  branches,  with  long,  narrow,  hairy,  serrate,  sessile  leaves, 
placed  alternately:  from  the  setting  on  of  these  leaves  come  out  the 
peduncles,  those  on  the  lower  part  of  the  stem  and  branches  four  or 
five,  inches  long,  diminishing  gradually  in  length  upwards,  and  thus 
forming  a  sort  of  pyramid.  The  flowers  are  very  large,  and  make  a 
fine  appearance;  they  are  smooth,  and  the  segments  turn  back  at 
the  end;  they  come  out  the  beginning  of  June,  and,  if  the  season  be 
not  very  hot,  continue  a  month  in  beauty.  It  grows  naturally  in 
Germany,  &c. 

There  are  varieties,  with  blue,  purple,  white,  striped,  and  double 
•flowers. 

The  eighth  species  is  an  annual  plant,  which  rises  with  slender 
stalks  a  foot  high:  the  flowers  are  of  a  beautiful  purple,  inclining  to  a 
violet  colour,  (sometimes  pale  purple  or  white,)  and  in  the  evening 
fold  up  into  a  pentagon  figure,  whence  it  is  sometimes  called  Viola 
pentagonia :  the  calyx  is  composed  of  five  narrow  leaves,  which 
spread  open,  turn  back,  and  are  much  longer  than  the  petals;  these 
remain  on  the  top  of  the  prismatic  seed-vessel,  which  is  filled  with 
small  angular  seeds :  the  stem  is  tender,  quadrangular,  naturally 
procumbent,  branched  from  the  bottom  at  very  great  angles:  the 
leaves  sessile,  obovate,  and  waved  about  the  edge:  the  flowers  axil- 
lary, erect,  on  very  long  peduncles:  the  corolla  wheel-shaped,  and 
so  deeply  five-cleft  that  the  segments,  which  are  ovate,  scarcely 
cohere. 

It  is  a  native  of  the  southern  countries  of  Europe,  flowering  from 
May  to  September. 

There  are  varieties,  with  bright  blue  flowers,  with  white  flowers, 
and  with  pale  purple  flowers. 

The  ninth  species  has  an  annual  root;  the  stem  and  germs 
smooth;  the  leaves  acuminate;  the  flowers  three  or  more  from  each 


121 

axil  or  bracte ;  the  corollas  small ;  the  style  longer  than  the  corolla. 
It  is  a  native  of  Pennsylvania,  flowering  in  July. 

There  are  varieties,  with  single  white,  wilh  single  blue,  and  with 
double  blue  flowers. 

The  tenth  is  a  shrubby  ornamental  plant,  a  native  of  the  Cape  of 
Good  Hope,  flowering  here  in  August. 

In  the  eleventh  species  the  whole  plant  is  full  of  a  milky  juice: 
the  root  is  biennial,  spindle-shaped,  sometimes  branching:  the  stem 
upright,   angular,  two  feet  high,   hairy  towards  the   base,  smooth 
above :  branches  alternate,  short,  upright :  the  leaves  towards  the 
base  of  the  stem  hairy  above  or  on  both  sides,  blunt;  the  upper  ones 
smooth,  and  becoming  gradually  more  pointed;  obscurely  notched: 
teeth  glandular,  whitish,  not  projecting  beyond  the  edge  of  the  leaf: 
there  is  an  awl-shaped  bracte  at  the  base  of  each  peduncle:  the  seg- 
ments of  the  calyx  are  awl-shaped,  or  setaceous,  twice  as  long  as  the 
germ,  wilh  a  small  tooth  on  each  side  of  the  base:  the  flowers  are 
upright:    the  corolla  blueish  purple,  sometimes  very  pale   purple 
or  whitish ;    each  segment  marked   with  three  lines :    the  nectary 
fringed.     It  grows  wild  in  France,  £c,,  flowering  in  June,  July,  and 
August. 

The  fleshy  roots  are  eatable,  and  are  much  cultivated  in  France 
for  salads. 

Culture. — The  plants  in  this  extensive  genus  are  mostly  hardy, 
and  increased  with  little  difficulty.     The  six   first  sorts,  and  their 
varieties,  are  all  capable  of  being  raised  by  dividing  the  rools  in  the 
autumn  or  early  spring,  and  planting  them  out  on  the  beds,  borders, 
or  other  parts.     The  former  is,  however,  the  better  season  for  the 
purpose,  as  the  roots  become  better  established  before  they  begin  to 
shoot  up  into  stem.     They  thrive  in  almost  any  soil  or  situation.     As 
the  plants  of  the  steeple  bell-flower,  trained  for  adorning  halls  and 
chimneys,  are  seldom  proper  for  the   purpose  the  following  season 
after  being  planted  out,  a  supply  of  young  plants  should  be  annually- 
raised.     And   though  this  is  mostly  done  by  offsets,  as   being   the 
quickest  mode,  the  plants  raised  from  seed  are  always  stronger;  the 


122 

stalks  rise  higher,  and  produce  a  great  number  of  flowers,  especially 
where  good  seeds  can  be  procured. 

In  the  fifth  sort,  especially  Avith  the  double  variety,  the  parting 
their  roots  should  be  annually  performed  in  the  autumn,  otherwise 
the  plants  are  apt  to  degenerate  to  single,  and  the  soil  should  not  be 
too  light  or  rich  in  which  they  are  planted,  as  in  either  of  these  cases 
they  degenerate.  In  a  strong  fresh  loam  their  flowers  are  in  the 
greatest  perfection. 

The  broad-leaved  sort  is  also  easily  propagated  by  seeds,  which 
it  furnishes  in  great  plenty. 

In  all  these  sorts,  when  not  sown  in  the  places  where  they  are  to 
remain,  the  plants  should  be  transplanted  into  such  situations,  in 
the  beginning  of  the  autumn,  as  by  that  means  they  flower  much 
better. 

The  seventh  and  eighth  kinds  are  increased  by  seeds,  which 
should  be  sown  in  the  spring,  on  beds  of  common  earth,  keeping 
them  clean  from  weeds  till  the  following  autumn;  when  they  may  be 
transplanted  into  the  borders  or  other  parts.  And  as  the  plants  in 
the  first  of  these  soils  perish  the  second  year,  young  ones  should  be 
annually  raised. 

The  latter  of  these  kinds  are  mostly  sown  in  patches  in  the  bor- 
ders or  clumps,  among  other  hardy  annuals,  at  the  above  period ; 
but  if  sown  in  autumn  the  plants  grow  much  taller,  and  flower  much 
earlier. 

The  ninth  sort  is  propagated  by  planting  the  offsets  from  the  roots 
in  the  beginning  of  the  autumn,  in  beds,  or  other  places,  where  they 
are  to  remain.  And  the  tenth  species  may  be  increased  by  planting 
the  cuttings  of  the  shoots  in  pots  of  light  earth,  and  plunging  them 
in  the  hotbed  of  the  stove. 

The  eleventh  kind  is  raised  from  seed,  which  should  be  sown  in 
April  in  a  moist  shady  situation,  the  plants  being  thinned  out  to  five 
or  six  inches  distance.  The  roots  are  ready  for  use  about  the  be- 
ginning of  autumn.  It  requires  to  be  sown  annually. 

All  the  hardy  flowering  sorts  are  highly  ornamental  in  the  borders 
of  pleasure-grounds  and  other  parts,  as  they  continue  long  in  flower. 
And  the  tender  kinds  afford  variety  in  the  greenhouse. 


123 


2.  C  RE  PIS    BAR  BAT  A. 

YELLOW    HAWK  WE  ED. 

THIS  genus  comprises  plants  of  the  herbaceous  ornamental  an- 
nual kind.  Bastard  Hawk-weed. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Syngenesia  Polygamia  JEqualis, 
and  ranks  in  the  natural  order  of  Composite  Semiflosculosce. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  common  double:  exterior, 
very  short,  spreading,  deciduous:  interior  ovate,  simple,  furrowed, 
permanent:  scales  linear,  converging:  the  corolla  is  compound  im- 
bricate, uniform:  corollets  hermaphrodite,  very  many,  equal:  proper 
one-petalled ;  ligulate,  linear,  truncate,  five-toothed  :  the  stamina 
consist  of  five  capillary  filaments,  very  short:  anther  cylindric,  tubu- 
lar: the  pistillum  a  somewhat  ovate  germ:  style  filiform,  length  of 
the  stamens:  stigmas  two,  reflex:  there  is  no  perica'rpium:  calyx 
roundish:  the  seed  solitary,  oblong,  fusiform,  sometimes  columnar: 
down  hairy,  generally  stipitalc:  the  receptacle  naked,  with  cells  or 
pits. 

The  species  cultivated  are:  1.  C.  barbata,  Spanish  bearded  Cre- 
pis,  or  Purple-eyed  Succory  Hawk-weed;  2.  C.  rubra,  Purple 
Crepis. 

The  first  is  an  annual  plant,  putting  out  leaves  next  the  root, 
nine  inches  in  length,  and  almost  two  broad  in  the  middle,  of  a  light 
green  colour:  the  stems  are  a  foot  and  half  high,  dividing  into  many 
branches,  having  leaves  of  the  same  form  with  the  others,  but  smaller 
and  sessile:  the  flowers  are  produced  at  the  ends  of  the  branches, 
and  of  a  yellow  colour,  with  a  purplish  base.  It  flowers  in  June;, 
and  is  a  native  of  the  South  of  Europe. 

There  are  varieties,  with  deep  yellow  flowers,  and  with  sulphur- 
coloured  flowers  inclining  to  white,  each  having  a  dark  purple 
base. 


124 

The  second  species  lias  also  an  annual  root;  the  root-leaves  many, 
lanceolate,  and  deeply  jagged.  From  these  the  stalks  arise,  which 
are  a  foot  and  half  high,  dividing  into  many  slender  branches,  each 
terminated  by  one  large  flower  of  a  red  colour.  It  is  a  native  of 
Italy. 

Culture, — These,  like  other  annuals  of  the  hardy  kind,  must  be 
raised  by  sowing  the  seeds  in  either  the  autumn  or  spring ;  or  at  both 
periods,  where  they  are  required  to  flower  for  a  great  length  of  time, 
in  patches,  in  the  clumps,  borders,  or  other  parts,  where  they  are 
to  remain,  six  or  seven  in  each,  covering  them  in  lightly.  When  the 
plants  have  attained  six  or  seven  inches  in  growth,  they  should  be 
thinned  out  to  three  or  four  in  each  patch,  and  be  kept  free  from 
weeds. 

They  succeed  in  most  soils  and  situations,  having  a  pleasing  effect 
in  their  flowers,  in  the  fronts  and  other  parts  of  the  borders  and 
clumps  of  ornamented  grounds. 


3.  CONVOLVULUS  TRICOLOR 

SMALL    BLUE    CONVOLVULUS. 

Tins  genus  contains  several  plants  of  the  herbaceous  trailing 
annual  and  perennial  kinds. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Pentandria  Monogynia,  and 
ranks  in  the  natural  order  of  Campanacea. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  five-parted  perianthium, 
converging,  ovate,  obtuse,  very  small,  permanent:  the  corolla  is 
one-petalled,  bell-shaped,  spreading,  large,  plailed,  obscurely  five- 
lobed  :  the  stamina  have  five  subulate  filaments,  shorter  by  half  than 
the  corolla:  anthers  ovate,  compressed:  the  pistillum  is  a  roundish 
superior  germ:  style  filiform,  length  of  the  stamens:  stigmas  two, 
oblosg,  broadish:  the  pericarpium  is  a  capsule  enwrapped  by  the 


125 

calyx,  roundish,  two-celled,  one,  two,  or  three-valved  (commonly 
three-celled,  seldom  two  or  four-celled:  partition  alternate  with  the 
valves):  the  seeds  in  pairs,  roundish  (one  or  two  seeds  in  each  cell, 
sometimes  abortive,  few  with  a  twisted  embryo). 

The  species  mostly  cultivated  are:  1.  C.  purpurea,  Purple  Convol- 
vulus, or  Convolvulus  Major;  2.  C.  tricolor,  Three-coloured  Trailing 
Convolvulus,  or  Convolvulus  Minor;  3.  C.nil,  Anil,  Blue  or  Azure 
Convolvulus;  4.  C.  caiwriensis,  Canary  Evergreen  Convolvulus; 
5.  C.  cenontm,  Silver-leaved  Convolvulus;  6.  C.  batatas  Tuberous- 
rooted  Convolvulus,  or  Spanish  Potatoes. 

The  first  is  an  annual  plant,  that  rises  on  support  to  the  height  of 
ten  or  twelve  feet.  In  its  native  situation  it  sends  out  long  branches, 
which  twist  about  the  trees,  and  rise  to  a  great  height.  The  leaves 
are  smooth,  heart-shaped,  ending  in  long  points;  the  ears  at  the  base 
are  large  and  rounded,  and  the  petioles  long  and  slender.  The 
peduncles  are  long,  each  sustaining  three  purple  c  1  ure  i  flowers. 
It  flowers  from  the  end  of  June  till  destroyed  by  the  frost.  It  is  a 
native  of  America. 

It  is  usually  known  in  garden- culture  by  the  name  of  Convolvulus 
Major. 

There  are  varieties,  with  deep  purple  flowers,  with  white  flowers, 
with  red  flowers,  and  with  whitish  blue  flowers. 

The  second  species  is  an  annual  plant,  with  several  thick  herb*, 
ceous  slalks,  about  two  feet  long,  not  twining,  but  bending  towards 
the  ground,  upon  which  many  of  the  lower  branches  lie  prostrate. 
The  leaves  are  likewise  sessile.  The  peduncles  come  out  just  above 
the  leaves  at  the  same  joint,  and  on  the  same  side ;  they  are  about 
two  inches  long,  each  sustaining  one  large  open  bell-shaped  flower? 
of  a  fine  blue  colour,  with  a  white  bottom,  varying  to  pure  white, 
and  sometimes  beautifully  variegated  with  both  colours.  The  white 
flowers  are  succeeded  by  white  seeds;  but  in  the  blue  ones  they  are 
dark-coloured.  It  is  a  native  of  Barbary,  &c.  commonly  known  in 
garden-culture  under  the  title  of  Convolvulus  Minor. 

The  third  is  also  an  annual  plant,  rising  with  a  twining  stalk  eight 
or  ten  feet  high.  The  leaves  are  woolly,  ending  in  sharp  points  and 


126 

on  long  petioles.    Each  peduncle  sustains  two  flowers  of  a  very  deep 
blue  colour,  whence  its  name  of  Anil  or  Nil. 

It  is  a  beautiful  plant;  and  it  flowers  all  the  latter  part  of  the 
summer.  It  is  a  native  of  America. 

The  fourth  species  lias  strong  fibrous  roots.  The  stems  are  woody, 
branched,  growing  twenty  feet  high,  and  more  when  supported. 
The  flowers  are  axillary,  several  on  one  peduncle,  for  the  most  part 
of  a  pale  blue  colour,  but  sometimes  white.  It  flowers  in  June,  July, 
and  August,  and  sometimes  ripens  seeds  here.  It  is  a  native  of  the 
Canary  Islands. 

The  fifth  has  upright,  shrubby  stems,  about  three  feet  high.  The 
leaves  are  lanceolate,  blunt,  silky,  placed  closely  on  every  side  the 
stem;  they  are  near  two  inches  long,  and  a  quarter  of  an  inch  broad. 
The  flowers  are  produced  in  clusters  at  the  lop  of  the  stem,  sitting 
very  close;  they  are  of  a  pale  rose-colour,  and  come  out  in  June  and 
July,  but  do  not  perfect  seeds  in  this  climate. 

The  sixth  species  has  a  round  perennial  stem,  hispid,  prostrate, 
creeping,  putting  forth  scattered,  oblong,  acuminate  tubers,  purple 
or  pale-coloured  on  the  outside.  The  leaves  are  angular,  on  long 
petioles.  The  flowers  are  purple,  lateral,  large,  three  or  thereabouts 
together,  on  upright  peduncles.  It  is  a  native  of  both  Indies,  &c. 

Culture. — All  the  annual  kinds  are  easily  raised,  by  sowing  the 
seed  in  the  early  spring  months  in  patches,  in  the  places  where  they 
arc  to  flower,  four  or  five  seeds  in  each,  half  an  inch  deep.  When 
the  plants  are  an  inch  or  two  high,  they  should  be  thinned  out,  so  as 
to  leave  but  two  or  three  of  the  best  in  each  patch,  managing  them 
afterwards  as  other  plants  of  similar  growth. 

The  perennial  species,  which  are  tender,  are  mostly  increased  by 
laj'ers  from  the  young  shoots  in  the  spring,  which  take  root  freely  in 
three  or  four  months:  cuttings  of  the  young  shoots  also  grow  freely 
in  a  shady  border  when  lanled  during  thesummer  months.  Suck- 
,ers  taken  from  the  root  also  make  good  plants  when  planted  in  the 
same  way.  They  should  be  kept  in  pots  of  rich  earth,  and  ma- 
naged iu  the  same  way  as  geraniums,  myrtles,  and  other  similar 
plants. 


127 

The  Tricolor  or  Minor  Convolvulus  may  either  be  suffered  to 
trail  upon  the  ground,  according  to  its  natural  growth,  or  tied  up  to 
sticks:  but  the  other  annual  species  and  varieties,  being  of  the  twin- 
ing or  running  kind,  should  have  tall  sticks  to  climb  upon,  on  which 
they  will  rise  several  feet  in  height,  flowering  all  the  way,  and  ap- 
pearing highly  ornamental. 

The  perennial  sorts  are  elegant  plants  for  the  greenhouse  collec- 
tio.i,  and  deserve  the  attention  of  those  who  can  preserve  them  dur- 
ing the  winter  season. 

The  la>l  species  may  be  raised  by  planting  the  roots,  either  whole 
or  divided,  in  a  warm  border,  in  the  early  spring  months,  where  they 
will  send  up  stalks,  and  flower  in  the  autumn ;  but  to  have  them  in 
greater  perfection,  they  should  be  planted  in  a  slender  hot-bed,  co- 
vered with  a  frame  ami  glasses  during  bad  weather,  by  which  means 
they  flower  earlier,  and  often  form  many  tubers  at  the  joints.  They 
are  chiefly  planted  for  the  sake  of  variety. 


PLATE   XV. 

1.  CHELONE    OBLIQUA. 

RED-FLOWERED    CHELONE. 

THIS  genus  comprehends  plants  of  the  flowery  herbaceous  pe- 
rennial kind. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Didynantia  Angiospermia,  and 
ranks  in  the  natural  order  of  Personates. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  one-leafed,  five-parted, 
very  short,  permanent  perianlhium:  divisions  erect  and  ovate:  the 
corolla  monopetalous  and  ringent:  tube  cylindric,  very  short:  throat 
inflated,  oblong,  convex  above,  flat  beneath:  border  closed,  small: 
upper  lip  obtuse,  emarginate;  lower  almost  equal  to  the  upper,  very 
slightly  trifid :  the  stamina  consist  of  four  filaments,  hid  beneath  the 
back  of  the  corolla;  the  two  side  ones  a  little  longer:  the  anthers  in- 
cumbent: the  rudiment  of  a  fifth  filament,  like  the  point  of  a  dagger, 
between  the  upper  pair  of  stamens:  the  pislillum  is  an  ovate  germ: 
style  filiform,  situation  and  length  of  the  stamens:  the  stigma  is  ob- 
tuse: the  pericarpium  is  an  ovate  capsule,  two  celled,  longer  than 
the  calyx:  the  seeds  very  many,  roundish,  surrounded  with  a  mem- 
branous rim. 

The  species  cultivated  for  ornament  are:  1.  C.  glabra,  White 
Smooth  Chelone;  2.  C.  obliqna,  Red  Oblique-leaved  Chelone;  3.  C. 
hirsuta,  Hairy  Chelone;  4.  G.  penstemon,  Forking  Chelone. 

The  first  has  a  pretty  thick  jointed  root,  which  creeps  under 
ground  to  a  considerable  distance,  sending  up  smooth  channelled 
stalks,  which  rise  about  two  feet  high,  with  two  leaves  at  each  joint, 
standing  opposite  without  foot-stalks;  these  are  three  inches  and  a 
half  long,  and  about  three  quarters  of  an  inch  broad  at  their  base, 


L'«,  «/,-./  t,  .M  EJoarJs 


ii' 
!\  .-•//  rf< 


Lsn.irn  l',M/li.  -./,)>/,  /'"/.IVTS    /•<:  I  '.  K,:,r.,/<->    f-'/.-ff  .tfnrf 

t  Celcnicum    ?>///!/  >>/ 
"  Autumnal  (  ri'<-//,r 


'EntniYal  A  t\  fia 


' 


mtr 


//f 


129 

where  they  are  broadest,  diminishing  gradually  to  a  sharp  point; 
they  have  small  serratures  on  their  edges,  which  scarcely  appear.  The 
flowers  grow  in  a  close  spike  at  the  end  of  the  stalks;  are  white,  and 
almost  like  those  of  the  Foxglove.  It  is  a  native  of  North  America. 

According  to  some,  it  varies  with  white  flowers,  with  rose-coloured 
flowers,  with  red  flowers,  and  with  purple  flowers. 

In  the  second  species,  the  roots  do  not  creep  so  far  as  those  of 
the  first:  the  stalks  are  stronger,  the  leaves  much  broader,  and 
oblique;  they  are  deeply  sawed  on  their  edges,  and  stand  upon  short 
foot-stalks;  the  corolla  is  of  a  bright  purple  colour,  and  consequently 
makes  a  finer  appearance  than  the  above  sort.  It  is  a  native  of  Vir- 
ginia. 

The  third  species  resembles  the  first;  but  the  stalks  and  leaves 
are  very  hairy,  and  the  flower  is  of  a  purer  white.  It  is  a  native  of 
New  England. 

Some  assert  this  to  vary  with  white  flowers,  with  blue  flowers, 
with  red  flowers,  and  with  purple  flowers. 

The  fourth  has  a  cylindric,  pubescent,  upright  stem,  a  foot  and 
half  high,  putting  out  several  side  branches:  the  leaves  are  oblong- 
lanceolate,  ending  in  a  point:  the  flowers  in  short  loose  spikes  from 
the  divisions  of  the  stalks,  and  of  a  purple  colour.  It  is  a  native  of 
North  America. 

They  all  flower  in  the  autumn,  from  September  to  November. 

Culture. — The  mode  of  propagation  in  the  three  first  species  is 
by  the  roots,  which  multiply  easily,  being  parted  in  autumn,  or  early 
in  spring,  and  planted  where  they  are  to  remain:  but  the  fourth  sort 
must  be  raised  annually  from  seed,  by  sowing  it  in  autumn  as  soon 
as  perfectly  ripened. 

The  plants  rise  the  following  spring,  and  may  be  planted  out  in 
the  borders  during  the  summer  months.  They  are  hardy  plants,  and 
succeed  in  most  soils  and  situations. 

All  these  plants  have  a  very  ornamental  effect  for  some  time  in 
autumn,  after  the  principal  bloom  of  most  others  is  over;  and,  from 
being  of  different  colours,  produce  much  variety  when  planted  in 
the  borders  of  pleasure-grounds. 


130 


2.  COLCHICUM  AUTUMNALE. 

AUTUMNAL    CROCUS. 


THIS  genus  comprehends  plants  of  the  perennial  flowering  bul- 
bous-rooted kind. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Alexandria  Trigynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Spathacete. 

The  characters  are:  that  there  is  no  calyx  (except  scattered 
spathes):  the  corolla  six-parted:  tube  angulated,  rooted;  divisions 
of  the  border  lance-ovate,  concave,  erect:  the  stamina  consist  of  six 
subulate  filaments,  shorter  than  the  corolla:  anthers  oblong,  four- 
valved,  incumbent:  the  pistillum  is  a  buried  germ  within  the  root: 
styles  three,  thread-form,  length  of  the  stamens:  stigmas  reflex,  chan- 
nelled: the  pericarpium  is  a  three-lobed  capsule  connected  inter- 
nally by  a  suture,  obtuse,  three-celled,  sutures  gaping  inwardly :  the 
seeds  many,  nearly  globular,  and  wrinkled. 

The  species  cultivated  are:  1.  C.  autumnale,  Common  Meadow 
Saffron;  2.  C.  montanum,  Mountain  Meadow  Saffron;  3.  C.  variega- 
tum,  Variegated  Meadow  Saffron. 

The  first  has  a  bulbous  root,  about  the  size  and  shape  of  the  tulip, 
but  not  so  sharp-pointed  at  the  top;  the  skin  or  cover  is  also  of  a 
darker  colour:  these  bulbs  are  renewed  every  year;  for  those  Avhich 
produce  the  flowers  decay,  and  new  roots  are  formed  above:  the 
flowers  come  out  in  autumn ;  these  arise  with  long  slender  tubes  from 
the  root,  about  four  inches  high,  shaped  like  those  of  the  saffron,  but 
larger :  the  number  of  flowers  is  generally  in  proportion  to  the  size 
of  the  roots,  from  two  to  seven  or  eight:  in  March  the  green  leaves 
appear,  these  are  commonly  four  to  a  full-grown  root;  they  are  folded 
over  each  other  below,  but  spread  open  above  ground,  standing 
cross-ways:  they  are  of  a  deep  green,  and  when  fully  grown  are  five 


131 

or  six  inches  long,  and  one  and  a  half  broad.  The  seed-vessel  comes 
out  from  between  the  leaves  in  April,  and  the  seeds  ripen  in  May, 
after  which  the  leaves  soon  decay.  It  is  a  native  of  most  parts  of 
Europe. 

There  are  varieties,  with  white  flowers;  with  striped  flowers; 
with  broad  leaves;  with  striped  leaves;  with  many  flowers;  with 
double  purplish  flowers  ;  with  double  white  flowers ;  with  many 
white  flowers.  The  double  sorts  are  chiefly  cultivated  in  the  garden. 

The  second  species  has  a  smaller  root,  with  a  darker  coat:  the 
leaves  come  up  soon  after  the  flowers  decay,  and  continue  green  all 
winter;  long,  narrow,  and  spread  on  the  ground,  decaj'ing  in  June: 
the  flowers  are  of  a  reddish  purple  colour,  and  appear  from  August 
to  September.  It  is  a  native  of  Spain,  &c. 

In  the  third  the  leaves  are  smaller  than  those  of  the  common  sort, 
for  the  most  part  three  in  number,  and  of  a  paler  and  fresher  green 
colour,  lying  close  upon  the  ground,  broad  at  the  bottom,  a  little 
pointed  at  the  end,  waved  about  the  edges:  the  root  is  not  so  large 
as  that  of  the  common  sort:  the  flowers  are  smaller,  but  very  beau- 
tiful, whitish,  with  deep  blue  or  purple  spots.  It  is  rather  tender, 
and  blows  about  October  or  November.  It  is  a  native  of  the  Greek 
islands. 

Culture.  — These  plants  are  increased  by  dividing  the  bunches  of 
their  roots  at  the  time  their  leaves  decay,  in  the  latter  part  of  the  sum- 
mer; as  from  the  latter  end  of  June  till  the  middle  of  the  following 
month,  planting  the  separated  bulbs  or  off-sets  to  the  depth  of  about 
three  inches. 

They  are  sometimes  planted  in  beds,  in  rows  at  eight  or  ten 
inches  asunder;  but  they  may  be  dispersed  in  the  fronts  of  borders 
and  clumps  with  success. 

It  is  of  advantage  to  take  up  and  divide  the  bunches  of  root- 
bulbs  every  two  or  three  years. 

New  varieties  may  be  raised  from  seed  sown  in  boxes,  or  large 
pots,  in  autumn,  covering  it  a  quarter  of  an  inch  deep,  and  placing 
them  in  a  warm  situation  till  spring,  when  the  plants  will  appear, 
which  should  have  only  the  morning  sun  during  summer,  giving  wa- 


132 

ter  in  dry  weather;  and  in  the  second  summer,  when  their  leaves 
decay,  planting  them  out  to  flower,  either  in  beds,  or  other  me- 
thods. 

They  are  of  a  hardy  nature,  and  produce  a  fine  effect,  by  their 
curious  growth,  as  well  as  flowers,  in  the  autumn  and  winter 
seasons. 


3.  CATANANCHE  C^ERULEA. 

BLUE    CATANANCHE. 

THIS  genus  contains  a  plant  of  the  herbaceous  perennial  flowery 
kind.  Candia  Lion's-foot. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Syngenesia  Polygania  JEqualis, 
and  ranks  in  the  natural  order  of  Composite. 

The  characters  are :  that  the  calyx  is  common  imbricate,  turbi- 
nate;  leaflets  very  many,  loosely  incumbent,  acute,  scariose;  the 
squamule  ovate-acuminate,  concave,  lax,  glossy  and  permanent: 
the  corolla  is  compound,  generally  imbricate,  uniform;  corollets  her- 
maphrodite, very  many;  the  exterior  ones  longer. 

Proper  monopetalous,  ligulate,  linear,  truncate,  five-toothed  : 
the  stamina  consist  of  five  capillary  filaments,  very  short:  the  anthers 
are  cylindric,  and  tubular:  the  pistillum  is  an  oblong  germ:  the  style 
filiform,  length  of  the  stamens:  the  stigma  bifid  and  reflex:  there  is 
no  pericarpium:  the  calyx  unchanged  :  the  seeds  solitary,  turbinate- 
ovate:  down  from  a  five-awned  calycle:  the  receptacle  is  chaffy. 

The  species  chiefly  cultivated  is  C.  ccerulea. 

It  is  perennial,  sending  out  many  long,  narrow,  hairy  leaves, 
which  are  jagged  on  their  edges.  Between  the  leaves  the  flower- 
stalks  come  out,  which  are  in  number  proportioned  to  the  size  of  the 
plant;  as  from  an  old  thriving  root  there  are  frequently  eight  or  ten, 
and  young  plants  seldom  send  out  more  than  two  or  three.  These  stalks 
rise  near  two  feet  high,  dividing  into  many  small  branches  upward, 


133 

with  leaves  like  those  below,  but  smaller,  and  have  few  or  no  jags  on 
their  edges;  each  of  the  peduncles  is  terminated  with  single  heads 
of  flowers,  of  a  blue  colour,  having  a  dry,  silvery,  scaly  calyx. 

It  is  a  native  of  the  south  of  Europe,  flowering  from  July  to 
October. 

There  is  a  variety  with  double  flowers. 

Culture. — It  is  increased  by  sowing  the  seeds  in  the  early  spring, 
on  the  borders  where  the  earth  is  light :  the  plants  when  sufficiently 
strong  may,  some  of  them,  be  removed  into  pots;  but  they  flower 
best  when  left  where  sown.  The  double  sort  is  best  increased  by 
slipping  the  roots  and  planting  them  out  either  in  the  early  autumn 
or  spring  seasons;  but  in  this  way  the  roots  should  not  be  divided 
into  too  small  parts,  as  that  prevents  their  sending  up  a  sufficient 
number  of  stalks  for  flowering. 

These  are  very  ornamental  plants  for  the  borders  or  clumps, 
where  sufficiently  dry,  warm,  and  protected,  as  they  continue  several 
years. 

Some  plants  may  likewise  be  preserved  in  pots,  to  set  out  in 
assemblage  with  other  potted  plants. 


PLATE    XVI. 

1.  CONVALLAR1A  MAJALIS. 

LILY    OF    THE    VALLEY. 


THIS  genus  contains  plants  of  the  hardy  herbaceous  perennial 
flowery  kind.  Lily  of  the  Valley,  and  Solomon's  Seal. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Hexandxia  Monogynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Sarmentacece. 

The  characters  are:  that  there  is  no  calyx:  the  corolla  is  mono- 
petalous,  bell-shaped,  smooth  :  border  six-cleft,  obtuse,  open  re- 
flected :  the  stamina  consist  of  six  subulate  filaments,  inserted  into 
the  petal,  shorter  than  the  corolla:  anthers  oblong  erect:  the  pistil- 
lum  is  a  globose  germ  :  style  filiform,  longer  than  the  stamens:  stig- 
ma obtuse,  three-cornered:  the  pericarpium  is  a  globose  berry,  three- 
celled,  before  maturity  spotted:  the  seeds  are  solitary  or  in  pairs, 
and  roundish. 

The  species  cultivated  are:  1.  C.  maialis,  Sweet-scented  Lily  of 
the  Valley ;  2.  C.  polygonatum,  Single-flowered  Solomon's  Seal ; 
3.  G.  multiftora,  Many- flowered  Solomon's  Seal ;  4.  C.  verticillata,  Nar- 
row-leaved Solomon's  Seal;  5.  C.  racemosa,  Cluster-flowered  Solo- 
mon's Seal. 

The  first  has  a  perennial  root,  with  numerous  round  fibres  trans- 
versely wrinkled,  creeping  horizontally  just  below  the  surface  to  a 
considerable  distance.  The  whole  plant  is  smooth.  Four  or  five 
alternate,  oblong,  blunt,  slightly  nerved,  purplish  scales  surround 
and  bind  together  the  base  of  the  leaves  and  stalk.  There  are  two 
leaves,  petioled,  elliptic  or  lanceolate,  pointed  at  each  end,  from  four 
to  five  inches  long,  and  near  an  inch  and  half  broad  in  the  middle, 
quite  entire,  upright,  smooth,  nerved,  one  usually  larger,  of  a 


ftrf 


C  MitniYfit  fry  J1 ,  \,in/i<m 
/*       '     */  •  ^ 

Irrinriif       iini/i'r 

*      /2        i    If         '  M. 

(-r/;*nf   Jji>//sv      w<>r(~ . 


135 

bright  green  colour;  petioles  clasping,  round,  the  outer  dotted  with 
red,  and  tubular,  to  receive  the  inner,  which  is  solid.  Scape  late- 
ral, the  length  of  the  leaves,  upright,  smooth,  semi-cylindrical.  The 
flowers  from  six  to  eight,  in  a  raceme,  nodding,  white,  and  fragrant- 
It  is  a  native  of  Europe;  flowering  in  May.  Hence  it  is  termed 
May,  and  sometimes  Conval  Lily. 

There  are  varieties  with  narrower  leaves,  with  broader  leaves, 
with  double  variegated  flowers;  with  double  reddish  or  red  flowers; 
with  double  white  flowers. 

The  second  species  has  a  twisted  root,  full  of  knot:  on  a  transverse 
section  of  it  characters  appear  that  give  it  the  resemblance  of  a  seal, 
whence  the  name  of  Solomon's  Seal.  The  stem  is  from  a  span  to 
near  a  foot  in  height,  of  a  harder  texture  than  the  third  species :  the 
leaves  are  simple,  inclined,  angular,  twisted,  sometimes  three-edged 
four  inches  long  and  one  broad,  oval-lanceolate,  half  embracing  the 
stem,  glaucous  underneath,  frequently  bending  down  on  one  side- 
The  flowers  sweet-scented,  generally  solitary,  but  sometimes  two,  on 
long  axillary  peduncles,  much  larger  than  in  the  third  sort.  The 
berries  are  black.  It  is  a  native  of  the  North  of  Europe. 

It  varies  with  double  flowers,.  &c. 

The  third  has  a  round  stem,  from  eighteen  inches  to  two  or  three 
feet  high,  erect  and  unbranched:  leaves  usually  bent  upwards,  and 
to  one  side,  underneath  glacous,  five  inches  long  and  two  broad;  the 
lower  ones  oval,  the  upper  oval-lanceolate,  half  embracing  the  stem. 
The  flowers  are  several  together  (from  two  or  three  to  seven  or  eight), 
axillary,  on  branched  compressed  peduncles.  The  berries  round,  of 
a  blackish  blue  colour,  purple  and  red. 

This  is  a  larger  plant  than  the  second  sort.  It  is  a  native  of  the 
North  of  Europe. 

There  are  varieties  with  double  flowers. 

The  fourth  sort  has  a  perennial  root,  toothed:  the  stem  is  simple, 
angular,  striated,  erect,  eighteen  inches  high.  The  leaves  narrower 
than  the  other  sorts,  lanceolate,  entire,  smooth,  three  or  four  in  a 
whorl,  three  or  four  inches  long,  and  from  half  an  inch  to  an  inch  in 
breadth,  bright  green,  and  glaucous  beneath.  The  peduncles  are 


136 

axillary,  solitary,  branched,  pendulous,  and  from  two  to  six-flow- 
ered. The  flowers  of  a  greenish  while  colour.  The  berries  violet  or 
deep  red.  It  flowers  in  June;  and  is  a  native  of  the  North  of  Eu- 
rope, &c. 

The  fifth  species  has  the  stems  two  feet  high,  unbranched,  with 
many  oblong  leaves  embracing  them  at  the  base,  resembling  the 
leaves  of  Plantain.  The  flowers  are  small  and  white,  and  are  pro- 
duced in  single  spikes  at  the  top,  and  are  succeeded  by  small  red 
berries,  about  the  same  size  as  in  the  first  sort.  It  flowers  the  begin- 
ning of  June,  and  is  a  native  of  Virginia,  &c. 

Culture. — In  all  these  sorts  of  plants  their  culture  may  be  effected 
by  parting  their  roots,  either  in  the  autumn  or  spring  months,  but 
the  former  is  the  better  season,  planting  them  out  where  they  are  to 
remain.  They  afterwards  only  require  to  be  kept  free  from  weeds, 
and  removed  every  three  or  four  years,  according  as  their  roots  may 
be  increased. 

As  they  succeed  best  in  rather  shady  situations,  they  are  well 
suited  for  affording  variety  and  ornament  in  shady  places,  such  as 
the  borders  or  the  sides  of  walks  in  woods  and  wilderness  parts  of 
pleasure-grounds,  producing  considerable  variety  by  the  singularity 
of  their  growth  and  the  beauty  of  their  foliage  and  flowers.  They 
also  grow  well  in  many  other  situations  that  are  more  open. 


2.    CERINTHE    MAJOR. 

GREAT    HONEY-WORT. 

THIS  genus  furnishes  plants  of  the  hardy,  ornamental,  flower- 
ing, annual  kind.  The  Moneywort. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Pentandria  Monogynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Asperifolite. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  five-parted  perianthium  ; 
divisions  oblong,  equal,  permanent:  the  corolla  is  monopetalous  and 


137 

bell-form:  tube  short,  thick:  border  tube-Jjellied,  rather  thicker  than 
the  tube :  mouth  five-cleft ;  thr.oat  naked,  pervious :  the  stamina 
consist  of  five,  subulate  filaments,  very  short:  anthers  acute,  erect: 
the  pistillum  is  a  four-parted  germ:  style  filiform,  length  of  the  sta- 
mens: stigma  obtuse:  there  is  no  pericarpium:  calyx  unchanged 
the  seeds  two,  bony,  glossy,  sub-ovate,  outwardly  gibbous,  and  bilo- 
cular. 

The  -species  cultivated  is  C.  major.  Great  Honey  wort. 

It  rises  with  stems  eighteen  inches  high  and  more,  round,  smooth, 
branching,  and  leafy:  the  leaves  are  glaucous,  becoming  blue  by  age, 
smooth,  without  prickles,  but  ciliated  about  the  edge,  and  doited 
with  white:  the  branches  are  leafy  and  nodding;  with  flowers  among 
the  leaves,  hanging  on  long  peduncles:  the  tube  of  the  corolla  is  yel- 
low, but  ihe  border  purple.  It  is  a  native  of  Italy,  flowering  in  June 
and  the  two  following  months. 

There  are  varieties  with  smooth  leaves  and  purple  flowers,  and 
with  prickly  leaves  and  yellow  flowers. 

Culture, — The  plants  are  raised  by  sowing  the  seeds  annually  in 
the  autumn  or  early  spring  months  in  patches  in  the  borders,  clumps* 
or  other  parts.  The  autumn  sowings  should  be  made  as  early  as 
possible.  They  also  rise  from  the  self-sown  seeds.  They  should  be 
managed  as  other  hardy  annuals.  These  are  plants  proper  for  be- 
ing planted  out  about  the  apiary,  or  in  the  small  beds  or  borders. 


PLATE  XVII. 

1.  CHELIDONIUM  GLAUCUM, 

YELLOW-HORNED    POPPY. 


THIS  genus  furnishes  a  plant  of  the  hardy  herbaceous  flowery 
kind. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Polyandria  Monogynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Rhoeadece. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  two-leaved  roundish  pe- 
rianthium:  leaflets  subovate,  concave,  obtuse,  caducous:  the  corolla 
has  four  roundish  flat  petals,  spreading,  large,  narrower  at  the  base: 
the  stamina  consist  of  very  many  filaments  (thirty),  flat,  broader  at 
top,  shorter  than  the  corolla:  the  anthers  are  oblong,  compressed, 
obtuse,  erect,  and  twin:  the  pislillum  is  a  cylindric  germ,  the  length 
of  the  stamens:  there  is  no  style:  the  stigma  headed  and  bifid:  the 
pericarpium  is  a  cylindric  silique,  sub-bivalve:  the  seeds  very  many, 
ovate,  increased,  and  shining:  the  receptacle  linear,  between  the 
valves  of  a  kind  of  circumambient  suture,  not  gaping. 

The  species  worthy  of  cultivation  as  an  ornamental  plant  is 
C.  glaucum,  Sea  Celandine,  or  Yellow-horned  Poppy. 

It  has  a  strong  stem:  the  root-leaves  are  pinnatifid,  waved,  va- 
riously lobed,  and  indenled  ;  pinnas  gradually  larger  upwardsi;  hairy 
on  both  sides:  stem-leaves  embracing,  deeply  indented,  rough  above, 
smooth  beneath:  the  branches  are  dichotomous:  the  flowers  are  of 
a  scarlet  colour,  and  succeeded  by  long  horn-shaped  pods.  The 
root,  according  to  some,  is  annual,  but  others  assert  it  to  be  pe- 
rennial. 

Culture. — These  plants  are  raised  from  seed,  which  should  be 
sown  either  in  the  autumn  or  spring  where  the  plants  are  to  remain; 


(   /.!//'!       /Ill/If  It  (fi't  HI 

<i it  >/t 


139 

or  they  may  be  raised  in  a  seed-bed,  and  be  afterwards  planted  ou 
where  they  are  to  flower.  Some  seed  should  be  sown  annually,  as 
the  plants  seldom  continue  longer  than  two  years.  It  is  hardy,  and 
succeeds  in  almost  any  soil  or  situation. 

The  plants  afford  ornament  and  variety  in  the  borders  both  from 
their  flowery  nature  and  the  peculiarity  of  their  long-horned  pods. 


2.  CISTUS  LADANIFERUS, 

GUM    CISTUS. 


THIS  genus  affords  plants  of  the  shrubby  evergreen  kind.  Rock 
Hose. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Polyandria  Monogynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Rotacece. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  five-leaved  permanent 
perianthium :  leaflets  roundish,  concave;  of  which  two  alternate  ones 
are  lower  and  smaller:  the  corolla  has  five  petals,  roundish,  flat, 
spreading,  very  large :  the  stamina  consist  of  numerous  capillary  fila- 
ments, shorter  than  the  corolla:  anthers  roundish,  small:  the  pistil- 
lum  is  a  roundish  germ:  style  simple,  the  length  of  the  stamens: 
stigma  flat,  orbiculate:  the  pericarpium  is  a  roundish  capsule,  co- 
vered with  the  calyx:  the  seeds  numerous,  roundish,  and  small. 

The  species  are:  1.  C.  populif'olius,  Poplar-leaved  Cistus,  or  Rock 
Rose;  2.  C.  laurifolius,  Bay-leaved  Gum  Cistus;  3.  C.  ladaniferus, 
Spanish  Gum  Cistus;  4.  C.  incanus,  Hoary  Rock  Rose,  or  Rose  Cis- 
tus; 5.  C.  halimifolius,  Sea  Purslain-leaved  Cistus;  6.  C.  Monspe- 
liensis,  Montpelier  Gum  Cistus;  7.  C.  creticus,  Cretan  Ladaniferous 
Cistus;  8.  C.  albidus,  White-leaved  Cistus;  9-  C.  crispus,  Curled 
leaved  Cistus;  10.  C.  salvifolius,  Sage-leaved  Cistus. 

In  this  numerous  genus  there  are  other  species  that  may;  equally 
deserve  cultivation. 


140 

The  first  has  a  stiff,  slender,  woody  stem,  six  or  seven  feet  high, 
sending  out  many  branches  the  whole  length:  these  and  the  leaves 
are  hairy;  the  calyxes  also  very  hairy:  but  the  branches  and  leaves, 
when  further  advanced,  become  naked:  the  leaves  are  large,  of  a 
light  green  colour,  sessile,  with  many  nerves:  the  flowers  are  pro- 
duced at  the  ends  of  the  branches,  on  naked  peduncles:  the  corolla 
is  while,  and  soon  drops  off;  and  the  petals,  according  to  Linnaeus, 
are  tinged  with  purple  on  their  edges;  the  stamens  yellow;  and  the 
calyxes,  before  they  unfold,  three-cornered  in  their  appearance.  It 
is  a  native  of  Portugal,  flowering  in  June  and  July. 

The  second  species  rises  with  a  strong  woody  stem,  to  the  height 
of  five  or  six  feet,  sending  out  many  erect  hairy  branches  :  the  leaves 
are  lanceolate,  acute,  thick,  dark  green  above,  and  white  beneath, 
very  glutinous  in  warm  weather;  but,  according  to  Linnaeus,  wrink- 
led, green  on  both  sides,  and  scarce  visibly  hairy;  the  petioles  be- 
coming purple  at  the  base:  the  flowers  are  produced  at  the  ends  of 
the  branches  upon  long  naked  peduncles,  branching  on  their  sides 
into  smaller  ones,  each  sustaining  one  large  white  flower  with  a  hairy 
calyx.  It  flowers  in  June  and  July,  and  is  a  native  of  Spain. 

The  third  grows  to  the  height  of  five  or  six  feet,  with  a  strong 
woody  stem,  sending  out  many  hairy  branches:  the  leaves  are  smooth 
on  their  upper  side,  but  veined  on  their  under,  on  short  foot-stalks 
which  join  at  their  base,  where  they  form  a  sort  of  sheath  to  the 
branch:  the  corolla  is  white,  the  size  of  the  officinal  Poppy :  the 
germ  has  ten  swellings:  stigma  sessile,  without  any  style.  It  is  a 
native  of  Spain,  &c.  It  flowers  from  June  till  August. 

Mr.  Curtis  objects  to  the  propriety  of  the  name  ladaniferiis,  as  it 
is  not  the  plant  from  which  ladanum  is  produced,  though  in  a  warmer 
climate  it  affords  a  gum  of  a  similar  kind. 

There  are  varieties  with  large  white  flowers,  and  a  purple  spot  in 
the  middle  of  the  petal,  and  with  entire  white  flowers. 

The  fourth  species  has  a  shrubby  stem,  branching  to  a  large 
bushy  head,  three  or  four  feet  high  :  the  branches  villose;  the  leaves 
are  not  at  all  nerved,  ending  in  a  point,  a  little  flexuose  in  the  disk, 
ending  at  the  base  in  coalescent  sheathing  petioles,  or  rather  obovate- 


141 

spatulate;  the  lower  more  connate,  and  in  a  manner  sheathing:  the 
calyxes  hairy,  with  subcordate  leaflets:  the  petals  purple,  emarginate 
or  obcordate,  quite  entire  and  concave.  It  is  a  native  of  Spain. 

The  fifth  species  is  an  upright  shrub,  three  or  four  feet  high:  the 
branches  are  round,  ash-coloured,  angular  at  top,  the  younger  ones 
dotted  with  yellow:  the  leaves  are  petioled,  opposite,  lanceolate, 
very  white,  scarcely  soft,  without  veins,  obtuse,  flat,  about  an  inch 
in  length:  the  peduncle  terminating,  compound,  white;  supporting 
three  or  four  bright  yellow  flowers,  which  appear  in  June  and  July. 
It  is  a  native  of  Portugal. 

There  are  varieties  with  numerous  leaves  and  sulphur-coloured 
flowers,  and  with  yellow  flowers  with  purple  spots  in  their  bases. 

The  sixth  rises  with  a  slender  stem,  from  three  to  four  feet  high, 
sending  out  many  hairy  branches  from  the  bottom  upwards:  the 
leaves  are  very  dark  green,  in  warm  weather  covered  with  a  glutinous 
sweet-scented  substance:  the  peduncles,  which  come  out  at  the  ends 
of  the  branches,  are  long,  naked,  and  sustain  many  white  flowers, 
rising  above  each  other;  their  calyxes  are  bordered,  and  end  in  sharp 
points.  It  flowers  from  June  to  August,  and  is  a  native  of  Nar- 
bonne. 

There  is  a  variety  with  olive-shaped  leaves  and  sulphur-coloured 
flowers. 

The  seventh  species  is  branching,  diffused,  a  foot  and  half  high 
and  more:  the  stem  and  branches  round,  and  somewhat  villose:  the 
leaves  from  broad  stem-clasping,  petioled,  first  spatulate,  then  ovate 
or  lanceolate,  somewhat  acute,  wrinkled,  sometimes  waved,  roughish, 
thickish,  quite  entire,  viscid,  closely  set  on  both  sides  and  round  the 
edge  with  white  hairs  of  different  lengths,  some  simple,  others 
branched  or  headed,  scarcely  visible  to  the  naked  eye:  peduncles 
one-flowered,  terminating  the  last  leafy  twigs,  erect  and  villose:  the 
flowers  of  a  rose-purple  colour:  these  appear  in  June  and  July,  and 
the  seeds  ripen  in  September.  It  is  a  native  of  the  Levant. 

This  is  the  species  from  which  the  drug  called  ladanum  is  pro- 
cured. 

The  eighth  has  a  shrubby  stem,  branching  from  bottom  five  or 


142 

six  feet  in  height:  much  resembling  the  fourth,  but  differing  in  the 
branches  being  tomentose,  not  hairy:  the  leaves  paler,  soft,  horizon- 
tal, sessile,  by  no  means  either  petioled  or  sheathing,  broad-lanceo- 
late, mostly  three-nerved:  the  flowers  long  from  the  branches,  of  a 
bright  purple  colour:  it  is  a  native  of  Narbonne,  &c. 

In  the  ninth,  the  branches  are  weak,  slender,  woody,  spreading 
horizontally:  it  is  seldom  more  than  two  or  three  feet  in  height:  the 
peduncles  and  calyxes  are  covered  with  a  thin  wool:  the  flowers  are 
of  a  purple  or  white  colour,  appearing  in  June  and  the  following 
month.  It  is  a  native  of  Portugal. 

The  tenth  has  a  slender,  smooth  stem,  covered  with  a  brown  bark, 
never  rising  more  than  three  feet  high,  and  sending  out  many  weak 
branches,  spreading  horizontally.  The  leaves  are  obtuse,  without 
veins,  not  so  soft  as  in  many  other  species:  the  peduncles  lateral, 
solitary,  one-flowered,  longer  than  the  leaves:  the  corolla  is  white, 
and  somewhat  smaller  than  that  of  the  other  rock-roses.  It  flowers 
from  June  to  August,  and  is  a  native  of  Italy,  &c. 

Culture. — A\\  these  sorts  are  capable  of  being  either  raised  by 
seeds  or  cuttings  in  common  earth,  or  on  hot-beds;  but  the  seed 
method  produces  the  best  plants.  The  seeds  should  be  sown  in  the 
early  spring,  in  a  warm  border  near  half  an  inch  deep,  and  the  plants 
will  come  up  in  six  weeks;  or,  to  render  them  more  forward,  in  pots, 
and  plunged  in  a  moderate  hot-bed.  When  the  plants  are  of  some 
growth,  they  should  have  the  full  air  in  mild  weather,  and  frequent 
waterings,  as  well  as  occasional  shade  from  the  sun,  while  young; 
and  when  an  inch  or  two  high,  some  may  be  planted  out  separately 
in  small  pots,  others  in  rich  borders,  occasional  shade  and  water  be- 
ing given  during  summer.  In  autumn  the  potted  plants  should  be 
removed  to  a  frame,  to  have  shelter  from  frost.  Those  in  the  full 
ground  should  also  be  shielded  in  frosty  weather  with  mats.  In 
spring,  those  remaining  in  the  seed-bed  should  be  planted  out,  and 
those  in  pots  shifted  into  larger  ones;  to  be  continued  another  win- 
ter, and  in  the  spring  following  be  planted  where  they  are  to  remain. 

In  the  latter  method,  cuttings,  five  or  six  inches  long,  should  be 
planted  in  beds  of  rich  earth,  occasional  shade  and  water  being 


143 

given.  When  well  rooted,  they  should  be  removed  into  separate 
pols:  but  by  being  planted  in  pots  in  spring,  and  plunged  in  a  hot- 
bed, they  are  rendered  much  forwarder.  In  other  respects  they  re- 
quire the  same  management  as  the  seedlings. 

These  are  beautiful  evergreen  shrubs,  effecting  a  fine  variety  at 
all  seasons,  both  from  their  leaves  being  of  different  figures,  sizes,  and 
shades  of  green  and  white,  and  their  being  very  profuse  in  most  ele- 
gant flowers,  which  though  of  short  duration,  there  is  a  daily  suc- 
cession of  new  ones  for  a  month  or  six  weeks  on  the  same  plant;  and 
when  these  different  species  are  employed,  they  exhibit  a  constant 
bloom  for  near  three  months. 

They  are  mostly  hardy  enough  to  prosper  in  the  open  ground  in 
any  dry  soil;  and  if  they  have  a  sheltered  situation  it  will  be  an  ad- 
vantage, as  in  open  exposures  they  are  rather  subject  to  injury  from 
very  severe  frost;  for  which  reason  a  plant  or  two  of  each  sort  should 
be  potted,  to  have  shelter  in  winter  in  the  green-house. 

The  second  and  fifth  are  the  most  tender  sorts. 

In  shrubbery  borders  and  clumps  they  should  be  placed  towards 
the  fronts,  in  assemblage  with  other  choice  shrubs  of  similar  growth. 
All  the  sorts  should  be  suffered  to  assume  their  own  natural  growth; 
the  straggling  branches  being  only  cut  in  with  a  knife. 


PLATE  XVIII. 

1.  CRASSULA    COCCINEA, 

SCARLET-FLOWERED    CRASSULA. 


THIS  genus  contains  plants  of  the  succulent  kind  for  the  green- 
house and  stove.  Lesser  Orpine,  or  Live-Ever. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Pentandria  Pentagynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Succulentcc. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  one-leafed  perianth,  five- 
cleft;  divisions  lanceolate,  channelled-concave,  erect,  acute,  converg- 
ing into  a  tube,  permanent:- the  corolla  has  five  petals,  claws  long, 
linear,  straight,  converging,  connected  at  the  base  with  the  ovate 
bractes  at  the  border,  reflex-expanding:  nectaries  five;  each  with  a 
very  small  emarginate  scale,  annexed  outwardly  to  the  base  of  the 
germ:  the  stamina  consist  of  five  subulate  filaments,  length  of  the 
tube,  inserted  in  the  claws  of  the  corolla:  anthers  simple:  the  pis- 
tillum  has  five  germs,  oblong,  acuminate,  ending  in  subulate  styles 
the  length  of  the  stamens;  stigmas  obtuse:  the  pericarpium  consists 
of  five  capsules,  oblong,  acuminate,  straight,  compressed,  gaping  in- 
wards lengthwise:  the  seeds  many  and  small. 

The  species  are:  1.  C.  coccitiea,  Scarlet-flowered  Crassula ;  2.  C. 
perfoliata,  Perfoliate  Shrubby  Crassula;  3.  C.  cultrata,  Sharp-leaved 
Crassula;  4.  C.  punctata,  Dolled-leaved  C  rassula ;  o.  C.  nudicaulis, 
Naked-stalked  Crassula ;  6.  C.  orbicularis,  Starry  Crassula. 

There  are  several  other  species  that  may  be  cultivated. 

The  first  has  a  reddish  jointed  stem,  about  three  feet  high,  divid- 
ing at  top  inlo  many  irregular  branches:  the  leaves  so  closely  oppo- 
site, as  to  appear  to  be  in  four  rows :  the  flowers  at  the  ends  of  the 


J  fa  ,(V7  /:',/»  ,;/•«/.• 

Crafitila. 

r  h  yfr/f/  //< 


fubhjhfJ  Jiuu  I  .J.Stt>.   by  tlffarvlry  Fleet  Jtrfet  .Enamt 

Cytutu     L</l>nrnu  in 
('ni/.rtt/ti  I  .iilinrnii  111 


145 

branches  in  close  umbels,  of  a  fine  scarlet  colour.     It  flowers  in  July 
and  the  following  month. 

The  second  species  rises  with  an  upright  stem  ten  or  twelve  feet 
high,  if  it  be  not  broken  or  injured,  but  requires  support;  the  stems 
being  slender,  and  the  leaves  very  weighty:  the  latter  are  about  three 
inches  long,  thick,  succulent,  pale  green,  acute,  hollowed  above,  and 
having  a  convex  ridge  beneath:  the  flowers  terminating  in  large  clus- 
ters, of  a  whitish  herbaceous  colour,  with  short  tubes,  and  the  brim, 
cut  into  five  parts.  The  flower-stalk  is  thick  and  succulent,  gene- 
rally turning  first  downwards,  then  upwards  again,  somewhat  in  the 
form  of  a  syphon.  It  flowers  in  July,  but  does  not  produce  seeds  in 
this  climate. 

The  third  has  a  weak  succulent  stalk,  about  two  feet  high,  send- 
ing out  many  irregular  branches:  the  leaves  thick,  plain  above,  con- 
vex beneath,  deep  green,  the  borders  set  with  a  few  silvery  hairs:  the 
stalk  which  supports  the  flowers  rises  from  the  top  of  the  branches, 
and  is  from  four  to  six  inches  long,  putting  out  several  side  branches, 
which  grow  erect;  these  are  terminated  by  large  clusters  of  small 
greenish  flowers,  which  appear  in  June  and  the  following  month,  but 
the  flower  never  fully  expands. 

In  the  fourth  species,  the  stems  are  very  slender,  full  of  joints, 
and  trailing:  the  leaves  thick,  succulent,  heart-shaped,  connate, 
grayish,  in  a  double  row,  hollow  dotted:  the  stems  are  divided,  grow 
about  eight  or  nine  inches  long,  and  are  terminated  by  clusters  of 
small  white  flowers,  sitting  very  close  to  the  top:  these  appear  in 
spring,  and  again  in  the  latter  part  of  summer. 

The  fifth  never  rises  with  a  stalk,  but  the  leaves  come  out  close  to 
(he  ground,  forming  a  sort  of  head;  they  are  smooth,  somewhat 
hairy,  set  with  excavated  dots,  succulent,  taper,  ending  in  points, 
and  frequently  put  out  roots.  Out  of  the  centre  of  these  arises  the. 
flower-stalk,  branching  into  two  or  three  shoots  at  top,  each  termi- 
nated by  clusters  of  greenish  flowers,  which  do  not  open.  It  flowers 
in  May,  and  sometimes  again  towards  the  latter  part  of  summer. 

The  sixth  species  is  a  low  perennial  plant,  having  open  spreading 

heads,  very  like  those  of  some  sorts  of  Houseleek,  growing  on  the 

u 


146 

ends  of  very  slender  trailing  stalks,  produced  in  plenly  on  every  side 
the  parent  plant,  as  on  the  Childing  Marigold.  The  flower-stalks 
arise  from  the  centre  of  these  heads;  are  naked,  about  four  inches 
long,  and  terminated  by  close  clusters  of  herbaceous  flowers:  tire 
leaves  are  radical,  forming  roses,  ovate,  fleshy,  gibbous,  even,  sharp- 
ish, ciliate  backwards,  with  cartilaginous;  very  slender  hairs:  the  root 
puts  forth  lateral  threads,  which  are  filiform  and  decumbent,  forming 
runners  at  the  end.  It  flowers  sometimes  in  May,  but  usually  in 
July  and  August. 

Culture.  —  The  first  three  sorts  may  be  easily  increased,  by  plant- 
ing the  cuttings  of  the  stems  and  branches  in  the  later  spring  and 
summer  months,  after  having  been  exposed  in  a  dry  situation  for  a 
few  days,  to  heal  over  the  cut  parts,  in  pots  filled  with  sandy  earth, 
plunging  them  in  the  bark-bed  of-  the  stove,  or  in  a  frame  shaded 
from  the  sun.  When  well  rooted,  they  should  he  removed  into  sepa- 
rate pots,  and  replaced  in  the  same  situations  till  fully  established, 
when  they  may  be  removed  into  the  greenhouse,  where  they  should 
have  a  sunny  situation  in  winter,  and  but  little  water. 

The  other  species  may  be  increased  by  planting  the  off-sets  from 
the  roots  in  the  same  manner  as  above. 

As  these  are  plants  of  a  succulent  nature,  both  in  their  stems, 
branches,  and  leaves,  as  well  as  of  curious  growth,  they  afford  variety 
among  collections  of  other  plants'  of  similar  kinds.   They  are  capable 
of  bearing  the  open  air  in  summer,  in  dry  warm  situations. 
'   . 

2.  CYTISUS  LABURNUM. 

LABURNUM. 


Tins  genus  contains  plants  of  the  hardy  evergreen  and  deciduous 
flowering  shrubby  kinds. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Diadelphia  Dicandria,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order 


147 

•  •* 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  one-leafed  perianthium, 
bell-form,  short,  obtuse  at  the  base:  mouth  two-lipped;  upper-lip 
two-cleft,  acuminate;  lower  three- toothed:  the  corolla  is  papiliona- 
ceous: standard  ovate,  rising  upwards,  sides  reflex:  wings  the  length 
of  the  standard,  straight,  obtuse:  the  keel  somewhat  bellied,  acumi- 
nate: the  stamina  consist  of  diadelphous  filaments,  (single  and  nine- 
cleft)  rising  upwards:  anthers  simple:  the  pistillum  is  an  oblong 
germ:  style  simple,  rising  upwards:  stigma  obtuse:  the  pericarpium 
is  an  oblong  legume,  obtuse,  attenuated  at  the  base,  stiff:  the  seeds 
few,  kidney-form,  compressed. 

The  species  are:  1.  C.  Laburnum,  Laburnum;  2.  C.  sessilifbliumt 
Common  Cytisus;  3.  C.hirsutus,  Hairy  or  Evergreen  Cytisus. 

The  first  has  a  large  upright  tree-stem,  branching  into  a  full- 
spreading  head,  from  ten  to  twenty  feet  high,  having  smooth  greenish 
branches,  trifoliate,  oblong-oval  entire  leaves,  on  long  slender  foot- 
stalks; and  from  the  sides  of  all  the  branches  numerous  yellow  flowers 
collected  in  long. spikes,  hanging  loosely  downward;  appearing  in 
May.  It  is  a  native  of  Switzerland. 

The  varieties  are:  theCommon  broad-leaved;  the  Narrow-leaved; 
Long-spiked,  having  very  long  pendulous  spikes  of  flowers;  the 
Short-spiked,  having  short,  roundish,  thick  spikes  of  flowers;  and  the 
Variegated-leaved  Laburnum. 

The  second  species  rises  with  a  woody  stalk,  putting  out  many 
branches,  covered  with  a  brownish  bark:  the  leaflets  are  obovate, 
ternale,  on  very  short  petioles:  the  flowers  in  close  short  terminating 
racemes,  of  a  bright  yellow  colour:  it  rises  to  the  height  of  seven  or 
eight  feet,  and  becomes  very  bushy.  It  is  a  native  of  the  South  of 
Europe. 

The  third  has  a  soft  shrubby  stalk,  dividing  into  many  branches, 
which  grow  erect,  and  frequently  rise  to  the  height  of  eight  or  ten 
feet:  the  stalks,  branches,  and  leaves  are  very  hairy;  the  leaves  are 
ternate,  ovate,  and  placed  closely  on  the  branches :  the  flowers 
come  out  from  the  side  of  the  slalk  in  short  racemes,  and  are  of  a 
pale  yellow,  appearing  in  June.  It  is  a  native  of  the  South  of 
Europe. 


148 

Culture. — These  plants  arc  all  capable  of  being  increased  by  seeds, 
and  many  of  them  by  cuttings  and  layers. 

In  the  first  mode  the  seed  should  be  sown,  either  on  beds  or  where 
the  plants  are  to  remain,  in  the  spring,  as  about  March,  being  in  the 
first  mode,  when  of  sufficient  growth,  transplanted  into  nursery  rows, 
to  remain  till  of  a  proper  size  for  being  planted  in  the  situations 
•where  they  are  to  grow.  When  sown  where  they  are  to  remain,  they 
only  require  to  be  kept  perfectly  free  from  weeds,  and  trimmed  to 
one  good  plant  in  a  place,  giving  the  lender  sorts  the  protection  of 
mats  during  the  severity  of  the  winter  season. 

The  trees  of  most  of  the  sorts  afford  seeds  in  abundance  in  the 
autumn. 

The  cuttings  should  be  made  from  the  young  shoots  ten  or  twelve 
inches  in  length,  and  planted  out  in  a  rather  moist,  shaded  situation, 
either  in  the  early  autumn  or  spring  months,  in  rows  twelve  or  eigh- 
teen inches  apart,  and  eight  or  ten  in  the  rows.  They  mostly  become 
well  rooted  in  the  course  of  twelve  months;  and  should  then  be  kept 
perfectly  clear  of  weeds. 

Layers  may  be  laid  down  either  in  the  summer,  autumn,  or  spring- 
seasons;  and  when  the  plants  are  well  rooted  they  should  be  taken 
off  and  planted  out  in  nursery-rows,  as  described  above. 

Jn  the  nursery  they  only  require  to  be  preserved  from  the  injury 
of  weeds,  and  to  have  the  land  dug  well  between  the  rows  annually 
in  the  autumn,  till  they  are  removed;  being  suffered  to  take  their 
natural  growth  in  a  great  measure. 

Most  of  the  sorts  are  hardy,  and  succeed  well  in  almost  any  soil 
or  situation.  The  third  sort  should  have  a  dry  soil  and  .sheltered 
situation,  as  it  is  liable  to  be  injured  by  frost.  It  may  also  be  planted 
i«  pots,  and  placed  in  the  green-house  during  the  winter. 

They  are  all  very  ornamental  plants  for  the  borders,  clumps,  and 
other  parts  of  ornamented  grounds,  affording  much  variety  by  their 
numerous  beau'iful  bunches  of  flowers.  The  large  sorts  should  be 
placed  towards  the  back  parts,  and  those  of  less  growth  towards  the 
fronts  and  more  conspicuous  parts. 


///v 


Piiintctt  bvL£ytiJ5i{-*anis  ,         TtOHilrn 

.  Cyd&nun    i><->;rt< 


l.tSC6  !>Y   I 'JC,:l  >:•/.; Y  -/?''•/  , 

2 


tfprina 


PLATE   XIX. 

1.    CYCLAMEN  PEHSICUM, 

PERSIAN    CYCLAMEN. 


THIS  genus  contains  plants  of  the  low,  herbaceous,  flowery,  pe- 
rennial tuberous  rooted  kind.     Snow-Bread. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Pentandria  Monogyuia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Precia;. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  half-five-cleft  perianthium, 
roundish,  permanent:  divisions  ovate:  the  corolla  one-petalled :  tube 
somewhat  globose,  twice  as  large  as  the  calyx,  small,  nodding :  bor- 
der bent  upwards,  five-parted,  very  large:  divisions  lanceolate:  neck 
prominent:  the  stamina  consist  of  five  very  small  filaments  in  the 
tube  of  the  corolla:  anthers  straight,  sharp,  in  the  neck  of  the  co- 
rolla, converging:  the  pistillum  is  a  roundish  germ:  style  filiform, 
straight,  longer  than  the  stamens:  stigma  sharp:  the  pericarpium  is 
a  globose  berry,  one-celled,  gaping  five  ways  at  the  top,  covered  wilh 
a  capsular  shell :  the  seeds  very  many,  somewhat  ovate,  cornered  : 
the  receptacle  ovate  and  free. 

The  species  cultivated  are:  1.  C,  Europium,  Common  Cycla- 
men; 2.  C.  Count,  Round-leaved  Cyclamen;  3.  C.  Persicum,  Persian 
Cyclamen;  4.  C.  hcdertefoliitm,  Ivy-leaved  Cyclamen. 

The  first  has  a  tuberous  root,  oblately  spheroidal,  white  within, 
brown  without ;  from  which  proceeds,  within  the  ground,  a  very 
short  stem,  and  from  that  the  leaves  and  one-flowered  peduncles  01' 
scapes:  the  leaves  are  kidney-form,  roundish,  very  blunt,  slightly 
crenulate,  deep  green,  and  spoiled  above;  beneath  commonly  red 
purple,  smooth,  on  very  long  round  red  petioles:  the  flowers  droop- 
ing, sweet-scenled,  and  purple.  It  is  a  unlive  of  Austria. 


150 

The  second  species  has  a  round,  solid,  tuberous  root,  and  low 
naked  stem,  furnished  with  plain  orbicular  leaves,  and  short  weak 
petioles;  the  under  side  of  the  leaves  very  red  in  the  beginning  of 
winter,  but  that  colour  goes  off  in  the  spring;  the  upper  side  smooth, 
of  a  lucid  green,  spreading  flat  open  :  the  flowers  are  very  bright 
purple,  appearing  in  the  middle  of  winter.  It  is  a  native  of  the 
South  of  Europe. 

There  are  varieties  with  purplish  flowers,  and  with  flesh-coloured 
flowers. 

In  the  third,  the  leaves  are  stiff,  on  strong  fleshy  petioles,  near  six 
inches  long,  of  a  purple  colour,  as  are  also  the  veins  of  the  leaves 
underneath;  but  the  upper  side  is  veined  and  marbled  with  while: 
the  corolla  is  pure  white,  with  a  bright  purple  bottom.  It  flowers  in 
March  and  April,  and  the  seeds  ripen  in  August. 

There  are  varieties  with  entire  white  sweet-scented  flowers,  and 
with  veined  and  marbled  leaves,  with  pale  purple  flowers,  and  bright 
red  or  purpled  bottoms. 

The  fourth  has  a  large,  orbicular,  compressed  root:  the  leaves 
are  numerous  on  petioles  six  or  seven  inches  long,  marked  with  black 
in  the  middle:  the  flowers  appear  before  them  on  long  fleshy  scapes 
about  August;  soon  after  which  the  leaves  come  out,  continue  grow- 
ing all  the  winter  and  spring  till  May,  when  they  begin  to  decay. 
After  the-flowers  are  fallen,  the  peduncles  twist  up  like  a  screw,  in- 
closing  the  germ  in  the  centre,  and  lie  close  to  the  ground  among  the 
leaves,  which  serve  as  a  protection  to  the  seed,  which  ripens  in  June. 
It  is  a  native  of  Italy. 

There  are  varieties  with  white  and  with  purplish  flowers. 

Culture. — These  plants  are  all  capable  of  being  increased  by 
sowing  the  seeds  in  large  wide  pots,  tubs,  or  boxes,  filled  with  good 
light  mould,  mixed  with  a  little  sand,  in  the  latter  end  of  summer  or 
beginning  of  autumn,  covering  them  to  the  depth  of  about  half  an 
inch,  exposing  them  at  first  in  situations  that  have  only  the  morning 
sun,  but  afterwards  removing  them  into  more  warm  and  sunny  ex- 
posures; and  as  the  winter  approaches,  placing  them  under  the  pro- 
tection of  frames  and  glasses,  or  some  other  contrivance;  fresh  air 


151 

being  freety  admitted  when  the  weather  is  mild  and  suitable.  In  this 
way  soiire  plants  of  the  hardy  sorts  will  appear  about  the  beginning, 
of  the  following  year,  and  of  all  the  kinds  in  the  spring.  During  tne 
beginning  of  summer,  when  the  \veather  is  hot  and  dry,  slight  water- 
ings should  be  given  occasionally;  but  when  their  leaves  begin  to 
decline  in  the  latter  end,  they  should  be  removed  to  an  eastern  as- 
pect, with  only  the  morning  sun,  and,  as  their  roots  are  then  in  an 
inactive  state,  have  little  or  no  water.  They  should  be  kept  tree 
from  weeds  in  the  autumn,  and  have  some  fresh  mould  applied  over 
the  surfaces  of  the  pots  or  tubs  in  which  they  grow,  protecting  them 
again  in  the  winter  as  before,  continuing  the  same  management  as 
in  the  preceding  3"ear,  till  the  decline  of  the  leaves  in  the  lalier  part 
of  the  summer,  when  they  should  be  carefully  taken  up,  and  the 
more  hardy  sorts  planted  out  in  the  situations  where  they  are  to  re- 
main, as  those  of  a  warm,  dry  border;  and  the  tender  kinds  removed 
into  pots,  to  have  protection  from  frosts  in  winter. 

As  the  Persian  sort  is. the  most  impatient  of  cold  and  moisture, 
it  should  constantly  be  kept  in  pols  filled  with  light  sandy  earth,  or 
a  compost  of  loam  and  lime-rubbish,  and  be  placed  in  such  situa- 
tions in  the  frame  or  green-house  as  to  have  as  much  free  air  as 
possible  in  mild  weather  in  winter.  Some  of  the  sorts  will  generally 
begin  to  flower  in  the.  course  of  one  or  two  years  after  being  thus: 
planted  out;  the  first  kind  often  about  Christmas,  which  is  succeeded: 
by  those  of  the  Persian  sort. 

The  plants  in  the  borders  should  have  the  protection  of  mats  or 
other  contrivances,  in  severe  winters,  as  by  such  means  they  produce' 
a  greater  abundance  of  flowers,  and  .these  more  fair  and  beautiful. 

The  varieties  of  the  different  sorts  are  best  preserved  and  conti- 
nued by  planting  pieces  of  the  divided  roots,  immediately  after  they 
have  been  separated  in  the  summer  season,  in  pots,  tubs,  or  other 
places,  as  above:  but  in  this  mode  they  do  not  increase  in  an  expe-: 
ditious  manner. 

These  plants  are  very  ornamental,  though  of  small  growth,  in 
their  variegated  large  foliage,  as  well -as  their  elegant  flowers,  which 
'n  some  of  the  sorts  are  fragrant,  as  those  of  the  spring  kinds.  • 


152  , 

The  hardy  sorts  produce  a  fine  effect  in  the  fronts  of  borders  or 
clumps  in  pleasure-grounds,  and  those  of  the  tender  kinds  among 
olher  potted  plants  in  the  green-house. 

The  proper  period  of  removing  these  plants  for  any  purpose  is 
about  the  beginning  of  June,  when  the  leaves  decline;  but  they 
should  not  be  oflen  removed,  as  the  roots  do  not  lose  their  fibres  as 
in  some  others  of  the  tuberous  and  bulbous  rooted  kinds. 


C2.    CROCUS    VERNUS. 

SPRING    CROCUS. 

Tins  genus  comprehends  plants  of  the  low-flowering  ornamental 
bulbous-rooted  perennial  kind. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Triandria  Monogyma,  and  ranks 
.in  the  natural  order  of  Emata. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  one-leafed  spathe :  the 
corolla  a  simple,  long  tube:  border  six-parted,  erect:  divisions  ovate- 
oblong,  equal:  the  stamina  consist  of  three  subulate  filaments, 
shorter  than  the  corolla:  anthers  sagittate:  the  pistillum  is  an  infe- 
rior, roundish  germ :  style  filiform,  length  of  the  stamens:  stigmas 
three,  convolute,  serrate:  the  pericarpium  is  a  roundish  capsule, 
three-lobed,  three-celled,  three-valved:  the  seeds  several,  and  round: 
the  corollets  six-parted,  equal:  stigmas  convolute. 

The  species  are  :  1.  C.  qfficinalis,  Autumnal  or  Common  Officinal 
Crocus;  2.  C.  vernus,  Spring  Crocus. 

The  first  has  a  roundish  bulbous  root,  as  large  as  a  small  Nutmeg, 
a  little  compressed  at  the  bottom,  and  covered  with  a  coarse,  brown, 
netted  skin;  from  the  bottom  of  the  bulb  many  long  fibres  are  sent 
out,  which  strike  pretty  deep  into  the  ground;  the  flowers  come  out 
at  the  upper  part  of  the  root,  which,  with  the  young  leaves,  whose 
tops  just  appear,  are  closely  wrapped  about  by  a  thin  spalha  or 
sheath,  which  parts  within  the  ground,  and  opens  on  one  side:  the 


153 

tube  of  the  flower  is  very  long,  arising  immediately  from  the  bulb, 
without  any  foot-stalk,  and  at  the  top  is  divided  into  six  ovate  ob- 
tuse segments,  which  are  equal,  and  of  a  purple  blue  colour.  In  the 
bottom  of  the  tube  is  situated  a  roundish  germ,  supporting  a  slender 
style,  which  is  not  more  than  half  the  length  of  the  petal,  crowned 
with  three  oblong  golden  stigmas,  spreading  asunder  each  way,  which 
is  the  Saffron.  It  flowers  in  October,  and  the  leaves  continue  grow- 
ing all  winter;  but  it  never  produces  seeds  in  this  climate.  It  is 
supposed  by  Marty n  to  be  a  native  of  Asia. 

The  chief  varieties  are:  the  Sweet-smelling  with  a  smaller,  and 
more  compressed  root,  having  a  deep  blue  colour,  but  varying  to  a 
sky-blue:  the  Mountain,  which  has  a  flower  of  a  paler  blue  colour; 
the  Many-flowering  blueish,  with  numerous  sky-blue  flowers;  and 
the  Small-flowering,  having  a  small  deep  blue  flower. 

The  second  species  has  a  pretty  large  compressed  bulb,  covered 
with  a  light  brown,  netted  skin,  from  which  arise  four  or  five  leaves 
of  a  purplish  colour  on  their  lower  parts:  from  among  these  come 
out  one  or  two  flowers,  sitting  close  between  the  young  leaves,  never 
rising  above  two  inches  high,  and  having  an  agreeable  odour. 
From  the  centre  of  the  tube  a  slender  style  proceeds,  which  is 
crowned  by  a  broad  flat  stigma  of  a  golden  colour.  After  the  flower 
is  past,  the  germ  pushes  out  of  the  ground.  In  the  wild  slate,  it 
is  most  commonly  white,  with  a  purple  base.  It  is  a  native  of 
Italy,  &c. 

The  chief  varieties  arc :  the  broad-leaved  purple  variegated, 
which  has  a  flower  of  a  deep  blue  colour,  nnd  striped  ;  the  broad- 
leaved  plain  purple;  the  broad-leaved  violet-coloured,  or  large 
deep  blue;  the  white  with  a  purple  bottom;  the  broad-leaved  white 
variegated;  the  broad-leaved  with  many  violet-purple  flowers  striped 
wiih  white;  the  broad-leaved  ash-coloured;  the  broad-leaved  large 
yeilow;  the  broad-leaved  small  pale  yellow;  the  broad-leaved  small 
yellow  striped  with  black;  the  narrow-leaved  small  briimftf&ti;  and 
the  narrow-leaved  small  while. 

In  modern  catalogues,  many  other  varieties  of  different  colours 


154 

are  introduced'  as  blue  and  purple,  yellow  and  white,  or  striped. 
New  ones  are  also  continually  imported  from  Holland.  The  visual 
varieties  at  present  in  gardens  are:  the  beautifully  striped  Scotch; 
the  blue;  the  blue  striped;  the  white;  the  yellow  of  several  shades, 
larger  and  smaller ;  the  yellow  striped  with  black  ;  the  cloth  of 
gold,  &c. 

Culture. — The  culture  in  both  these  sorts  is  easily  effected,  by 
planting  the  bulbs  or  off-sets  taken  from  the  roots;  the  first  sort  in 
July,  or  the  beginning  of  the  following  month,  and  the  latter  any 
time  when  the  weather  is  open,  from  September  to  the  beginning  of 
April  in  the  following  year;  but  the  more  early  it  is  performed,  the 
stronger  they  flower ;  by  means  of  a  dibble  or  trowel,  to  the  depth 
of  about  two  inches,  the  ground  being  previously  well  dug  over, 
and  left  some  time  to  settle.  They  may  be  set  either  in  beds  by 
themselves  in  rows,  at  the  distance  of  eight  or  nine  inches,  and 
six  or  eight  inches  apart,  or  in  patches  of  five  or  six  roots  in 
each,  on  the  fronts  of  the  clumps,  borders,  or  other  parts  of  gar- 
dens and  pleasure  grounds,  pulling  them  in  a  varied  manner, 
both  in  respect  to  the  sorts,  and  the  order  in  which  they  are 
planted. 

Where  the  soils  are  tolerably  dry,  they  may  remain  two  or  three 
years  without  being  disturbed,  but  should  then  be  taken  up  at  the 
time  the  leaves  decay,  in  order  to  separate  the  new  bulbs  or  off-sets 
for  further  increase,  as  well  as  to  new  dig  the  ground.  The  larger 
bulbs  should  be  separated  from  the  small  ones,  and  put  up,  each  by 
themselves,  in  order  to  be  planted  at  the  proper  season;  the  former 
in  the  above  manner,  and  the  latter  in  beds  in  rows  six  inches  dis- 
tant, to  remain  till  they  are  of  a  proper  size. 

As  the  bulbs  increase  fast,  a  large  stock  may  with  care  soon  be 
provided.  But  when  this  is  not  practised,  bulbs  of  the  different 
species  and  varieties  may  easily  be  procured  from  the  nursery  and 
seeds-men. 

In  the  culture  of  these  plants,  great  injury  is  frequently  done 
by  trimming  off  the  green  leaves  at  the  time  the  flowers  decline,  in 


155 

order  to  prevent  litter;  as  by  such  means  the  future  blow  is  rendered 
more  weak  and  less  beautiful. 

Where  new  varieties  are  wanted,  recourse  must  be  had  to  the 
seed,  which  must  be  sown  in  the  spring  season,  either  where  the 
plants  are  to  remain,  in  a  bed  of  light  mellow  earth,  or  in  pots  filled 
with  the  same  sort  of  earth. 

The  first  species  is  the  plant  which  is  cultivated  in  fields,  and 
from  the  stigma  of  which  the  preparation  known  under  the  title  of 
English  Saffron  is  made. 


PLATE  XIX.* 

1.  DAHLIA  PINNATA. 

PURPLE    DAHLIA. 

2.  DAHLIA  CROCATA. 

YELLOW    DAHLIA. 


THIS  genus  was  established  by  the  late  Cavanilles,  in  honour  of 
Dr.  Andrew  Dahl,  a  Swedish  botanist,  and  the  friend  of  Baron 
Alstrcemer. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Syngenesia  Polygamia  Frustranea, 
at  least  in  this  cold  climate. 

The  stems  die  every  winter,  but  the  root  is  perennial  and  tube- 
rous, not  very  dissimilar  to  that  of  the  Artichoke. 

Four  species  have  been  described. 

1.  Pinnata,  pinnated  as  it  is  called,  and  figured  by  Cavanilles  in 
his  Ic.  PL  v.  1.  tab.  80.     It  is  also  figured  under  this  name  in  the  4ih 
vol.  of  Andrews's  Bot.  Repository.     In  the  Annales  dit  Mas.  National 
Hist.  Nat.  v.  3.  M.  Thouin  calls  this  species  Purpwea,  but  its  colour 
varies  from  the  common  Pinnata,  being  very  deep;  and  Mr.  R.  A. 
Salisbury  suspects  that  this  Purpurea  of  Thouin  is  the  true  Rosea  of 
Cavanilles.  A  paler  coloured  variety  of  ihePinnata,  the  seeds  of  which 
were  sent  to  Holland-House  with  the  name  of  Rosea  by  Cavanilles, 
has  been  lately  figured  by  Mr.  Hooker  in  the  Puradisus  Londinensis, 
and  described  by  the  above-mentioned  botanist,  under  the  name  of 
Sambucifolia:  that  it  is  not  the  true   Rosea  of  C.ivanilles,  Ic.  is  un- 
questionable; for  the  leaves  were  simply  pinnate,  not  bipinnate. 

2.  Rosea,  Rose-coloured.     It  is  so  called   and  figured  by  Cava- 


I  />/'  /,/'//</<•// 

/)fl/t/t  ft 
/          i 


i,,/  ,\l,ir  1  1*/'/'   In  • 


\-[7,',' 


157 

nilles  in  his  Icones;  but  the  plant  called  Rosea  by  Mr.  Thouin  in  ihe 
Annales,  is  most  probably  the  very  variety  of  the  first  species  figured 
by  die  name  of  Sambucifolia  in  the  Paradisus  Londinensis. 

3.  Coccinea,  Scarlet.    This  is  figured  in  Curtis's  publication;  but 
we  entertain  a  doubt  if  it  is  the  same  with  Cavanilles's  plant,  if  the 
colour  is  well  copied.     The  plant,  we  understand,  is  dead. 

4.  Crocata,  Saffron-coloured.     This    plant  is  not  mentioned  in 
any  work  previous  to  the  Paradisus  Londinensis,  where  it  is  figured 
and  described  by  the  name  of  Bidentifolia.     Though  the  parcels  of 
seeds  which  came  from  Cavanilles  himself  had  the  title  of  Crocata, 
the  flowers  turned  out  yellow. 

It  is  not  intended  here  to  describe  minutely  these  plants;  it  is 
sufficient  to  say,  that  they  elevate  themselves  majestically  like  the 
Holy-hock,  and  bear  both  axillary  and  terminal  showy  flowers  late 
in  the  autumn. 

Culture. — The  first  Dahlias  introduced  into  England  were  lost  by 
taking  too  much  care  of  them.  As  they  are  natives  of  the  hilly  parts 
of  Mexico,  they  will  thrive  in  the  open  ground  very  well,  and  accus- 
tom themselves  in  a  very  few  generations  to  ripen  seeds  here  an- 
nually. By  giving  the  history  of  those  plants  which  have  grown  in 
the  gardens  of  Holland-House,  Kensington,  it  is  only  meant  to  offer 
hints  for  their  culture,  leaving  the  rest  to  future  experience  and  ob- 
servation. 

On  the  20th  of  May,  1804,  the  Right  Honourable  Lady  Holland 
sent  home  from  Spain  a  parcel  of  seeds.  Though  so  late  in  ihe  sea- 
son, part  of  them  were  sown  in  pots  in  a  hot-bed,  and  among  these 
was  the  Dahlia  Pinnata,  with  a  wrong  name  on  the  parcel.  When 
the  plant  was  about  fourteen  inches  high,  it  was  planted  in  the  open 
ground  and  grew  luxuriantly,  pushing  up  several  stems  to  the  height 
of  seven  and  eight  feet.  The  Coccinea  and  Crocata,  the  seeds  of 
which  also  came  up,  but  did  not  grow  so  full.  In  the  middle  of 
September  the  first  flowers  appeared,  by  which  the  plant  was  known 
to  belhe  Pinnata  of  Cavanilles,  and  it  was  figured  by  Mr.  Andrews 
the  same  year.  The  seeds  did  not  ripen,  and  the  roots  were  taken 


158 

up  on  the  approach  of  a  sharp  frost,  and  placed  in  the  green-ho'ise 
in  a  pot  for  the  winter. 

In  the  spring  of  1805  all  the  parcels  of  seed  sent  from  abroad 
were  sown,  and  many  Dahlias  came  up  among  them,  which  at  the 
time  of  flowering  showed  four  distinct  species  or  varieties.  It  seems 
that  Cavanilles,  and  the  French  botanists  after  him,  mean  to  make 
as  many  species  as  there  are  different  coloured  Dahlias;  but  the 
learned  Mr.  Salisbury,  one  of  the  Vice  Presidents  last  year  of  the 
Linnean  Society,  considers  them  all  simply  as  varieties  of  only  two 
distinct  species,  and  has  in  the  Paradisits  Londinensis  named  them, 
not  according  to  their  colour,  but  after  the  differences  of  their  leaves, 
being  inclined  to  believe  that  they  will  in  time  vary  like  the  China 
Aster  and  Mary  gold. 

And,  in  fact,  with  regard  to  the  Dahlia  Pinnata,  now  commonly 
called  Pnrpurea,  we  have  great  reason  to  confirm  that  botanist's 
suspicion,  having  seen  nine  different  varieties  of  it,  either  in  the 
colour  or  multiplication  of  the  petals.  The  flower,  in  its  natural 
state,  has  only  eight  ligulated  petals:  a  few  had  twelve.  There  was 
also  one  plant  with  archdouble  flowers,  exceedingly  pale :  another 
with  archdouble  flowers,  exceeding  deep  purple,  exactly  like  that 
figured  in  the  Annaks  du  Mm.  but  the  flowers  were  so  complicated 
together,  and  the  autumn  of  1805  so  cold,  they  never  expanded.  We 
must  observe,  that  the  leaves  of  this  plant  were  bipinnalcd,  but 
whether  it  is  a  real  distinct  species  is  not  yet  positively  ascertained. 

The  Dahlia  Rosea  was  in  the  year  1805  the  most  handsome,  and 
ripened  plenty  of  seeds.  The  Pnrpurea  ripened  fewer  and  weaker 
seeds,  though  they  now  (10th  May,  1806)  come  up  freely;  the 
plants,  however,  look  weak.  Of  the  seeds  of  Coccinea  and  Crocata, 
no  plants  have  yet  appeared,  though  to  the  eye  they  seemed  as  per- 
fect as  those  imported  from  Spain. 

All  the  plants  of  1805,  except  one,  were  taken  up  before  Christ- 
mas, and  planted  in  pots  or  large  pans;  but  though  kept  in  a  very- 
cold  green-house,  they  began  to  push  new  shoots  in  the  middle  of 
April,  and  will  be  planted  in  the  open  ground  Avilhout  the  help  of 


159 

an}'  artificial  heat.  Some  rich  mould  round  the  roots  is  the  only  cul- 
ture they  require.  The  plant  left  all  the  winter  out  of  doors  was 
situated  close  to  a  south  wall ;  and  though  it  had  no  covering  of  any 
kind,  it  is  now  pushing  up  new  shoots.  It  is  necessary  to  add,  that 
several  plants  of  Dahlias  have  been  raised  by  cuttings,  which  are 
now  in  good  health,  and  which  will  probably  flower  and  produce 
seeds  next  autumn. 

lOlh  July,  1806.  Above  a  hundred  plants  of  Dahlias  are  no\v 
growing  in  various  parts  of  the  gardens  at  Holland-House  in  the 
highest  luxuriance:  among  them  are  several  of  the  yellow-flowered 
Bidentifolia,  raised  from  seeds  saved  there  last  year,  though  the  au- 
tumn proved  so  unfavourable.  One  plant  of  the  Purpurea  of  An- 
drews's  Bot.  Repository  is  already  showing  flowers. 

The  true  Rosea  of  Cavanilles,  with  doubly  pinnated  leaves,  is  also 
growing  most  vigorously,  and  one  of  its  stems  has  been  pinched  to 
produce  lateral  shoots  for  cuttings.  A  plant  left  in  the  middle  of 
one  of  the  borders  of  the  French  garden  at  Holland-House  by  mis- 
take, and  exposed  to  the  severity  of  the  winter,  without  any  shelter, 
is  as  strong  and  vigorous  as  any  of  the  Qther  two-year  old  plants;  so 
that  there  is  not  a  doubt  that  this  magnificent  genus  will  soon  be  a 
common  ornament  of  the  gardens  in  this  island. 

In  plate  19*  is  a  representation  of  a  plant  of  the  Dahlia  Pinnata, 
or  Pitrpurea. 


PLATE  XX. 

1.   DAPHNE  CNEORUM. 

TRAILING    DAPHNE. 

THIS  geuus  comprises  plants  of  the  low  shrubby  ornamental, 
evergreen,  and  deciduous  kinds. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Octandria  Monogynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Fepreculce. 

The  characters  are:  that  there  is  no  calyx:  the  corolla  one-pe- 
talled,  funnel-form,  withering,  including  the  stamens:  tube  cylindric, 
imperforate,  longer  than  the  border :  border  four-cleft ;  divisions 
ovate,  acute,  flat,  spreading:  the  stamina  have  eight,  short  filaments, 
inserted  into  the  tube;  the  alternate  ones  lower:  anthers  roundish, 
erect,  two-celled :  the  pistillum  is  an  ovate  germ  :  style  very  short : 
stigma  headed,  depressed-flat :  the  pericarpium  a  roundish  one-, 
celled  berry:  (drupe  berried  superior;)  the  seed  single,  roundish, 
fleshy. 

The  species  are :  1.  D.  Mezereum,  Mezereon ;  2.  D.  Laureola, 
Wood  or  Spurge  Laurel;  3.  D.  tartouraira,  Silvery-leaved  Daphne, 
or  Tartouraira;  4.  D.  cneontm,  Trailing  Daphne;  5.  D.  odora,  Sweet- 
smelling  Daphne. 

The  first  is  a  shrub,  growing  to  the  height  of  from  three  or  four 
to  five  or  six  feet,  with  a  strong  woody  stalk,  putting  out  many 
woody  branches  on  every  side,  so  as  to  form  a  regular  head.  The 
leaves  are  smooth,  about  two  inches  long,  and  three  quarters  of  an 
inch  broad  in  the  middle,  placed  without  order.  The  flowers  come 
out  very  early  in  the  spring,  before  the  leaves,  in  clusters  all  round 
the  shoots  of  the  former  year.  The  fruit  is  a  superior  berried  drupe, 
fir&t  green,  then  red,  of  an  ovate-globular  form;  with  a  thin  succu- 


I'ainlt.i  l,Y  .W  EJ,.u.L  Lcn:l,',<  fuili/hfd  J) 

2)«j>// //>       CMC  rum. 
'/  fttf/i  //(/     />/ti>li  tt<- 


'  ty  GKf.irflfi  f'ff.-f  .It 

DracecepTuUUm     rrn/i  inn  mi  >n 

f   I  f(/t  Hid  II    Jh'dt/i'lt.c   /if/I,/ 


ntfWvftl  fa  _/ 


lent  pulp,  and  a  crustaceous,  thin,  brittle,  black  shining  shell.     It 
is  a  native  of  Lapland,  £c.  flowering  in  January,  in  mild  seasons. 

Martyn  remarks,  that  there  are  two  principal  varieties;  one  with 
a  white  flower,  succeeded  by  yellow  berries;  the  other  with  peach- 
coloured  flowers  and  red  fruit:  the  latter  has  sometimes  flowers  of  a 
much  deeper  red:  and  that  there  is  also  a  variety  with  variegated 
leaves. 

The  second  species  is  a  low  evergreen  shrub,  rising  with  several 
stalks  to  the  height  of  two  or  three  feet,  dividing  at  top  into  several 
branches.  The  leaves  come  out  irregularly  on  every  side,  sit  pretty 
close  to  the  branches,  are  thick,  smooth,  and  of  a  lucid  green. 
Among  these,  towards  the  upper  part  of  the  stalks,  come  out  the 
flowers  in  small  clusters;  they  are  of  a  yellowish  green  colour,  and 
appear  soon  after  Christmas  if  the  season  be  not  very  severe.  They 
are  succeeded  by  oval  berries,  which  are  green  till  June,  when  they 
ripen  and  turn  black,  soon  after  which  they  fall  off.  It  is  a  native 
of  Britain,  &c. 

The  third  species  is  a  low  shrubby  plant,  which  sends  out  several 
weak  stalks  from  the  root,  about  a  foot  long,  and  spreading  about 
irregularly;  these  seldom  become  woody  in  England,  but  are  tough 
and  stringy,  covered  with  a  light  bark:  the  leaves  are  small,  very 
soft,  white  and  shining  like  satin,  and  sit  pretty  close  to  the  stalks 
between  these,  white  flowers  come  out  in  thick  clusters,  commonly 
two  or  three  together,  very  seldom  solitary,  bell-shaped,  silky  on 
the  outside,  but  yellowish  within,  imbricated  at  the  base  with  four 
or  more  ovate  keeled  scales.  It  is  a  native  of  the  South  of  France. 

The  fourth  species  is  a  very  humble  shrub,  seldom  more  than  one 
foot  high:  the  stems  are  branched;  the  leaves  narrow  lanceolate, 
placed  without  order:  the  branches  terminated  by  small  clusters  of 
purple  flowers,  which  stand  erect:  the  flowers  emit  a  pleasant  odour> 
and  appear  early  in  the  spring.  It  is  a  native  of  France,  &c. 

It  varies  with  white  flowers. 

The  fifth  has  the  stem  becoming  shrubby,  dichotomous,  smooth, 
naked,  eredt;  the  branches,  like  the  stem,  from  divaricate  erect:  the 
leaves  at  the  top  of  the  last  branchlcls,  approximating,  sessile,  acute, 


162 

quite  entire,  spreading,  bent  back  at  the  tip;  deep  green  on  the 
upper  surface,  with  a  groove  along  the  middle,  paler  underneath; 
unequal,  thick,  evergreen,  an  inch  in  length :  the  flowers  about 
eleven  in  number,  of  a  purple  colour.  It  is  a  native  of  Japan,  flow- 
ering here  from  December  to  March. 

Culture. — These  plants  are  capable  of  being  raised  in  different 
methods  according  to  the  kinds. 

O 

The  first  sort  and  varieties  are  best  propagated  by  sowing  the 
seeds  or  berries,  as  soon  as  they  have  become  perfectly  ripe,  as  about 
August,  on  beds  of  light  sandy  earth,  covering  them  in  to  the  depth 
of  half  an  inch.  When  possible,  a  south-easterly  aspect  should  be 
chosen.  And  to  preserve  the  seeds  in  a  perfect  slate,  the  shrubs 
should  be  netted  in  the  latler  end  of  the  summer,  to  prevent  the 
attacks  of  the  birds. 

The  young  plants  generally  appear  in  the  following  spring,  when 
they  should  be  kept  clear  from  weeds,  and  the  largest  ones  removed 
when  too  close  together:  they  may  remain  in  these  beds  till  the  be- 
ginning of  the  second  autumn,  when  they  should  be  removed,  and 
set  out  in  nursery-rows,  at  the  distance  of  a  foot  and  half,  and  ten  or 
twelve  inches  in  the  rows,  great  care  being  taken  not  to  break  or 
injure  their  roots.  After  they  have  had  two  years  growth  in  these 
situations,  they  are  in  a  proper  condition  for  being  planted  out  where 
they  are  to  remain :  and  as  the  plants  flower  very  early  in  the  spring, 
the  best  time  for  removing  them  is  in  the  early  part  of  the  autumn. 

The  plants  grow  to  the  greatest  size,  and  flower  in  the  most  full 
and  perfect  manner,  when  the  soils  are  of  a  dry  quality:  as  in  moist, 
adhesive  soils  they  are  apt  to  become  mossy. 

The  second  species  may  be  increased  by  sowing  the  seeds  in  the 
same  manner  as  the  above;  and  also  by  cuttings  and  layers  of  the 
young  shoots:  these  should  be  planted  out  or  laid  down  in  the  be- 
ginning of  the  autumn,  and  in  the  following  autumn  they  will  be 
well  rooted :  the  layers  may  be  then  taken  off,  and  planted  where 
they  are  to  remain,  or  put  into  nursery-rows  as  above.  The  cuttings 
may  likewise  be  treated  in  the  same  way. 

The  third  and  fourth  sorts  succeed  best  when  raised  from  seed 


163 

procured  from  abroad,  and  sown  on  a  Avarm  dry  situation,  in  the 
early  autumn,  in  the  places  where  the  plants  are  to  remain,  as  they 
do  not  bear  transplanting  well.  The  ground  should  be  as  little  as 
possible  stirred  about  the  plants.  The  former  should  have  a  dry 
warm  aspect  where  the  land  is  poor,  but  the  latter  succeeds  in  such 
as  are  more  cool :  these  plants  are  sufficiently  hardy  to  succeed  in 
the  open  air,  when  the  winters  are  not  very  severe. 

The  last  sort  is  raised  by  sowing  the  seeds  procured  from  its  na- 
tive situation,  on  a  gentle  hot-bed  in  the  autumn  or  spring,  and  when 
the  plants  are  of  sufficient  growth  removing  them  into  separate  pots, 
to  be  placed  under  the  protection  of  the  greenhouse.  It  is  much 
more  tender  than  the  other  sorts. 

The  first  and  second  kinds  are  highly  ornamental  plants  in  the 
clumps,  borders,  and  other  conspicuous  parts  near  the  house,  the 
former  flowering  early,  and  where  many  are  together  affording  a  fine 
fragrance. 

The  other  sorts,  though  more  tender,  are  curious,  and  afford  an 
agreeable  variety  in  assemblage  with  others  of  similar  growth,  either 
in  the  borders  or  among  potted  plants. 


2.  DRACOCEPHALUM  VIRGINIANUM. 
VIRGINIAN  DRAGON'S  HEAD. 

THIS  genus  comprehends  plants  of  the  herbaceous,  annual,  and 
perennial  kind. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Didynamia  Gymjiospermia,  and 
ranks  in  the  natural  order  of  Verticillatce. 

The  characters  are :  that  the  calyx  is  a  one-leafed  perianthium, 
tubular,  permanent,  very  short:  the  corolla  one-petalled,  ringent: 
tube  length  of  the  calyx:  throat  very  large,  oblong,  inflated,  gaping, 
a  little  compressed  on  the  back:  lip  superior  straight,  arched, 


164 

plicated,  obtuse:  lip  inferior  three-cleft;  lateral  divisions  upright,  as 
it  were  the  segments  of  the  throat;  the  intermediate  one  hanging 
down,  small,  prominent  forwards  at  the  base,  roundish,  emarginate: 
the  stamina  consist  of  four  subulate  filaments,  hid  beneath  the  upper 
lip  of  the  corolla,  of  which  two  are  a  litte  shorter:  anthers  somewhat 
cordate:  the  pistillum  is  a  four-parted  germ:  style  filiform,  in  the 
situation  of  the  stamens :  stigma  two-cleft,  sharp,  slender,  reflex : 
there  is  no  pericarpium :  calyx  cherishing  the  seeds  in  its  bottom : 
the  seeds  four,  ovate-oblong,  three-sided. 

The  species  chiefly  cultivated  are:  1.  D.  Virginiamim,  Virginian 
Dragon's  Head;  2.  D.  Canarieme,  Canary  Dragon's  Head,  or  Balm 
of  Gilead;  3.  D.  Austriacum,  Austrian  Dragon's  Head  ;  4.  D.  Ruys- 
chiana,  Hyssop-leaved  Dragon's  Head ;  5.  D.  Moldavica,  Moldavian 
Dragon's  Head,  or  Balm. 

There  are  other  species  that  deserve  cultivation. 

The  first  is  a  perennial  plant.  It  rises  with  an  upright  stalk,  near 
three  feet  high.  The  leaves  are  about  three  inches  long,  and  half  an 
inch  broad,  sessile;  usually  in  pairs  at  each  joint,  but  sometimes 
there  are  three  together.  The  flowers  are  purple,  in  terminating 
spikes.  It  is  a  native  of  North  America,  flowering  from  July  to 
September. 

The  second  species  is  also  a  perennial  plant,  rising  with  several 
stalks  to  the  height  of  three  feet  or  more,  becoming  woody  at  the 
lower  part;  the  leaves  at  each  joint  having  three  or  five  oblong, 
pointed,  serrate  leaflets. — The  flowers  come  out  in  short  thick  spikes 
on  the  top  of  the  stalks;  they  are  of  a  pale  blue  colour.  It  is  a  na- 
tive of  the  Canary  Islands,  flowering  at  the  same  time  as  the  first.  / 

The  third  has  likewise  a  perennial  root.  The  stalks  are  hairy,  a 
foot  and  half  high,  sending  out  several  side-branches.  The  leaves 
are  hairy,  linear,  cut  into  three  parts.  The  flowers  terminating  in 
short  whorled  spikes,  with  some  very  narrow  leaves  (bractes)  under 
each  whorl.  It  is  a  beautiful  plant,  growing  naturally  in  Aus- 
tria, &c. 

In  the  fourth  the  root  is  perennial.  The  stems  about  two  feet 
high,  with  two  smooth  linear  leaves  at  each  joint,  about  an  inch 


165 

long,  and  one-eighth  of  an  inch  broad,  with  a  deep  furrow  along  the 
middle :  at  each  joint,  at  the  other  sides  of  the  stem,  come  out  two 
or  three  very  narrow  small  leaves  of  the  same  shape.  The  flowers 
are  in  spikes,  of  a  fine  blue  colour.  It  is  a  native  of  Norway,  flower- 
ing in  June. 

The  fifth  is  an  annual  plant,  rising  with  branching  stalks  a  foot 
and  half  high,  with  oblong  leaves,  deeply  serrate  on  their  edges. 
The  flowers  come  out  in  whorls  round  the  stalks  at  every  joint ;  are 
blue,  and  appear  in  July,  continuing  to  the  middle  of  August.  It 
has  a  strong  balsamic  odour,  which  to  some  is  very  agreeable.  It 
is  a  native  of  Moldavia. 

Culture. — These  plants  are  raised  in  different  methods,  according 
to  the  kinds. 

The  first  sort  is  best  propagated  by  parting  the  roots  and  planting 
them  out  in  moist,  sheltered,  shady  situations,  either  in  the  autumn 
or  spring. 

In  the  second  kind  the  plants  are  best  raised  by  sowing  the  seeds 
in  pots  of  good  mould  in  the  autumn,  protecting  them  by  means  of 
a  frame  and  glasses  during  the  winter.  When  the  plants  have  some 
growth  they  may  be  removed  into  separate  pots,  and  placed  in  the 
open  air  during  the  summer,  but  brought  under  the  shelter  of  a 
green-house  or  garden-frame  in  the  winter;  the  latter  is  probably 
the  better  practice. 

They  may  likewise  be  increased  by  planting  cuttings  of  the  young 
shoots  in  a  warm  shady  spot  during  the  summer.  These,  when  they 
have  formed  good  roots,  should  be  removed  into  pots,  to  be  protected 
under  glasses  during  the  winter. 

They  require  a  pretty  full  exposure  to  the  air  when  the  weather 
is  suitable,  being  sufficiently  hardy  to  stand  the  open  air  in  mild 
winters. 

The  third  and  fourth  species  may  be  raised  by  sowing  the  seeds 
in  the  early  spring  months,  in  a  bed  of  earth  in  an  open  exposure, 
or  in  pots.  When  the  plants  have  attained  sufficient  growth  they 
should  be  removed  into  a  spot  of  fresh  light  earth,  and  planted  out 
six  inches  apart,  proper  shade  and  water  being  given,  till  they  be- 


come  rooted,  or  into  separate  pots.  If  the  pots  be  plunged  in  11 
moderate  hot-bed  it  Avill  greatly  forward  them, 

They  must  be  kept  free  from  weeds  till  the  autumn,  in  the  first 
situation,  when  they  should  be  taken  up  with  good  balls  to  their 
roots,  and  be  planted  out  in  the  borders  or  other  parts,  where  they 
are  to  remain.  They  may  also  be  increased  by  planting  cuttings  of 
the  branches  in  summer,  in  a  shady  spot,  or  in  large  pots,  giving 
them  shade  and  water,  and  afterwards  removing  them  into  other 
pots. 

The  fifth  species  must  be  raised  annually  by  sowing  the  seeds  in 
patches,  in  the  places  where  the  plants  are  to  remain,  in  the  spring. 
When  the  plants  appear,  they  should  be  properly  thinned,  and  kept 
perfectly  free  from  weeds. 

All  the  sorts,  except  the  second,  may  be  employed  for  ornament  in 
the  beds  or  borders  of  gardens  and  pleasure-grounds;  some  of  them 
affording  a  fine  smell,  as  well  as  pretty  effect  in  their  flowers.  They 
should  be  raised  almost  annually,  in  order  to  keep  good  plants. 

The  second  kind  is  chiefly  introduced  among  green-house  col- 
lections, both  for  variety  and  the  fragrant  balsamic  smell  which  it 
affords. 


./7.2Z. 


try  A\.J  /•:./»,  tnt, 

Dflphinium        ////////// 

LarJupntr 


;/  .1'  •.    (i 


t> 

,     /)  i,  i  rif/in,i        />,/  r/»i/u,r 

'  //>///,/  /// 


PLATE  XXI. 

1.  DELPHINIUM  ELATUM, 

LARKSPUR. 


THIS  genus  comprises  plants  of  the  herbaceous  flowery  hardy 
annual  and  perennial  kinds.     Dolphin  Flower. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Polyandria  Trigynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Multisilign<e. 

The  characters  are:  that  there  is  no  calyx:  the  corolla  has  five 
petals,  unequal,  disposed  in  a  circle;  of  which  the  uppermost  in 
some  is  more  obtuse  than  the  rest  in  front,  and  is  extended  behind 
into  a  tubular,  straight,  long,  obtuse  horn:  the  rest  ovate-lanceolate, 
spreading,  nearly  equal:  nectary  two-cleft,  seated  in  front  within  the 
circle  of  petals  on  the  upper  part,  behind  stretched  out,  involved 
within  the  tube  of  the  petal :  the  stamina  have  very  many  filaments 
(fifteen  or  thirty,)  subulate,  wider  at  the  base,  very  small,  inclined 
towards  the  petal:  anthers  erect,  small:  the  pislillum  consists  of  three 
or  one  germ;  ovate,  ending  in  styles  the  length  of  the  stamens: 
stigmas  simple,  reflex:  the  pericarpium  has  as  many  capsules,  ovate- 
subulate,  straight,  one-valved,  gaping  inwards:  the  seeds  very  many, 
and  cornered. 

The  species  mostly  cultivated  are:  1.  D.  adjacis,  Upright  Lark- 
spur; 2.  D.  grandiflorum,  Great-flowered  Bee  Larkspur;  3.  D,  datum, 
Tall  Bee  Larkspur. 

There  are  other  species  that  may  be  cultivated. 
The  first  is  annual,  and  has  the  stalks  eighteen  inches  and  more 
in  height,  seldom  branched:  the  leaves  are  finely  divided,  commonly 
by  threes,  on  broad  petioles :  the  segments  are  linear,  quite  entire, 


168 

and  channelled  above;  the  spike  of  flowers  erect,  dense,  and  of  dif_ 
ferent  colours. 

There  are  varieties  with  single  and  double  blue  flowers;  with 
single  and  double  purple  flowers;  with  single  and  double  silver- 
coloured  flowers;  with  single  and  double  violet-coloured  flowers; 
with  single  and  double  ash-coloured  flowers;  with  single  and  double 
striped  flowers ;  Large  Rocket  Larkspur,  and  Dwarf  or  Rocket 
Larkspur. 

The  second  species  has  a  perennial  root,  which  puts  out  two  or 
three  branching  stalks  every  spring,  rising  about  a  foot  and  a  half 
high:  the  leaves  are  smoolh  and  of  a  light  green  colour  above,  and 
hoary  beneath,  composed  of  many  narrow  segments,  which  terminate 
in  several  acute  points:  the  flowers  come  out  towards  the  upper  part 
of  the  stalks  singly,  each  on  a  long  naked  peduncle;  they  are  large, 
and  of  a  fine  azure  colour.  They  appear  in  June  and  July,  and  the 
seeds  ripen  in  autumn,  ll  is  a  native  of  Siberia. 

The  third  rises  to  the  height  of  a  man:  the  root  is  perennial:  the 
leaves  slightly  villose,  becoming  smooth  by  age,  half-five-lobed,  pe- 
tioled;  lobes  acute,  often  half-three-lobed,  sharply  serrate.  The 
spikes  of  flowers  very  long  and  handsome,  of  a  deep  blue  colour, 
with  a  wrinkled  spur.  It  is  a  native  of  Switzerland,  &c.  flowering 
from  June  to  September. 

Culture. — These  plants,  in  all  the  sorls  and  varieties,  are  propa- 
gated by  sowing  the  seeds  in  the  early  spring,  as  in  February,  March, 
or  the  following  month,  or  in  the  autumn  immediately  after  the  seeds 
become  ripe,  in  the  clumps,  borders,  or  other  places  where  the  plants 
are  to  remain,  as  they  do  not  succeed  so  perfectly  by  transplanting, 
in  patches  of  eight  or  ten  in  a  place,  covering  the  seed  in  to  the  depth 
of  nearly  half  an  inch,  the  mould  being  previously  rendered  fine. 

Where  the  annual  sort  and  varieties  are  cultivated  for  a  large 
show,  the  seed  may  be  sown  thinly  in  drills  on  beds  four  feet  broad, 
at  a  foot  distance,  covering  it  in  to  the  above  depth.  They  are  some- 
times sown  in  other  forms  for  the  purpose  of  appearance. 

The  autumn  sowings  of  these  seeds  should  be  marked  by  placing 


169 

•small  sticks  in  the  places,  lo  prevent  their  being  disturbed  by  the 
spring  digging  of  the  ground. 

The  only  culture  the  plants  in  general  require  after  they  appear, 
is  that  of  thinning  them  in  a  proper  manner,  according  to  circum- 
stances, and  keeping  them  free  from  weeds.  And  in  the  petenial 
sorts  removing  the  stems  in  the  autumn. 

These  plants  afford  much  ornament  and  variety  in  the  different 
compartments  of  pleasure-grounds,  and  they  succeed  in  most  soils 
and  situations,  being  of  hardy  growth. 


2.  DIANTHUS  BARBATUS. 

SWEET    WILLIAM. 

THIS  genus  furnishes  plants  of  the  herbaceous  flowery  orna- 
mental kind. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Decandria  Digyiiict,  and  ranks  in 
the  natural  order  of  Caryophyllei. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  cylindric  perianthiurn. 
tubular,  striated,  permanent,  five-toothed  at  the  mouth,  surrounded 
at  the  base  with  four  scales,  of  which  the  two  opposite  are  lower: 
the  corolla  has  five  petals,  claws  length  of  the  calyx,  narrow,  inserted 
into  the  receptacle:  border  flat;  the  plaits  outwardly  wider,  obtuse, 
crenate:  the  stamina  consist  of  ten  subulate  filaments,  length  of  the 
calyx,  with  spreading  tips:  anthers  oval-oblong,  compressed,  incum- 
bent: the  pistillum  is  an  oval  germ:  styles  two,  subulate,  longer 
than  the  stamens:  stigmas  bent  back,  acuminate:  the  pericarpium  is 
a  cylindric  capsule,  covered,  one-celled,  gaping  open  at  top  four 
ways:  the  seeds  a  great  many,  compressed,  roundish:  receptacle  free, 
four-cornered,  shorter  by  half  than  the  pericarpium. 

The  species  chiefly  cultivated  in  the  garden  are:  1.  D.barbatus, 
Sweet  William,  or  Bearded  Pink;  2.  D.  caryophillus,  Clove  Pink,  or 
Clove  Gilliflower;  3.  D.  ddtoides,  Common  or  Madder  Pink;  4-  D. 


170 

plumarius,  Feathered  Pink;  5.  D.  ccesius,  Gray-leaved  or  Mountain 
Pink;  6.  D.  Chinensis,  China  Pink;  7-  D.superbus,  Superb  Pink. 

The  first  has  a  perennial  fusiform  root:  the  stems  are  upright, 
jointed,  smooth,  a  foot  and  half  high,  branched:  the  leaves,  soft, 
veined,  connate,  from  half  an  inch  to  ajmost  an  inch  broad  in  the 
widest  part,  bright  green;  the  bundles  of  flowers  compact,  um  belled, 
and  sessile.  These  are  of  different  colours,  in  different  varieties.  It 
is  a  native  of  Germany. 

The  principal  varieties  are:  the  Broad-leaved,  or  Sweet- Williams: 
the  Narrow-leaved,  or  Sweet-Johns;  with  single  and  double  flowers 
in  each. 

The  chief  of  the  sub-varieties  in  the  first  or  broad-leaved  kind  are, 
with  broad  leaves  and  tall  deep  red  flowers,  with  tall  flesh-coloured 
flowers,  with  pure  white  flowers,  with  white  dotted  flowers,  with 
striped  leaves  and  red  flowers,  large  double  rose-coloured  with  sweet- 
scented  flowers,  large  double  with  deep  purple  burster  flowers,  and 
with  double  variegated  flowers. 

In  the  second,  or  narrow-leaved  sort,  with  narrow  leaves  and  deep 
red  flowers,  with  pale  red  flowers,  with  pale  red  and  flesh-coloured 
flowers,  with  purplish  white-eyed  flowers,  with  snow-white  flowers, 
with  white  and  flesh-coloured  flowers,  with  white  and  purple  flowers* 
with  white  spotted  flowers,  and  with  red  flowers  and  white  borders, 
or  Painted  Lady  Sweet- Williams. 

It  is  observed  by  Marty n,  that  the  broad-leaved  sort,  with  very 
double  flowers  of  a  deep  purple,  inclining  to  blue,  bursting  the  calyx, 
is  not  so  much  esteemed;  but  that  the  double  Rose  Sweet-William, 
with  flowers  of  a  fine  deep  rose-colour,  and  smelling  sweet,  is  much 
valued,  as  it  does  not  burst.  The  Mule,  or  Fairchild's  Sweet-Wil- 
liam, which  is  one  of  the  narrow-leaved  double  sorts,  supposed  to 
have  been  produced  from  seeds  of  a  Carnation  impregnated  by  a 
Sweet-William;  the  flowers  are  of  a  brighter  red  than  in  either  of 
the  former;  their  bunches  not  quite  so  large,  but  the  flowers  have  an 
agreeable  smell.  The  narrow-leaA'ed  kind  are  in  general  the  most 
productive  of  double  flowers. 

The  second  sort,  in  its  natural  state,  has  the  root  large,  woody, 


171 

and  branched:  the  stems  a  foot  or  eighteen  inches  high,  decumbent 
at  bottom,  jointed  and  branched:  the  leaves  are  glaucous,  smooth, 
linear,  a  line  in  breadth:  every  branch  is  terminated  by  one,  two,  or 
three  flowers.  These  flowers,  in  the  improved  garden  plant,  have  a 
spicy  odour. 

There  are  both  single  and  double  varieties,  with  reddish  flowers? 
with  variegated  red  and  white  flowers,  with  variegated  red,  white, 
and  purple  flowers,  with  variegated  red,  scarlet,  purple,  and  white 
flowers,  and  with  variegated  red  or  purple  above  and  white  under- 
neath. 

The  Carnations  are  distinguished  by  modern  florists,  from  the 
difference  of  variegation,  into  four  classes: — as  Flakes,  having  two 
colours  only,  and  their  stripes  large,  going  quite  through  the  leaves. 
Bizarres,  with  flowers  striped  or  variegated  with  three  or  four  different 
colours,  in  irregular  spots  and  stripes.  Piquettes,  having  a  white 
ground,  spotted  or  pounced  with  scarlet,  red,  purple,  or  other  colours. 
Painted  Ladies,  with  the  petals  of  a  red  or  purple  colour  on  the  upper 
side,  and  entirely  white  underneath. 

Each  of  these  classes  have  numerous  sub-varieties,  especially  the 
third,  which  was  formerly  in  most  esteem  with  florists;  but  of  late 
years  the  Flakes  have  been  in  greater  request.     It  is  useless  however 
'to  enumerate  their  sub-varieties,  as  they  are  not  by  any  means  per- 
manent. 

The  properties  of  a  good  Carnation  are  thus  stated  by  florists: — 
The  stem  of  the  flower  should  be  straight,  strong,  and  able  to  sup- 
port the  weight  of  the  flower  without  hanging  down:  the  flower  at 
least  not  less  than  from  thirty  to  forty-five  inches  high:  the  petals 
well  formed,  long,  broad,  stiff,  and  pretty  easy  to  expand,  or,  as  the 
florists  term  it,  make  free  flowers,  being  neither  too  close  nor  too  thin; 
the  middle  of  the  flower  not  advanced  too  high  above  the  other  parts; 
the  colours  bright,  and  equally  marked  all  over  the  flower:  the  flower 
very  full  of  petals,  so  as  to  render  it,  when  blown,  very  thick  in  the 
middle,  with  the  outside  perfectly  round.  And  Martyn  adds,  "  that 
the  lower  or  outer  circle  of  petals,  commonly  called  the  guard  leaves, 
should  be  particularly  substantial;  should  rise  perpendicularly  about 


172 

half  an  inch  above  the  calyx,  and  then  turn  off  graceful!}'  in  a  hori- 
zontal direction,  supporting  the  interior  petals,  which  should  decrease 
gradually  in  size  as  they  approach  the  centre,  which  should  be  well 
filled  with  them.  All  the  petals  should  be  regularly  disposed,  and 
lie  over  each  other  in  such  a  manner  as  that  their  respective  and 
united  beauties  may  meet  the  eye  all  together ;  they  should  be  nearly 
flat,  or  at  most  have  a  small  degree  of  inflection  at  the  broad  end; 
their  edges  perfectly  entire,  without  notch,  fringe,  or  indenture.  The 
calyx  should  be  at  least  an  inch  in  length,  sufficiently  strong  at  top 
to  keep  the  bases  of  the  petals  in  a  close  and  circular  body:  the 
colours  distinct,  and  the  stripes  regular,  narrowing  gradually  to  the 
claw  of  the  petal,  and  there  ending  in  a  fine  point.  Almost  one  half 
of  each  petal  should  be  of  a  clear  white,  free  from  spots." 

These  properties  are,  however,  chiefly  expected  in  the  fine  potted 
varieties,  which  on  coming  into  blow  are  usually  placed  together 
upon  a  stand  or  stage  considerably  raised  and  covered,  in  order  to 
produce  the  fullest  effect,  and  by  protecting  them  to  continue  longer 
in  beauty. 

The  double  varieties,  as  being  more  large  and  beautiful  in  their 
colours,  should  be  principally  cultivated.  Some  of  them,  especially 
the  Bursters,  are  extremely  large,  as  three  or  four  inches  in  diameter 
over  the  crown. 

Whole  Blowers  and  Bursters  are  common  to  most  of  the  varieties, 
especially  the  Flakes  and  Bizarres ;  the  former  are  those  in  which 
the  calyx  or  outer  cup  is  long  and  of  equal  growth,  opening  regularly 
each  way  only  at  top,  to  admit  a  free  and  equal  expansion  of  the 
petals  all  round:  the  flowers  in  these,  though  somewhat  smaller,  are 
more  equally  expanded,  and  require  less  trouble  in  the  manage- 
ment of  their  bloom  than  in  the  Bursters.  The  latter  are  those  in 
which  the  cup  is  large,  and  as  it  were  swollen,  being  liable  to  burst 
on  one  side,  and  permit  the  petal  to  break  out  and  produce  irregular 
flowers,  if  care  be  not  taken  to  prevent  it  by  tying,  and  opening  the 
calyx  a  little  on  the  opposite  side.  The  Whole  Blotters  are  OH  this 
account  the  more  convenient  for  culture,  where  much  time  cannot 
be  spared  in  attending  to  the  flowers. 


173 

The  third  species  has  numerous  barren  stems,  reclining  and  pulling 
forth  roots,  the  flowering  stems  from  six  to  eight  inches  high,  colum- 
nar below,  square  at  top,  slender,  weak,  but  usually  erect,  some- 
times simple,  sometimes  branched  or  dichotomous,  swollen  at  the 
joints,  slightly  pubescent:  the  leaves  are  in  pairs  at  each  joint,  linear 
or  subulate,  nearly  the  length  of  the  internode,  converging  to  the  slalk, 
and  embracing  it  at  the  base,  slightly  pubescent;  those  of  the  barren 
branches  narrower:  the  peduncles  are  round,  downy,  from  the  ends 
of  the  stem  and  branches,  single,  or  two  from  the  same  joint,  each 
bearing  one  flower:  the  petals  are  toothed  at  the  edge,  bright  red 
above,  pale  beneath;  but  according  to  Ray  reddish,  with  a  ring  of 
deeper-coloured  dots  surrounding  the  eye;  with  dark  purplish  teeth 
near  the  throat,  and  beset  with  while  silvery  points,  with  hairs  pro- 
ceeding from  them:  the  petals  vary  much  in  colour,  being  some- 
times of  a  very  pale  flesh  colour,  sometimes  deep  red,  but  always 
marked  with  a  ring  of  deeper  red  dots  near  the  centre  of  the  flower. 
It  is  a  native  of  Sweden,  &c. 

There  is  a  cultivated  variety  in  gardens  with  white  flowers,  with 
a  beautiful  purple  ring,  and  leaves  rather  more  glaucous  than  in  the 
common  sort. 

The  fourth  species  has  the  stems  ascending,  a  foot  or  eighteen 
inches  in  height,  and  branched :  the  leaves  of  a  grayish  or  glaucous 
hue,  a  line  and  half  wide,  very  sharp  at  the  end:  the  flowers  one, 
two,  seldom  three,  at  the  ends  of  the  branches,  and  sweet-scented: 
the  calyx  is  of  a  glaucous-green,  longer  than  in  the  other  species : 
the  petals  large,  light  red  or  bright  purple,  sometimes  white,  with  a 
circle  of  red;  deeply  jagged,  having  a  red  down  at  the  base  of  the 
lamina  or  border.  It  is  a  native  of  Europe;  flowering  from  June  to 
August,  and  is  perennial. 

The  fifth,  according  to  Dr.  Smith,  has  a  woody  root:  the  stalks 
several,  a  span  high,  erect,  simple,  smooth,  quadrangular,  having 
two  or  three  pair  of  leaves  on  them,  one-flowered,  scarcely  ever  two- 
flowered:  the  leaves  are  linear-lanceolate,  bluntish,  glaucous:  the 
scales  of  the  calyx  only  one  third  of  the  length  of  the  tube,  ovate- 
roundish,  bluntly  mucronate  and  striated :  the  petals  are  flesh-coloured, 


174 

with  a  double  row  of  blunt  notches,  marked  with  lines,  and  bearded 
at  the  base.     It  is  a  native  of  Switzerland. 

In  the  sixth,  the  flower-stems  are  from  six  to  eight  or  nine  inches 
high,  branching  out  on  every  side;  the  branches  grow  erect,  and 
are  terminated  each  by  one  flower:  the  flowers  have  no  scent,  but, 
having  a  great  variety  of  colours,  they  are  a  considerable  ornament 
to  the  flower-garden  from  July  until  the  autumn :  they  have  been 
greatly  improved  by  culture;  some  flowers  being  as  lull  of  petals  as 
the  best  double  Pinks,  and  display  the  most  gloAving  and  vivid  red 
colours.  It  is  a  native  of  China. 

Marty n  observes,  that  the  roots  often  last  two  years  in  a  dry  soil; 
but  they  arc  generally  raised  from  seeds  annually.  In  the  nursery- 
grounds  it  is  generally  known  by  the  name  of  Indian  Pink.  Dr. 
Smith  mentions  having  had  a  plant  from  Mr.  Sikes's,  which  seemed 
to  be  a  mule  between  this  and  the  first  species. 

There  are  varieties  with  red  flowers,  Avith  purple  flowers,  with 
white  flowers,  with  variegated  flowers,  each  single  and  double,  and 
imperial  large-flowered. 

The  seventh  species  has  the  sterna  foot  or  eighteen  inches  in 
height,  procumbent  at  the  base,  and  then  erect,  round,  somewhat 
two-edged  on  the  upper  part,  smooth,  branching  only  at  top:  the 
leaves  are  like  those  of  narrow-leaved  Sweet-Wittiatri,  connale,  lan- 
ceolate-linear or  linear  subulate,  acute,  quite  entire,  bright  green, 
smooth,  marked  with  lines  and  a  rising  nerve,  rough  on  the  edge, 
green  not  glaucous:  the  flowers  arc  erect,  usually  two  terminating 
each  branch,  on  short  peduncles;  sometimes  there  are  more,  and 
sometimes  only  one:  petals  pale  red,  sometimes  white,  sprinkled 
with  bloody  spots:  they  smell  very  sweet,  especially  in  the  evening. 
It  is  supposed  by  some  perennial,  but  by  others  biennial,  or  annual. 
It  succeeds  best  in  a  calcareous  soil.  It  is  a  native  of  Denmark, 
£c.  flowering  in  July  and  the  following  month. 

The  varieties  of  pinks  principally  cultivated  in  the  garden  are  as 
below,  flowering  in  the  following  order. 

The  Damask  Pink,  which  is  the  first  of  the  double  sorts  in  flower; 
it  has  but  a  short  stalk;  the  flower  is  not  very  large,  nor  so  doable 


175 

as  in  many  others;  the  colour  is  of  a  pale  purple,  inclining  to  red. 
It  is  very  sweet  in  its  smell. 

The  White  Shock,  which  is  thus  denominated  from  the  whiteness 
of  its  flowers,  and  the  borders  of  the  petals  being  much  jagged  and 
fringed:  the  flower-stalks  are  eight  or  ten  inches  in  height.  Its  scent 
is  not  so  agreeable  as  in  some  other  sorts. 

The  Pheasant's  Eye,  of  which  there  are  different  varieties,  and 
frequently  new  ones  introduced,  some  of  which  have  very  large 
double  flowers;  those  which  burst  their  pods  are  the  least  esteemed. 
They  have  firm  flower-stems,  eight  or  ten  inches  high :  the  flowers 
large,  whitish,  or  blush-coloured,  with  dark  purple  spots  in  the 
middle.  That  sort  of  Pheasant's  Eye  called  Bat's  Pink  often  flowers 
again  in  autumn. 

The  Cob  Pink,  the  stalks  of  which  are  much  taller  than  in  those  of 
the  former  sorts;  twelve  or  fifteen  inches  high  ;  the  flowers  very  double, 
and  of  a  bright  red  colour ;  it  has  the  most  agreeable  odour  of  all  the 
sorts  ;  flowering  from  the  latter  end  of  May  to  the  middle  of  July. 

The  Old  Man's  Head  Pink,  and  the  Painted  Lady,  flower  in  July, 
at  the  same  time  with  the  Carnation,  to  which  they  are  more  nearly 
allied  than  to  the  Pink.  The  first,  when  in  its  proper  colours,  is 
purple  and  white  striped  and  spotted,  but  it  is  frequently  of  one  plain 
colour,  as  purple:  it  continues  flowering  till  the  frost  in  autumn  puts 
a  stop  to  it,  and  the  flower  having  an  agreeable  scent  renders  it  va- 
luable. The  latter  is  chiefly  admired  for  the  liveliness  of  its  colour; 
as  it  is  not  so  sweet,  or  of  so  long  continuance,  as  the  other. 

The  Clove  Pink  has  a  large  deep  red  flower,  affording  a  strong 
scent  of  the  Clove. 

Martyn  thinks  it  probable  that  the  Red  Pinks  take  their  rise  from 
the  Carnation,  Avhilst  the  Pheasant's  Eye  Pinks  seem  to  derive  their 
origin  from  the  fourth.  Some  give  them  all  as  variations  of  the 
third ;  which  is  not,  he  conceives,  likely. 

There  are  single  and  double  flowers  of  each  of  these  sorts. 

Culture. — Though  the  culture  in  these  ornamental  plants  is  effected 
without  much  difficulty,  considerable  attention  is  necessary  in  the 


176 

management  of  some  of  the  sorts,  to  have  them  flower  in  the  utmost 
perfection  and  beauty. 

Culture  in  the  Sweet-William  Kind. — The  single  sorts  of  these 
plants  are  readily  increased  by  sowing  seed  which  has  been  carefully 
collected  in  a  bed  of  light  earth,  that  has  not  been  much  enriched 
by  manure,  in  the  latter  end  of  March  or  beginning  of  the  following 
month,  either  over  the  surface  or  in  slight  drills,  covering  it  in  well: 
when  the  plants  have  attained  a  proper  growth,  as  about  the  latter 
end  of  June,  they  should  be  removed  and  set  out  on  other  small 
beds  prepared  for  them,  planting  them  out  six  or  eight  inches  dis- 
tant each  way,  watering  them  and  keeping  them  perfectly  free  from 
weeds  till  the  following  autumn  or  spring,  when  they  must  be  taken 
up  with  good  balls  of  earth  about  their  roots,  and  set  out  where  they 
are  to  flower.  It  is  by  this  method  that  new  varieties  are  produced. 
Although  these  plants  are  perennial,  they  should  be  raised  every 
year  from  seed,  to  have  them  blow  strong  and  in  perfection. 

These  and  the  double  sorts  may  be  continued  by  slips  or  layers. 
In  the  former  mode  the  slips  should  be  planted  out  either  in  the 
early  autumn  or  spring  months  where  they  are  to  remain,  giving 
them  a  little  water  at  the  time,  when  the  weather  is  dry.  When  the 
slips  are  taken  from  the  young  plants,  they  should  be  made  quite 
down  to  the  roots,  so  as  to  have  fibres  to  them.  In  this  way  the 
plants  are  often  good  and  flower  well.  Cuttings  or  pipings  managed 
in  the  same  way  also  succeed  well. 

In  the  latter  method  the  more  tender  branches  should  be  laid 
down  in  the  summer  months,  water  being  frequently  given  when  the 
weather  is  hot  and  dry-  After  the}'  have  taken  root  perfectly  they 
should  be  separated  or  taken  off,  and  planted  out  where  they  are  to 
remain,  or  in  beds  of  light  earth,  to  be  afterwards  removed,  a  little 
water  being  given  at  the  time.  A  few  of  the  best  should  be  potted  in 
the  beginning  of  autumn,  in  order  to  be  more  conveniently  removed 
under  shelter  during  the  severity  of  winter. 

These  plants  should  neither  be  kept  too  moist  or  dry,  as  in 
both  situations  they  are  liable  to  sustain  much  injury  by  the  canker. 


177 

The  seed  for  the  culture  of  these  plants  should  be  collected,  when 
perfectly  ripened,  from  the  best  and  most  perfect  flowers  which  have 
grown  at  a  distance  from  any  bad  or  inferior  plants,  and  be  kept  in 
a  dry  situation. 

Culture  in  the  Gillijlower  or  Carnation  Kind. — These  plants  may  be 
raised  with  facility  in  the  beds  or  borders  of  pleasure-grounds  or  gar- 
dens where  the  soil  is  moderately  light  and  dry;  but  in  order  to  have' 
them  in  the  greatest  superiority  and  perfection,  it  is  the  practice  of 
florists  to  employ  a  compost  prepared  by  mixing  the  surface  vege- 
table mould  of  old  pastures  with  well  rotted  stable-dung  from  old 
hot-beds,  or  neat's  dung  in  the  same  stale  and  sea-sand,  in  the  pro- 
portion of  a  third  of  the  former  and  a  fourth  of  the  latter.  These  ma- 
terials should  be  well  blended,  and  lie  for  a  considerable  length  of 
time,  being  frequently  turned  before  they  are  made  use  of.  This 
mould  may  be  employed  both  for  filling  the  pots  with  and  for  form- 
ing the  beds;  and  in  preparing  it  for  these  purposes  it  should  not 
be  sifted  fine,  but  merely  well  broken  down  and  reduced  by  the 
spade. 

These  flowers  may  be  increased  and  new  ones  produced  by  seeds, 
which  should  be  sown  on  beds  formed  of  the  above  compost,  or  on 
the  common  borders  of  light  fine  mould,  from  about  the  middle  of 
March  to  the  same  period  in  the  following  month,  raking  it  in  evenly 
to  the  depth  of  a  quarter  of  an  inch,  giving  slight  waterings  when 
necessary,  to  promote  their  vegetation.  The  fine  sorts  are  likewise 
often  sown  in  pots  or  boxes,  in  order  that  they  may  be  readily  placed 
so  as  to  have  only  the  morning  sun  when  the  season  is  hot  and 
dry. 

After  the  plants  are  come  up  they  should  be  kept  clear  from 
weeds,  and  be  watered  occasionally,  and  about  July,  when  the  wea- 
ther is  moist,  be  taken  up  and  pricked  out  in  nursery-rows  on  beds 
three  feet  in  width,  setting  them  six  inches  distant,  and  watering 
them  well  at  the  lime  and  afterwards  till  they  have  taken  fresh 
root. 

At  the  beginning  of  autumn,  as  about  September,  they  will  havf 

2  A 


178 

attained  a  large  growth,  and  require  to  be  removed  into  other  beds 
or  situations  for  flowering,  in  which  they  should  be  set  out  in  rows 
eight  or  nine  inches  distant  each  way.  Some  place  them  in  the 
quincunx  manner,  as  producing  a  better  effect.  In  this  situation 
they  should  be  protected  in  severe  weather  during  the  winter  by  the 
application  of  mats  upon  hoops  placed  over  the  beds.  The  culture 
they  require  in  these  beds  is  merely  that  of  keeping  them  free  from 
weeds,  occasionally  stirring  the  earth  between  them  by  a  hoe,  and  as 
their  flower-stalks  advance  giving  them  the  support  of  handsome 
sticks.  They  should  remain  in  these  situations  till  they  flower,  after 
which  the  singles  should  be  taken  out  and  made  use  of  as  there  may 
be  occasion,  in  order  to  afford  full  room  for  the  double  sorts,  the 
finest  and  most  perfect  of  which  being  made  stage  or  principal  flow- 
ers, and  the  others  set  out  in  the  borders;  the  whole  being  increased 
as  there  may  be  necessity  by  layering  both  the  first  and  succeeding 
years. 

The  layer  method  is  that  which  is  principally  employed  in  in- 
creasing and  continuing  particular  varieties,  as  being  the  most  cer- 
tain. For  this  purpose  the  radical  leafy  shoots  proceeding  from  the 
crowns  of  the  plants,  when  of  six  or  eight  inches  growth,  are  the 
most  proper.  These  should  be  laid  down  into  the  earth  about  the 
latter  end  of  June  or  beginning  of  the  following  month.  The  work 
is  performed  by  stripping  off  the  leaves  from  the  lower  part  of  the 
shoot,  cutting  off  a  little  of  the  top,  and  then  fixing  upon  a  strong 
joint  about  the  middle,  to  slit  it  with  a  sharp  knife  nearly  half  way 
through  in  a  slanting  manner,  so  as  nearly  to  reach  the  joint  above, 
forming  a  sort  of  tongue  on  the  under  side  of  the  shoot,  removing  the 
bark  from  the  enlarged  part  or  joint  to  promote  the  striking  root. 
The  mould  about  the  root  of  the  plant  should  then  be  stirred,  and 
fresh  added  where  it  is  wanting,  forming  a  slight  drill  or  opening  for 
the  branch  to  be  gently  laid  down  into  in  a  horizontal  manner  with 
the  Cut  part  in  the  earth,  the  top  being  left  out  and  raised  a  little  to 
keep  the  slit  open,  pegging  the  main  part  of  the  branch  down  by 
-hort  hooked  slicks,  drawing  the  earth  over  the  cut  part.  When  this 


179 

method  1ms  been  practised  on  all  the  branches,  a  good  watering 
should  be  given  to  settle  the  mould  about  them,  and  frequently 
repeated  when  the  season  is  dry. 

When  the  layers  thus  formed  have  stricken  good  roots,  which  is 
mostly  the  case  in  six  or  eight  weeks,  they  should  be  taken  off  with 
the  root-fibres  as  entire  as  possible,  and  after  having  the  sticky  parts 
about  the  bottom  and  the  top  leaves  trimmed  off,  be  planted  out 
either  in  pots  or  beds,  in  the  latter  method  at  six  or  eight  inches 
distance,  with  a  dibble,  a  good  watering  being  immediately  given, 
and  repeated  every  two  days  for  ten  days  or  a  fortnight  till  the  plants 
become  well  rooted.  They  should  be  removed  from  these  beds  with 
balls  of  earth  about  their  roots  in  the  beginning  of  the  autumn  into 
small  pots,  to  have  shelter  during  the  winter,  and  in  the  early  spring 
be  placed  in  large  ones  for  flowering;  but  when  there  is  room,  it  is 
a  better  practice  to  plant  them  at  once  in  the  pots,  as  frequent  trans- 
planting injures  their  growth.  Some  florists,  however,  think  it  bene- 
ficial. 

The  less  fine  sorts  may  at  the  above  season  be  planted  out  in  the 
clumps,  borders,  or  other  parts,  or  be  left  in  the  beds  for  flowering. 

These  flowers  may  likewise  be  increased  by  cuttings  or  pipings 
in  the  manner  directed  below  in  raising  pinks. 

In  the  winter  management  of  the  plants,  the  fine  potted  sorts 
should  about  November  be  removed  under  the  protection  of  a  deep 
frame  covered  with  glasses,  and  plunged  closely  together  in  a  slight 
bed  of  old  tan,  dry  sand,  or  earth.  In  this  situation  they  should  have 
a  free  admission  of  air  when  the  weather  is  mild,  but  be  covered  in 
frost,  and  care  should  be  taken  that  there  be  no  stagnation  of  mois- 
ture, by  the  holes  in  the  bottoms  of  the  pots  being  obstructed. 

The  flowers  in  the  beds  should  be  covered  by  mats  or  other  con- 
trivances when  the  weather  is  severe  at  the  same  season. 

In  the  spring  their  culture  should  be  continued  by  removing 
those  fine  varieties  planted  out  in  small  pots  in  the  autumn  into  large 
ones  for  flowering,  and  such  as  have  remained  in  the  nur&ery-beds 
into  the  borders  or  large  pots  nine  or  ten  inches  over  at  top,  to  afford 
flowers,  in  each  of  which  the  business  should  be  done  by  preserving 


180 

balls  of  earth  about  their  roots,  about  the  beginning  of  March  or  the 
following  month.  The  work  is  performed  by  closing  the  holes  iu 
tlie  bottoms  of  the  pots  with  pieces  of  oyster  shells  or  tiles,  then 
filling  them  half  way  up  with  the  earth  prepared  as  above,  placing 
the  plants  with  their  balls  of  earth  in  them,  and  filling  up  the  vacan- 
cies on  the  sides  with  more  fresh  mould,  closing  it  well  up  about  the 
bodies  of  the  plants  so  as  they  may  stand  nearly  as  high  as  the  tops 
of  the  pots,  giving  a/good  watering  at  the  time. 

When  the  plants  have  been  thus  potted  they  should  be  placed  in 
a  sheltered  sunny  situation  in  the  open  air,  being  frequently  refreshed 
with  water  in  hot  dry  weather. 

It  is  the  practice  with  some  florists  to  plant  two  flowers  in  a  large 
pot ;  but  it  is  better  as  well  as  more  convenient  for  layering  only  to 
have  one,  the  plants  flowering  stronger  and  making  more  free  shoots. 

In  the  summer  treatment  of  the  flowers  the  care  of  frequent  wa- 
tering should  be  continued  when  the  weather  is  hot  and  droughty, 
and  the  surface  mould  be  occasionally  stirred  to  promote  the  growth 
and  preserve  neatness;  and  when  the  flower-stalks  are  a  little  ad- 
vanced, handsome  painted  sticks  should  be  placed  for  their  support, 
both  in  the  pots  and  other  situations,  to  which  they  should  be  neatly 
tied  as  they  proceed  in  their  growth.  When  they  approach  the  pe- 
riod of  flowering,  the  curious  sorts  should  be  removed  to  a  stage 
constructed  for  the  purposse,  and  provided  with  an  awning  to  pro- 
tect them  from  being  injured  by  the  scorching  heat  of  the  sun  in  the 
middle  of  the  day,  and  the  effects  of  too  much  wet,  by  which  they  are 
continued  much  longer  in  beauty. 

Stages  of  this  nature  are  formed  in  different  methods,  according 
to  the  fancy  of  the  persons  who  make  use  of  them.  The  following 
is  a  neat  mode  of  constructing  such  apparatus:  a  platform  is  erected 
at  the  height  of  eighteen  inches  or  two  feet,  constituted  of  two  ranges 
of  planks,  in  order  to  contain  two  rows  of  pots,  sustained  by  posts 
in  one  or  two  rows  underneath  with  an  open-work  roof  five  or  six 
feet  in  height,  covered  by  means  of  painted  canvass,  or  some  other 
suitable  material,  the  whole  being  supported  by  upright  posts,  accord- 
ing to  the  taste  of  the  proprietor. 


181 

,     The  body  of  the  stage  should  be  neatly  painted,  for  the  purpose  of 
effect  as  well  as  preservation. 

Instead  of  these  stages  some  make  use  of  a  sort  of  caps  or 
umbrellas  formed  of  tin  or  other  materials,  supported  on  stems  or 
sticks,  one  for  each  plant;  but  these  are  neither  so  convenient  nor 
afford  so  good  an  effect  as  the  former  in  displaying  the  beauties  of 
the  flowers. 

But  whatever  contrivances  are  made  use  of  for  the  protection  and 
display  of  these  curious  flowers,  the  tying  of  the  plants  to  the  support- 
sticks  should  be  continued  as  the  stems  advance;  and  some  curious 
florists  contrive  to  keep  them  erect  at  the  tops  by  the  use  of  fine  wire 
or  other  similar  means.  And  in  order  to  procure  the  flowers  as  large 
and  fine  as  possible,  they  trim  off  all  the  side-shoots  from  the  steins, 
leaving  only  one  or  two  of  the  top  flower-buds  to  expand.  When 
the  flowers  begin  to  open,  care  should  be  taken  to  prevent  their 
bursting  and  expanding  in  an  irregular  manner,  especially  in  the 
bursters,  by  making  a  little  opening  or  two  in  the  indentings  at  the 
top  at  equal  distances  in  other  places,  by  means  of  fine  small  pointed 
scissars.  The  regular  expansion  of  the  flowers  may  likewise  be  much 
assisted,  especially  where  one  side  is  more  expanded  than  the  other, 
and  they  are  in  pots,  by  turning  the  pots,  that  the  contrary  sides  may 
have  the  full  influence  of  the  sun. 

Some  florists  likewise,  to  blow  the  curious  sorts  as  broad  and  fine 
as  possible,  make  use  of  a  kind  of  spreading,  stiff,  white  paper  collar, 
cut  open  on  one  side  and  placed  round  the  bottoms  of  the  flowers  to 
expand  the  petals  upon  to  the  utmost  extent;  but  the  practice  is  not 
in  general  advisable. 

As  these  plants  flower  less  perfectly  as  they  increase  in  age,  it  is 
proper  to  provide  fresh  supplies  of  new  varieties  of  them  annually  by 
sowing  seed  obtained  from  the  best  sorts  in  the  spring  season,  as 
directed  above,  and  likewise  to  continue  the  most  valuable  double 
varieties  by  means  of  layering  in  the  summer  months  every  year,  or 
the  planting  of  cuttings  or  pipings,  but  the  first  is  by  much  the  best 
mode. 

Tn  order  to  have  good  seed,  some  plants  of  the  best  and  most 


182 

curious  sorts  should  be  preserved  distinct,  and  suffered  to  flower  and 
ripen  their  seed  in  a  perfect  manner,  which  should  then  be  taken  off 
in  the  pods  when  the  weather  is  dry,  and,  after  being  hardened  a 
little,  rubbed  out  and  put  up  in  a  bag  to  be  placed  in  a  dry  situa- 
tion. 

Culture  in  the  Pink  Kind. — All  the  species  and  varieties  of  these 
plants  may  be  increased  from  seeds,  and  the  perennial  sorts  likewise 
by  layers,  slips,  cuttings,  and  pipings. 

Where  the  best  sorts  only  are  grown,  great  care  should  be  taken, 
in  providing  the  seed,  that  it  be  always  had  from  the  best  and  most 
perfect  kinds. 

It  should  be  sown  in  the  manner  directed  for  Carnations,  in  the 
beginning  of  March  or  the  following  month,  and  the  plants  be  ma- 
naged in  a  similar  manner,  only,  as  b&jng  more  hardy  in  their  nature, 
with  less  tenderness. 

The  sixth  species  is  best  increased  by  sowing  the  seed  on  a  very 
gentle  hot-bed  the  beginning  of  April,  as  the  vegetation  is  thereby 
much  forwarded.  When  the  plants  appear  air  should  be  admitted 
freely,  to  prevent  their  drawing  up  weak,  and  when  of  a  little  growth 
they  may  be  pricked  out  with  good  roots,  if  the  weather  be  suitable, 
on  a  bed  of  light  earth,  at  about  three  inches  distance,  proper  shade 
and  water  being  given.  When  they  are  of  considerable  growth,  as 
about  the  letter  end  of  May,  they  should  be  removed  with  good  balls 
of  earth  about  their  roots,  and  planted  where  they  are  to  remain  for 
flowering. 

The  layers  should  be  laid  down  in  the  latter  end  of  July  or  begin- 
ning of  the  following  month,  in  exactly  the  same  manner  as  has  been 
directed  for  Carnations,  giving  them  the  same  culture  in  every 
respect. 

Where  there  are  large  plants  that  spread  considerably  in  a  lateral 
manner,  their  shoots  may  be  covered  with  earth  in  the  spring  to  the 
depth  of  an  inch  or  two;  they  will  thus  often  take  root,  form  good 
plants,  and  be  in  a  state  to  be  planted  out  in  the  beginning  of  the 
autumn. 

The  slips  of  the  young  shoots  either  made  from  the  sides  of  the 


183 

principal  ones  or  from  the  roots,  so  as  to  have  fibres  to  them,  and 
planted  out  in  February  or  the  two  following  months  in  beds  of  good 
mould  to  a  good  depth,  readily  take  root  and  become  good  plants 
before  the  end  of  the  summer;  at  which  time,  or  in  the  following 
spring,  they  may  be  removed  with  good  balls  of  earth  about  their 
roots,  to  the  places  where  they  are  to  flower. 

Cuttings  made  from  the  firm  shoots  of  the  same  year  at  the  joints, 
to  the  length  of  three  or  four  inches,  when  planted  pretty  deeply  in  a 
bed  of  very  fine  mould,  or  in  large  pots  at  the  distance  of  an  inch  or 
two,  and  well  watered  at  the  time,  readily  grow  and  become  plants 
after  being  transplanted  into  separate  pots,  or  the  borders  where  they 
are  to  flower. 

Pipings  made  by  drawing  out  or  breaking  off  the  top  parts  of  the 
young  shoots  at  the  joints  and  trimming  them,  by  which  a  sort  of 
pipe  is  formed,  on  being  planted  and  managed  in  the  same  manner, 
take  root  and  afford  plants. 

In  both  these  last  methods  the  rooting  of  the  shoots  is  greatly 
promoted  by  their  being  closely  covered  by  bell,  hand,  or  other  sorts 
of  glasses,  and  having  frequent  slight  waterings  given  round  the  sides 
of  -them. 

The  seed  of  the  different  best  sorts  should  be  collected  in  the  pods 
in  August  or  the  following  month  when  perfectly  ripened,  choosing 
a  dry  season  for  the  purpose,  spreading  them  out  to  harden  and  be- 
come dry  on  paper  or  in  some  other  manner,  after  which  it  should 
be  rubbed  out  and  kept  in  some  dry  situation  till  it  is  wanted. 

All  the  different  species  and  varieties  of  these  plants  are  highly 
ornamental,  and  many  of  them  curious,  affording  an  extremely  fra- 
grant smell. 

The  first  sort  in  all  the  varieties  may  be  made  use^f  in  the  bord- 
ers, clumps,  and  other  places,  where  they  produce  a  fine  effect  by 
the  variety  of  their  flowers  in  assemblage  with  others  of  similar 
growth. 

A  few  of  the  double  more  curious  kinds  may  also  be  cultivated 
in  pots  for  adorning  the  more  conspicuous  places  about  the  house. 

The  second  species  and  all  the  different  varieties  of  the  Carnation 


184 

kind  are  proper  ornamental  plants  for  the  fronts  of  clumps,  borders, 
and  other  principal  parts  of  gardens  or  ornamented  grounds,  where 
they  have  a  very  agreeable  effect  from  the  beauty  and  elegance  of 
their  flowers,  as  well, as  the  fragrance  which  they  afford. 

The  curious  double  sorts  are  mostly  cultivated  in  pots  for  the  con- 
venience of  protection,  and  being  exhibited  on  stages  or  in  particular 
situations  during  the  time  of  their  blowing,  as  well  as  for  the  ease 
and  facility  of  removal  when  necessary. 

The  third  sort  and  the  different  varieties  of  the  common  pink  are 
well  adapted  for  producing  ornament  in  the  fore  parts  of  beds,  borders, 
and  other  compartments  of  pleasure-grounds  and  gardens,  both  from 
the  multiplicity  of  their  flowers  and  their  beauty,  as  well  as  fragrant 
smell.  These  are  sometimes  used  for  edgings,  but  from  their  spread- 
ing growth  they  require  frequent  cutting  in. 

The  fourth  and  fifth  sorts  may  likewise  be  employed  for  the  pur- 
pose of  affording  a  greater  variety. 

The  sixth  species  is  very  ornamental  from  the  fineness  of  the  co- 
lour of  the  flowers,  and  the  great  length  of  time  which  the}7  continue 
in  bloom. 

It  is  observed  by  Martyn  that  the  seventh  species,  from  the  ele- 
gance and  delicious  fragrance  of  its  flowers,  is  deserving  of  being 
employed  in  all  curious  gardens. 

In  the  planting  out  the  various  sorts,  the  annual  kinds  are  mostly 
disposed  in  patches  of  three  or  four  plants  in  each;  but  the  peren- 
nial kinds  singly,  as  being  more  bushy  and  spreading  in  their 
growth. 

All  the  several  species  and  varieties  of  these  flowery  plants  may 
be  brought  to  blow  much  more  early  by  being  cultivated  in  frames 
or  the  hot-house. 


\ 


It  2 2 


Mt'tit/.r      l)(><Ji<-i' 


t 


PLATE  XXII. 

1.  DODECATHEON  MEADIA, 

MEAD'S  DODECOTHEAN. 

THIS  genus  furnishes  a  plant  of  the  low  flowering  perennial  kind- 
It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Pentandria  Monogynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Precice. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  many-leaved,  many-flow- 
ered involucre,  very  small:  perianthium  one-leafed,  half  five-cleft, 
permanent:  divisions  reflex,  finally  longer,  permanent:  the  corolla 
one-petalled,  five-parted:  tube  shorter  than  the  calyx:  (naked  at  the 
throat)  border  reflex:  divisions  very  long,  lanceolate:  the  stamina  con- 
sists of  five  filaments,  very  short,  obtuse,  seated  on  the  tube:  anthers 
sagittate,  converging  into  a  beak  :  the  pistillum  is  a  conic  germ:  style 
filiform,  longer  than  the  stamens:  stigma  obtuse:  the  pericarpium 
is  an  oblong,  one-celled  capsule,  gaping  at  the  tip:  (subcylindric, 
opening  into  five  parts):  the  seeds  very  many,  and  small:  receptacle 
free,  small. 

The  only  species  is  D.  Meadea,  Virginian  Cowslip,  or  Meadea. 
It  has  a  yellow  perennial  root,  from  which  come  out  in  the  spring 
several  long  smooth  leaves,  near  six  inches  long,  and  two  and  a  half 
broad;  at  first  standing  erect,  but  afterwards  spreading  on  the  ground, 
especially  when  much  exposed  to  the  sun:  from  among  these  leaves 
arise  two,  three,  or  four  flower-stalks,  in  proportion  to  the  strength  of 
the  roots,  which  rise  eight  or  nine  inches  high,  smooth,  naked,  and 
terminated  by  an  umbel  of  flowers,  which  are  purple,  inclining  to  a 
peach  blossom  colour.  It  is  native  of  Virginia,  flowering  about  the 
end  of  April  or  beginning  of  the  following  month. 

Culture. — The  methods  of  propagation  in  this  plant  are  either  by 
seeds,  or  off-sets  from  the  roots;  but  the  last  is  the  best. 

2  B 


186 

In  the  first,  the  seeds  should  be  sown  either  in  the  autumn,  soon 
after  they  are  fully  ripened,  or  in  the  spring,  in  a  moist  shady  spot, 
or  in  pots  to  be  placed  in  such  situations.  When  the  plants  appear, 
they  should  be  kept  free  from  weeds,  and  have  occasional  water  when 
the  weather  is  dry,  being  shaded  from  the  heat  of  the  sun.  When 
the  stems  decay,  the}'  may  be  carefully  removed  and  planted  in  moist 
shady  places,  at  the  distance  of  twelve  or  eighteen  inches,  to  remain 
till  the  following  autumn,  when  they  should  be  finally  planted  in  the 
borders  and  other  places  where  there  are  due  shade  and  moisture. 

The  roots  may  be  removed,  and  the  off-sets  carefully  taken  off 
from  them  about  the  latter  end  of  August  or  the  following  month, 
and  immediately  planted  in  such  situations  as  the  above,  when  they 
will  be  fully  established  before  the  frosts  set  in. 

These  plants  are  found  to  be  hardy,  but  incapable  of  succeeding 
in  dry  soils  or  sunny  situations.  They  afford  ornament  in  the  beds, 
borders,  or  other  parts  of  pleasure-grounds. 


2.   D1CTAMNUS   ALBUS. 

WHITE    FRAXINELLA. 


THIS  genus  affords  a  plant  of  the  herbaceous  hardy  flowering  pe- 
rennial kind. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Decandria  Monogynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Multisiliqua. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  five-leaved  perianthium, 
very  small,  deciduous:  leaflets  oblong,  acuminate:  the  corolla  has 
five  petals,  oval-lanceolate,  acuminate,  with  claws,  unequal;  of  which 
two  are  bent  upwards;  two  placed  obliquely  at  the  sides;  one  bent 
downwards:  the  stamina  consist  of  ten  subulate  filaments,  length  of 
the  corolla,  situated  between  the  two  lateral  declining  petals,  une- 
qual; small  point-like  glands  scattered  over  the  filaments;  anthers 


187 

four-sided,  rising  upwards :  the  pistillum  is  a  five-cornered  germ, 
elevated  from  the  receptacle:  style  simple,  short,  bent  downwards, 
incurved:  stigma  sharp,  rising  upwards:  the  pericarpium  has  five 
capsules,  conjoined  inwardly  at  the  border,  compressed,  acuminate, 
with  distant  tips,  two-valved :  the  seeds  in  pairs,  ovate,  very  smooth, 
within  a  common  aril,  which  is  two-valved,  and  cut  down. 

The  species  cultivated  is  D.  albus,  Fraxinella,  or  While  Dittany. 

It  has  a  perennial  root,  striking  deep  into  the  ground,  and  the 
head  annually  increasing  in  size:  the  stalks  many,  two  or  three  feet 
high,  round,  here  and  there  slightly  grooved,  sometimes  subancipi- 
tal,  not  branched,  at  bottom  green  and  beset  with  white  hairs,  ferru- 
ginous-red towards  the  top,  with  resinous  glands:  the  leaves  are  alter- 
nate, the  larger  above  a  foot  in  length,  spreading  out  horizontally, 
ascending  towards  the  end;  the  midrib  flat  at  top  and  edged  on  both 
sides,  convex  beneath  and  hairy;  leaflets  from  two  to  five  pairs,  Avith 
an  odd  one  at  the  end,  most  of  them  alternate,  except  the  top  pair 
or  two,  sessile  or  subsessile,  except  the  end  one,  which  is  on  a  long 
winged  petiole,  smooth,  stiff,  oblique  except  the  end  one,  ovate, 
acute,  serrate,  shining  on  both  sides,  about  two  inches  long  and  an 
inch  wide;  the  whole  somewhat  resembling  an  Ash  leaf.  The  flowers 
in  a  long  pyramidal  loose  spike  or  raceme,  nine  or  ten  inches  long, 
of  a  purplish  colour:  the  branches  of  the  raceme  alternate,  with  a 
bracte  at  the  foot  of  each,  one  or  two-flowered ;  there  is  also  a  short, 
lanceolate,  hairy  bracte  to  each  pedicel.  To  each  flower  succeeds 
a  fruit  consisting  of  five  compressed  capsules,  spreading  out  like  the 
points  of  a  star. 

The  whole  plant,  especially  when  gently  rubbed,  emits  an  odour 
like  that  of  lemon-peel,  but  when  bruised  it  has  something  of  a  bal- 
samic scent.  It  is  a  native  of  Germany,  flowering  here  at  the  end  of 
May. 

There  are  varieties  with  white  flowers,  wilh  red  and  purple  striped, 
and  with  short  spikes  of  flowers. 

Culture.  These  plants  may  be  increased  by  sowing  the  seeds  in 
the  beds,  borders,  or  other  parts  of  pleasure-grounds  or  gardens 
where  the  plants  are  to  remain,  in  the  beginning  of  the  autumn  soon 


188 

after  they  become  ripe,  or  in  the  spring;  but  the  former  is  the  best 
season,  as  the  plants  rise  stronger  and  with  more  certainty.  The 
plants  should  afterwards  be  kept  perfectly  clear  from  weeds,  and 
have  their  stems  cut  down  and  cleared  away  every  year  in  the  au- 
tumn, as  well  as  the  earth  dug  round  them  in  the  early  spring. 
Some,  however,  advise  the  roots  of  the  plants  in  the  first  autumn  to 
be  taken  up  and  planted  out  in  small  beds  at  six  or  eight  inches 
distance  each  way,  to  stand  two  or  three  years  till  they  are  strong 
enough  to  flower,  when  they  are  to  be  carefully  taken  up  in  the  au- 
tumn, and  placed  where  they  are  to  remain.  They  continue  for  a 
great  length  of  time,  and  require  little  culture  except  that  of  being 
kept  free  from  weeds,  and  trimmed  as  above  in  the  autumn. 

They  are  plants  well  suited  to  the  middle  parts  of  beds,  border*, 
clumps,  and  other  parts  of  ornamented  grounds. 


Iry 


I.,  ll.l.ll    fulilllli.:f ,!,/,/"/ 1A'/'    !>' 


Flat  Slrtet 


r<r>6l  lnfJan<srr> 


'77    /// 

///////> 


>  /'>tc 


PLATE  XXIII. 

1.  ECHINOPS  SPH^ROCEPHALUS. 

GREAT    GLOBE    THISTLE. 

THIS  genus  contains  plants  of  the  hardy,  herbaceous,  perennial 
and  annual  kinds. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Syngenesia  Potygamia  Segregate!, 
and  ranks  in  the  natural  order  of  Composite  Capitatce. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  common,  many- leaved,  with 
scales  subulate,  totally  reflected,  containing  many  flowers :  perian- 
thium  partial  one-flowered,  oblong,  imbricate,  cornered :  leaflets 
subulate,  loose  above,  upright,  permanent:  the  corolla  one-petalled, 
length  of  the  calyx,  tubular;  border  five-cleft,  reflex,  spreading:  the 
stamina  consist  of  five  capillary  filaments,  very  short:  anthers  cylin- 
dric,  tubular,  five-toothed:  the  pistillum  is  an  oblong  germ:  style 
filiform,  length  of  the  corolla :  stigma  double,  somewhat  depressed, 
rolled  back :  there  is  no  pericarpium :  calyx  unchanged,  larger :  the 
seed  single,  ovate-oblong,  narrower  at  the  base,  with  obtuse  tip:  the 
down  obscure;  the  receptacle  common  globose  and  bristly. 

The  species  cultivated  are:  1.  E.  spheerocephalus,  Great  Globe 
Thistle;  2.  E,  ritro,  Small  Globe  Thistle;  3.  E.  strigosus,  Annual 
Globe  Thistle. 

The  first  has  a  perennial  root.  The  stalks  many,  four  or  five  feet 
high.  The  leaves  long  and  jagged,  divided  into  many  segments  al- 
most to  the  midrib,  the  jags  ending  in  spines;  they  are  of  a  dark- 
green  on  their  upper  side,  but  woolly  on  their  under.  There  are 
several  globular  heads  of  flowers  on  each  stalk.  The  florets  are  com- 
monly blue,  but  sometimes  white.  These  come  out  in  July,  and  the 
seeds  ripen  in  August.  It  is  a  native  of  France,  &c. 

It  varies  with  white  flowers. 


190 

The  second  species  has  a  perennial  creeping  root,  sending  up 
several  strong  stalks  two  feet  high,  and  branching.  The  leaves  cut 
into  many  fine  segments  to  the  mid  rib.  Each  branch  is  terminated 
by  a  globular  head  of  flowers,  smaller  than  those  of  the  first,  and  of 
a  deeper  blue,  but  sometimes  white:  they  come  out  in  July.  It  is  a 
native  of  the  South  of  France. 

It  also  varies  with  white  flowers. 

The.  third  is  an  annual  plant,  with  a  stiff  while  stalk  two  feet  high. 
The  leaves  divided,  ending  in  many  points,  which  have  spines;  their 
upper  side  green,  covered  with  brown  hairs,  their  under  side  white 
and  woolly :  the  stalk  is  terminated  by  one  large  head  of  pale  blue 
flowers,  appearing  in  July.  It  is  a  native  of  France,  &c. 

Culture. — These  plants  are  readily  increased  by  sowing  the  seeds 
in  the  autumn  in  the  places  where  the  plants  are  to  grow.  When 
they  are  come  up  in  the  spring,  they  should  be  properly  thinned  and 
kept  free  from  weeds.  Some  of  the  strongest  plants  may  likewise  be 
removed  to  other  situations.  In  the  third  sort  the  seeds  are  better 
sown  in  the  early  spring. 

They  are  well  suited  to  afford  variety  in  the  large  borders  of  gar- 
dens or  pleasure-grounds,  as  they  succeed  in  almost  any  soil. 


£.  ERYNGIUM  ALPINUM. 

ALPINE    ERYNGO, 

THIS  genus  contains  plants  of  the  hardy  flowering  biennial  and 
perennial  kind. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Pentandria  Digyiria,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Umbellate. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  common  conic  receptacle, 
chaffs  separating  the  sessile  floscules :  involucre  of  the  receptacle 
many-leaved,  flat,  exceeding  the  floscules:  perianthium  proper  five- 
Jeaved,  upright,  sharp,  exceeding  the  corolla,  seated  on  the  germ: 


191 

the  corolla  universal,  uniform,  roundish:  floscules  all  fertile:  proper 
five-petalled :  petals  oblong,  the  tips  bent  inwards  to  the  base> 
straightened  longitudinally  by  a  line:  the  stamina  consist  of  five  ca- 
pillary filaments,  straight,  exceeding  the  floscules:  anthers  oblong: 
the  pistillum  is  a  hispid  inferior  germ:  styles  two,  filiform,  straight, 
length  of  the  stamens:  stigmas  simple:  the  pericarpium  is  an  ovate 
fruit,  divisible  in  two  directions:  the  seeds  oblong,  and  columnar. 

The  species  cultivated  are :  1.  E.  fcetidum,  Stinking  Eryngo ; 
2.  E.  planum,  Flat-leaved  Eryngo;  3.  E.  maritimum,  Sea  Eryngo,  or 
Sea-Holly;  4-.E.  amethystinum,  Amethystine  Eryngo;  5.  E.  alpinum, 
Alpine  Eryngo. 

The  first  has  an  annual  or  biennial  root.  The  root-leaves  blunt- 
ish;  the  serratures  terminating  in  harmless  spines.  The  stem  a  foot 
high  or  more,  green,  somewhat  angular,  dichotomous,  spreading; 
with  the  extreme  branches  flexuose.  The  leaves  on  the  branches  op- 
posite, stem-clasping,  wedge-shaped,  subconnate,  with  the  edge 
toothed  and  semitrifid;  the  divisions  lanceolate,  all  the  angles  ter- 
minating in  a  purplish  spine.  The  peduncle  springs  from  the  angles 
of  the  stem ;  it  is  straight,  shorter  than  the  internode,  triangular, 
streaked  on  the  sides.  The  involucres  are  composed  of  six  leaflets 
or  thereabouts;  are  horizontal,  and  longer  than  the  flower;  the  leaf- 
lets are  lanceolate,  nerved,  and  have  a  spine  at  the  tip  and  at  one 
or  two  of  the  serratures.  The  common  receptacle  is  cylindric,  Avhence 
the  flower  is  cylindric.  It  is  of  a  dull  white  colour,  appearing  at  the 
divisions  and  extremities  of  the  branches.  The  whole  plant  has  a 
very  penetrating,  strong,  but  not  unsavoury  smell*  It  is  a  native  of 
Virginia,  flowering  in  June  and  July. 

The  second  species  has  a  perennial  root.  The  slem  upright,  round, 
furrowed  or  streaked,  whitish,  about  a  foot  and  half  in  height,  blueish 
at  top,  where  it  divides  into  three  parts,  each  of  which  is  terminated 
by  a  peduncled  axillary  flower.  Lower  leaves  cordate  ovate,  obtuse, 
on  long  petioles,  with  unequal,  mucronale  notches  about  the  edge; 
stem-leaves  sessile;  the  uppermost  lobed,  gashed,  smaller  serrate,  the 
notches  spinulose.  The  flowers  in  terminating  heads,  fenced  with  a 


192 

six-leaved  involucre,  spreading  and  reflex.     It  is  a  native  of  Austria, 
&c.  flowering  in  July. 

There  is  a  variety  with  white  stalks  and  flowers. 

The  third  has  a  creeping  root,  running  deep  into  the  ground. 
The  leaves  roundish,  stiff,  gray,  set  with  sharp  spines  on  the  edges. 
The  stems  a  foot  high,  branched,  smooth,  having  at  each  joint  leaves 
of  the  same  form  with  the  lower  ones,  but  smaller.  The  flowers  come 
out  at  the  ends  of  the  branches  in  roundish  prickly  heads,  and  are  of 
a  whitish  blue  colour;  under  each  head  is  a  range  of  narrow,  stiff', 
prickly  leaves,  spreading  like  the  rays  of  a  star.  The  flowers  appear 
in  July.  It  is  a  native  of  Britain,  &c.  The  young  flowering-shoots 
when  eaten  as  asparagus  are  very  grateful,  and  of  a  nourishing  qua- 
lity. 

The  fourth  species  has  the  lower  leaves  divided  like  the  fingers  of 
a  hand,  into  five  or  six  segments,  which  are  very  much  cut  at  their 
extremities  into  many  parts,  and  have  small  spines.  The  stem  is 
about  two  feet  high,  with  smaller  and  more  divided  leaves.  The 
upper  part  of  the  stem,  and  also  the  heads  of  flowers,  are  of  the  finest 
amethystine  colour,  making  a  fine  appearance.  It  is  a  native  of 
Styria,  flowering  in  July. 

The  fifth  species  has  a  perennial  root.  The  leaves  are  cordate 
and  toothed,  the  lower  on  long  petioles,  the  upper  stem-clasping. 
The  lower  leaves  resemble  those  of  Cacalia,  but  are  more  acute,  and 
the  teeth  end  in  a  soft  spine.  Amethystine  leaves  surround  the  ob- 
long head  of  flowers ;  some  of  them  bristle-form  and  reflex,  others 
pinnatifid  and  lanceolate.  It  is  curious,  according  to  Villars,  on  ac- 
count of  the  beauty  of  the  involucres,  which  are  of  a  vinous  azure 
blue,  mixed  with  green  and  white.  It  is  a  native  of  Switzer- 
land, &c. 

Culture. — Some  of  these  plants  may  be  increased  by  seed,  and 
the  others  by  planting  their  creeping  roots. 

The  first,  second,  filth,  and  sixth  sorts  are  raised  by  sowing  the 
seeds,  in  the  first  on  a  hot-bed  or  in  pots  plunged  into  it,  but  in  the 
others  in  the  autumn,  in  the  places  where  the  plants  are  to  grow. 


When  the  plants  have  attained  some  growth,  in  the  first  kind, 
they  should  be  removed  into  separate  small  pots,  filled  with  light, 
fresh,  fine  mould,  and  replunged  into  the  bark  hot-bed,  being  after- 
wards managed  as  other  exotic  plants  of  the  tender  kind.  The 
plants  usually  flower  the  second  year,  and  then  die.  In  the  other 
species  aH  the  culture  that  is  required  after  the  plants  appear  is  that 
of  thinning  them  properly,  keeping  them  free  from  weeds,  and 
digging  the  ground  about  them  in  the  early  spring  season. 

The  third  species  must  be  increased  by  planting  portions  of  the 
creeping  roots  of  the  young  plants  in  a  dry  gravelly  soil  in  the  au- 
tumn, as  soon  as  the  stems  decay.  They  grow  the  largest  and  most 
fleshy  in  the  root  in  such  situations  as  are  occasionally  overflowed 
by  the  sea- water. 

They  afterwards  only  require  the  culture  of  being  kept  free  from 
weeds. 

They  are  all  proper  for  being  introduced  in  the  borders  or  other 
parts  of  pleasure-grounds  for  variety,  except  the  first,  which  requires 
the  protection  of  the  stove. 


2   C 


PLATE    XXIV. 

1.  ERICA    GRANDIFLORA. 

GREAT-FLOWERED    HEATH. 


THIS   genus   comprehends   plants  of  the  evergreen,   flowery,, 
shrubby  kind;  mostly  exotics. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Octandria  Monogynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Bicorncs. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  four-leaved  perianthium : 
leaflets  ovate- oblong, permanent:  the  corolla  one-pctalled,  bell-form, 
four-cleft,  often  bellied:  the  stamina  consist  of  eight  filaments,  capil- 
lary, inserted  into  the  receptacle:  anthers  two-cleft  at  the  tip:  the 
pistillum  is  a  roundish,  superior  germ:  style  filiform,  upright,  longer 
than  the  stamens:  stigma  crowned,  four-cornered,  four-cleft:  the 
pericarpium  is  a  roundish  capsule,  smaller  than  the  calyx,  covered, 
four-celled,  four-valved;  partitions  meeting  with  the  sutures  (opposite 
to  the  sutures):  the  seeds  numerous  and  very  small. 

The  species  most  in  cultivation,  according  to  Martyn,  arer 
1.  E.  Tetralixy  Cross-leaved  Heath;  2.  E.cinerea,  Fine-leaved  Heath; 
3.  E.  didyma,  Double-anthered  Heath;  4.  E.  arborea,  Tree  Heath; 
5.  E.  Australis,  Spanish  Heath;  6.  E.  multiflora,  Many-flowered 
Heath;  7-  E.  Hediterranea,  Mediterranean  Heath;  8.  E.  Itttea,  Yel- 
low Heath;  9-  E.  halicacaba,  Purple-stalked  Heath;  10.  E.  mon- 
soniana,  Bladder-flowered  Heath:  11.  E.  mucosa,  Mucous  Heath: 
12.  E.  urceolaris,  Hairy- flowered  Heath;  13.  E.  marifolia,  Marum- 
leaved  Heath;  14.  E.  cruenta,  Bloody-flowered  Heath;  15.  E.  ra- 
mentacea,  Slender-branched  Heath;  16.  E.persoluta,  Blush-flowered 
Heath;  17-  E.  triflora,  Three-flowered  Heath;  18.  E.  baccans,  Ar- 
butus-flowered Heath ;  19.  E.  corifolia,  Slender-twigged  Heath ; 


fl24. 


r<ll>if«l    A    ,  I',-,/  /.',/',,, ,,;/'r 


ETTCO.      i/rr/  /v  //////  v  •// 
(;,;;f/    '//,•>,,'/•;/    //<;r//, 


f/t'/J //////         .  1//t//f,l'/t/f/7//M 

c    ixrv    ItY/d'H'    //,•/•/' 


1.93 

20.  E.  entpetrifolia,  Crow  Berry-leaved  Heath;  21.  £.  capitata,  Woolly 
Heath;  22.  E.  titbiflora^  Tube-flowered/ Heath ;  23.  E.  conspicua, 
Long-tubed  Yellow  Heath ;  24.  E.  cerinthiodes,  Honey  wort-flowered 
Heath;  25.  E.  comosa,  Tufted-flowered  Heath;  26.  E.  massoni,  Tall 
Downy  Heath;  27.  E.  Plukenetii,  Smooth-twigged  Pencil-flowered 
Heath;  28.  E.  Petiveri,  Downy-twigged  Pencil-flowered  Heath;  29. 
E.  herbacea,  Early-flowered  Dwarf  Heath;  30.  E. grandiflora,  Great- 
flowered  Heath. 

There  are  many  other  species  equally  deserving  of  cultivation. 

The  first  has  shrubby  stems,  from  nine  to  twelve  inches  high, 
branched,  brown,  somewhat  rugged  from  the  remains  of  the  leaves 
which  have  fallen  off:  branches  a  little  woolly:  the  leaves  are  com- 
monly in  fours,  but  sometimes  in  fives,  ovate-linear,  spreading,  near 
the  flowers  pressed  close  to  the  stem,  the  edges  turned  in  and  ciliated, 
each  hair  terminating  in  a  small  round  gland ;  the  upper  surface  is 
flat,  the  lower  concave  and  white:  flowers  hanging  down  one  over 
another  all  one  way.  It  is  a  native  of  the  northern  parts  of  Europe, 
flowering  in  July  and  August;  but  according  to  Linnaeus,  twice  in 
the  year. 

It  is  not  inferior  to  many  of  the  foreign  heaths  in  the  beauty  and 
delicacy  of  its  flowers.  This  is  distinguished  from  the  other  British 
heaths,  not  only  by  the  flowers  growing  in  a  kind  of  pendulous  clus- 
ter on  the  tops  of  the  stalks,  but  by  the  leaves  growing  in  fours,  and 
forming  a  sort  of  cross. 

The  second  species  has  a  perennial  woody  root:  the  stems 
shrubby,  about  a  foot  high,  with  opposite  branches:  the  bark  ash- 
coloured:  the  leaves  are  linear,  fleshy,  spreading;  above  smooth  and 
shining,  transversely  wrinkled;  towards  the  end  beset  with  a  few 
scattered  hair-like  points ;  beneath  having  a  longitudinal  furrow, 
which  is  white  from  a  woollintss  apparent  to  the  magnifier;  the  edge 
somewhat  membranaceous,  and  when  viewed  with  the  microscope 
appearing  serrulate:  the  leaves,  when  young,  have  three  flat  sides, 
but  when  full  grown  are  nearly  flat :  the  flowers  are  in  long  clustered 
whorls  terminating  in  spikes,  of  a  deep  purple  colour,  sonorous  when 
struck;  they  come  out  from  the  sides  of  the  young  shoots ;  those 


196 

from  the  end-shoots  being  near  each  other,  but  scattered  and  bare; 
those  from  the  small  lateral  branches  generally  in  pairs.  It  is  a 
native  of  the  middle  parts  of  Europe,  flowering  from  June  to 
August. 

The  third  has  twisted,  trailing  stems:  the  branches  between 
scored  and  singular,  light  reddish  brown  ;  the  more  slender  shoots 
ash-coloured,  all  lateral,  to  seven  or  more  rising  from  the  same  point 
in  the  manner  of  an  umbel;  when  beginning  to  flower,  gradually 
tapering  towards  the  end:  the  leaves  are  linear,  somewhat  like  those 
of  fir,  bowed  sideways,  smooth,  but  not  glossy,  somewhat  pointed, 
when  magnified  appearing  to  have  distant  serratures  on  the  edge, 
which  is  bent  in;  upper  surface  green,  slightly  elevated  in  the  middle; 
under  whitish,  convex,  with  a  smooth  furrow  running  along  it,  longer, 
and  sometimes  thrice  as  long  as  the  corolla,  and  crowded  so  close  as 
to  conceal  the  younger  shoots:  the  flowers  roundish,  on  long  slender 
peduncles,  from  the  sides  of  the  branches,  beginning  from  below  the 
middle,  and  extending  to  the  ends,  continuing  on,  in  the  cultivated 
plants,  till  the  next  season.  It  is  a  native  of  Britain. 

The  fourth  species  is  an  upright  shrub,  growing  to  the  height  of 
six  feet,  with  upright  branches  covered  with  a  white  nap:  the  leaves 
are  very  abundant,  upright,  smooth,  almost  awl-shaped,  covering  the 
branches,  wrinkled  when  dry:  the  flowers  very  numerous,  on  the 
middle  of  the  branches,  so  that  the  later  leaves  are  above  them;  they 
are  on  branching  peduncles,  forming  a  panicle.  It  is  a  native  of  the 
South  of  Europe,  flowering  from  February  to  May. 

The  fifth  is  an  upright  rigid  shrub,  with  an  ash-coloured  bark: 
the  leaves  are  in  threes  or  fours,  linear,  obtuse,  somewhat  rugged  on 
the  edge:  the  flowers  terminating,  two  or  three,  subsessile.  It  is  a 
native  of  Spain,  flowering  in  April  and  May. 

The  sixth  species  has  the  stem  the  height  of  a  man:  the  leaves 
are  in  fours  or  fives,  spreading,  obtuse,  gibbous  at  the  base:  the 
flowers  purplish.  It  is  a  native  of  the  South  of  Europe,  flowering 
from  June  to  November. 

The  seventh  has  the  branches  whitish,  and  angular:  the  leaves 
are  in  fours,  seldom  in  fives,  and  even:  the  flowers  lateral,  and  of  a 


197 

purple  colour,  simple,  coloured,  lanceolate,  acute,  shorter  by  half 
than  the  corolla:  style  twice  as  long  as  the  corolla:  stigma  entirely 
simple :  it  resembles  the  multiftora,  but  the  corolla  is  absolutely  ovate; 
the  branches  angular  and  while.  It  is  a  native  of  the  South  of 
Europe,  flowering  from  March  to  May. 

In  the  eighth  species  the  stem  is  subdivided  into  narrow  branches: 
the  leaves  pressed  close,  almost  imbricate,  opposite,  blunt,  grooved 
underneath,  a  line  in  length:  the  flowers  are  on  the  extreme  branch- 
lets,  one,  two,  or  three  together,  and  upright,  of  a  yellow  colour. 
The  whole  plant  being  covered  with  shining  golden  or  silvery  flowers 
is  very  beautiful  and  ornamental.  It  is  a  native  of  the  Cape  of  Good 
Hope.  It  varies  with  yellow  or  white  flowers. 

The  ninth  is  a  lofty  shrub  with  purplish  branches:  the  branchlets 
subtomentose  and  white:  the  leaves  crowded  very  much,  even,  rug- 
ged about  the  edge. 

But,  according  to  Thunbcrg,  the  stem  is  smooth,  rugged,  brown, 
flexuose,  decumbent,  strict,  a  span  high:  the  branches  alternate, 
divaricate,  like  the  stem:  the  leaves  in  threes,  lanceolate,  acute, 
smooth,  flat  above,  convex  beneath,  with  a  slender  groove,  spread- 
ing. It  is  a  native  of  the  Cape  of  Good  Hope,  flowering  in  May 
and  June.  It  is  distinguished  from  the  other  sorts  by  the  size  of  the 
flowers. 

In  the  tenth  the  stem  is  erect,  pubescent  leafless,  two  feet  high: 
the  branches  scattered,  frequent,  spreading,  covered  with  leaves,  very 
short,  simple:  the  leaves  in  threes,  ovate,  obtuse,  convex  beneath, 
with  a  longitudinal  groove,  flat  above,  entire,  imbricate,  smooth, 
scarcely  a  line  in  length:  the  flowers  solitary,  nodding,  on  pubescent 
reflex  peduncles  large  and  white.  It  is  a  native  of  Africa.  This  is 
one  of  the  most  beautiful  planls  of  this  beautiful  genus. 

The  eleventh  species  has  a  delitescent  stem,  dcterminately  branch- 
ed, with  white,  awl-shaped,  decurrcnt  lines  under  the  scars  of  the 
leaves;  which  are  linear,  even,  pressed  close,  scarcely  longer  than 
the  interstices:  the  flowers  terminating,  subumbclled,  on  peduncles 
the  length  of  the  flowers.  It  is  a  native  of  the  Cape  of  Good 
Hope. 


198 

In  the  twelfth  the  stem  is  fluxuose-erecl,  ash-coloured,  two  feet 
high:  the  branches  opposite,  or  in  threes,  cinereous-villose,  wand- 
like:  branchlets  filiform,  scattered,  frequent,  wand-like:  the  leaves 
are  in  threes,  linear-lanceolate;  beneath  grooved  from  the  revolute 
margins,  tomentose-whilish,  from  erect  spreading,  curved  a  little: 
the  flowers  flesh-coloured.  It  is  a  native  of  the  Cape  of  Good  Hope, 
flowering  in  May  and  June. 

It  varies  with  flowers  very  hirsute  and  hairy,  red,  and  whitish 
flesh-coloured. 

The  thirteenth  species  has  the  leaves  three-fold  oval,  downy-white 
underneath:  the  flowers  ovate,  conic.  It  is  a  native  of  the  Cape  of 
Good  Hope. 

In  the  fourteenth  the  branches  are  round  and  smooth;  branchlets 
pubescent:  the  leaves  linear-awl-shaped,  grooved,  spreading,  half  an 
inch  long,  on  appressed  petioles  scarcely  half  a  line  in  length:  the 
flowers  axillary,  and  of  a  deep  red  colour.  It  is  a  native  of  the  Cape, 
flowering  at  various  seasons. 

The  fifteenth  species  has  the  branches  filiform,  ramentaceous, 
long,  ferruginous:  the  leaves  very  narrow,  upright,  pressed  close: 
the  flowers  umbelled,  of  a  purple  colour.  It  is  a  native  of  the  Cape 
of  Good  Hope,  flowering  in  July. 

The  sixteenth  has  the  stem  shrubby,  smoothish,  with  pubescent 
branches:  the  leaves  linear,  obtuse,  erect,  channelled  underneath, 
the  length  of  the  joints,  hispid  or  subscabrous:  the  flowers  are  um- 
belled, dispersed  on  the  upper  twigs,  and  of  a  flesh  colour.  It  is  a 
native  of  the  Cape,  flowering  from  February  to  May. 

The  seventeenth  has  a  brown  stem,  smooth  below,  hispid  at  top. 
erect,  a  foot  high:  the  branches  dichotomous,  brown  at  bottom,  and 
smooth,  above  ash-coloured,  hirsute,  erect,  fastigiate:  branchlets  scat- 
tered all  over  the  branches,  filiform,  frequent,  hairy-rough,  wand-like: 
the  leaves  are  linear-subulate,  entire,  smooth,  flat  above,  convex  be- 
neath, with  a  very  slender  groove,  incurved,  from  erect  spreading : 
the  flowers  solitary,  or  two  or  three  together,  on  very  short  drooping 
peduncles,  ash-coloured,  tomentose.  It  is  a  native  of  the  Cape. 

The  eighteenth  species  has  an  erect  stem,  branched:  the  leaves 


19.9 

linear,  bluntish,  rugged  on  the  edge,  longer  than  the  internodes,  on 
white  petioles:  the  flowers  terminating,  in  threes,  or  thereabouts,  nod- 
ding, the  size  of  a  pea,  on  purple  peduncles,  with  alternate,  remote, 
flesh-coloured  bractes.  It  is  a  native  of  the  Cape,  flowering  in  April 
and  May. 

The  nineteenth  has  a  shrubby,  compound  stem:  the  leaves  linear, 
smooth:  the  flowers  terminating,  sessile,  of  a  purple  colour.  It  is  a 
native  of  the  Cape,  flowering  in  August. 

The  twentieth  species  has  a  brown,  rugged  stem,  a  foot  high:  the 
branches  in  whorls,  like  the  stem,  flexuose-erect;  branchlets  trichoto- 
mous  and  dichotomous,  like  the  branches:  the  leaves  in  sixes,  ob- 
long, obtuse,  incurved,  above  three-cornered,  flat,  beneath  grooved, 
rugged,  especially  underneath,  very  finely  ciliate,  imbricate,  a  line 
in  length:  the  flowers  aggregate,  in  whorls,  in  the  middle  and  at  the 
ends  of  the  branchlets  of  a  blood-red  colour.  It  flowers  in  April  and 
May. 

The  twenty-first  species  has  the  stem  seldom  erect,  commonly 
decumbent,  smooth,  flexuose,  filiform:  the  branches  filiform,  flexuose, 
villose:  branchlets  capillary,  frequent,  tomentose :  the  leaves  ovate, 
spreading,  rough,  with  long  hairs:  the  flowers  at  the  ends  of  the  ex- 
treme branchlels,  ped uncled,  one,  two,  or  three  together,  the  whole 
calyxes  covered  close  with  a  white  wool. 

The  twenty-second  has  the  leaves  linear,  even  the  upper  ones, 
ciliate :  the  flowers  terminating,  solitary,  sessile,  of  a  purple  colour. 

The  twenty-third  species  has  the  leaves  four-fold,  smooth,  and 
long  yellow  flowers.  It  flowers  from  May  to  August. 

The  twenty-fourth  has  the  branches  compound:  the  leaves  ob- 
long, convex,  even,  grooved  underneath,  ciliate,  with  spinules:  the 
flowers  large,  heaped  on  the  side  into  a  sort  of  head,  sessile,  pubes- 
cent: calyx  rough,  with  white  hairs,  as  it  were  doubled:  the  corolla 
bright  blood  red,  rough  with  white  hairs,  having  the  rnouth  obscurely 
four-cleft.  It  is  a  native  of  the  Cape,  flowering  most  part  of  the  year. 

The  twenty -fifth  species  has  the  branches  heaped  above  the 
flowers:  the  leaves  linear,  bluntish,  erect:  the  flowers  heaped,  lateral, 
below  the  top  of  the  stalk.  It  is  a  native  of  the  Cape. 


200 

The  twenty-sixth  species  has  shrubby  filiform  stems,  covered  all 
round  with  leaves:  the  leaves  in  fours,  imbricate  in  eight  rows,  very 
short,  elliptic,  crowded,  obtuse,  ciliate,  so  that  they  appear  villose:  the 
flowers  red,  in  a  terminating  sessile  head.  It  is  a  native  of  the  Cape. 

The  twenty-seventh  has  the  leaves  linear  and  crowded:  the  flowers 
pedunclecl,  and  nodding.  It  is  a  native  of  the  Cape. 

The  twenty-eighth  species  is  a  brown  shrub:  the  branches  covered 
with  branchlets  in  threes,  crowded,  very  short,  pubescent,  clothed 
with  squarrose  leaves;  which  are  also  crowded,  alw-shaped,  sub- 
trigonal,  somewhat  rugged  at  the  edge,  patulous,  or  standing  out  at 
the  tip  ;  the  flowers  solitary,  at  the  ends  of  the  branchlets,  drooping, 
on  a  short,  pubescent  peduncle,  of  a  red  colour.  It  is  a  native  of  the 
Cape,  flowering  from  January  to  March. 

The  twenty-ninth  species  is  a  small  shrub,  from  a  foot  to  eighteen 
inches  in  height,  decumbent  at  bottom,  then  upright,  branched,  flex- 
ible: the  leaves  are  almost  covering  the  whole  stem,  deciduous,  re- 
sembling those  of  the  fir,  thickish,  having  a  prominent  nerve,  narrow, 
very  sharp,  smooth :  the  flowers  at  the  tops  of  the  branchlets,  on  short 
peduncles,  alternate,  among  the  leaves:  they  come  out  in  autumn, 
continue  closed  during  winter,  and  are  then  green;  in  May  the  year 
following  the  flowers  are  unfolded;  the  anthers  which  were  inclosed 
are  protruded,  the  calyx  and  corolla,  opening,  are  both  changed  into 
a  pale  purple  or  flesh-colour.  It  is  a  native  of  Austria. 

The  thirtieth  species  has  the  leaves  linear,  four-folded:  the  flowers 
large  and  yellow.  It  is  a  native  of  the  Cape,  flowering  from  May 
to  July. 

Culture. — These  elegant  plants  must  be  treated  in  different  me- 
thods, according  to  their  nature. 

The  first  three  British  sorts  are  capable  of  being  propagated  by 
sowing  the  seeds,  either  in  the  places  where  they  are  to  remain,  or  in 
pots  filled  with  peaty  earth  in  either  the  autumn  or  spring  seasons, 
but  this  is  a  tedious  practice.  The  best  method  is,  to  take  them  up 
from  the  places  where  they  grow  naturally  in  the  early  autumn,  with 
good  balls  of  earth  about  their  roots,  planting  them  again  imme- 
diately where  they  are  to  grow. 


201 

They  succeed  best  where  the  soil  is  of  the  peaty  or  nioory  kind, 
and  where  it  has  not  been  enriched  by  manure;  and  as  they  protrude 
their  rools  chiefly  near  the  surface,  it  should  be  as  little  dug  about 
them  as  possible. 

The  four  following  sorts  may  be  increased  in  the  same  manner  as 
the.  former;  but  the  best  practice  is  by  layers,  cuttings,  or  slips, 
which  should  be  laid  down  or  planted  out  in  pots  filled  with  boggy 
earth,  either  in  the  early  spring  or  the  latter  end  of  summer,  plunging 
them  in  a  moderate  hot-bed,  giving  them  proper  shade  and  water. 
When  they  have  taken  full  root,  they  should  be  removed  with  balls 
of  earth  about  them  into  separate  pots,  being  replaced  in  the  hot-bed 
till  they  become  well  established,  when  they  will  be  capable  of  bear- 
ing the  open  air  in  mild  weather. 

All  the  other  species  may  be  increased  either  by  cuttings  or  layers, 
but  most  of  them  by  the  former.  The  cuttings  should  be  made  from 
the  best  young  shoots,  and  be  planted  in  the  spring  season  in  pots 
filled  with  a  composition  of  light  boggy  and  loamy  earth,  being 
placed  in  the  hot-bed,  and  covered  with  bell-glasses,  an<£  duely 
shaded  from  the  sun,  slight  waterings  being  given  when  necessary; 
the  layers  are  best  made  in  the  autumn,  being  managed  in  the  same 
way. 

When  the  plants  are  perfectly  rooted,  they  may  be  removed  into 
separate  pots  filled  with  the  same  sort  of  earth,  and  placed  in  the 
dry,  stove  or  green-house,  where  many  of  the  plants  must  constantly 
be  kept. 

The  ninth,  twentieth,  and  twenty-sixth  species  must,  however,  be 
raised  by  layers,  as  they  have  not  yet  been  increased  by  planting 
their  cuttings. 

When  seeds  are  made  use  of  in  producing  these  plants,  they 
should  be  sown  in  pots  filled  with  the  above  sort  of  earth,  in  the 
early  spring,  and  plunged  in  the  hot-bed  of  the  stove.  When  the 
plants  have  acquired  a  few  inches  growth,  they  should  be  removed 
into  single  pots  with  a  little  earth  about  their  roots,  and  be  replunged 
in  the  hot-bed  in  the  stove,  being  preserved  in  it,  or  the  warmest 
part  of  the  green-house,  during  the  winter. 


202 

The  first  three  sorts  afford  an  agreeable  variety  in  the  borders 
and  clumps,  as  they  continue  long  in  flower.  The  four  following 
kinds  are  likewise  hardy,  and  afford  variety  among  other  potted 
plants  in  the  open  air  during  the  summer. 

The  other  species  are  more  tender,  but  produce  an  agreeable 
effect  among  the  stove  and  green-house  collections,  from  the  great 
beauty  and  continuance  of  the  flowers  in  many  of  the  sorts. 


2.  EPILOBIUM  ANGUSTIFOLIUM, 

ROSE-BAY    WILLOW-HERB. 


THIS  genus  contains  a  plant  of  the  herbaceous,  flowery,  peren- 
nial kind. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Octandria  Monogynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Calycanthemte. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  one-leafed  perianthium, 
four-parted,  superior;  divisions  oblong,  acuminate,  coloured,  deci- 
duous :  the  corolla  has  four  roundish  petals,  outwardly  wider,  emar- 
ginate,  expanding,  inserted  into  the  divisions  of  the  calyx:  the  sta- 
mina consist  of  eight  subulate  filaments;  the  alternate  ones  shorter: 
anthers  oval,  compressed,  obtuse:  the  pistillum  is  a  cylindric  germ, 
extremely  long,  inferior:  style  filiform :  stigma  four-cleft,  thick,  ob- 
tuse, rolled  back :  the  pericarpium  is  an  extremely  long  capsule, 
cylindric,  streaked,  four-celled,  four-valved :  the  seeds  numerous  ob- 
long, crowned  with  down:  receptacle  extremely  long,  four-cornered, 
free,  flexile,  and  coloured. 

The  species  cultivated  is  E.  angustifolium,  Narrow-leaved  or  Rose- 
bay  Willow-herb. 

It  has  a  creeping  root.  The  stem  is  upright,  from  three  to  six 
feet  high,  branched  at  top,  round,  and  pubescent;  the  branches  alter- 
nate. The  leaves  alternate,  running  slightly  down  the  stem,  smooth, 


203 

the  edge  minutely  and  rarely  indented,  the  midrib  whitish :  the  la- 
teral nerves  are  nearly  at  right  angles  with  this;  and  the  leaves  at 
their  first  appearance  are  rolled  in  at  the  edge.  The  flowers  are 
purple,  showy,  growing  in  a  kind  of  long  spike,  on  purple  peduncles, 
the  length  of  the  germ,  bending  down  before  the  flowers  open,  but 
afterwards  erect;  seldom  more  than  four  or  five  blow  together  on 
the  same  spike.  From  the  great  similitude  of  the  leaves  to  those  of 
willow,  it  has  obtained  the  name  of  Willow-herb,  or  French  Willow. 

There  is  a  variety  with  white  flowers. 

Culture. — It  is  readily  increased  by  dividing  its  creeping  roots, 
and  planting  portions  of  them  out  in  moist  shady  situations  where 
they  are  to  remain,  in  either  the  autumn  or  early  spring.  The  plants 
may  also  be  raised  by  sowing  the  seeds  in  the  same  situations.  The 
plants  afterwards  require  only  to  be  kept  within  proper  limits. 

They  are  well  suited  to  shady  situations,  and  for  covering  rock- 
work. 


PLATE  XXV. 

1.  FRITILLARIA  IMPERIALS 

CROWN    IMPERIAL. 

THIS  genus  comprises  plants  of  the  bulbous-rooted  perennial 
flowery  kind. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Hexandria  Monogynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Coronarice. 

The  characters  are:  that  there  is  no  calyx;  the  corolla  is  six- 
petalled,  bell-shaped,  spreading  at  the  base:  petals  oblong,  parallel: 
nectary  an  excavation  or  pit  in  the  base  of  each  petal :  the  stamina 
have  six  subulate  filaments,  approximating  to  the  style,  the  length  of 
the  corolla:  anthers  quadrangular,  oblong,  erect:  the  pistillum  is  an 
oblong  germ,  three-cornered,  obtuse:  style  simple,  longer  than  the 
stamens:  stigma  triple,  spreading,  blunt:  (style  trifid,  with  three  stig- 
mas:) the  pericarpium  is  an  oblong  capsule,  obtuse,  three-lobed, 
three-celled,  three-valved  (superior):  the  seeds  very  many,  flat,  semi- 
orbicular  on  the  outside,  in  a  double  row. 

The  species  are:  1.  F.  meleagris,  Common  Fritillary,  or  Che- 
quered Lily;  2.  F.  pyrenaica,  Black  Fritillary;  3.  F.  imperialis,  Im- 
perial Fritillary,  or  Crown  Imperial;  4.  F.  Persica,  Persian  Fritillary, 
or  Persian  Lily. 

In  the  first  the  root  is  a  solid  bulb  or  tuber,  about  the  size  of  a 
hazel  nut,  white  or  yellowish  white,  roundish,  compressed,  divisible 
into  several,  enclosed  by  the  withered  wrinkled  bulb  of  the  preceding 
year  as  in  a  case.  The  stem  from  six  to  twelve,  fifteen,  and  even 
eighteen  inches  in  height,  advancing  considerably  in  length  after 
flowering;  it  comes  out  from  the  side  of  the  root,  is  simple,  upright, 
round,  smooth,  glaucous,  and  not  unfrequently  purplish:  the  leaves 


fnhllaria       imperut&t. 
t       imperial, 


f7,,t  ,),,.,/  KH.,,,,,fJ  I,  F.f,  „/;•», 

l''mmtrnf        rrf/ 
//<//,<»>   r<><>/<;/  /// 


205 

three  or  four,  sometimes  five  or  six,  grass-like,  distantly  alternate, 
half  embracing,  round  on  the  under,  and  hollow  on  the  upper  side, 
somewhat  twisted  and  glaucous:  the  flower  usually  single,  sometimes 
two,  or  even  three,  on  the  top  of  the  stem,  Jarge,  pendulous,  at  first 
somewhat  pyramidal,  but  afterwards  bell-shaped,  chequered  with 
purple  and  white,  or  purple  and  greenish  yellow.  It  is  a  native  of 
the  southern  countries  of  Europe,  flowering  in  April  and  May. 

There  are  numerous  varieties;  the  chief  are,  the  Common  Pur- 
ple, the  Blood  Red,  the  Great  Purple  or  Red,  the  White,  the  Double 
Blush,  the  Pure  Yellow,  the  Chequered  Yellow,  the  Great  Yellow 
Italian,  the  Small  Italian,  the  Small  Portugal  Yellow,  the  Black, 
and  the  Spanish  Black. 

The  second  species  has  a  double  fleshy  bulbous  root:  the  leaves 
are  broader,  and  of  a  deeper  green  than  in  the  first;  the  lower  leaves 
are  opposite,  but  those  above  alternate:  the  stem  a  foot  and  half 
high,  terminated  by  two  flowers  of  an  obscure  yellow  colour,  and 
spreading  more  at  the  brim  than  those  of  the  first  sort,  but  turned 
downwards  in  the  same  manner.  It  flowers  three  weeks  after  it;  and 
is  a  native  of  France. 

The  third  has  a  large  round  scaly  root  of  a  yellow  colour,  and  a 
strong  foxy  odour:  the  stalk  rises  to  the  height  of  four  feet  or  up- 
wards: it  is  strong,  succulent,  and  garnished  two-thirds  of  the  length 
on  every  side  with  long  narrow  leaves  ending  in  points,  which  are 
smooth  and  entire:  the  upper  part  of  the  stalk  is  naked,  a  foot  in 
length :  the  flowers  come  out  all  round  the  stalk  upon  short  foot- 
stalks, which  turn  downward,  each  sustaining  one  large  flower. 
Above  these  rises  a  spreading  tuft  of  green  leaves,  which  are  erect, 
and  called  the  Coma.  It  flowers  the  beginning  of  April,  and  the 
seeds  ripen  in  July. 

The  chief  varieties  are;  those  with  yellow  flowers,  with  large 
flowers;  and  with  double  flowers;  but  that  which  has  two  or  three 
whorls  of  flowers  above  each  other  makes  the  finest  appearance, 
though  it  seldom  produces  its  flowers  after  this  manner  the  first  year 
after  removing. 

The  fourth  species  has  a  large  round  root :  the  stem  three  feet 


206 

high,  the  lower  part  closely  garnished  on  every  side  with  leaves, 
which  are  three  inches  long  and  half  an  inch  broad,  of  a  gray  colour, 
and  twisted  obliquely:  the  flowers  are  in  a  loose  spike  at  the  top, 
forming  a  pyramid;  shorter  than  the  other  sorts,  spreading  wider  at 
the  brim,  and  not  bent  down;  of  a  dark  purple  colour;  appearing 
in  May.  They  seldom  produce  seeds  in  this  climate. 

There  is  a  variety  which  has  a  much  shorter  stem  and  smaller 
leaves  ;  the  stem  branches  out  at  the  top  into  several  small  pedun- 
cles, each  sustaining  one  dark-coloured  flower.  It  is  termed  Dwarf 
Persian  Lily. 

Culture. — The  common  mode  of  propagation  in  all  these  plants 
is  by  off-sets  from  the  sides  of  their  roots,  separated  every  second  or 
third  year;  the  proper  time  for  which  is  when  their  flower-stalks  de- 
cay, taking  the  whole  root  up  entirely,  and  separating  them  into 
distinct  roots,  then  planting  the  smaller  off-sets  by  themselves  in 
nursery-beds,  to  remain  a  year  or  two,  to  acquire  a  flowering  state ; 
and  the  larger  roots,  where  they  are  to  remain  for  flowering. 

They  are  likewise  capable  of  being  propagated  by  seed;  but  this 
is  principally  practised  for  new  varieties;  and  the  process  is  tedious; 
the  Fritillary  and  Persian  Lily  being  three  years,  and  the  Crown  Im- 
perial sometimes  six  or  seven,  before  they  flower  in  perfection.  The 
seeds  may  be  sown  in  the  beginning  of  autumn,  in  large  wide  pots, 
or  in  boxes  of  similar  width,  filled  with  light  mellow  earth,  each  sort 
separate,  covering  them  evenly  with  fine  earth  half  an  inch  deep, 
placing  the  pots,  &c.  to  have  only  the  morning  sun  all  summer,  or 
during  hot  dry  weather,  and  in  the  full  sun  in  winter  and  spring:  the 
plants  will  appear  in  the  spring,  which,  after  the  first  or  second  year's 
growth,  when  the  leaves  decay  in  summer,  may  be  taken  up,  and  the 
whole  planted  immediately  in  nursery-beds,  in  shallow  drills  four 
inches  asunder,  to  remain  till  they  flower. 

They  are  all  hardy,  and  highly  ornamental  plants  for  the  borders, 
clumps,  and  other  parts;  the  fourth  sort  being  set  backwards,  the 
third  in  the  middle,  and  the  others  forwards. 


207 


2.    FUM  ARI  A    C  AVA. 

HOLLOW-ROOTED    FUMITORY. 

THIS  genus  contains  plants  of  the  tuberous-rooted  low  flowery 
perennial  kind. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Diadelphia  Hexandria,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Corydales. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  two-leaved  perianthium: 
leaflets  opposite,  equal,  lateral,  erect,  acute,  small,  deciduous:  the 
corolla  oblong,  tubular,  ringent,  palate  prominent,  closing  the  throat: 
upper  lip  flat,  obtuse,  emarginate,  reflex :  the  nectary  the  base  of 
the  upper  lip  prominent  backward,  obtuse:  the  lower  lip  entirely 
similar  to  the  upper,  keeled  towards  the  base:  nectary  the  keeled 
base,  but  in  this  less  prominent :  the  throat  four-cornered,  obtuse, 
perpendicularly  bifid:  the  stamina  consist  of  two  equal  filaments, 
broad,  one  within  each  lip,  enclosed,  acuminate:  anthers  three  at  the 
end  of  each  filament:  the  pistillum  is  an  oblong,  compressed  germ, 
acuminate :  style  short :  stigma  orbiculate,  erect,  compressed :  the 
pericarpium  is  a  one-celled  silicic:  the  seeds  are  roundish. 

The  species  are:  F.  cucullaria^  Naked-stalked  Fumitory;  2.  F. 
sempervirens,  Glaucous  Fumitory;  3.  F.  lutea,  Yellow  Fumitory; 
4.  F.  capnoides,  White-flowered  Fumitory. 

The  first  has  a  scaly  root,  the  size  of  a  large  hazel-nut:  the  flower- 
stalk  is  eight  or  nine  inches  high:  the  root-leaves  are  in  pairs,  triter- 
nate,  gashed,  smooth,  slender;  with  red  petioles:  the  scape  simple, 
round,  length  of  the  leaf,  rufous :  the  raceme  terminating,  simple ; 
the  flowers  (four  or  five)  pendulous;  of  a  dull  white  colour.  It  is  a 
native  of  Virginia.  Perennial,  flowering  in  June  and  July. 

The  second  species  is  annual:  the  stem  upright,  a  foot  and  half 
high,  round,  and  very  smooth,  sending  out  several  branches  at  top : 
the  leaves  smooth,  branching,  pale,  divided  like  the  common  sort, 


208 

but  the  leaflets  larger  and  more  oblusc :  the  flowers  in  loose  pani- 
cles from  the  sides  of  the  stem  and  at  the  extremities  of  the  branches, 
of  a  pale  purple  colour,  with  yellow  chaps  or  lips:  the  pods  are 
taper,  narrow,  an  inch  and  half  long,  containing  many  small  black 
shining  seeds.  It  flowers  during  summer,  and  is  a  native  of  North 
America. 

In  the  third,  the  root  strikes  deep  into  the  ground:  the  stems  are 
many,  succulent,  diffused,  about  six  inches  high:  the  leaves  on  long 
branching  petioles,  composed  of  many  irregular  leaflets,  trifid  at  the 
top:  peduncles  axillary,  naked,  longer  than  the  leaves,  supporting 
eight  or  nine  flowers,  of  a  bright  yellow  colour,  in  a  loose  spike:  the 
leaves  continue  green  all  the  year,  and  the  flowers  in  succession  from 
April  to  October.  It  is  very  like  the  fourth  species,  but  is  peren- 
nial- and  according  to  Miller,  the  stalks  have  blunt  angles,  are  of  a 
purplish  colour;  and  the  flowers  grow  in  a  looser  panicle,  on  longer 
pedicles.  It  is  a  native  of  Barbary. 

The  fourth  is  annual:  the  stem  four-cornered  at  the  base:  the 
leaves  superdecompound,  the  terminating  leaflets  larger,  and  semi- 
trifid ;  the  middle  segment  lobed;  petioles  three-cornered:  the  ra- 
cemes naked:  pedicles  shorter  by  half  than  the  corollas,  blackish  at 
the  tip.  There  is  a  succession  of  the  flowers  from  May  to  October. 
It  is  a  native  of  the  South  of  Europe. 

Culture, — The  first  sort  of  these  plants  may  be  readily  increased, 
by  planting  .off-sets  from  the  roots  in  a  light  soil,  in  a  shady  situation, 
in  the  beginning  of  autumn,  as  soon  as  the  stems  begin  to  decay. 

The  other  sorts  may  be  raised  by  sowing  the  seeds  where  the 
plants  are  to  grow,  as  soon  as  they  become  perfectly  ripened. 

The  only  culture  they  demand  afterwards  is,  that  of  keeping  them 
free  from  weeds. 

They  are  all  very  ornamental  in  the  fore  parts  of  clumps,  borders, 
and  other  parts  of  pleasure-grounds. 


n.26. 


/„•//,/,•«   PuthlJtrJ    '      :    /'/!'<!  5     I,Y  l-'K.:ii:rtfY    F/.-.'l    .ffr'A-f 


J'ainir.l/r,J\J  K./w., r./. 


<! 


Gvnha.n. 


/)'///,  "\-f-7t  < 


•  -.  .     . 


PLATE   XXVI. 

1.    GENTIANA   ACAULIS. 

LARGE-FLOWERED    GENTIAN. 

THIS  genus  of  plants  is  of  the  hardy  heibaceous  perennial 
flowery  kind. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Pentandria  Digynia,  and  ranks  in 
the  natural  order  of  Rotacea. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  five-parted  perianthium, 
sharp:  divisions  oblong,  permanent:  the  corolla  has  one  petal,  tubu- 
lar at  bottom,  imperforate,  at  top  five-cleft,  flat,  withering,  various  in 
form:  the  stamina  have  five  filaments,  subulate,  shorter  than  the  co- 
rolla: anther  simple:  the  pistillum  is  an  oblong  germ,  cylindric, 
length  of  the  stamens:  styles  none:  stigmas  two,  ovate:  (germ  supe- 
rior; style  simple,  or  two  sessile  stigmas:)  the  pericarpium  is  an 
oblong  capsule,  columnar,  acuminate,  slightly  bifid  at  the  tip,  one- 
celled;  two-valved:  the  seeds  numerous,  small,  fixed  all  round  to  the 
walls  of  the  capsule:  receptacles  two,  each  fastened  longitudinally  to 
a  valve. 

The  species  cultivated  are:  1.  G.  lutea,  Yellow  Gentian;  2.  G. 
punctata,  Spotted-flowered  Gentian ;  3.  G.  asclepiadea,  Swallow- 
wort-leaved  Gentian;  4.  G.  acaulis,  Dwarf  Gentian,  or  Gentianella. 

The  first  has  a  thick  root,  of  a  yellowish  brown  colour,  and  very 
bitter  taste:  the  lower  leaves  are  petioled,  oblong-ovate,  a  little 
pointed,  stiff,  yellowish  green,  having  five  large  veins  on  the  back, 
and  plaited :  the  stem  three  or  four  feet  high  or  more,  with  a  pair 
of  leaves  at  each  joint,  sessile  or  almost  embracing,  of  the  same  form 
with  the  lower  ones,  but  diminishing  gradually  to  the  top:  the 
flowers  are  in  whorls  at  the  upper  joints.  It  is  a  native  of  Switzerland, 
flowering  in  June  and  July. 

2  E 


210 

The  second  species  has  the  leaves  ovate,  elongated,  and  strict: 
the  calyxes  shallow,  and  in  form  of  a  basin,  the  calycine  teeth  nar- 
row, sharp,  and  not  very  leafy :  the  corolla  is  of  a  papery  substance, 
extremely  thin,  of  a  dull  and  very  pale  greenish  straw-colour,  with 
very  minute  dots  thickly  and  irregularly  scattered  over  it:  the  seg- 
ments of  the  border  commonly  seven,  sometimes  eight,  but  very  sel- 
dom six,  always  shorter,  narrower,  contiguous,  rounded,  blunt,  with- 
out any  auricles  at  the  base;  and  finally  the  bellying  of  the  corolla 
is  blunter  and  almost  the  same  over  the  whole  bell.  It  is  a  native  of 
Austria. 

The  third  has  the  stem  upright  near  a  foot  high :  the  leaves  smooth, 
about  two  inches  long,  and  three  quarters  of  an  inch  broad  at  the 
base,  embracing  there,  and  ending  in  an  acute  point;  they  are  of  a 
fine  green,  have  five  longitudinal  veins,  joining  at  both  ends,  but 
diverging  in  the  middle,  and  diminish  in  size  as  they  are  nearer  the 
top:  the  flowers  are  in  pairs  opposite,  on  short  peduncles;  pretty 
large,  bell  shaped,  and  of  a  fine  blue  colour.  It  is  a  native  of  Switz- 
erland, flowering  in  July  and  August. 

The  fourth  species  has  a  large  woody  branched  root:  a  set  of 
ovate-lanceolate  leaves  spreads  on  the  surface:  the  stem  from  one  to 
three  inches  in  height,  with  one  or  two  pairs  of  leaves  on  it,  and  ter- 
minated by  one  very  large,  upright,  handsome  flower  (in  the  garden, 
when  the  plants  are  strong,  there  are  sometimes  more,)  which  is 
of  a  deep  azure  blue,  dotted  on  the  inside.  It  is  a  native  of 
Austria. 

Culture. — The  three  first  sorts  are  easily  raised,  by  sowing  the 
seed  in  pots  soon  after  it  is  ripe,  as  when  kept  till  the  spring  it  will 
not  succeed :  the  pots  should  be  placed  in  a  shady  situation,  and 
kept  clean  from  weeds.  Some  advise  their  being  sown  where  they 
are  to  remain,  but  the  first  is  probably  the  best  method.  In  the 
spring  the  plants  appear,  when  they  must  be  duly  watered  in  dry 
weather,  and  kept  clean  from  weeds  till  the  following  autumn;  then 
be  carefully  shaken  out  of  the  pots,  so  as  not  to  break  or  injure  their 
roots;  and  a  shady  border  of  loamy  earth  should  be  well  dug  and 


211 

prepared  to  receive  them,  into  which  they  should  be  put  at  about 
six  inches  distance  each  way,  the  tops  of  the  roots  being  kept  a  little 
below  the  surface  of  the  ground,  and  the  earth  pressed  close  to  the 
roots.  If  the  following  spring  prove  dry,  they  should  be  duly  watered, 
to  forward  their  growth.  The  plants  may  remain  here  two  years,  by 
which  time  they  will  be  fit  to  transplant  where  they  are  designed  to 
grow,  removing  them  in  the  autumn,  as  soon  as  their  leaves  decay, 
great  care  being  taken  in  digging  them  up,  not  to  cut  or  break  their 
roots,  as  that  greatly  weakens  them.  They  require  afterwards  no 
other  culture,  but  to  dig  the  ground  about  them  early  in  the  spring 
before  they  begin  to  shoot,  and  in  the  summer  to  keep  them  clean 
from  weeds.  The  roots  continue  many  years,  but  the  stalks  decay 
every  autumn;  the  same  roots  not  flowering  two  years  together,  or 
seldom  oftener  than  every  third.  When  they  flower  strong,  they 
have,  however,  a  fine  appearance. 

The  first  is  mostly  propagated  by  off-sets  or  parting  the  roots, 
and  planting  them  where  they  are  to  remain  in  the  early  autumn ; 
but  in  order  to  have  the  plants  flower  well,  they  must  not  be  often 
transplanted  or  parted. 

They  are  also  capable  of  being  raised  from  seeds  managed  as  the 
first  sorts. 

They  all  succeed  the  most  perfectly  in  moist  loamy  soils,  where 
there  is  a  degree  of  shade. 

All  the  sorts  are  useful  as  ornamental  plants,  for  the  various 
clumps,  borders,  and  quarters  of  pleasure-grounds;  those  of  low 
growth  being  planted  towards  the  fronts,  and  the  latter  kinds  more 
backward. 


212 


2.  GLYCINE  RUBICUND  A, 

DINGY-FLOWERED    GLYCINE. 

THIS  genus  contains  plants  of  the  shrubby  climbing  kind. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Diadelphia  Decandria,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of>Papilionace<s. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  one-leafed,  compressed 
perianthium  :  mouth  two-lipped  :  upper  lip  emarginate,  obtuse : 
lower  longer,  trifid,  acute:  the  middle  tooth  more  produced:  the 
corolla  is  papilionaceous:  banner  pbcordate,  the  sides  bent  down, 
the  back  gibbous,  the  tip  emarginate,  straight,  repelled  from  the 
keel:  wings  oblong,  towards  the  tip  ovate,  small,  bent  downwards: 
keel  linear,  sickle-shaped,  bent  upwards,  at  the  tip  pressing  the 
banner  upwards,  obtuse,  towards  the  tip  broader:  the  stamina  have 
diadelphous  filaments  (simple  and  nine-cleft),  only  a  little  divided 
at  the  tip,  rolled  back:  anthers  simple:  the  pistillum  is  an  oblong 
germ:  style  cylindric,  rolled  back  in  a  spiral:  stigma  obtuse:  peri- 
carpium  an  oblong  legume:  the  seeds  kidney-form. 

The  species  are:  1.  G.  frutescens,  Shrubby  Glycine,  or  Carolina 
Kidney-bean  Tree;  2.  G.  bimaculata,  Two-spotted  Glycine;  3.  G. 
rubicunda,  Reddish-flowered  Glycine;  4.  G.  coccinea,  Scarlet  Gly- 
cine. 

The  first  has  woody  stalks,  which  twist  themselves  together,  and 
also  twine  round  any  trees  that  grow  near,  and  will  rise  to  the  height 
of  fifteen  feet  or  more.  The  leaves  are  in  shape  somewhat  like  those 
of  the  ash-tree,  but  have  a  greater  number  of  leaflets.  The  flowers  are 
produced  in  clusters  from  the  axils,  and  are  of  a  purple  colour.  They 
are  succeeded  by  long  cylindrical  legumes,  shaped  like  those  of  the 
Scarlet  Kidney-bean,  containing  several  seeds,  which  are  never  per- 
fected in  this  climate.  It  flowers  from  June  to  September. 


213 

The  second  species  rises  with  a  twining  shrubby  stalk  to  the 
height  of  six  or  eight  feet  and  more;  multiplying  greatly  by  age, 
becoming  loaded  with  a  profusion  of  purple  flowers  growing  in  ra- 
cemes; the  richness  of  the  corolla  is  enlivened  by  two  green  spots  at 
the  base  of  the  banner.  For  the  most  part  the  flowers  go  off  in  this 
climate  without  producing  any  seed-vessels.  It  begins  to  flower  in 
February,  and  continues  during  the  summer.  It  is  a  native  of  Bo- 
tany Bay. 

The  third  has  a  shrubby,  slender,  twining  stem,  five  or  six  feet 
high  and  more,  red,  branched,  leafy.  The  leaves  ternate,  on  pe- 
tioles from  an  inch  to  two  inches  in  length,  channelled  above,  round 
underneath:  leaflets  ovate  or  elliptic,  quite  entire,  the  two  side-ones 
on  very  short  petioles,  the  end  one  on  a  petiole  half  an  inch  in 
length,  bending  and  swelling  immediately  under  the  leaflet,  and  hav- 
ing there  a  pair  of  deciduous  stipules.  Almost  the  whole  plant  is 
covered  with  hairs  pressed  close. 

The  flowers  are  of  a  purplish-scarlet  colour.  It  is  a  native  of  New 
South  Wales,  flowering  from  April  to  June. 

The  fourth  is  a  shrubby  climbing  plant,  growing  to  the  height  of 
many  feet,  if  supported,  and  producing  a  great  number  of  flowers 
on  its  pendent  branches.  The  leaflets  nearly  round,  and  in  the  older 
ones  especially  curled  at  the  edges.  The  flowers  for  the  most  part  in 
pairs,  of  a  glowing  scarlet  colour,  at  the  base  of  the  keel  somewhat 
inclined  to  purple;  the  bottom  of  the  banner  is  decorated  with  a 
large  yellow  spot,  verging  to  green.  It  flowers  from  April  to  June, 
and  is  a  native  of  New  South  Wales. 

Culture. — The  first  sort  is  increased  by  laying  down  the  young 
branches  in  the  early  autumn.  When  well  rooted  in  the  following 
autumn,  they  may  be  taken  off  and  planted  where  they  are  to  re- 
main, or  in  nursery-rows,  being  watered  when  the  weather  is  hot, 
and  the  roots  protected  in  the  winter  by  some  sort  of  strawy  ma- 
terial. 

They  succeed  best  in  dry  warm  light  soils. 

The  other  sorts  may  be  raised  by  sowing  the  seeds,  when  they 
can  be  obtained  from  abroad  or  produced  here,  in  pots  of  light 


214 

earth,  in  the  early  spring,  being  afterwards  removed  into  other  pots,, 
and  placed  in  the  green-house  or  Cape  stove.  Mr.  Curtis,  how- 
ever, suggests  that  the  two  last  may  succeed  in  the  open  air,  when 
planted  out  in  warm  sheltered  situations,  and  protected  in  the  winter 
season. 

They  are  all  ornamental  in  their  flowery  climbing  nature;  the 
first  in  the  open  ground,  and  the  latter  in  the  green-house  and  stove 
collections. 


PI.2Z 


/;,,;/  ,  ,v ,/;,////;;, . ;/- v/ 


PLATE   XXVII. 

1.  HELLEBORUS  VIRIDIS, 

GREEN  HELLEBORE. 


Tins  genus  contains  plants  of  the  herbaceous  perennial  kind. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Polyandria  Polygynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Multisiliqutg. 

The  characters  are:  that  there  is  no  calyx,  unless  the  corolla, 
which  in  some  species  is  permanent,  be  considered  as  such:  the 
corolla  has  five  petals,  roundish,  blunt,  large:  nectaries  several,  very 
short,  placed  in  a  ring,  one-leafed,  tubular,  narrower  at  bottom : 
mouth  two-lipped,  upright,  emarginate,  the  inner  lip  shortest :  the 
stamina  consist  of  numerous  subulate  filaments:  anthers  compressed, 
narrower  at  bottom,  upright:  the  pistillum  consists  of  about  six 
germs,  compressed:  styles  subulate:  stigmas  thickish:  (five  or  more:) 
the  pericarpium  consists  of  capsules  (leguminous,  beaked)  compress- 
ed, two-keeled:  the  lower  keel  shorter;  the  upper  convex,  gaping: 
the  seeds  several,  round,  and  fixed  to  the  suture. 

The  species  cultivated  are  :  1.  H.  hy  emails,  Winter  Hellebore,  or 
Yellow  Winter  Aconite;  2.  H.niger,  Black  Hellebore,  or  Christmas 
Rose;  3.  H.  viridis,  Green  Hellebore;  4.  H.fcetidus,  Slinking  Helle- 
bore, or  Bear's-foot;  5.  H,  lividus,  Livid  Purple,  or  Great  Three- 
flowered  Black  Hellebore. 

The  first  has  a  tuberous  transverse  root,  with  many  dependent 
fibres,  putting  up  several  naked  steins  or  scapes,  simple,  smooth, 
round,  from  an  inch  or  two  to  four  inches  in  height,  terminated  by  a 
single  leaf,  spreading  out  horizontally  in  a  circle,  divided  into  five 
parts  almost  to  the  base,  and  the  parts  simple,  or  divided  into  two, 
three,  or  four  lobes.  In  the  bosom  of  this  sits  one  large,  upright, 


216 

yellow  flower.  It  is  native  of  Loinbardy,  and  flowers  with  us  from 
January  to  March. 

The  second  has  transverse  roots,  externally  rough  and  knotted, 
with  many  dependent  fibres,  and  some  large  roots  striking  down ;  the 
scapes  from  six  inches  to  near  a  foot  in  length,  round,  upright,  varie- 
gated with  red,  rising  from  a  sheath,  and  terminated  usually  with 
one  flower,  sometimes  two,  and  very  rarely  three:  corolla  very  large, 
generally  white  at  first,  but  frequently  with  a  tint  of  red,  growing 
deeper  with  age,  but  finally  becoming  green.  It  is  a  native  of 
Italy,  Sec.  flowering  from  December  to  March.  Martyn  observes, 
that  "  it  has  the  name  of  Black  Hellebore  from  the  colour  of  the  root; 
and  of  Christmas  Hose,  from  the  time  of  flowering  and  the  colour  of 
the  corolla." 

The  third  has  a  round  stem,  a  little  branched  at  top,  but  not  near 
so  much  as  in  the  next  sort;  leafy,  reddish  at  the  base,  upright,  smooth, 
a  foot  or  eighteen  inches  in  height:  the  leaves  not  of  a  stiff  leathery 
consistence,  as  in  the  next  species,  but  soft  and  of  a  lighter  green  ; 
those  from  the  bottom  are  on  long  petioles,  but  those  on  the  stem  sit 
close  to  their  sheaths:  the  leaflets  (seven  to  ten)  lanceolate,  acuminate, 
sharply  serrate,  smooth,  gashed,  usually  trifid,  the  divisions  some- 
times deeply  lobed;  and  at  the  base  of  each  peduncle  is  a  similar 
leaf,  only  smaller:  the  peduncles  axillary,  an  inch  long,  round;  sup- 
porting two  (sometimes  only  one)  nodding,  green  flowers.  It  is  a 
native  of  France,  &c.  flowering  in  March  and  April. 

The  fourth  has  a  small  but  bent  root,  with  a  prodigious  number 
of  slender  dark-coloured  fibres:  the  stem  is  from  eighteen  inches  to 
near  a  yard  in  height,  towards  the  bottom  round,  strong,  naked, 
marked  with  alternate  scars,  the  vestiges  of  former  leaves;  dividing 
and  subdividing  at  top  into  many  branches,  producing  great  abun- 
dance of  flowers  pendent,  of  a  pale  yellowish  colour:  the  leaves  com- 
posed of  eight  or  nine  long  narrow  lobes,  joined  at  their  base, 
commonly  four  on  each  side,  united  at  the  bottom,  and  one  in  the 
middle  of  the  foot-stalk,  serrate,  and  ending  in  acute  points;  those 
on  the  lower  part  much  larger  than  those  on  the  upper,  of  a  deep 


217 

green  colour.  It  is  a  native  of  Italy,  &c.  flowering  from  November 
or  December  to  April. 

The  fifth  species  resembles  the  third,  but  differs  in  having  tri- 
foliate leaves,  broader  and  entire,  their  surface  being  smoother,  and 
the  stalks  rise  higher  than  either  of  the  common  sorts.  It  flowers 
from  January  to  May. 

Culture. — The  first  sort  is  increased  by  planting  the  off-sets  from 
the  roots  after  the  leaves  are  decayed,  in  the  latter  end  of  the  sum- 
mer season,  in  the  places  where  they  are  to  flower,  in  patches  of 
several  roots  together.  They  have  the  best  effect  when  intermixed 
wilh  the  Snow-drop,  as  being  of  similar  growth,  and  flowering  about 
the  same  time.  The  off-sets  may  be  separated  from  the  old  plants 
every  three  or  four  years. 

The  second  sort  is  increased  by  parting  the  roots  in  the  autumn, 
and  planting  them  out  in  moist  warm  sheltered  situations,  in  the 
borders  or  other  parts  where  the  soil  is  fresh  and  unmanured.  And 
to  have  it  flower  well,  it  should  be  protected  by  glasses  in  the  winter. 
Some  plants  may  be  potted  in  this  intention. 

The  third  and  fourth  sorts  are  raised  by  sowing  the  seeds  in  the 
autumn  or  early  spring,  either  in  the  places  where  they  are  to  grow, 
or  in  beds  for  the  purpose,  afterwards  thinning  them  out  to  a  few 
plants,  or  transplanting  them  into  other  beds,  at  the  distance  of  a 
foot  in  the  rows. 

They  rise  well  from  self-sown  seed,  and  succeed  in  shady  situa- 
tions very  well- 

The  last  sort  is  increased  by  seeds  and  parting  the  roots. 

The  well  ripened  seeds  should  be  sown,  or  the  roots  planted  out, 
in  the  autumn,  either  in  pots  of  light  fresh  earth,  or  in  warm  pro- 
tected situations  in  the  borders.  The  plants  should  afterwards  be 
protected  in  the  green-house,  or  by  hand-glasses  in  the  winter.  But 
they  do  not  increase  fast  in  either  of  these  ways. 

These  are  all  ornamental  plants;  the  first  sort  in  the  fronts  of 
beds,  borders,  and  clumps;  and  the  third  and  fourth  in  the  large 
borders  and  wilderness  parts  of  pleasure-grounds.  The  second  and 

last  sorts  produce  a  fine  effect  among  collections  of  potted  plants. 

2  F 


218 


2.  HYPERICUM    HIRCINUM. 

FETID    ST.  JOHN'S    WORT. 


Tins  genus  furnishes  plants  of  the  shrubby  and  under-shrubby, 
hardy  and  tender  kinds. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Polyaddphia  Polyandria,  and 
ranks  in  the  natural  order  of  Rotacea. 

The  characters  are:  that  the  calyx  is  a  five-parted  perianthium: 
segments  subovate,  concave,  permanent:  the  corolla  has  five  petals, 
oblong-ovate,  obtuse,  spreading,  wheel-shaped,  according  to  the  sun's 
apparent  motion :  the  stamina  have  numerous  capillary  filaments, 
united  at  the  base  in  five  or  three  bodies:  anthers  small:  the  pis- 
tillum  is  a  roundish  germ:  styles  three  (sometimes  one,  two,  or  five), 
simple,  distant,  the  length  of  the  stamens:  stigmas  simple:  the  peri- 
carpium  is  a  roundish  capsule,  with  the  same  number  of  cells  as  there 
are  styles:  the  seeds  very  many  and  oblong. 

The  species  cultivated  are:  1.  H.  balearicum,  Warled  St.  John's- 
wort;  2.  H.  Ascyron,  Great  flowered  St.  Peter's-wort ;  3.  H.Andro- 
stzmutfi,  Common  Tutsan;  4.  H.Canariense,  Canary  St.  John's- wort; 
5.  H.  hircinum,  Slinking  Shrubby  St.  John's-wort ;  6.  H.  monogynum, 
Chinese  St.  John's-wort. 

The  first  rises  with  a  slender  shrubby  stalk  in  this  country,  about 
two  feet  high;  but  in  its  native  soil  it  acquires  the  height  of  seven 
or  eight  feet,  sending  out  several  weak  branches  of  a  reddish  colour, 
and  marked  with  scars  where  the  leaves  have  fallen  off:  the  leaves 
are  small,  oval,  waved  on  their  edges,  and  having  several  small  pro- 
tuberances on  their  under  side:  they  sit  close  to  the  branches,  half 
embracing  them  at  the  base:  the  flowers  are  terminating,  large, 
bright,  yellow.  It  is  a  native  of  Majorca. 

The  second  species  has  a  stem  a  cubit  and  half  high,  round, 


219 

smooth,  rufescent :  the  leaves  are  pale  green,  paler  underneath,  an 
inch  long  and  half  an  inch  wide,  roundish,  opposite:  the  flowers 
terminating:  calyx  green:  corolla  pale  yellow,  five  times  as  large  as 
in  the  common  sort.  It  is  a  native  of  the  Pyrennees. 

The  third  has  a  perennial,  thick,  woody  root,  of  a  reddish  colour, 
sending  out  very  long  fibres:  the  steins  suffruticose  or  under-shrubby, 
ancipital  two-edged  or  slightly  winged  on  opposite  sides,  two  feet 
high  and  more,  branched  towards  the  top,  of  a  reddish  colour,  and 
smooth:  branches  brachiate  or  decussated,  spreading:  the  leaves  op- 
posite, sessile,  ovate,  entire,  smooth,  dark  green,  glaucous  on  the 
under  side,  netted  with  numerous  projecting  veins  and  nerves,  which 
become  through  age  ferruginous:  on  the  stem  they  are  two  inches 
long,  and  an  inch  and  half  broad  at  the  base;  those  on  the  branches 
are  smaller,  of  different  sizes,  and  some  of  them  approaching  to 
lanceolate:  the  flowers  small  for  the  size  of  the  plant,  disposed  in  a 
cyme:  the  peduncles  round,  smooth,  usually  two  or  three-flowered, 
but  sometimes  one-flowered :  the  fruit  an  ovate  capsule,  assuming 
the  appearance  of  a  berry;  at  first  yellowish  green,  then  red  or 
brownish  purple,  and  lastly  almost  black  when  ripe.  It  is  a  native 
of  the  south  of  Europe. 

The  fourth  species  rises  with  a  shrubby  stalk  six  or  seven  feet 
high,  dividing  into  branches  at  top:  the  leaves  are  oblong,  set  by 
pairs  close  to  the  branches,  having  a  strong  odour,  but  less  than  those 
of  the  fifth :  the  flowers  terminating  in  clusters,  very  like  those  of  the 
fifth.  It  is  a  native  of  the  Canary  islands,  flowering  from  July  to 
September. 

The  fifth  rises  with  shrubby  stalks  three  feet  high,  sending  out 
small  opposite  branches  at  each  joint:  the  leaves  are  oblong,  ovate, 
placed  by  pairs,  sessile,  and  having  a  rank  smell :  the  flowers  are  in 
terminating  bunches.  It  is  a  native  of  the  south  of  Europe,  flower- 
ing from  July  to  September. 

There  are  varieties ;  one  larger,  which  is  the  common  one :  the 
other  smaller. 

The  sixth  has  a  root  composed  of  many  woody  fibres,  striking 
deep  into  the  ground:  the  stems  several,  shrubby,  near  two  feet  high, 


220 

covered  with  a  purplish  bark:  the  leaves  stiff,  smooth,  about  two 
inches  long,  and  a  quarter  of  an  inch  broad,  opposite,  sessile,  of  a 
lucid  green  on  their  upper  surface,  and  gray  underneath,  having 
many  transverse  veins  running  from  the  midrib  to  the  border:  the 
flowers  terminating  in  small  clusters,  each  on  a  short  peduncle.  It 
is  a  native  of  China,  flowering  from  March  to  September. 

Culture. — The  first  and  last  sorts  are  more  tender  than  the  others, 
requiring  the  protection  of  the  green-house  in  winter.  They  are 
capable  of  being  increased  by  layers  or  cuttings.  The  former  are 
made  in  the  spring  on  the  young  shoots,  which,  when  well  rooted  in 
the  end  of  summer,  may  be  taken  off  and  planted  out  in  separate 
pots.  The  cuttings  of  the  young  shoots  may  be  planted  in  pots  in 
the  summer,  and  plunged  in  a  hot-bed,  and  when  well  rooted,  re- 
moved into  separate  pots. 

The  last  species  may  likewise  be  increased  by  planting  slips  of 
the  roots  in  the  spring,  in  the  same  manner. 

They  may  also  be  raised  by  sowing  the  seed  in  pots,  in  the  spring, 
and  plunging  them  in  a  hot-bed  just  to  bring  up  the  plants. 

The  second  and  third  sorts  are  readily  increased  by  sowing  the 
seeds  in  the  autumn,  in  a  bed  of  common  earth,  or  where  they  are 
to  remain. 

They  are,  however,  best  raised  by  slipping  the  roots,  and  plant- 
ing them,  at  the  same  time,  where  the  plants  are  to  grow. 

The  fourth  and  fifth  sorts  are  easily  increased  by  planting  slips 
from  the  old  roots  in  the  autumn  or  spring,  taken  with  root  fibres  to 
them;  or  by  dividing  the  roots,  and  planting  them  where  they  are  to 
grow,  or  in  nursery  rows. 

They  may  likewise  be  increased  by  seeds,  sown  as  in  the  two 
former  species,  removing  them  in  the  spring  following  to  where  they 
are  to  remain. 

The  two  tender  sorts  afford  variety  in  green-house  collections, 
and  the  other  sorts  in  the  borders,  clumps,  and  other  parts  of  plea- 
sure grounds. 


J'l.2.1 


1'cunttJ  by  Svti  EJ-xarJj  Lemtnt  ./'iM,  >/,.-,/  .'„»,-  i  jJr.'.f  bj  ifKu 

Jfemer0ca2us  ///Ay/ 


7('t\' 


/'/It  /I'.  I 


PLATE  XXVIII. 

1.  HEMEROCALLIS  FULVA. 

TOWN    LILY. 

i 

THIS  genus  contains  plants  of  the  herbaceous  flowery  perennial 
kinds. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Hexandria  Monogynia,  and  ranks 
in  the  natural  order  of  Liliacea. 

The  characters  are:  that  there  is  no  calyx:  the  corolla-  is  six- 
parted,  bell-funnel-form:  tube  short:  border  equal,  spreading,  more 
reflex  at  top:  the  stamina  have  six.  subulate  filaments,  the  length  of 
the  corolla,  declining;  upper  ones  shorter :  anthers  oblong,  incum- 
bent, rising:  the  pistillum  is  a  roundish  germ,  furrowed,  superior: 
style  filiform,  the  length  and  situation  of  the  stamens:  stigma  ob- 
tusely-three-cornered, rising :  the  pericarpium  is  an  ovate-three- 
lobed  capsule,  three-cornered,  three-celled,  three-valved:  the  seeds 
very  many,  and  roundish. 

The  species  are:  l.H.Jtava,  Yellow  Day-Lily;  2.H.fulva,  Cop- 
per-coloured Day-Lily. 

The  first  has  strong  fibrous  roots,  to  which  hang  knobs,  or  tubers, 
like  those  of  the  Asphodel,  from  which  come  out  leaves,  two  feet 
long,  with  a  rigid  midrib,  the  two  sides  drawing  inward,  so  as  to 
form  a  sort  of  gutter  on  the  upper  side:  the  flower-stalks  rise  two 
feet  and  a  half  high,  having  two  or  three  longitudinal  furrows;  these 
are  naked,  and  at  the  top  divide  into  three  or  four  short  peduncles, 
each  sustaining  one  pretty  large  yellow  flower  shaped  like  a  Lily, 
having  but  one  petal,  with  a  short  tube,  spreading  open  at  the  brim, 
where  it  is  divided  into  six  parts;  these  have  an  agreeable  scent,, 
from  which  some  have  given  them  the  title  of  Yellow  Tuberose.  It 
is  a  nativeof  Siberia,  &c.  flowering  in  June. 


222 

There  is  a  variety  with  smaller  roots;  the  leaves  are  not  near  so 
long,  have  not  more  than  half  the  breadth,  and  are  of  a  dark  green 
colour:  the  flower-stalk  is  a  foot  and  half  high,  naked  and  com- 
pressed, without  furrows ;  at  the  top  are  two  or  three  yellow  flowers, 
which  are  nearer  the  bell-shape  than  the  others,  and  stand  on  shorter 
peduncles. 

The  second  species  is  a  much  larger  plant  than  the  first,  and  the 
roots  spread  and  increase  much  more;  the  roots  have  very  strong 
fleshy  fibres,  to  which  hang  large  oblong  tubers :  the  leaves  are  near 
three  feet  long,  hollowed  like  those  of  the  former,  turning  back  to- 
ward the  top:  the  flower-stalks  are  as  thick  as  a  man's  finger,  and 
rise  near  four  feet  high;  they  are  naked,  without  joints,  and  branch- 
ing at  the  top,  where  are  several  large  copper-coloured  flowers,  shaped 
like  those  of  the  Red  Lily,  and  as  large.  These  flowers  never  conti- 
nue longer  than  one,  but  there  is  a  succession  of  flowers  on  the 
same  plants  for  a  fortnight  or  three  weeks.  It  flowers  in  July  and 
August. 

Culture. — These  plants  are  easily  increased  by  planting  the  off- 
sets taken  from  the  roots  in  autumn  in  any  situation,  as  they  are  ex- 
tremely hardy.  They  afterwards  require  no  other  culture,  but  to 
keep  them  clean  from  weeds,  and  to  allow  them  room,  that  their 
roots  may  spread. 

The  first  sort  may  also  be  increased  by  seeds,  which  should  be 
sown  in  autumn.  The  plants  come  up  in  the  following  spring,  and 
these  will  flower  in  two  years. 

A  moist  soil  and  shady  situation  are  the  best  suited  to  their 
growth ;  their  size,  and  the  great  increase  of  their  roots,  especially  in 
the  second  sort,  render  them  most  proper  for  large  gardens  and  plan- 
tations, where  they  produce  much  variety  and  effect. 


2.  HIBISCUS  SYRIACUS. 

ALTHEA    FRUTEX. 

THIS  genus  furnishes  plants  of  the  shrubby  and  flowery  exotic 
kinds. 

It  belongs  to  the  class  and  order  Monaddphia  Polyandria,  and 
ranks  in  the  natural  order  of  Columniferce. 

The  characters  are :  that  the  calyx  is  a  double  perianthium:  outer 
many-leaved,  permanent:  leaflets  linear:  more  rarely  one-leafed, 
many-cleft:  inner  one-leafed,  cup-shaped,  half  five-cleft,  perma- 
nent: or  five-toothed,  deciduous  :  the  corolla  has  five  petals,  round- 
ish-oblong, narrower  at  the  base,  spreading,  fastened  at  bottom  to 
the  tube  of  the  stamens:  the  stamina  have  very  many  filaments, 
united  at  bottom  into  a  tube,  at  top  (in  the  apex  and  surface  of  this) 
divided  and  loose:  anthers  kidney-form:  the  pistillum  is  a  roundish 
germ:  style  filiform,  longer  than  the  stamens,  five-cleft  at  top:  stig- 
mas headed :  the  pericarpium  is  a  five-celled  capsule,  five-valved: 
partitions  contrary,  doubled:  the  seeds  solitary  or  several,  ovate- 
kidney-form. 

The  species  cultivated  are:  1.  II.  Syriacus,  Syrian  Shrubby  Hi- 
biscus, or  Althaea  Frutex;  2.  H.  Trionum,  Bladder  Hibiscus,  Blad- 
der Ketmia,  or  Flower  of  an  Hour;  3.  H.  Rosa  Sinemis,  China  Rose 
Hibiscus;  4.  H.  mutabilis,  Changeable  Rose  Hibiscus,  or  Martinico 
Rose. 

The  first  rises  with  a  shrubby  stalk  to  the  height  of  six  or  seven 
feet,  sending  out  many  woody  branches,  covered  with  a  smooth  gray 
bark :  the  leaves  have  the  upper  part  frequently  divided  into  three 
lobes,  placed  alternately  on  the  branches,  and  stand  on  short  foot- 
stalks: the  flowers  come  out  from  the  wings  of  the  stalk  at  every 
joint  of  the  same  year's  shoot;  they  are  large,  and  shaped  like  those 


224 

of  the  mallow,  having  five  large  roundish  petals,  which  join  at  their 
base,  spreading  open  at  the  top  in  the  shape  of  an  open  bell :  these 
appear  in  August,  and  if  the  season  is  not  too  warm,  there  is  a  suc- 
cession of  flowers  part  of  September.  The  early  flowers  are  suc- 
ceeded by  short  capsules;  but  unless  the  season  proves  warm,  they 
do  not  ripen  in  this  climate.  It  is  usually  termed  Althaa  frutex  by 
the  nursery  gardeners.  It  is  a  native  of  Syria. 

There  are  varieties  with  pale  purple  flowers,  with  dark  bottoms; 
with  bright  purple  flowers,  with  black  bottoms;  with  white  flowers, 
with  purple  bottoms;  with  variegated  flowers,  with  dark  bottoms, 
called  Painted  Lady  Althaea  frittex;  with  pale  yellow  flowers,  with 
dark  bottoms;  with  variegated  leaves,  and  with  double  flowers. 

The  second  species  rises  with  a  branching  stalk  a  foot  and  a  half 
high,  having  many  short  spines  which  are  soft :  usually  the  leaves 
are  divided  into  three  lobes,  which  are  deeply  jagged  almost  to  the 
midrib;  these  jags  are  opposite,  and  the  segments  are  obtuse:  the 
flowers  come  out  at  the  joints  of  the  stalks  upon  pretty  long  pedun- 
cles; the  outer  calyx  is  composed  of  ten  long  narrow  leaves,  which 
join  at  their  base;  the  inner  is  of  one  thin  leaf,  swollen  like  a  bladder, 
cut  into  five  acute  segments  at  the  top,  having  several  longitudinal 
purple  ribs,  and  is  hairy  ;  both  these  are  permanent,  and  enclose  the 
capsule  after  the  flower  is  past:  the  flower  is  composed  of  five  ob- 
tuse petals,  which  spread  open  at  the  top,  and  form  an  open  bell- 
shaped  flower;  these  have  dark  purple  bottoms,  but  are  of  a  pale 
sulphur  colour  above,  tinged  sometimes  partially  with  pale  purple  on 
the  outside,  where  they  are  also  ribbed:  the  capsule  is  ovate,  the 
consistence  of  paper,  pustuled  with  protuberances  occasioned  by 
the  seeds,  villose  and  black.  It  is  annual,  growing  naturally  in  Italy, 
&c.  The  flowers  are  of  short  duration,  in  hot  weather  continuing 
only  a  few  hours  open;  but  there  is  a  succession  of  them  daily  for  a 
considerable  time,  in  June,  July,  and  August.  It  has  been  long 
known  by  the  title  of  Venice  Mallow. 

There  are  varieties  with  erect  purplish  stems,  and  the  flowers 
larger,  and  their  colour  deeper;  and  with  large  paler-coloured 
flowers. 


225 

The  third,  in  its  native  situation,  grows  to  the  size  of  an  ordinary 
tree;  but  here  it  is  shrubby,  the  stem  round,  erect,  with  alternate, 
spreading  branches,  that  are  wand-like,  leafy,  brownish-green,  and 
nearly  smooth :  the  leaves  alternate,  spreading,  unequally  and 
coarsely  serrate,  entire  at  the  base,  five-nerved,  bright  green,  very 
smooth,  except  the  young  ones,  which  are  slightly  downy;  their  pe- 
tioles are  round,  downy  on  the  upper  side:  the  stipules  in  pairs, 
opposite,  at  the  base  of  the  petioles,  linear,  acute,  deciduous :  the 
flowers  axillary,  solitary,  peduncled,  large,  of  a  deep  scarlet  colour, 
resembling  a  double  rose.  It  is  common  in  China  and  the  East 
Indies.  It  is  rare  with  single  flowers. 

The  fourth  species  has  a  pale  stem,  single,  smooth,  spreading  out 
wide  into  leafy  branches  at  top;  the  wood  resembling  that  of  the 
fig:  the  leaves  are  the  same  size  with  those  of  the  vine,  having  the 
roughness  of  fig  leaves,  and  the  form  of  both,  or  rather  of  the  angu- 
lar leaves  of  ivy;  whitish  underneath :  the  petioles  rough,  thick,  three 
or  four  inches  in  length:  the  peduncles  thicker  towards  the  top, 
sometimes  tinged  with  red,  sustaining  large  handsome  flowers,  which 
alter  in  their  colour,  as  at  their  first  opening  they  are  white,  then 
they  change  to  a  blush  rose-colour,  and  as  they  decay  they  turn  to 
a  purple.  Marty n  remarks,  that  in  the  West  Indies  all  their  altera- 
tions happen  the  same  day;  but  that  in  England,  where  the  flowers 
last  near  a  week  in  beauty,  the  changes  are  not  so  sudden.  It  is  a 
native  of  the  East  Indies,  £c.  The  period  of  its  blowing  in  the  stoves 
of  this  climate  is  November  and  December. 

It  varies  with  double  flowers,  from  which  the  single  is  frequently 
produced ;  but  the  seeds  of  the  single  seldom  vary  to  the  double 
kind. 

Culture. — The  first  sort  is  increased  by  seeds,  layers,  and  cuttings. 

The  seeds  should  be  procured  from  abroad,  and  sown  in  pols 
filled  with  light  earth  in  the  early  spring  months,  plunging  them  in 
a  gentle  hot-bed  to  bring  them  forward,  or  on  a  border  in  a  warm 
exposure.  They  should  be  watered  during  the  summer,  and  be  pro- 
tected from  frost  in  the  winter.  When  they  have  had  two  year? 

2  G 


226 

growth,  they  may  be  set  out  in  nursery  rows,  or  be  planted  where 
they  are  to  remain. 

The  layers  should  be  laid  down  in  the  autumn,  the  shoots  being 
cut  on  the  backs  at  one  or  two  joints,  and  well  laid  into  the  ground. 
They  are  generally  well  rooted  in  twelve  months,  when  they  may  be 
taken  off  and  removed  to  where  they  are  to  remain. 

The  cuttings  of  the  young  shoots  should  be  planted  in  pots  of 
light  earth  in  the  early  spring,  plunging  them  in  a  mild  hot-bed ;  or 
they  may  be  planted  in  a  shady  border  in  the  summer  season.  When 
well  rooted,  they  should  be  carefully  taken  up  and  planted  where 
they  are  to  remain,  either  in  the  autumn  or  spring. 

The  second  sort  is  increased  by  sowing  the  seed  either  in  the  au- 
tumn or  spring,  in  the  places  where  the  plants  are  to  flower,  in  patches 
of  several  seeds  together.  When  they  come  up,  they  should  be  thin- 
ned out  to  two  or  three  plants  in  each  patch. 

The  two  last  sorts  may  be  increased  by  sowing  the  seeds  in  the 
early  spring  months,  in  pots  filled  with  rich  light  mould,  plunging 
them  in  a  moderate  hot-bed  under  glasses,  or,  what  is  better,  in  the 
bark-bed  of  the  stove.  When  the  plants  are  up,  and  have  attained 
two  or  three  inches  in  growth,  they  should  be  removed  into  separate 
small  pots,  watering  them  well,  and  replunging  them  in  the  hot-bed, 
where  they  must  be  kept. 

They  may  likewise  sometimes  be  raised  by  planting  cuttings  of 
the  young  shoots  in  pots  of  the  same  sort  of  earth,  in  the  spring  or 
summer,  giving  them  water,  and  plunging  them  in  the  bark  hot-bed. 
They  should  afterwards  be  managed  as  the  others. 

The  two  first  hardy  sorts  are  highly  ornamental  in  the  borders  and 
clumps,  among  other  flowery  plants;  and  the  two  last  tender  sorts 
produce  much  variety  by  their  beautiful  flowers  in  the  stove  and  con- 
servatory collections. 


LIBRARY 

UNIVERSITY  OF  f*^EY 

,<sk  from  which  borrowed. 
Reti-DUE  on  the  last  date  stamped  below. 
ThisL 


"UMar'SOAR 


REC'D  LD 

SCP  JO  195S 


REC'D  LD 

APR  JO  1969 
KEC'DLD 


EC'DLD     JUL9 

1  2  1981 

REJCEIVED  BY 

nicao  1980 
OCT17197359 

CIRCULATION  DEFT. 


LD  21-100m-ll,'49(B7146sl6)476 


m 

JUL  28  1930 
131930 

NOV  2 


UNIVERSITY  OF  CALIFORNIA  UBRARY 


-4,